More annual reports from null:
2023 ReportPeers and competitors of null:
Diversified Royalty Corp.CODI 14 EXECUTING OUR STRATEGY 3 LETTER TO SHAREHOLDERS 4 2014 HIGHLIGHTS 5 OUR COMPANIES 14 CODI GOVERNANCE 16 CODI INFORMATION 17 FINANCIAL REVIEW CODI 14 CODI EXECUTING OUR STRATEGY Compass Diversified Holdings (“CODI”) offers shareowners an opportunity to own profitable middle market businesses with leading market positions in the branded products and niche industrial industries. We own controlling interests in ALL of our subsidiaries, enabling us to take a focused and proactive approach to managing THEM in order to create value for our shareowners. We are exceedingly disciplined with respect to due diligence, valuation, terms and niche market leadership when identifying potential new subsidiaries. Our shareowners deserve – AND We deliver – an extraordinarily high level of transparency in our financial reporting and governance processes. As of December 31, 2014, CODI’s subsidiaries consisted of three branded products and six niche industrial companies. We believe that these businesses will continue to produce stable and growing cash flows, allowing us to invest in their long-term growth and to make cash distributions to our shareowners. In addition, we own approximately 41% of FOX Factory Holding Corp. (Nasdaq: FOXF) previously a subsidiary company that went public in August 2013. LETTER TO SHAREOWNERS Dear Fellow Shareowners, 2014 was an active year with many notable achievements for Compass Diversified Holdings as we continued to execute on our strategy of creating value for you by allocating capital in a patient and disciplined manner and growing the cash flows of our niche market leading subsidiary businesses. Our subsidiaries delivered another strong year of performance. On a consolidated basis, and pro forma excluding Fox Factory Holding Corp. (“Fox”), which we took public in 2013, and including Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. (“Clean Earth”) and Candle Lamp Company, LLC (“SternoCandleLamp”), which we acquired in 2014, subsidiary revenue and EBITDA increased 3.0% and 2.9%, respectively, in 2014 versus 2013. Our Niche Industrial group posted a strong performance, with revenue and EBITDA increases of 6.4% and 17.5%, respectively. Our Branded Products group experienced declines of 3.8% and 12.3% in revenue and EBITDA, respectively, due largely to the adverse impact of industry conditions that led to significant year-over-year underperformance at one of our subsidiaries, Liberty Safe. Excluding Liberty Safe, which we are pleased to report is poised in 2015 to resume operating in line with historical levels of performance, the Branded Products group generated increases in revenue and EBITDA of 11.4% and 13.1%, respectively. We believe that both groups remain well positioned to continue to deliver growth in earnings and cash flow going forward. After an extended period of time during which we were unable to acquire new subsidiary companies due to pricing levels that we did not believe presented appropriate risk-adjusted returns, we successfully completed the acquisition of two new subsidiaries that met our thresholds. In August, we acquired Clean Earth and in October, we acquired SternoCandleLamp. Both subsidiaries are additions to our Niche Industrial group and share the characteristics that we seek in all of our subsidiaries – niche market leading companies with exceptional management teams serving industries with favorable macroeconomic outlooks and having a demonstrated history of and potential for stable and growing revenue and cash flow. Further, in December, Clean Earth enhanced its growth potential with the accretive add-on acquisition of AES Environmental. The debt and equity capital markets continued to support our strategy and business model in 2014, enabling us to strengthen our financial and liquidity position. In June, we refinanced our credit facilities, lowering our borrowing costs, extending our maturities and increasing our debt capacity to support future growth. In addition, we completed a public offering of our stock in November, after the completion of our acquisitions of Clean Earth and SternoCandleLamp, and utilized the proceeds to reduce our outstanding borrowings and, like our debt refinancing, increase available capital to sustain our growth initiatives. In addition to our acquisitions, in July we completed a partial divestiture of our Fox shares reducing our ownership to approximately 41%. As you will recall, we successfully completed an initial public offering of FOX in 2013 and retained 54% ownership of our former subsidiary in the form of common stock following Fox’s IPO. Our partial sale enhanced our liquidity and increased the realized gains from opportunistic divestitures for our shareowners. In addition, reducing our ownership to 41% of Fox allowed us to deconsolidate it from our financial statements, streamlining our financial reporting. CODI shares have outperformed all of the major indices on a total return basis since our inception as a public company in 2006; however our total return in 2014 lagged the indices. Although we are very disappointed by this, we are confident that if we continue to execute our strategy of allocating capital in a patient and disciplined manner and growing the cash flow of our subsidiaries that we will continue to create value for our shareowners. Entering 2015, we are confident that our subsidiaries are well positioned to continue their strong performance and deliver growing revenue and cash flow. We are unwavering in our strategy to create value for our shareowners and we remain confident in our ability to execute our strategy. We are extremely grateful for the commitment of our talented employees, subsidiary management teams and the almost 3,500 subsidiary employees, as well as our board of directors. They are the engine that drives our ability to create value for our shareowners, and we could not achieve our goals without their extraordinary dedication and commitment. We are also thankful for you, our shareowners, for your support and trust. We are privileged to work on your behalf. Very Truly Yours, Alan B. Offenberg Chief Executive Officer Ryan J. Faulkingham Chief Financial Officer Elias Sabo Founding Partner Compass Group Management 2014 HIGHLIGHTS Completes $725 million in debt financing in June Acquires Clean Earth for $253 million in August Acquires SternoCandleLamp for $163 million in October Executes CODI and FOXF secondary offerings totaling $165 million in net proceeds CODI 139.3% Nasdaq 117.2% DJIA 100.8% S&P 85.6% TOTAL RETURN SINCE IPO: 150 120 90 60 30 0 4 OUR COMPANIES Advanced Circuits/John Yacoub, CEO Clean Earth/ Chris Dods, CEO Arnold Magnetic Technologies/Tim Wilson, CEO Ergobaby/Margaret Hardin, CEO American Furniture/Al Wiygul, CEO Liberty Safe/Kim Waddoups, CEO CamelBak/Sally McCoy, CEO Tridien Medical/Fred Kohnke, Interim CEO SternoCandleLamp/ Don Hinshaw, CEO 5 Headquartered in Los Angeles, California, and founded in 2003, Ergobaby is a premier designer, marketer and distributor of wearable baby carriers and related baby wearing products, stroller travel systems and accessories. Ergobaby products are sold through approximately 450 retailers and web shops in the United States and throughout the world. The company also designs and markets a premium brand of strollers under the Orbit Baby name. Ergobaby’s reputation for product innovation, reliability and safety has led to numerous awards and accolades. TO LEARN MORE ABOUT ERGOBABY AND ORBIT BABY, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.ERGOBABY.COM • WWW.ORBITBABY.COM 6 Headquartered in Petaluma, California, and founded in 1989, CamelBak is a designer of hydration packs, reusable BPA- free water bottles, performance hydration accessories, purification and filtration products and specialized gloves for outdoor, recreation and military use. The company’s reputation as an innovator of best-in-class personal hydration products has enabled CamelBak to establish preferred partnerships with leading national and international retailers, sporting goods stores, independent and chain specialty retailers and the U.S. military. TO LEARN MORE ABOUT CAMELBAK, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.CAMELBAK.COM 7 Headquartered in Payson, Utah, and founded in 1988, Liberty Safe is a designer and manufacturer of premium home and gun safes and accessories. Products are marketed under the Liberty® brand, as well as a portfolio of licensed and private label brands, including Cabela’s® and John Deere®. Liberty Safe’s products are the market share leader and are sold in various sporting goods, and farm and fleet retailers. Liberty also has the largest independent dealer network in the industry. TO LEARN MORE ABOUT LIBERTY SAFE, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.LIBERTYSAFE.COM 8 Headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, and founded in 1990, Clean Earth is a provider of environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials including soils, dredged material, hazardous waste and drill cuttings. Clean Earth analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste streams generated in end-markets such as power, construction, oil & gas, infrastructure, industrial and dredging. Clean Earth operates 12 permitted facilities in the Eastern U.S. TO LEARN MORE ABOUT CLEAN EARTH, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.CLEANEARTHINC.COM ENUE GROWTH AND EBITDA GROWTH OF 38% AND 42% 2013 REVENUE GROWTH AND EBITDA GROWTH OF 38% AND 42% 8% AND 42% 9 Headquartered in Corona, CA, SternoCandleLamp is a manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative table lighting solutions for the foodservice industry. SternoCandleLamp’s product line includes wick and gel chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories, liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps. For over 100 years, the iconic “Sterno” brand has been synonymous with quality canned heat. TO LEARN MORE ABOUT STERNOCANDLELAMP, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.STERNOCANDLELAMP.COM 10 Headquartered in Rochester, New York, and founded in 1895, Arnold Magnetic Technologies is a leading global manufacturer of engineered permanent magnets and precision magnetic assemblies that are mission critical in motors, generators, sensors and other systems and components. With facilities in the United States, the United Kingdom, Switzerland and China, Arnold serves thousands of customers worldwide in diverse end markets including aerospace and defense, energy, automotive, medical and industrial. TO LEARN MORE ABOUT ARNOLD, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.ARNOLDMAGNETICS.COM 11 Headquartered in Aurora, Colorado, and founded in 1989, Advanced Circuits is the preeminent North American manufacturer of quick-turn, small-run and production rigid printed circuit boards (“PCBs”). Customers include research and development professionals from corporations and academic institutions in the United States and Canada. Advanced Circuits is able to meet its over 10,000 customers’ demands for responsiveness, quality and timely delivery by shipping high quality, custom PCBs in as little as 24 hours. TO LEARN MORE ABOUT ADVANCED CIRCUITS, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.4PCB.COM 12 Headquartered in Ecru, Mississippi, and founded in 1998, American Furniture is a leading manufacturer of upholstered furniture targeted at the promotional segment of the furniture industry. American Furniture offers a broad product line of stationary and motion furniture, including sofas, loveseats, sectionals, recliners and accessory products. American Furniture’s merchandising strategy focuses on a limited number of popular, high volume styles and colors adapted from proven designs. TO LEARN MORE ABOUT AMERICAN FURNITURE, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.AMERICANFURN.NET 13 Headquartered in Coral Springs, Florida, and founded in 2006, Tridien is focused on the design and manufacture of medical support surfaces and devices designed to treat and prevent various types of ulcers, frequently formed on immobile patients. Tridien offers its customers a full spectrum of powered and static support surfaces based on both polyurethane foam and air based technologies. Tridien maintains manufacturing operations throughout the United States to better serve its national customer base. TO LEARN MORE ABOUT TRIDIEN, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.TRIDIEN.COM 14 MINORITY EQUITY INVESTMENT IN FOXF OWN 15.1 MILLION SHARES VALUED AT ~$245 MILLION FOX (NASDAQ: FOXF), headquartered in Scotts Valley, California, designs, engineers, manufactures and markets high-performance suspension products for customers world- wide. FOX’s premium brand suspension products are used primarily on mountain bikes, side- by-side vehicles, on-road vehicles with off-road capabilities, off-road vehicles and trucks, all-terrain TO LEARN MORE ABOUT FOX, PLEASE VISIT: WWW.RIDEFOX.COM vehicles, snowmobiles, specialty vehicles and applications, and motorcycles. Some of FOX’s products are specifically designed and marketed to some of the leading original equipment manufacturers, while others are distributed directly to consumers through a global network of dealers and distributors. FOX/Larry Enterline, CEO 15 CODI GOVERNANCE Board of Directors C. Sean Day has served as chairman of the Board since April which is also a NASDAQ listed company. Mr. Edwards is a graduate 2006. Mr. Day has been the president of Seagin International, since of Lewis and Clark College and The Thunderbird School of Global 1999, and he was the chairman of our Manager’s predecessor from Management. 1999 to 2006. Previously, Mr. Day was with Navios Corporation and Citicorp Venture Capital. Mr. Day is currently the chairman of D. Eugene Ewing has served as a director of the Company since the boards of directors of Teekay Corporation; Teekay Offshore April 2006. Mr. Ewing has been the managing member of Deeper GP LLC, the general partner of Teekay Offshore Partners LP; Water Consulting, LLC, a private wealth and business consulting Teekay GP L.L.C., the general partner of Teekay LNG Partners LP; company since March 2004. Previously, Mr. Ewing was with the and a member of the board of directors of Kirby Corporation, all Fifth Third Bank. Prior to that, Mr. Ewing was a partner in Arthur NYSE listed companies. Mr. Day is a graduate of the University of Andersen LLP. Mr. Ewing is a member of the board of directors Capetown and Oxford University. and serves on the audit committee and compensation committee of Darling Ingredients, Inc., a NYSE listed company. Mr. Ewing also James J. Bottiglieri has served as a director of the Company serves on the boards of directors of a private trust company located since December 2005. Mr. Bottiglieri was the Company’s chief in Wyoming and a private consulting company located in California. financial officer and an executive vice president of the Company’s Mr. Ewing also serves on an advisory board to the Gatton College of Manager from 2005 to 2013. Previously, Mr. Bottiglieri was the Business & Economics at the University of Kentucky. Mr. Ewing is a senior vice president/controller of WebMD Corporation. Prior graduate of the University of Kentucky. to that, Mr. Bottiglieri was with Star Gas Corporation and a predecessor firm to KPMG LLP. Mr. Bottiglieri serves as a director Mark H. Lazarus has served as a director of the Company since for the Company’s American Furniture Manufacturing, Inc. April 2006. Mr. Lazarus has been the president and chairman of subsidiary. Mr. Bottiglieri also serves on the board of directors and is NBC Universal Sports Group since January 2011. Previously, Mr. the chairman of the audit committee of Horizon Technology Finance Lazarus was a senior sports adviser for Comcast Corporation, a Corporation, a NASDAQ listed company. Mr. Bottiglieri is a graduate NASDAQ listed company, since December 2010, the president, of Pace University. media and marketing, of CSE, a sports and entertainment company from 2008 through 2010, and the president of Turner Entertainment Gordon M. Burns has served as a director of the Company since Group from 2003 through 2008. Prior to that, Mr. Lazarus served in May 2008. Mr. Burns has been a private investor since 1998. Previously, a variety of other roles for Turner Broadcasting and also worked for he was responsible for investment banking at UBS Securities and Backer, Spielvogel, Bates, Inc. and NBC Cable. Mr. Lazarus served before that was a managing director at Salomon Brothers Inc. Mr. on the board of directors of Cincinnati Bell, a NYSE listed company, Burns served on the board of directors of Aztar Corporation, a from 2009 through 2011. Mr. Lazarus is a graduate of Vanderbilt NYSE listed company, from 1998 through 2007. Mr. Burns is a University. graduate of Yale University and the Harvard Business School. Harold S. Edwards has served as a director of the Company officer of the Company since February 2011. Mr. Offenberg has also since April 2006. Mr. Edwards has been the president and been a partner of our Manager and its predecessor since 1998. chief executive officer of Limoneira Company, a NASDAQ listed Previously, Mr. Offenberg was with Trigen Energy, Creditanstalt- company, since November 2003. Previously, Mr. Edwards was the Bankverein and GE Capital. Mr. Offenberg currently serves as a president of Puritan Medical Products, a division of Airgas Inc. Prior director for all of our subsidiary companies. Mr. Offenberg serves Alan B. Offenberg has served as a director and chief executive to that, Mr. Edwards held management positions with Fisher Scientific International, Inc., Cargill, Inc., Agribrands International and the Ralston Purina Company. Mr. Edwards is currently a member of the boards of directors of Limoneira Company and Calavo Growers, Inc., 16 as the chairman of American Furniture a Manufacturing, Inc., CamelBak MM Products, LLC, and Clean Earth, Inc. Mr. Offenberg is a graduate of Tulane University and the Northeastern University Graduate School of Business. The Audit Committee is comprised entirely of independent directors who meet the independence requirements of the New York Stock Exchange and includes at least one “audit committee financial expert,” as required by applicable SEC regulations. The audit committee is responsible for, among other things: • retaining and overseeing our independent accountants; • assisting the Company’s board of directors in its oversight of the integrity of our financial statements, the qualifications, independence and performance of our COMMITTEES The Company’s operating agreement gives our board the authority to delegate its powers to committees independent auditors and our compliance with legal and regulatory requirements; appointed by the board. • reviewing and approving the plan and scope of the internal and external audit; • pre-approving any non-audit services provided by our independent auditors; • approving the fees to be paid to our independent auditors; All of our standing committees are comprised • reviewing with our chief executive officer and chief financial officer and independent solely of independent auditors the adequacy and effectiveness of our internal controls; • preparing the audit committee report to be filed with the SEC; • reviewing hedging transactions; and directors. We have three standing committees - the • reviewing and assessing annually the audit committee’s performance and the audit committee, the adequacy of its charter. compensation committee Messrs. Burns, Ewing, and Edwards serve on our audit committee, and the board has determined and the nominating and corporate governance committee. that Mr. Ewing qualifies as an audit committee financial expert as defined by the SEC. The Compensation Committee is comprised entirely of independent directors who meet the independence requirements of the New York Stock Exchange. The responsibilities of the compensation committee include: • reviewing our manager’s performance of its obligations under the management services agreement; • reviewing the remuneration of our manager and approving the reimbursement paid to our manager for the compensation of its financial staff; • determining the compensation of our independent directors; • granting rights to indemnification and reimbursement of expenses to our manager; and • making recommendations to the Board regarding equity-based and incentive compensation plans, polices and programs. Messrs. Edwards, Ewing and Lazarus serve on our compensation committee. The Nominating & Corporate Governance Committee is comprised entirely of independent directors who meet the independence requirements of the New York Stock Exchange. The nominating and corporate governance committee is responsible for, among other things: • • recommending the number of directors to comprise the board of directors; identifying and evaluating individuals qualified to become members of the board of directors and soliciting recommendations for director nominees from the chairman and chief executive officer of the company; • recommending to the board of directors the directors’ nominees for each annual shareholders’ meeting; • recommending to the board of directors the candidates for filling vacancies that may occur between annual shareholders’ meetings; • reviewing independent director compensation and board processes, self-evaluations and polices; • overseeing compliance with our code of ethics and conduct by our officers and directors; and • monitoring developments in the law and practice of corporate governance. Messrs. Lazarus, Burns, and Edwards serve on our nominating and corporate governance committee. 17 CODI INFORMATION Distributions Paid Since IPO ) e r a h s r e p ( i d a P s n o i t u b i r t s D i Distributions Paid Per Year Cumulative Distributions Paid Trading Our stock trades on the NYSE under the symbol “CODI”. During fiscal year 2014, the highest and lowest trading prices per share were $18.45 and $15.89, respectively. As of December 31, 2014, we had 54,300,000 shares outstanding that were held by approximately 30,000 beneficial holders. Distributions Our board of directors declared distributions of $1.44 per share for the year ended December 31, 2014. The declaration and payment of any distribution is subject to a decision by our board of directors. In making such a decision, our board will take into account such matters as general business conditions, our specific financial condition, results of operations and capital requirements, as well as any other factors that it deems relevant. Tax Reporting CODI shareholders receive their tax information on a Form K-1. We endeavor to provide this tax information as early as possible, and made information for tax year 2014 available for our shareholders as of February 27, 2015. Tax information is both mailed to shareholders and is available on our website. We expect the items of income reported on Form K-1 to our shareholders to remain fairly limited, and to include interest income, dividend income, capital gains, interest expense and other expense. Website CODI’s website is www.compassdiversifiedholdings.com. On our website, shareholders can find our press releases, documents filed with the SEC, investor events, and tax reporting, as well as information on our corporate 18 governance policies and procedures, subsidiary companies, and board of directors. FINANCIAL INFORMATION 19 UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION Washington, D.C. 20549 Form 10-K ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014 or TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 For the transition period from to Commission File Number: 001-34927 Compass Diversified Holdings (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter) Delaware (Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization) 57-6218917 (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) Commission File Number: 001-34926 Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter) Delaware (Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization) Sixty One Wilton Road Second Floor Westport, CT (Address of principal executive offices) 20-3812051 (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) 06880 (Zip Code) (203) 221-1703 (Registrants’ telephone number, including area code) Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: Title of Each Class Shares representing beneficial interests in Compass Diversified Holdings (“trust shares”) Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered New York Stock Exchange Securities registered pursuant to Section 12 (g) of the Act: None Indicate by check mark if the registrants are collectively a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes No Indicate by check mark if the registrants are collectively not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes No Indicate by check mark whether the registrants (1) have filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrants were required to file such reports), and (2) have been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes No Indicate by check mark whether the registrants have submitted electronically and posted on their corporate website, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes No Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrants’ knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. Indicate by check mark whether the registrants are collectively a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer”, “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one): Large accelerated filer Non-accelerated filer Accelerated filer Smaller reporting company Indicate by check mark whether the registrants are collectively a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes No The aggregate market value of the outstanding shares of trust stock held by non-affiliates of Compass Diversified Holdings at June 30, 2014 was $719,930,250 based on the closing price on the New York Stock Exchange on that date. For purposes of the foregoing calculation only, all directors and officers of the registrant have been deemed affiliates. There were 54,300,000 shares of trust stock without par value outstanding at February 27, 2015. Certain information in the registrant’s definitive proxy statement to be filed with the Commission relating to the registrant’s 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders is incorporated by reference into Part III. Documents Incorporated by Reference Table of Contents Business Risk Factors Unresolved Staff Comments Properties Legal Proceedings Mine Safety Disclosures Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities Selected Financial Data Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk Financial Statements and Supplementary Data Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure Controls and Procedures Other Information Directors, and Executive Officers and Corporate Governance Executive Compensation Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters Certain Relationships and Related Transactions and Director Independence Principal Accountant Fees and Services Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules Page 5 65 78 79 81 81 82 85 88 128 129 129 129 130 130 130 130 131 131 F-1 PART I Item 1. Item 1A. Item 1B. Item 2. Item 3. Item 4. PART II Item 5. Item 6. Item 7. Item 7A. Item 8. Item 9. Item 9A. Item 9B. PART III Item 10. Item 11. Item 12. Item 13. Item 14. PART IV Item 15. 2 In reading this Annual Report on Form 10-K, references to: (cid:2)OTE TO READER • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • the “Trust” and “Holdings” refer to Compass Diversified Holdings; the “Company” refer to Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC; “businesses”, “operating segments”, “subsidiaries” and “reporting units” all refer to, collectively, the businesses controlled by the Company; the “Manager” refer to Compass Group Management LLC (“CGM”); the “initial businesses” refer to, collectively, Staffmark Holdings, Inc., Crosman Acquisition Corporation, Compass AC Holdings, Inc. and Silvue Technologies Group, Inc.; the “2012 acquisition” refer to the acquisition of Arnold Magnetic Technologies; the "2014 acquisitions" refer to, collectively, the acquisitions of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and SternoCandleLamp; the “2012 disposition” refer to the sale of HALO Branded Solutions.; the “Trust Agreement” refer to the amended and restated Trust Agreement of the Trust dated as of April 25, 2007; the “2011 Credit Facility” refer to the Credit Facility with a group of lenders led by TD Securities (USA) LLC (“TD Securities”) which provided for the 2011 Revolving Credit Facility and the 2011 Term Loan Facility; the "2014 Credit Facility" refer to the credit agreement entered into on June 14, 2014 with a group of lenders led by Bank of America (cid:2).A. as administartive agent, which provides for a Revolving Credit Facility and a Term Loan; the “2014 Revolving Credit Facility” refer to the $400 million Revolving Credit Facility provided by the 2014 Credit Facility that matures in June 2019; the “2014 Term Loan” refer to the $325 million Term Loan Facility, provided by the 2014 Credit Facility that matures in June 2021; the “LLC Agreement” refer to the fourth amended and restated operating agreement of the Company dated as of January 1, 2012; “we”, “us” and “our” refer to the Trust, the Company and the businesses together. 3 Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Disclosure This Annual Report on Form 10-K, including the sections entitled “Risk Factors,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and “Business,” contains forward-looking statements. We may, in some cases, use words such as “project,” “predict,” “believe,” “anticipate,” “plan,” “expect,” “estimate,” “intend,” “should,” “would,” “could,” “potentially,” or “may” or other words that convey uncertainty of future events or outcomes to identify these forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements in this Annual Report on Form 10-K are subject to a number of risks and uncertainties, some of which are beyond our control, including, among other things: • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • our ability to successfully operate our businesses on a combined basis, and to effectively integrate and improve any future acquisitions; our ability to remove our Manager and our Manager’s right to resign; our trust and organizational structure, which may limit our ability to meet our dividend and distribution policy; our ability to service and comply with the terms of our indebtedness; our cash flow available for distribution and our ability to make distributions in the future to our shareholders; our ability to pay the management fee, and profit allocation when due; our ability to make and finance future acquisitions; our ability to implement our acquisition and management strategies; the regulatory environment in which our businesses operate; trends in the industries in which our businesses operate; changes in general economic or business conditions or economic or demographic trends in the United States and other countries in which we have a presence, including changes in interest rates and inflation; environmental risks affecting the business or operations of our businesses; our and our Manager’s ability to retain or replace qualified employees of our businesses and our Manager; costs and effects of legal and administrative proceedings, settlements, investigations and claims; and extraordinary or force majeure events affecting the business or operations of our businesses. Our actual results, performance, prospects or opportunities could differ materially from those expressed in or implied by the forward-looking statements. A description of some of the risks that could cause our actual results to differ appears under the section “Risk Factors”. Additional risks of which we are not currently aware or which we currently deem immaterial could also cause our actual results to differ. In light of these risks, uncertainties and assumptions, you should not place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements. The forward-looking events discussed in this Annual Report on Form 10-K may not occur. These forward-looking statements are made as of the date of this Annual Report. We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements to reflect subsequent events or circumstances, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise, except as required by law. 4 ITEM 1. BUSI(cid:2)ESS PART I Compass Diversified Holdings, a Delaware statutory trust (“Holdings”, or the “Trust”), was incorporated in Delaware on (cid:2)ovember 18, 2005. Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability Company (the “Company”), was also formed on (cid:2)ovember 18, 2005. The Trust and the Company (collectively “CODI”) were formed to acquire and manage a group of small and middle-market businesses headquartered in (cid:2)orth America. The Trust is the sole owner of 100% of the Trust Interests, as defined in our LLC Agreement, of the Company. Pursuant to the LLC Agreement, the Trust owns an identical number of Trust Interests in the Company as exist for the number of outstanding shares of the Trust. Accordingly, our shareholders are treated as beneficial owners of Trust Interests in the Company and, as such, are subject to tax under partnership income tax provisions. The Company is the operating entity with a board of directors whose corporate governance responsibilities are similar to that of a Delaware corporation. The Company’s board of directors oversees the management of the Company and our businesses and the performance of Compass Group Management LLC (“CGM” or our “Manager”). Certain persons who are employees and partners of our Manager receive a profit allocation as beneficial owners of 58.8% through Sostratus LLC of the Allocation Interests in us, as defined in our LLC Agreement. Overview We acquire controlling interests in and actively manage businesses that we believe (i) operate in industries with long-term macroeconomic growth opportunities, (ii) have positive and stable cash flows, (iii) face minimal threats of technological or competitive obsolescence and, (iv) have strong management teams largely in place. Our unique public structure provides investors with an opportunity to participate in the ownership and growth of companies which have historically been owned by private equity firms, wealthy individuals or families. Through the acquisition of a diversified group of businesses with these characteristics, we believe we offer investors an opportunity to diversify their own portfolio risk while participating in the ongoing cash flows of those businesses through the receipt of quarterly distributions. Our disciplined approach to our target market provides opportunities to methodically purchase attractive businesses at values that are accretive to our shareholders. For sellers of businesses, our unique financial structure allows us to acquire businesses efficiently with little or no third party financing contingencies and, following acquisition, to provide our businesses with substantial access to growth capital. We believe that private company operators and corporate parents looking to sell their business units may consider us an attractive purchaser because of our ability to: provide ongoing strategic and financial support for their businesses; • • maintain a long-term outlook as to the ownership of those businesses where such an outlook is required for maximization of our shareholders’ return on investment; and consummate transactions efficiently without being dependent on third-party transaction financing. • In particular, we believe that our outlook on length of ownership and active management on our part may alleviate the concern that many private company operators and parent companies may have with regard to their businesses going through multiple sale processes in a short period of time. We believe this outlook reduces both the risk that businesses may be sold at unfavorable points in the overall market cycle and enhances our ability to develop a comprehensive strategy to grow the earnings and cash flows of each of our businesses, which we expect will better enable us to meet our long-term objective of continuing to pay distributions to our shareholders while increasing shareholder value. Finally, it has been our experience, that our ability to acquire businesses without the cumbersome delays and conditions typical of third party transactional financing is appealing to sellers of businesses who are interested in confidentiality and certainty to close. We believe our management team’s strong relationships with industry executives, accountants, attorneys, business brokers, commercial and investment bankers, and other potential sources of acquisition opportunities offer us substantial opportunities to assess small to middle market businesses available for acquisition. In addition, the flexibility, creativity, experience and expertise of our management team in structuring transactions allows us to consider non-traditional and complex transactions tailored to fit a specific acquisition target. In terms of the businesses in which we have a controlling interest as of December 31, 2014, we believe that these businesses have strong management teams, operate in strong markets with defensible market niches and maintain long standing customer 5 relationships. We believe that the strength of this model, which provides for significant industry, customer and geographic diversity, has become even more apparent in the recent challenging economic environment. 2014 Highlights Acquisition of Clean Earth On August 26, 2014, we purchased a 97.9% controlling interest (86.2% on a fully diluted basis) in Clean Earth Holdings Inc. ("Clean Earth"). Founded in 1990 and headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, Clean Earth is a provider of environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials. Clean Earth provides a one-stop shop solution that analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste streams generated in multiple end-markets such as power, construction, commercial development, oil & gas, infrastructure, industrial and dredging. Approximately 98% of the material processed by Clean Earth is beneficially reused for such purposes as daily landfill cover, industrial and brownfield redevelopment projects. The purchase price, including proceeds from non-controlling interests, was approximately $251.4 million and was based on a total enterprise value of $243 million and included approximately $10.3 million in cash and working capital adjustments and $1.9 million in acquisition related costs. We funded the acquisition through available cash on hand and a draw of $95 million on our Revolving Credit Facility. Clean Earth’s management invested in the transaction alongside us, collectively representing approximately 2.1% in initial non-controlling interest on a primary basis. CGM acted as an advisor to us in the acquisition and will continue to provide integration services during the first year of our ownership of Clean Earth. CGM will receive integration service fees of approximately $2.5 million which will be payable quarterly as services are rendered. Clean Earth paid CGM $0.6 million in integration service fees during 2014. Acquisition of SternoCandleLamp On October 10, 2014, we purchased all of the issued and outstanding equity of Candle Lamp Company, LLC ("SternoCandleLamp"). Headquartered in Corona, California, SternoCandleLamp is the leading manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative table lighting solutions for the foodservice industry. SternoCandleLamp’s product line includes wick and gel chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories, liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps. The purchase price was approximately $160.0 million and was based on a total enterprise value of $161.5 million and included approximately $1.3 million in working capital adjustments and $2.8 million in acquisition related costs. We funded the acquisition through available cash on hand and a drawing of approximately $166 million on our Revolving Credit Facility. CGM acted as an advisor to us in the acquisition and will continue to provide integration services during the first year of our ownership of SternoCandleLamp. CGM will receive integration service fees of approximately $1.5 million which will be payable quarterly as services are rendered. SternoCandleLamp paid CGM $0.4 million in integration service fees during 2014. Sale of FOX Common Stock On July 10, 2014, 5,750,000 shares of Fox Factory Holding Corp. ("FOX") common stock, held by certain FOX shareholders, including us, were sold in a secondary offering at a price of $15.50 per share for total net proceeds to selling shareholders of approximately $84.4 million (the "FOX Secondary Offering"). As a selling shareholder, we sold a total of 4,466,569 shares of FOX common stock, including 633,955 shares sold in connection with underwriters’ exercise of the over-allotment option in full, for total net proceeds of approximately $65.5 million. Upon completion of the offering, our ownership in FOX decreased from approximately 53% to 41%, or 15,108,718 shares of FOX’s common stock and as a result we deconsolidated FOX as of July 10, 2014 which is consistent with our intention to streamline our consolidated financial reporting. We recorded a gain of $264.2 million in July 2014 in connection with the FOX deconsolidation. Debt Refinancing On June 6, 2014, we obtained a $725 million credit facility led by Bank of America, (cid:2).A., as Administrative Agent for a group of lenders. The 2014 Credit Facility provides for (i) revolving loans, swing line loans and letters of credit up to a maximum aggregate amount of $400 million (the "2014 Revolving Credit Facility"), and (ii) a $325 million term loan (the "2014 Term Loan"). The 2014 Term Loan was issued at an original issuance discount of 99.5% of par value. The 2014 Term Loan requires quarterly payments of $812,500 commencing September 30, 2014 with a final payment of all remaining principal and interest due on June 6, 2021, which is the 2014 Term Loan maturity date. All amounts outstanding under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility will become due on June 6, 2019, which is the maturity date of loans advanced under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility and the 6 termination date of the revolving loan commitment. The 2014 Credit Facility also permits us, prior to the applicable maturity date, to increase the revolving loan commitment and/or obtain additional term loans in an aggregate amount of up to $200 million subject to certain restrictions and conditions. We used approximately $290.0 million of the 2014 Term Loan proceeds to pay all amounts outstanding under the 2011 Credit Facility and to pay the closing costs. In addition, at closing, approximately $1.2 million of the revolving loan commitment was utilized in connection with the issuance of letters of credit. Future advances under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility will be used to finance working capital, capital expenditures and other general corporate purposes (including funding acquisitions of additional businesses, permitted distributions and loans to our businesses and, in the case of any incremental loans that are term loans, to repay amounts outstanding under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. Secondary Offering On (cid:2)ovember 14, 2014, we completed a public offering of 6,000,000 Trust shares at an offering price of $17.50 per share. The net proceeds to us, after deducting the underwriter's discount and offering costs, totaled approximately $99.9 million. 2014 Distributions For the 2014 fiscal year we declared and paid distributions to our shareholders totaling $1.44 per share. The following is a brief summary of the businesses in which we own a controlling interest at December 31, 2014: Branded Products Businesses CamelBak CamelBak Products LLC (“CamelBak”), headquartered in Petaluma, California, is a diversified hydration and personal protection platform offering products for outdoor, recreation and military applications. CamelBak offers a broad range of recreational / military hydration packs, reusable water bottles, specialized military gloves and performance accessories. We made loans to, and purchased a controlling interest in, CamelBak on August 24, 2011 for approximately $211.6 million. We currently own 89.9% of the outstanding stock of CamelBak on a primary basis and 79.7% on a fully diluted basis. Ergobaby Ergobaby Carrier, Inc. (“Ergobaby”), headquartered in Los Angeles, California, is a premier designer, manufacturer and distributor of wearable baby carriers and related baby wearing products, as well as stroller travel systems and accessories. Ergobaby’s reputation for product innovation, reliability and safety has led to numerous awards and accolades from consumers, industry experts and publications. Ergobaby offers a broad range of wearable baby carriers, stroller travel systems and related products that are sold through more than 450 retailers and web shops in the United States and internationally. We made loans to, and purchased a controlling interest in, Ergobaby on September 16, 2010 for approximately $85.2 million. We currently own 81.0% of the outstanding stock of Ergobaby on a primary basis and 74.3% on a fully diluted basis. Liberty Safe Liberty Safe and Security Products, Inc. (“Liberty Safe” or “Liberty”), headquartered in Payson, Utah, is a designer, manufacturer and marketer of premium home and gun safes in (cid:2)orth America. From it’s over 300,000 square foot manufacturing facility, Liberty produces a wide range of home and gun safe models in a broad assortment of sizes, features and styles. We made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Liberty Safe on March 31, 2010 for approximately $70.2 million. We currently own 96.2% of the outstanding stock of Liberty Safe on a primary basis and 84.8% on a fully diluted basis. 7 (cid:2)iche Industrial Businesses Advanced Circuits Compass AC Holdings, Inc. (“Advanced Circuits” or “ACI”), headquartered in Aurora, Colorado, is a provider of small-run, quick- turn and volume production rigid printed circuit boards, or “PCBs”, throughout the United States. PCBs are a vital component of virtually all electronic products. The small-run and quick-turn portions of the PCB industry are characterized by customers requiring high levels of responsiveness, technical support and timely delivery. We made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Advanced Circuits, on May 16, 2006, for approximately $81.0 million. We currently own 69.4% of the outstanding stock of Advanced Circuits on a primary basis and 69.3% on a fully diluted basis. American Furniture AFM Holding Corporation (“American Furniture” or “AFM”) headquartered in Ecru, Mississippi, is a leader in the manufacturing of low-cost upholstered stationary and motion furniture, including sofas, loveseats, sectionals, recliners and complementary products to the promotional furniture market. We made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in AFM on August 31, 2007 for approximately $97.0 million. We currently own approximately 99.9% of AFM’s outstanding stock on a primary and fully diluted basis. Arnold AMT Acquisition Corporation (“Arnold” or “Arnold Magnetics”), headquartered in Rochester, (cid:2)Y, with nine additional facilities worldwide, is a manufacturer of engineered, application specific permanent magnets. Arnold Magnetics products are used in applications such as general industrial, reprographic systems, aerospace and defense, advertising and promotional, consumer and appliance, energy, automotive and medical technology. Arnold Magnetics is the largest U.S. manufacturer of engineered magnets as well as only one of two domestic producers to design, engineer and manufacture rare earth magnetic solutions. We made loans to, and purchased a controlling interest in Arnold on March 5, 2012 for approximately $128.8 million. We currently own 96.7% of the outstanding stock of Arnold on a primary basis and 87.5% on a fully diluted basis. Clean Earth Clean Earth, headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, is a provider of environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials. Clean Earth provides a one-stop shop solution that analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste streams generated in multiple end-markets such as power, construction, commercial development, oil and gas, infrastructure, industrial and dredging. We made loans to, and purchased a controlling interest in, Clean Earth on August 26, 2014 for approximately $251.4 million. We currently own 97.9% of the outstanding stock of Clean Earth on a primary basis and 86.2% on a fully diluted basis. SternoCandleLamp SternoCandleLamp, headquartered in Corona, California, is a leading manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming devices and creative table lighting solutions for the food service industry. SternoCandleLamp's product line includes wick and chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories , liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps. We made loans to and purchased all of the equity interests in SternoCandleLamp on October 10, 2014 for approximately $160.0 million. We currently own 100% of the outstanding stock of SternoCandleLamp on a primary basis and 91.7% on a fully diluted basis. Tridien Anodyne Medical Device, Inc. (“Anodyne”, which was rebranded as “Tridien” in September 2010) headquartered in Coral Springs, Florida, is a leading designer and manufacturer of powered and non-powered medical therapeutic support services and patient positioning devices serving the acute care, long-term care and home health care markets. Tridien is one of the nation’s leading designers and manufacturers of specialty therapeutic support surfaces and is able to manufacture products in multiple locations to better serve a national customer base. We made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Tridien from CGI on August 1, 2006 for approximately $31.0 million. We currently own 81.3% of the outstanding capital stock on a primary basis and 65.4% on a fully diluted basis. 8 Our businesses also represent our operating segments. See—“Our Businesses” and “(cid:2)ote F – “Operating Segment Data” to our Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion of our businesses as our operating segments. We also own approximately 41% of the outstanding shares of FOX, which is accounted for as an equity method investment. FOX is headquartered in Scotts Valley, California, and is a designer, manufacturer and marketer of high-performance suspension products used primarily on mountain bikes, side-by-side vehicles, on-road vehicles with off-road capabilities, off-road vehicles and trucks, all-terrain vehicles, or ATVs, snowmobiles, specialty vehicles and applications, and motorcycles. Tax Reporting Information returns will be filed by the Trust and the Company with the IRS, as required, with respect to income, gain, loss, deduction and other items derived from the Company’s activities. The Company has and will file a partnership return with the IRS and intends to issue a Schedule K-1 to the trustee. The trustee intends to provide information to each holder of shares using a monthly convention as the calculation period. For 2014 and future years, the Trust will continue to file a Form 1065 and issue Schedule K-1 to shareholders. For 2014, we delivered the Schedule K-1 to shareholders within the same time frame as we delivered the schedule to shareholders for the 2013 and 2012 taxable years. The relevant and necessary information for tax purposes is readily available electronically through our website. Each holder will be deemed to have consented to provide relevant information, and if the shares are held through a broker or other nominee, to allow such broker or other nominee to provide such information as is reasonably requested by us for purposes of complying with our tax reporting obligations. WHERE YOU CA(cid:2) FI(cid:2)D ADDITIO(cid:2)AL I(cid:2)FORMATIO(cid:2) We have filed with the SEC Forms S-1 and S-3 under the Securities Act, and Forms 10-Q, 10-K, and 8-K under the Exchange Act, which include exhibits, schedules and amendments. In addition, copies of such reports are available free of charge that can be accessed indirectly through our website http://www.compassdiversifiedholdings.com and are available as soon as reasonably practicable after such documents are electronically filed or furnished with the SEC. 9 1) 2) 3) 4) CGI and its affiliates beneficially own approximately 14.6% of the Trust shares and is our single largest holder. Mr. Offenberg, our Chief Executive Officer, is not a director, officer or member of CGI or any of its affiliates. 58.8% beneficially owned by certain persons who are employees and partners of our Manager. Mr. Day, the Chairman of our Board of Directors, CGI and the former founding partner of the Manager, are non-managing members. Mr. Offenberg is a partner of this entity. The Allocation Interests, which carry the right to receive a profit allocation, represent less than 0.1% equity interest in the Company. Our Manager Our Manager, CGM, has been engaged to manage the day-to-day operations and affairs of the Company and to execute our strategy, as discussed below. Our management team has worked together since 1998. Collectively, our management team has extensive experience in acquiring and managing small and middle market businesses. We believe our Manager is unique in the marketplace in terms of the success and experience of its employees in acquiring and managing diverse businesses of the size and general nature of our businesses. We believe this experience will provide us with an advantage in executing our overall strategy. Our management team devotes a majority of its time to the affairs of the Company. We have entered into a management services agreement, (the “Management Services Agreement” or “MSA”) pursuant to which our Manager manages the day-to-day operations and affairs of the Company and oversees the management and operations of our 10 businesses. We pay our Manager a quarterly management fee for the services it performs on our behalf. In addition, certain persons who are employees and partners of our Manager receive a profit allocation with respect to its Allocation Interests in us. All of the Allocation Interests in us are owned by Sostratus LLC. See Part III, Item 13 “Certain Relationships and Related Transactions” for further descriptions of the management fees and profit allocations. The Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer are employees of our Manager and have been seconded to us. (cid:2)either the Trust nor the Company has any other employees. Although our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer are employees of our Manager, they report directly to the Company’s board of directors. The management fee paid to our Manager covers all expenses related to the services performed by our Manager, including the compensation of our Chief Executive Officer and other personnel providing services to us. The Company reimburses our Manager for the salary and related costs and expenses of our Chief Financial Officer and his staff, who dedicate substantially all of their time to the affairs of the Company. See Part III, Item 13, “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions and Director Independence.” Market Opportunity We acquire and actively manage small and middle market businesses. We characterize small to middle market businesses as those that generate annual cash flows of up to $60 million. We believe that the merger and acquisition market for small to middle market businesses is highly fragmented and provides opportunities to purchase businesses at attractive prices. We believe that the following factors contribute to lower acquisition multiples for small and middle market businesses: • • • • there are fewer potential acquirers for these businesses; third-party financing generally is less available for these acquisitions; sellers of these businesses frequently consider non-economic factors, such as continuing board membership or the effect of the sale on their employees; and these businesses are less frequently sold pursuant to an auction process. Frequently opportunities exist to augment existing management at such businesses and improve the performance of these businesses upon their acquisition. In the past, our management team has acquired businesses that were owned by entrepreneurs or large corporate parents. In these cases, our management team has frequently found that there have been opportunities to further build upon the management teams of acquired businesses beyond those that existed at the time of acquisition. In addition, our management team has frequently found that financial reporting and management information systems of acquired businesses may be improved, both of which can lead to improvements in earnings and cash flow. Finally, because these businesses tend to be too small to have their own corporate development efforts, opportunities frequently exist to assist these businesses as they pursue organic or external growth strategies that were often not pursued by their previous owners. Our Strategy We have two primary strategies that we use in order to provide distributions to our shareholders and increase shareholder value. First, we focus on growing the earnings and cash flow from our acquired businesses. We believe that the scale and scope of our businesses give us a diverse base of cash flow upon which to further build. Second, we identify, perform due diligence on, negotiate and consummate additional platform acquisitions of small to middle market businesses in attractive industry sectors in accordance with acquisition criteria established by the board of directors Management Strategy Our management strategy involves the proactive financial and operational management of the businesses we own in order to increase cash flow, pay distributions to our shareholders and increase shareholder value. Our Manager oversees and supports the management teams of each of our businesses by, among other things: • • • • • • recruiting and retaining talented managers to operate our businesses using structured incentive compensation programs, including non-controlling equity ownership, tailored to each business; regularly monitoring financial and operational performance, instilling consistent financial discipline, and supporting management in the development and implementation of information systems to effectively achieve these goals; assisting management in their analysis and pursuit of prudent organic growth strategies; identifying and working with management to execute attractive external growth and acquisition opportunities; assisting management in controlling and right-sizing overhead costs, particularly in the current challenging economic environment; and forming strong subsidiary level boards of directors to supplement management in their development and implementation of strategic goals and objectives. 11 Specifically, while our businesses have different growth opportunities and potential rates of growth, we expect our Manager to work with the management teams of each of our businesses to increase the value of, and cash generated by, each business through various initiatives, including: • making selective capital investments to expand geographic reach, increase capacity, or reduce manufacturing costs of our businesses; investing in product research and development for new products, processes or services for customers; improving and expanding existing sales and marketing programs; pursuing reductions in operating costs through improved operational efficiency or outsourcing of certain processes and products; and consolidating or improving management of certain overhead functions. • • • • Our businesses typically acquire and integrate complementary businesses. We believe that complementary add-on acquisitions improve our overall financial and operational performance by allowing us to: • • • • • leverage manufacturing and distribution operations; leverage branding and marketing programs, as well as customer relationships; add experienced management or management expertise; increase market share and penetrate new markets; and realize cost synergies by allocating the corporate overhead expenses of our businesses across a larger number of businesses and by implementing and coordinating improved management practices. We incur third party debt financing almost entirely at the Company level, which we use, in combination with our equity capital, to provide debt financing to each of our businesses and to acquire additional businesses. We believe this financing structure is beneficial to the financial and operational activities of each of our businesses by aligning our interests as both equity holders of, and lenders to, our businesses, in a manner that we believe is more efficient than each of our businesses borrowing from third- party lenders. Acquisition Strategy Our acquisition strategy involves the acquisition of businesses that we expect to produce stable and growing earnings and cash flow. In this respect, we expect to make acquisitions in industries other than those in which our businesses currently operate if we believe an acquisition presents an attractive opportunity. We believe that attractive opportunities will continue to present themselves, as private sector owners seek to monetize their interests in longstanding and privately-held businesses and large corporate parents seek to dispose of their “non-core” operations. Our ideal acquisition candidate has the following characteristics: is an established (cid:2)orth American based company; • • maintains a significant market share in defensible industry niche (i.e., has a “reason to exist”); • • • maintains a diversified customer and supplier base. has a solid and proven management team with meaningful incentives; has low technological and/or product obsolescence risk; and We benefit from our Manager’s ability to identify potential diverse acquisition opportunities in a variety of industries. In addition, we rely upon our management team’s experience and expertise in researching and valuing prospective target businesses, as well as negotiating the ultimate acquisition of such target businesses. In particular, because there may be a lack of information available about these target businesses, which may make it more difficult to understand or appropriately value such target businesses, on our behalf, our Manager: • • • • • • engages in a substantial level of internal and third-party due diligence; critically evaluates the target management team; identifies and assesses any financial and operational strengths and weaknesses of the target business; analyzes comparable businesses to assess financial and operational performances relative to industry competitors; actively researches and evaluates information on the relevant industry; and thoroughly negotiates appropriate terms and conditions of any acquisition. The process of acquiring new businesses is both time-consuming and complex. Our management team historically has taken from two to twenty-four months to perform due diligence, negotiate and close acquisitions. Although our management team is always at various stages of evaluating several transactions at any given time, there may be periods of time during which our management team does not recommend any new acquisitions to us. Even if an acquisition is recommended by our management team, our board of director’s may not approve it. 12 A component of our acquisition financing strategy that we utilize in acquiring the businesses we own and manage is to provide both equity capital and debt capital, raised at the parent company level largely through our existing credit facility, to close acquisitions. We believe, and it has been our experience, that having the ability to finance our acquisitions with capital resources raised by us, rather than negotiating separate third party financing, provides us with an advantage in successfully acquiring attractive businesses by minimizing delay and closing conditions that are often related to acquisition-specific financings. In addition, our strategy of providing this intercompany debt financing within the capital structure of the businesses we acquire and manage allows us the ability to distribute cash to the parent company through monthly interest payments and amortization of principle on these intercompany loans. Upon acquisition of a new business, we rely on our Manager’s experience and expertise to work efficiently and effectively with the management of the new business to jointly develop and execute a successful business plan. We believe our financing structure, in which both equity and debt capital are raised at the Company level, allows us to acquire businesses without transaction specific financing and is conducive to our ability to consummate transactions that may be attractive in both the short- and long-term. In addition to acquiring businesses, we sell those businesses that we own from time to time when attractive opportunities arise that outweigh the value that we believe we will be able to bring such businesses consistent with our long-term investment strategy. As such, our decision to sell a business is based on our belief that doing so will increase shareholder value to a greater extent than through our continued ownership of that business. Upon the sale of a business, we may use the proceeds to retire debt or retain proceeds for acquisitions or general corporate purposes. We do not expect to make special distributions at the time of a sale of one of our businesses; instead, we expect to pay shareholder distributions over time solely through the earnings and cash flows of our businesses. Since our inception in May 2006, we have recorded gains on sales of our businesses of approximately $198 million (excluding the gains on the sale of our shares in FOX). We sold Crosman Acquisition Company (“Crosman”) in January 2007, Aeroglide Company (“Aeroglide”) and Silvue Technologies Group, Inc. (“Silvue”) in June 2008, Staffmark Holdings Inc. (“Staffmark”) in 2011 and HALO Branded Solutions (“HALO”) in 2012. We sold Crosman, our majority owned recreational products company for approximately $143 million and our net proceeds and gain on sale were approximately $110 million and $36 million, respectively. We sold Aeroglide, our majority owned designer and manufacturer of industrial drying and cooling equipment for approximately $95 million and our net proceeds and gain on sale were approximately $78 million and $34 million, respectively. We sold Silvue, our majority owned developer and producer of proprietary, high performance liquid coating systems for approximately $95 million and our net proceeds and gain on sale were approximately $64 million and $39 million, respectively. We sold Staffmark, our majority-owned provider of temporary staffing solutions subsidiary for approximately $295 million and our net proceeds and gain on sale were approximately $217 million and $89 million, respectively. We sold HALO, our majority owned fulfillment provider of promotional items for $76.5 million and our net proceeds upon sale were approximately $66.0 million and our loss on sale was approximately $0.5 million. In August 2013, FOX completed an initial public offering of its common stock at an initial offering price of $15.00 per share. FOX sold 2,857,143 shares and certain of its shareholders sold 7,000,000 shares (including 5,800,238 shares held by us). FOX trades on the (cid:2)ASDAQ stock market under the ticker “FOXF”. We received approximately $80.9 million in net proceeds from the sale of our FOX shares in the initial public offering, and our ownership interest in FOX was reduced to approximately 53.9%. (cid:2)o gain was reflected as a result of the sale of our FOX shares in the initial public offering because our majority classification of FOX did not change. FOX used a portion of their net proceeds received from the sale of their shares as well as proceeds from the FOX credit facility to repay $61.5 million in outstanding indebtedness to us under their existing credit facility with us. On July 10, 2014, FOX filed a registration statement on Form S-1 with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC") for the FOX Secondary Offering. Certain FOX shareholders, including us, sold shares of FOX common stock through the FOX Secondary Offering at a price of $15.50 per share. As a selling shareholder, we sold a total of 4,466,569 shares of FOX common stock, for total net proceeds of approximately $65.5 million. Upon completion of the offering, our ownership in FOX was reduced from approximately 53% to 41%, or 15,108,718 shares of FOX’s common stock. As a result of the sale of the FOX shares by the Company in the FOX Secondary Offering, we no longer hold a controlling ownership interest in FOX. We recognized a gain of approximately $76.2 million related to the shares that were sold in the FOX Secondary Offering, and a gain of approximately $188.0 million related to the deconsolidation of our retained interest in FOX, for a total gain of approximately $264.3 million. 13 Strategic Advantages Based on the experience of our management team and its ability to identify and negotiate acquisitions, we believe we are well- positioned to acquire additional businesses. Our management team has strong relationships with business brokers, investment and commercial bankers, accountants, attorneys and other potential sources of acquisition opportunities. In addition, our management team also has a successful track record of acquiring and managing small to middle market businesses in various industries. In negotiating these acquisitions, we believe our management team has been able to successfully navigate complex situations surrounding acquisitions, including corporate spin-offs, transitions of family-owned businesses, management buy-outs and reorganizations. Our management team has a large network of approximately 2,000 deal intermediaries who we expect to expose us to potential acquisitions. Through this network, as well as our management team’s proprietary transaction sourcing efforts, we have a substantial pipeline of potential acquisition targets. Our management team also has a well-established network of contacts, including professional managers, attorneys, accountants and other third-party consultants and advisors, who may be available to assist us in the performance of due diligence and the negotiation of acquisitions, as well as the management and operation of our acquired businesses. Finally, because we intend to fund acquisitions through the utilization of our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility, we expect to minimize the delays and closing conditions typically associated with transaction specific financing, as is typically the case in such acquisitions. We believe this advantage can be a powerful one, especially in a tight credit environment, and is highly unusual in the marketplace for acquisitions in which we operate. Valuation and Due Diligence When evaluating businesses or assets for acquisition, our management team performs a rigorous due diligence and financial evaluation process. In doing so, we evaluate the operations of the target business as well as the outlook for the industry in which the target business operates. While valuation of a business is, by definition, a subjective process, we define valuations under a variety of analyses, including: • • • • discounted cash flow analyses; evaluation of trading values of comparable companies; expected value matrices; and examination of comparable recent transactions. One outcome of this process is a projection of the expected cash flows from the target business. A further outcome is an understanding of the types and levels of risk associated with those projections. While future performance and projections are always uncertain, we believe that with detailed due diligence, future cash flows will be better estimated and the prospects for operating the business in the future better evaluated. To assist us in identifying material risks and validating key assumptions in our financial and operational analysis, in addition to our own analysis, we engage third-party experts to review key risk areas, including legal, tax, regulatory, accounting, insurance and environmental. We also engage technical, operational or industry consultants, as necessary. A further critical component of the evaluation of potential target businesses is the assessment of the capability of the existing management team, including recent performance, expertise, experience, culture and incentives to perform. Where necessary, and consistent with our management strategy, we actively seek to augment, supplement or replace existing members of management who we believe are not likely to execute our business plan for the target business. Similarly, we analyze and evaluate the financial and operational information systems of target businesses and, where necessary, we enhance and improve those existing systems that are deemed to be inadequate or insufficient to support our business plan for the target business. Financing We have a credit facility with a group of lenders led by Bank of America (cid:2).A. that we entered into on June 6, 2014. The 2014 Credit Facility provides for (i) revolving loans, swing line loans and letters of credit up to a maximum aggregate amount of $400 million, and (ii) a $325 million term loan. The 2014 Term Loan was issued at an original issuance discount of 99.5% of par value. The 2014 Term Loan requires quarterly payments of $812,500 commencing September 30, 2014 with a final payment of all remaining principal and interest due on June 6, 2021, which is the 2014 Term Loan maturity date. At December 31, 2014, we had $323.4 million outstanding on the 2014 Term Loan. All amounts outstanding under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility will become due on June 6, 2019, which is the maturity date of loans advanced under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility and the termination date of the revolving loan commitment. The 2014 Credit Facility also permits us, prior to the applicable maturity date, to increase the revolving loan commitment and/or obtain additional term loans in an aggregate amount of up to $200 million subject to certain restrictions and conditions. 14 The 2014 Credit Facility provides for letters of credit under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility in an aggregate face amount not to exceed $100 million outstanding at any time, as well as swing line loans of up to $25 million outstanding at one time. At no time may the (i) aggregate principal amount of all amounts outstanding under the Revolving Credit Facility, plus (ii) the aggregate amount of all outstanding letters of credit and swing line loans, exceed the borrowing availability under the 2014 Credit Facility. At December 31, 2014, we had outstanding letters of credit totaling approximately $4.5 million. The borrowing availability under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility at December 31, 2014 was approximately $225.7 million. The Credit Facility is secured by all of the assets of the Company, including all of its equity interests in, and loans to, its consolidated subsidiaries. (See (cid:2)ote J to the consolidated financial statements for more detail regarding our 2014 Credit Facility). We intend to finance future acquisitions through our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility, cash on hand and, if necessary, additional equity and debt financings. We believe, and it has been our experience, that having the ability to finance our acquisitions with the capital resources raised by us, rather than negotiating separate third party financing specifically related to the acquisition of individual businesses, provides us with an advantage in acquiring attractive businesses by minimizing delay and closing conditions that are often related to acquisition-specific financings. In this respect, we believe that in the future, we may need to pursue additional debt or equity financings, or offer equity in Holdings or target businesses to the sellers of such target businesses, in order to fund multiple future acquisitions. Our Businesses We categorize the businesses we own into two separate groups of businesses (i) branded consumer businesses and, (ii) niche industrial businesses. Branded products businesses are characterized as those businesses that we believe capitalize on a valuable brand name in their respective market sector. We believe that our branded products businesses are leaders in their particular product category. (cid:2)iche industrial businesses are characterized as those businesses that focus on manufacturing and selling particular products and industrial services within a specific market sector. We believe that our niche industrial businesses are leaders in their specific market sector. During the three years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, 48%, 61.5%, and 62.1% of net sales are attributable to our branded consumer businesses with the remaining net sales attributable to our niche industrial businesses. The 2014 percentage includes the net sales attributable for FOX prior to July 10, 2014, when FOX became an equity method investment. Branded Consumer Businesses CamelBak Overview CamelBak, headquartered in Petaluma, California, is a diversified hydration and personal protection platform, offering products for outdoor, recreation and military applications. CamelBak offers a broad range of recreational / military hydration packs, reusable water bottles, specialized military gloves and performance accessories. As the leading supplier of hydration products to specialty outdoor, cycling and military retailers, CamelBak maintains the leading market share position in recreational markets for hands- free hydration packs and the leading market share position for reusable water bottles in specialty channels. CamelBak is also dominant supplier of hydration systems to the military, with a leading market share in post-issue hydration systems. Over its more than 25-year history, CamelBak has developed a reputation as the preferred supplier for the hydration needs of the most demanding athletes and warfighters. Across its markets, CamelBak is respected for its innovation, leadership and authenticity. For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, CamelBak contributed net sales of approximately $148.7 million, $139.9 million, and $157.6 million, respectively, and operating income of $17.9 million, $17.9 million and $25.5 million in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. CamelBak had total assets of $235.9 million and $241.0 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. (cid:2)et sales from CamelBak represented 15.1%, 14.2%, and 17.8% of our consolidated net sales in the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. History of CamelBak Founded in 1989, CamelBak initially gained a following among mountain bikers in the early 1990’s through its first product, the ThermoBak™. As CamelBak grew among this base of users, its products continued to gain acceptance within other arenas where participants needed easy access to water to achieve optimal performance in their activity. 15 The hands-free feature of CamelBak’s products proved to be appealing to outdoor sports enthusiasts and critical to others, including the U.S. Military. After successfully developing the hands-free hydration category, CamelBak in 2006, recruited new management, including industry veteran and Board member Sally McCoy in the role of CEO, and acquired Southwest Motorsports (since rebranded CamelBak Gloves). With a strong market presence in hydration packs, the management team focused on continued expansion into adjacent markets and developing and executing on a consistent strategy of innovation. Since this time, CamelBak has steadily grown sales and earnings and has enhanced its relationships with suppliers to strengthen its supply chain, reengineered its product distribution capabilities and tightly controlled operating expenses to match the needs of the business. In 2006, CamelBak expanded its recreational business into the fast growing bottle category. CamelBak’s initial launch of the innovative Better Bottle™ was followed by numerous successful bottle product introductions for everyday users, road cyclists, kids and recreational enthusiasts, including eddy™ and the podium collection. CamelBak was first to market with an entirely BPA-free plastic bottle product line. We purchased a majority interest in CamelBak on August 24, 2011. Industry Recreation Market—With over 100 million participants, the outdoor recreational activity market represents a large, attractive and stable group of consumers. CamelBak’s legacy products have historically been focused on a subset of this group, consisting of cyclists, mountain bikers and other passionate outdoor enthusiasts who tend to be loyal and consistent buyers of premium and performance-enhancing offerings. CamelBak’s core customers are typically outdoor enthusiasts who exhibit very high participation rates and frequent purchasing behavior. In addition to CamelBak’s legacy consumer group, CamelBak has increasingly used its brand authenticity, credibility and broadening product portfolio to reach athletes in adjacent sporting activities. Long-term growth in the hydration and personal protection industry is driven by a number of factors. Consumer recognition of personal hydration’s importance to health and well-being has been a growing and enduring trend, reflected by the proliferation of bottled water and functional beverages. The importance of water as a healthy choice has become even more prominent as a key component to healthy living. Further, people are increasingly aware of the effects of even minimal dehydration on multiple functions of the body, including brain function, digestion, metabolism and skin health. CamelBak’s products have proven their ability to provide greater hydration. An independent study conducted by Pepperdine University found that people utilizing CamelBak’s Bite Valve™ technology consume 24% more than those using single serving disposable bottled water or less innovative products. Recently there has been a reduction in disposable bottled water consumption in the U.S., primarily as a result of price and the wide-spread awareness of the negative environmental impact of disposable water bottles. With respect to the environment, the disposable water bottle’s environmentally harmful lifecycle is generating significant backlash. We believe the reliance on oil in the production and transportation of the bottles and the fact that over two-thirds of bottles are not recycled is driving consumers to seek alternatives to disposable bottles. Further, there are a number of government mandates forcing the elimination of disposable bottles. (cid:2)ationwide, local governments are enacting these curbs to combat the cost and waste of disposable bottles. In recent years, governments of all levels have received scrutiny for fiscal irresponsibility and a number of municipalities have launched initiatives focused on curbing disposable water bottles in their communities. In 2006, a San Francisco investigation revealed that the city spent over $500,000 per year on bottled water. This revelation triggered a nationwide analysis of government spending on bottled water with public funds. In 2013 Concord, Massachusetts prohibited the sale of plastic water bottles. U.S. Government & Military Market—The military acquisition process has responded to the demands of modern warfare which require forces to be more agile and flexible than ever before. This trend has been highlighted by the increased use of multiple funding and procurement mechanisms such as Rapid Fielding Initiatives (“RFI”) and Joint Urgent Operational (cid:2)eeds Statement (“JUO(cid:2)S”). These programs provide funding for mission critical operational needs such as IED detection and defeat and lifesaving warfighter equipment purchases without the normal bid and proposal process that can take months and even years to get equipment in the hands of the end user. In addition to responsive procurement contracts such as the RFI, the military has continued a gradual decentralization of purchasing which allows decision makers closer to the front line to select what specific items need to be acquired for a unit. Unit and individual equipment purchases are made primarily through U.S. Government Services Administration (“GSA”) contracts or at military exchange and supply locations. Warfighters and their families frequently purchase supplemental gear that is superior to standard issue products. CamelBak is well positioned to benefit from continued decentralized purchasing. Products and Services CamelBak focuses on offering high quality, industry leading hydration and performance equipment. CamelBak’s products fall into four key categories: 16 Hydration Packs—CamelBak’s heritage and legacy is in hydration packs and CamelBak maintains the broadest and deepest line of packs in the industry. CamelBak’s core hydration product consists primarily of an easily cleaned and filled polyurethane reservoir, a connecting tube and a self-sealing mouthpiece, or “bite-valve,” which facilitates simple and intuitive drinking. The CamelBak hydration system allows users to conveniently carry one to three liters of water, which can be easily accessed without interruption of the user’s task or activity. The system is most often sold as an integrated backpack or waist-pack, which is uniquely designed for a specific use, such as biking, running or military applications. Hydration packs represented 37%, 44%, and 50% of CamelBak’s gross sales in the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Recreation Packs Having created the hands-free hydration category, CamelBak continues to be the dominant market leader in the recreational sector since its inception. After starting with a mountain biking product, CamelBak developed a host of other types of biking hydration packs that are designed to match specific types of biking. CamelBak sells classic cycling packs that are lightweight and streamlined. CamelBak also sells larger more durable packs designed for long off-road rides and a Downhill/Freeride line designed for specific types of mountain biking activities. By starting with a focused line and expanding it to cover many different types of biking activities, CamelBak has created the deepest, broadest line of hydration packs in the industry. As CamelBak extended its packs to cover different biking niches, top athletes from other outdoor sports began to clamor for product. To meet this demand, CamelBak has created lines that cater to the diverse set of outdoor athletes: Ski / Snowboard has attachments for helmets, boards and shovels • Hike / Alpine consists of lightweight packs with extra back panel padding and air flow for breathability • • Multi-sport are ultra-light and include wearable hydration units for use in almost any athletic activity • Run includes hip packs designed to hold as many as four water bottles in a remarkably stable set up These customized solutions have all been developed with an eye towards enhancing the performance of each activity’s respective athletes. That customization is part of the innovative difference that allows CamelBak to differentiate itself in a competitive market. Military Packs CamelBak sells a wide selection of category leading military packs. Management estimates CamelBak has in excess of 85% market share in post-issue military hydration packs. It is also one of only a few brands sold to U.S. Military personnel that is allowed to prominently display the brand name on the outside of the product. The packs include features such as easy armor integration and extreme durability appropriate for use in the harshest conditions. Bottles—In 2006, CamelBak parlayed its credibility in hands-free hydration and expanded into bottles. CamelBak introduced the Better Bottle™, subsequently replaced by eddy™, which incorporated a number of features that quickly established it as a best- in-class hydration solution. These features include: (i) the patented spill-proof Bite Valve, (ii) the first insulated stainless steel water bottle and (iii) in 2008, the first all BPA-free line of plastic water bottles. The success of the Better Bottle™ led CamelBak to design a complete line of bottles that would mirror the pack line’s legacy of customization. CamelBak developed a line for children, which included bite valves that have to be removed from the inside of the bottle to prevent choking. CamelBak also released the Podium® insulated and non-insulated line, which includes features such as the patented Jet Valve™. CamelBak’s bottle offering has continued to evolve to meet the specific demands of consumers. These demands have included activity-based needs such as customized cycling bottles. They have also included health concerns, including the consumer backlash against BPA. CamelBak recognized this concern early and became the first to offer an entire line of BPA-free hard plastic bottles in May of 2008. CamelBak’s bottle offering Groove™, provides users the ability to filter water in any place at any time through its integrated straw assembly. Users simply fill the bottle with tap water, screw the cap on and start sipping. The integrated plant-based carbon filter reduces chlorine taste and odors found in tap water thus improving taste and eliminating the desire to purchase disposable bottles of water. In 2013 CamelBak introduced Chute™. Chute™ is a BPA-Free reusable bottle that is durable for the outdoor conditions, leak proof for safe transport and features an ergonomic, high flow spout that provides rapid hydration. Bottles represented approximately 50%, 42%, and 34% of CamelBak’s gross sales for the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. 17 Gloves—The evolution of CamelBak gloves parallels that of the pack business in the Government / Military channel. Initially created for pit crews in the auto racing market, members of elite squads who became aware of the product were impressed with its dexterity and durability. Following this unofficial endorsement, members of the U.S. Armed Forces began requesting CamelBak gloves. The gloves are highly-technical and difficult to produce, with some styles requiring 44 individual pieces for the assembly of the final product. Today, CamelBak gloves are exclusively a Government / Military product, as their technical characteristics exceed that which a non-military user would desire. Gloves represented approximately 3%, 3%, and 6% of CamelBak’s gross sales for the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The reduction in Glove sales over the past three years is consistent with the reduction of deployed U.S. troops. Accessories—CamelBak offers various accessories to complement its hydration systems. Accessories are available for each product line and include items that are made to enhance hydration performance and others for maintenance or replacement parts. CamelBak’s goal is to reinvent the way that individual athletes, warfighters and every day users hydrate and perform. To that aim, CamelBak has developed a number of new products that help to further enhance the already innovative way that its products deliver water: • Elixir is a flavored electrolyte supplement for performance athletes. It’s sugar free and works well with reusable reservoirs and bottles as it helps athletes with their hydration needs. • All Clear is a portable microbiological UV water purifier. It is easy to use with UV light built into the cap that attaches to the bottle. It is fast, completing a cycle in 60 seconds. And it’s proven effective to U.S. EPA guide standards. CamelBak products are known for their high quality and durability. CamelBak provides products to help maintain this durability and offers replacement parts in the rare instance that the products cease to perform at optimal levels: • Reservoir cleaning kits are designed to optimally clean the reservoirs that are inside of each pack. Properly cleaning and drying the reservoirs promotes longevity. • Replacement reservoirs are made for each pack. This ensures that in the rare case that a reservoir must be replaced, the athlete or warfighter does not need to replace the entire pack but can easily swap out the necessary components. Many users also like to have multiple reservoirs. In addition to recreational accessories, CamelBak offers a specialized line associated with its military products. These accessories help enhance the performance of military products by adding resistance to chemical and biological agents or allowing connection to standard issue gas masks. For example, the HydroLink allows warfighters to replace their bite valve with a connector, allowing them to hydrate while wearing their gas mask. Accessories accounted for approximately 9%, 11%, and 10% of CamelBak’s gross sales for the twelve months ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Competitive Strengths Leading Brand Recognition & Market Share—CamelBak believes it has a #1 market share in each of the following areas: (i) recreational hands- free hydration packs, (ii) reusable water bottles for specialty channels and (iii) post-issue hydration packs for the U.S. military. CamelBak enjoys outstanding awareness and a reputation for superior performance with consumers, retailers and warfighters. For example, within the Armed Forces, CamelBak is one of only a few companies allowed to prominently display its brand name on active military products. Preferred Partner—CamelBak is a preferred partner to leading retailers and the military. CamelBak is a supplier to leading national specialty and sporting goods retailers, including REI, EMS, Dick’s Sporting Goods and The Sports Authority. In addition, CamelBak does business in over 400 military retail exchanges and is an official military supplier which requires a rigorous application and certification process. Business Strategies Introducing Technically Superior Products in Core Categories—CamelBak’s core categories include hydration packs, bottles and warfighter protection products, and CamelBak’s mission is to continuously reinvent the way people hydrate and perform. To meet this goal, CamelBak will continue to create innovative, technical solutions that exceed the demands of its customers. CamelBak’s product pipeline for its core customers remains robust. Expanding Product Suite in Everyday Hydration to Reach (cid:2)ew Customers and Channels—The CamelBak brand is synonymous with personal hydration, and this credibility grants CamelBak permission to enter broader aspects of hydration. CamelBak is committed to continuing to broaden its portfolio of personal hydration solutions to reach new customers, and, under the leadership of its CEO, has proven that it can extend its brand beyond hard-core athletes. For example, Camelback has successfully 18 reached new consumers and channels through its water bottle product line, which offers the features desired by its core customer base of performance athletes to the everyday customer shopping at Target. As CamelBak continues to expand its relevance to everyday users, its authenticity will allow it to enter other areas such as purification and other products. Broadening International Opportunities—Management believes there is significant potential to expand its international sales in the consumer market. Currently, CamelBak’s recreational business is sold through a network of approximately 82 foreign distributors. With improved distribution in the recreational market, CamelBak would have a number of opportunities to expand throughout Europe, Asia and South America. Penetrating Select Areas of Specialty Retail – CamelBak aspires to build a product portfolio that shapes the way consumers and warfighters perform across all activities. CamelBak has made significant strides introducing new products that target activities outside of its core biking and hiking audience. Past examples include multi-sport enthusiasts and runners. CamelBak targeted the multi-sport category with highly functional wearable hydration, which consists of a wearable shirt with built in hydration pack that allows enthusiasts to hydrate hands-free without a traditional pack. CamelBak keeps an open dialogue with the athletes it endorses and is thus able to gain real-time feedback on the products it produces. By learning the needs of these consumers and others, CamelBak is able to identify other areas to develop ground- breaking hydration solutions. As CamelBak continues to innovate and create new products to serve the needs of more diverse consumers, it will further grow sales to these retailers. As a sports subculture brand, CamelBak is able to migrate to different activities without losing the authenticity and credibility it has developed as a leading product innovator. As examples, skiers and kayakers alike have adopted the brand as their own without even realizing that other sports enthusiasts have done the same. CamelBak launched its own direct to consumer E-Commerce site during the fourth quarter of 2012. The site offers the vast majority of CamelBak's product line. Research and Development CamelBak’s hydration products are among the most technically advanced and rigorously engineered in their markets. They are specifically designed to function and perform under diverse and extreme conditions. CamelBak’s research and development effort is at the core of its strategy of product innovation and market leadership. CamelBak’s products feature a combination of innovative design, high-quality materials, and superb functionality and performance elements and are recognized as being the leaders or among the leaders in all of the market segments in which they participate. CamelBak has a robust core research and development team, which has collectively over 36 years of combined industry experience. In addition to the core engineering group, a large number of other CamelBak staff members, who also use CamelBak’s products, contribute to the research and development effort at various stages. Product development also includes collaborating with customers and field testing. This feedback helps ensure products will meet CamelBak’s demanding standards of excellence as well as the constantly changing needs of end users. CamelBak’s research and development activities are supported by state-of-the-art engineering software design tools, integrated manufacturing facilities and a performance testing center equipped to ensure product safety, durability and superior performance. The testing center collects data and tests products prior to and after commercial introduction. Research and development costs totaled $3.1 million, $3.2 million, and $3.0 million during the years 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Customers and Distribution channels CamelBak offers a unique value proposition for its customers. As an innovative subculture sports brand, CamelBak has the authenticity and credibility to defend market share, command premium prices and leverage into new categories. The brand strength allows retailers to hold prices and thus protect margins. Further, CamelBak’s “Got Your Bak” lifetime warranty speaks to the level of quality and customer service offered. CamelBak’s products, which are sold domestically and internationally, are segmented into two major end markets: Recreational and Government/Military. CamelBak’s powerful product distribution network is comprised of long-standing, entrenched relationships with a diversified set of customers. CamelBak’s top ten non-military customers comprised approximately 42%, 38% and 30% of gross sales in the year ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively CamelBak’s largest recreational customer accounted for approximately 12% of gross sales in 2014, 12% of gross sales in 2013 and approximately 8% of gross sales in 2012. Military customers comprised approximately 21%, 29% and 38% of gross sales in the year ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. International sales were approximately 25% of gross sales in 2014, 22% of gross sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 and 19% for the same period in 2012. 19 Recreational Distribution—CamelBak markets its hydration and performance products to several channels in the recreational market. Management estimates that it currently holds in excess of 85% of the market share of the hands-free hydration market. A share this large demonstrates the strength of the brand and the credibility that the products have with consumers. CamelBak invented the category in 1989 and although competitors have introduced a number of similar products, CamelBak has held on to its base. Recreational–Domestic Distribution: The Recreational–Domestic Division is focused on product distribution through a variety of retail accounts in the United States. Particular emphasis is placed on premium active lifestyle retailers across a broad spectrum of channels, including camping/outdoor, bike, natural foods, housewares, hunting/fishing, paddle sports and surf/skate. The division manages approximately 2,500 retail customers with over 10,000 retail storefronts. Current distribution channels range from specialty bicycle, outdoor, paddle sports, hunting stores and catalogs to large outdoor and sporting goods chains that reach the broader market. Importantly, CamelBak has selectively expanded and diversified its distribution channels over time. Today, notable customers include REI, Dick’s Sporting Goods, EMS, Target, Whole Foods Market, Academy and The Sports Authority. CamelBak’s entrance into the reusable bottle category in 2006 resulted in a notable broadening of distribution, as CamelBak made the decision to strategically expand into new channels. CamelBak felt it was important to reach an even broader consumer base to further its vision of “obsoleting” bottled water as the most common way to hydrate. The bottle business has also enabled CamelBak to achieve penetration in the college and corporate sponsorship markets. Recreational–International Distribution: The Recreational–International division is focused on product distribution through outdoor, sporting goods and specialty retailers that are managed through local distributors focused on premier retail accounts. CamelBak maintains an office in Europe to provide oversight of distributor performance, market intelligence and limited supplemental marketing support, including event staffing, trade show management, athlete sponsorships, public relations and market/product intelligence gathering. Order scheduling, fulfillment and logistics support for CamelBak’s international operations are provided from CamelBak’s Petaluma headquarters. Key international markets include the United Kingdom, Germany, France, Australia, Japan, Canada, and (cid:2)orway. As is the case in the United States, the CamelBak brand is widely recognized and respected by enthusiasts and maintains a dominant market share. Military–Retail Exchange Distribution—Military retail exchanges, including the Army and Air Force Exchange Service (“AAFES”), the (cid:2)avy Exchange Service Command (“(cid:2)EXCOM”) and the Marine Corps Exchange (“MXC”), are essentially large retail chains serving the military community. Military personnel, veterans and their families are strongly incentivized to shop at exchanges given that the store markup is typically less than the off base markup from other retailers, exchanges do not charge sales tax and a portion of the exchanges’ earnings often go towards funding expenditures related to the military’s morale, welfare and recreation. Furthermore, the exchanges provide an added benefit to consumers, given the convenience they provide to troops deployed in nearby locations. The military retail exchanges represent large distribution platforms extending across many different countries. CamelBak sells through over 400 locations. CamelBak pioneered the adoption of hands-free hydration systems by U.S. and foreign militaries and is today, we believe, the preferred brand of warfighters. As a result, CamelBak has dominant market share throughout the military retail channel. CamelBak is one of AAFES largest vendors and has a strong, long-term relationship with the retailer. Government / Military Distribution—In the Government / Military division, CamelBak sells products and accessories related to both hydration and performance. CamelBak continues to expand its Government / Military market by increasing penetration into foreign governments and militaries. A key component of U.S. foreign policy is the replacement of some deployed troops with those of foreign militaries. CamelBak’s success in the U.S. Military carries tremendous credibility abroad, which has enabled CamelBak to achieve meaningful adoption outside the U.S. CamelBak sells its products through a range of domestic Government / Military channels: • GSA: The Government Services Administration (‘GSA”) provides a channel for all federal government agencies and government end-users to procure items easily. All products sold through the GSA must be pre-approved to get listed on GSA schedules. Once products are listed, thousands of Government / Military units and agencies purchase through this channel knowing that all pricing and legal obligations have already been negotiated and approved. • Direct Department of Defense Procurement: The U.S. Military will, from time to time, request for proposal a large amount of a given product. In addition, this request can oftentimes require that the product be manufactured with domestic content and other various specific rules. As it relates to CamelBak’s business, CamelBak calls such direct contracts “DFAR” business. This is patterned after the Defense Federal Acquisition Regulation (“DFAR”) set of rules used by the government. 20 Selling through the direct government channel entails abiding by specific sourcing guidelines and responding to a solicitation. Typically, a branch of the military will identify a need, issue a solicitation and multiple parties will bid to win the contract. While these orders are intermittent and often large, CamelBak has developed a strong supply chain to deal with these types of orders. International Government / Military Distribution—International Sales in the Government / Military is driven by ordinary replenishment and large solicitations that occur on an irregular basis to meet the equipment needs of each individual country. CamelBak has consistently participated in these solicitations in the past with significant success. Sales and Marketing CamelBak approaches marketing from a unique point of view that is meant to inspire customers. CamelBak is engaged in small endorsement deals that provide gear to actual users as well as athletes who bike, climb and hike professionally as opposed to entering into large multi-year contracts. Second, CamelBak’s marketing campaign uses photographs and videos shot from a user’s perspective. This photographic style encourages the consumers viewing the ad to imagine they are engaging in the activity shown. This experience serves to promote the inspirational nature of CamelBak’s brand by “liberating people to go further.” CamelBak’s sales are typically higher in the spring and summer months as this corresponds with warmer weather in the (cid:2)orthern Hemisphere and an increase in hydration related activities. Marketing—CamelBak uses a “two pronged” approach to marketing: • CamelBak has set out to aggressively pursue new users and expand its customer base while remaining true to its authentic, innovative ideals. Given the customization that has occurred across its product lines, CamelBak created a unique, highly targeted marketing plan to acquire new users for specific products. In the case of Groove™, CamelBak set out to expand its customer base of 25-45 year old women. To that end, CamelBak designed print and web ads with a message that appeals more directly to this group and placed these advertisements in the appropriate women’s lifestyle magazines. CamelBak also has a strong presence on the internet and uses instructional videos and direct marketing through social media sites such as Facebook. • CamelBak makes a point to continue cultivating the passionate consumer base that already admires and respects CamelBak and its products. A recent example is the release of the Antidote™ Reservoir. CamelBak uses a unique marketing approach for different target users. Since these products are geared towards passionate outdoor athletes, CamelBak placed ads in forums including: (i) bicycling and mountain bike magazines, (ii) backpacking and hiking magazines and (iii) internet and social media sites that cater to active men and women. Sales Organization—CamelBak’s in-house sales team consists of dedicated sales people and customer service employees. The sales organization is strategically aligned by product category/sales channel. The sales managers split coverage for major national accounts with one team responsible for maintaining and growing sales to established channels and the other for business to larger national retailers and natural foods stores. With an average tenure of over 5 years, CamelBak’s sales team maintains enduring and entrenched relationships with each of its customers. The Recreational–Domestic division manages customers through both an in- house sales management staff and a network of sales agencies consisting of a number of independent sales representatives. The Recreational– International division manages its international customers through local distributors focused on premier retail accounts. CamelBak maintains an office in Europe with two employees to provide oversight. CamelBak had firm sales backorders totaling $20.5 million and $21.6 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Competition CamelBak pioneered the hydration category with the introduction of the hydration pack more than 25 years ago. CamelBak’s brand admiration and customer loyalty, which are driven by its innovative products, have allowed it to continuously defend its market position in packs. These traits have also allowed CamelBak to successfully enter the bottle category where it holds a leading market position. 21 A summary of CamelBak’s competitors in hydration packs, bottles and reservoirs is listed below: CamelBak Recreational Competitors Hydration Packs Osprey The (cid:2)orth Face DaKine Bottles (cid:2)algene SIGG (cid:2)athan Performance Gear Polar Kleen Kanteen Contigo Reservoirs Platypus Hydrapak Source Across its military product set, CamelBak competes against a wide variety of industry players which include large prime and tier two defense companies, small and mid-sized companies specializing in warfighter equipage and companies focused predominantly on the consumer or materials market with a limited number of defense product offerings. CamelBak is recognized as a high-end supplier in each of its product categories (hydration and gloves). Management believes CamelBak is the leading supplier of post- issue hydration packs with over 85% of the market share and among the leading providers of specialized tactical gloves which are worn by some of the most elite warfighters in the world. Suppliers CamelBak’s product manufacturing is based on a dual strategy of in-house manufacturing and strategic alliances with select sub- contractors and vendors. CamelBak operates a scalable, low-cost supply chain, sourcing materials and employing contract manufacturers from across the Asia-Pacific region, the U.S. and Puerto Rico. Once manufactured, products are shipped directly from overseas manufacturers to CamelBak’s distribution center in San Diego for receiving and stocking and thereafter distributed to retail locations or third-party distributors. CamelBak has developed an efficient and low-cost supply chain. CamelBak’s deep understanding of military procurement requirements has allowed it to build a flexible network of vendors to reliably meet large military orders on short notice and to shift orders to vendors to be compliant with military requirements for its products. While striving to maximize the profitability of its products, CamelBak is also keenly aware of its corporate responsibility and, thus, holds itself and its vendors to the highest supply chain practices. As a result of CamelBak’s dedication to superior supply chain and manufacturing practices, the U.S. Military’s GSA named CamelBak the “Green Contractor of the Year” in 2009 and “MAS Contractor of the year in 2011”. In recent years, CamelBak has streamlined its operating expenses, tightening cost controls and maintaining a cost structure more in line with the size of its platform. Additionally, CamelBak has driven cost improvements by negotiating prices with vendors using an “open book” policy, in which each vendor’s profit margins, labor rates and material costs are agreed to upfront. This allows CamelBak’s operations group to negotiate reductions in component prices from raw material manufacturers resulting in cost savings. CamelBak’s primary raw materials are fabric, resin, polyurethane film and various resins for which CamelBak and/or its supplier partners receive multiple shipments per week. CamelBak purchases its materials from a combination of domestic and foreign suppliers. Intellectual Property Hydration priorities include easy cleaning and filling, freshness and taste, durability, temperature, water purity, leak-proof products and sustainability, all of which improve a customer’s overall hydration experience or enable the customer to perform at high levels. As a reflection of this focus, CamelBak holds 81 active patents and 15 pending patent applications. Regulatory Environment Management is not aware of any existing, pending or contingent liabilities that could have a material adverse effect on CamelBak’s business. CamelBak is proactive regarding regulatory issues and is in compliance with all relevant regulations. Management is not aware of any potential environmental issues. 22 Employees As of December 31, 2014, CamelBak employed approximately 275 persons. (cid:2)one of CamelBak’s employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. CamelBak believes its relationship with its employees is good. Ergobaby Overview Ergobaby, headquartered in Los Angeles, California, is a premier designer, marketer and distributor of wearable baby carriers and related baby wearing products as well as stroller travel systems and accessories. Ergobaby offers a broad range of wearable baby carriers, stroller travel systems and related products that are sold through more than 450 retailers and web shops in the United States and throughout the world. Ergobaby’s reputation for product innovation, reliability and safety has led to numerous awards and accolades from consumer surveys and publications, including babycenter, theBump, SheKnows Parenting, Parenting Magazine, Pregnancy magazine and Wired magazine. For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, Ergobaby had net sales of approximately $82.3 million, $67.3 million and $64.0 million, respectively. Ergobaby had operating income totaling $18.1 million, $12.6 million and $10.9 million in the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Ergobaby had total assets of $115.3 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013. Ergobaby’s net sales represented 8.4%, 6.8%, and 7.2% of our consolidated net sales for the year ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. History of Ergobaby Ergobaby was founded in 2003 by Karin Frost, who designed baby carriers following the birth of her son. The baby carrier product line has since expanded into four key categories: the Original, Organic, Performance, and 360 4-position carriers, with multiple style variations. In its second year of operations, Ergobaby sold 10,500 baby carriers and by 2014 sold over 1,103,000 in the year. In order to support the rapid growth, in 2007, Ergobaby made a strategic decision to establish an operating subsidiary (“EBEU”) in Hamburg, Germany. We purchased a majority interest in Ergobaby on September 16, 2010. On (cid:2)ovember 18, 2011 Ergobaby acquired Orbit Baby for approximately $17.5 million. Founded in 2004 and based in (cid:2)ewark, California, Orbit Baby produces and markets a premium line of stroller travel systems that utilize a patented hub ring to allow parents to easily move car seats from car seat bases to stroller frames in an instant without the need for any additional components. The product offering has increased to a full line of mix-and-match seats and bases. In 2013, Ergobaby expanded its portfolio into the swaddling category. The launch of the Ergobaby Swaddler which focused on healthy hip and arm positioning for newborns is the first significant category expansion outside of baby carriers for the Ergobaby brand. Both the Ergobaby and Orbit Baby brands are well regarded in the infant and juvenile industry. Ergobaby was named to the “20 Best Products in the Last 20 Years” by Parenting Magazine (2007), and continues to be recognized for its quality evident by recently being named babycenters’ 2014 “Moms’ Pick” for Best Baby Carrier and receiving the Juvenile Products Manufacturers Association ("JPMA") 2014 Innovation Award for the 360 4-Position Carrier. The Orbit Baby Infant System has received vast honors, including Baby Gizmo’s Editor’s Choice 2012, babble.com favorite Car Seats 2012, and She Knows Parenting Stroller Award 2011. Industry Ergobaby competes in the large and expanding infant and juvenile products industry. The industry exhibits little seasonality and is somewhat insulated from overall economic trends, as parents view spending on children as largely non-discretionary in nature. Consequently, parents spend consistently on their children, particularly on durable items, such as car seats, strollers, baby carriers, and related items that are viewed as necessities. Further, an emotional component is often a factor in parents’ purchasing decisions, as parents desire to purchase the best and safest products for their children. As a result, according to the USDA’s most recent report on Expenditures on Children by Families 2013 (released in August 2014), parents on average, spend between $9,130 and $25,700 on their child on an annual basis for related housing, food, transportation, clothes, healthcare, daycare and other items, depending on age of the child & annual income. The amount spent by parents in the highest income group (before tax income greater than $106,540) was more than twice the amounts spent by parents in the lowest income group (before tax income of less than $61,530). 23 On average, households spent between 14 - 25% of their before-tax income on a child. Similar patterns are seen in other counties around the world. Demand drivers fueling the growing spending on infant and juvenile products include favorable demographic trends, such as (i) an increasing number of births worldwide; (ii) a high percentage of first time births; (iii) an increasing age of first time mothers and a large percentage of working mothers with increased disposable income; and (iv) an increasing percentage of single child households and two-family households. Given that the child’s safety is paramount, many parents do not want to compromise a baby or child’s safety by purchasing secondhand products to save money. In many cases, when purchasing secondhand, the parent does not know key facts about the product they are buying, such as the age of the product, history of the item, or potential recalls by the manufacturer. Furthermore, the safety standards for the product may have changed since the version being resold, resulting in a product that does not meet the most rigorous safety standards. Consequently, as parents consider purchases of important necessities such as baby durables, they typically favor new products. According to Mintel Research, approximately 83% of baby carrier purchases were first-time purchases, with the remainder being either purchased second hand or borrowed. Safety influences not only whether parents purchase new or used products, but also which brands parents choose, which consequently impacts pricing and competition within the infant and juvenile products market. In purchases of baby durables, parents often seek well-known and trusted brands that offer a sense of comfort regarding a product’s reliability and safety. As a result, brand name and safety certifications can serve as a barrier to entry for competition in the market, as well as allow well- known brands such as Ergobaby to charge a premium. Wearable Carriers and Baby Wearing Trends Within the broader market for infant and juvenile products, Ergobaby operates specifically within the market for child mobility and transport products. According to JPMA, reported child mobility and transport manufacturer dollar sales, which includes sales of carriers, strollers, travel systems, and related products, totaled approximately $1.2 billion in the U.S. in 2013. Penetration of baby carriers currently trails that of strollers, car seats, and other infant and juvenile products. JPMA manufacturer sales growth from 2012 to 2013 suggests that the soft carrier segment is growing more rapidly than other infant and juvenile product categories, with 22% sales dollar growth. Comparatively, stroller shipments and convertible car seat shipments increased 16% and 5%, respectively, over the same period Management believes that continued growth within the market for wearable baby carriers is driven by several trends, including (i) lower relative penetration of baby carriers versus other infant and juvenile products; (ii) favorable demographics; (iii) increasing focus on the popularity of baby wearing; and (iv) convenience and mobility of wearable products. Products and Services Ergobaby Baby Carriers Ergobaby has two main baby carrier product lines: baby carriers and related carrier accessories. Ergobaby’s baby carrier design supports a natural sitting position for babies, eliminating compression of the spine and hips that can be caused by unsupported suspension. The baby carrier also balances the baby’s weight to parents’ hips and shoulders, and alleviates physical stress for the parent. Additional accessories are provided to complement the baby carriers including the increasingly popular Infant Insert. Within the Baby Carrier product line, Ergobaby sells four key categories or collections: the Original, Organic, Performance, and 360 4-position carriers and; within each line, Ergobaby offers multiple styles and color variations. Baby Carrier sales were approximately $63.1 million, $53.8 million and $44.6 million in the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, and represented approximately 76.6% of total sales in 2014, 79.9% of total sales in 2013, and 70% of total sales in 2012. Within the accessories category, the Infant Insert is the largest sales component of the accessory category, representing more than half of total accessory sales for 2014, 2013, and 2012. Accessory sales were $8.7 million, $7.2 million, and $6.0 million in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively and represented approximately 11% in 2014 and 2013, and 13% of total sales in 2012. Ergobaby’s core Baby Carrier product offerings with average retail prices are summarized below: • • 4 styles of baby carriers – $115 – $195 3 styles of Infant Inserts – $25 – $38 24 Orbit Baby Infant Systems The Orbit Baby Infant System has three main product groups: stroller travel systems, product extensions and accessories. The Orbit Baby Stroller Travel System is a three-piece kit that includes an infant car seat, car seat base, and stroller. Unlike traditional infant travel systems, the Orbit Stroller Travel System’s unique docking technology, or “SmartHub TM", allows for easy interchange of four different seats, including the Infant Car Seat, Stroller Seat, Bassinet, and Toddler Car Seat. The Orbit Baby car seat base (which stays in the car when not in use) is touted as the easiest, quickest base to safely install. The base’s patent-pending StrongArm TM technology allows a secure installation in 60 seconds and easily docks the car seat from almost any angle, allowing the parent to ergonomically transport the child. The Orbit Baby Infant Car Seat is the common “plug- in” for the three-in-one system and can be moved effortlessly from the car seat base to the stroller. As a result of the SmartHub technology, Orbit is the only infant car seat that ergonomically rotates for simple docking and undocking to and from the car and stroller. The third member of the Stroller Travel System is Orbit’s modern and easy-to-use stroller. As is the case with the car seat base, the circular SmartHub allows the infant car seat to dock on the stroller from any angle without adaptors, and with 360 degree rotation and recline, the baby can face rear, forward, or sideways to view the world from different perspectives. Orbit Baby offers product extensions including additional seats and strollers, including the Double Helix Stroller for multiple children, to accommodate growing families. Orbit Baby also offers a wide range of accessories including the Sidekick Stroller Board, Stroller Panniers, Weather Pack, Color Pack, Footmuffs, Stroller Travel Bag and Baby Gear Spa Kit. Orbit Baby’s core product offerings, extensions and accessories and suggested retail prices are below: • • Stroller Travel System (includes Infant Car Seat, Car Seat Base, Stroller) – $980 Stroller – $660 - $1,150 • Car Seats and Car Seat Base – $380 – $440 • Bassinet Cradle – $295 • Accessories – $25 - $195 Competitive Strengths Ergobaby innovation—Ergobaby Carriers are known for their unsurpassed comfort – Ergobaby’s superior design results in improved comfort for both parent and baby. Parents are comfortable because baby’s weight is evenly distributed between the hips and shoulders while baby sits ergonomically in a natural sitting position. The concept of baby carrying has increased in popularity in the U.S. as parents recognize the emotional and functional benefits of carrying their baby. Consumers continually cite the comfort, design, and convenient “hands free” mobility the Ergobaby carrier offers as key purchasing criteria. Orbit Baby Innovation – With 19 patents and 2 patents pending, Orbit Baby offers a complete child travel system, from stroller to car seat and beyond. A favorite with moms and dads alike, the integrated Orbit Baby system is designed to take your children everywhere with unprecedented ease and style. With an emphasis on advanced safety and engineering, Orbit Baby is continually recognized for its innovation, ergonomic design and environmentally friendly focus. Orbit Baby applies hands-on experience and extensive research to create products that are elegantly simple, intuitive to use, and unsurpassed in real-world safety. Business Strategies Increase Penetration of Current U.S. Distribution Channels – Ergobaby continues to benefit from steady expansion of the market for wearable baby carriers and related accessories in the U.S. and internationally. Going forward, Ergobaby will continue to leverage and expand the awareness of its outstanding brands (both Ergobaby and Orbit Baby) in order to capture additional market share in the U.S., as parents increasingly recognize the enhanced mobility, convenience, and the ability to remain close to the child that Ergobaby carriers enable. Ergobaby currently markets its products to consumers in the U.S. through brick-and-mortar retailers, including specialty boutiques; online web shops; and directly through its website. Management has developed a targeted strategy to increase its penetration of these currently underpenetrated distribution channels that includes: (i) improved retain presence, including new packaging and in-store support materials; (ii) improving the effectiveness of marketing programs including utilization of social sites, digital marketing, and improved consumer engagement, and (iii) development of new products and designs. 25 International Market Expansion – Testimony to the global strength of its lifestyle brand, Ergobaby derives approximately 60% of its sales from international markets. Similar to the U.S., Ergobaby can continue to leverage its brand equity in the international markets it currently serves to aggressively drive future growth, as well as expand its international presence into new regions. The market for Ergobaby’s products abroad continues to grow rapidly, in part due to the growth in the number of births worldwide and the fact that in many parts of Europe and Asia, the concept of baby wearing is a culturally entrenched form of infant and child transport. (cid:2)ew Product Development – Management believes Ergobaby has an opportunity to leverage its unique, authentic lifestyle brand and expand its product line. Since its founding in 2003, Ergobaby has successfully introduced new carrier products to maintain innovation, uniqueness, and freshness within its baby carrier and travel system product lines. The newest product category introduction has been the Ergobaby Swaddler focused on ergonomically swaddling newborns in a healthy hip and arm position. The product launched in July 2013 in specialty stores only in the US and in international markets. Management anticipates continued distribution expansion and new offerings in this category. Customers Ergobaby primarily sells its products through brick-and-mortar retailers, online retailers and distributors and derives approximately 60% of its sales from outside of the U.S. Within the U.S., Ergobaby sells its products through over 450 brick-and-mortar retail customers and small infant and juvenile products chains, representing an estimated 2,900 retail doors. Ergobaby products are sold through its German based subsidiary, Ergobaby Europe, which services brick-and-mortar retailers and online retailers in Germany and France as well as services a network of distributors located in the United Kingdom, Austria, Finland, Russia, Switzerland, Belgium, the (cid:2)etherlands, Sweden, (cid:2)orway, Spain, Denmark, Italy, Turkey and the Ukraine. Sales to customers outside of the U.S. and European markets are predominantly serviced through distributors granted rights, though not necessarily exclusive, to sell within a specific geographic region. Sales & Marketing Within the U.S., Ergobaby directly employ sales professionals and utilizes independent sales representatives assigned to differing U.S. territories managed by in-house sales professionals. Independent salespeople in the U.S. are paid on a commission basis based on customer type and sales territory. In Europe, Ergobaby directly employs its salespeople and salespeople are paid a base salary and a commission on their sales, which is standard in that territory. Ergobaby has implemented a multi-faceted marketing plan which includes (i) targeted print advertising; (ii) online marketing efforts, including online advertisement, search engine optimization and social networking efforts; (iii) increasing tradeshow attendance; and (iv) increasing promotional activities. Ergobaby had approximately $15.6 million and $13.2 million in firm backlog orders at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Competition The infant and juvenile products market is fragmented, with a few larger manufacturers and marketers with portfolios of brands and a multitude of smaller, private companies with relatively targeted product offerings. Within the infant and juvenile products market, Ergobaby’s Carriers primarily compete with companies that market wearable baby carriers. Within the wearable baby carrier market, several distinct segments exist, including (i) slings and wraps; (ii) soft-structured baby carriers; and (iii) hard frame baby carriers. The primary global competitors in this segment are Baby Bjorn, Chicco, Britax and Manduca, which also market products in the premium price range. Especially in the US, Ergobaby also competes with several smaller companies that have developed wearable carriers, such as Beco, Boba, Tula and L’il Baby. Within the soft-structured baby carrier segment, Ergobaby benefits from strong distribution, good word of mouth, and the functionality of the design. The Orbit Baby Infant System principally competes with other premium stroller systems including Stokke, Bugaboo, UppaBaby and Britax. Suppliers During 2014, Ergobaby sourced its carrier and carrier accessory products from Vietnam and India and manufactures its stroller systems and accessory products in China. In 2012, Ergobaby began sourcing carriers and accessories from a manufacturing facility 26 in Vietnam. Vietnam accounted for approximately 57% of Ergobaby’s purchases in 2014. Ergobaby partnered with a manufacturer located in India in 2009, which manufactures Ergobaby’s carriers and accessories, and represented approximately 20% of Ergobaby’s purchases in 2014. The Orbit Baby stroller systems and accessories manufactured in China and purchases from its primary China based manufacturing facility accounted for approximately 22% of Erbobaby purchases. Ergobaby’s manufacturers in China, Vietnam and India have the additional capacity to accommodate Ergobaby’s projected growth. Intellectual Property Ergobaby maintains a utility patent on its standard carrier, which was filed in 2003 and issued January 29, 2009. Ergobaby also has 19 patents and 2 patents pending for its Orbit Baby technology including Smart Hub. Ergobaby also depends on brand name recognition and premium product offering to differentiate itself from competition. Regulatory Environment Management is not aware of any existing, pending, or contingent liabilities that could have a material adverse effect on Ergobaby’s business. Ergobaby is proactive regarding regulatory issues and is in compliance with all relevant regulations. Ergobaby maintains adequate product liability insurance coverage and to date has not incurred any losses. Management is not aware of any potential environmental issues. Employees As of December 31, 2014 Ergobaby employed 97 persons in 5 locations. (cid:2)one of Ergobaby’s employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. We believe that Ergobaby’s relationship with its employees is good. Liberty Safe Overview Liberty Safe, headquartered in Payson, Utah and founded in 1988, is the premier designer, manufacturer and marketer of home, gun and office safes in (cid:2)orth America. From its over 314,000 square foot manufacturing facility, Liberty Safe produces a wide range of home, office and gun safe models in a broad assortment of sizes, features and styles ranging from an entry level product to good, better and best products. Products are marketed under the Liberty Safe brand, as well as a portfolio of licensed and private label brands, including Remington, Cabela’s and John Deere. Liberty Safe’s products are the market share leader and are sold through an independent dealer network (“Dealer sales”) in addition to various sporting goods and home improvement retail outlets (“(cid:2)on-Dealer sales” or “(cid:2)ational sales”). Liberty Safe has the largest independent dealer network in the industry. Historically, approximately 60% of Liberty Safe’s sales are (cid:2)on-Dealer sales and 40% are Dealer sales. For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, Liberty Safe had net sales of approximately $90.1 million, $126.5 million and $91.6 million, respectively, and operating loss of $2.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2014, and operating income of $12.5 million and $6.0 million in the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 respectively. Liberty Safe had total assets of $78.2 million and $94.8 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. (cid:2)et sales from Liberty Safe represented 9.2%, 12.8% and 10.4% of our consolidated net sales for the year ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. History of Liberty Safe The Liberty Safe brand and its leading market share has been built over a 26 year history of superior product quality, engineering and design innovation, and leading customer service and sales support. Liberty Safe has a long history of continuous improvement and innovative approaches to sales and marketing, product development and manufacturing processes. Significant investments over the last five years have solidified Liberty Safe’s reputation for providing substantial value to retailers and enhanced its long- standing position as the leading producer of premium home, office and gun safes. Liberty Safe commenced operations in 1988 and throughout 1991 and 1992, increased its distribution capabilities, establishing a regional sales force model to better serve the Dealer channel. This expanded sales coverage gave Liberty Safe the needed organizational structure to provide ready support and products nationwide, helping to establish its reputation for service to its customers. On the strength of its growing reputation and national sales presence, Liberty Safe achieved the status of the #1 selling safe company in America in 1994, according to Sargent and Greenleaf data, the major lock supplier to the industry, a position that it has maintained to this day. In 2001, Liberty Safe opened its current 314,000 square foot state-of-the-art facility in Payson, UT and consolidated all of its manufacturing and distribution operations to a centralized location. As the only facility in the industry 27 utilizing significant automation and a streamlined roll-form manufacturing process, it represented a significant step forward when compared to the production capabilities of its competitors. Incremental investments following the consolidation have solidified Liberty Safe’s position as the pre-eminent low-cost and most efficient domestic manufacturer. Beginning in 2007, Liberty Safe reorganized its manufacturing process, retooled its product line for increased standardization throughout the production process and realigned employee incentives to increase labor efficiency. These improvements enabled Liberty Safe to shift from build-to-stock production to build-to-order with shorter lead time requirements, greater labor efficiency and reduced working capital. During 2011 Liberty Safe constructed a new production line that has allowed Liberty to build entry level safe products in-house. This production line produces home and gun safe models that were previously completely sourced through foreign manufacturers. The production line began operations in February 2012 and Liberty is currently manufacturing five different sizes of safes on this line which translates into several new SKUs. Liberty invested over $9.0 million to build the line. This investment in production capacity now makes Liberty Safe the largest manufacturer of home, office and gun safes in the world. This added investment in capacity in the U.S. will allow Liberty Safe to provide shorter lead times and more competitive pricing to its (cid:2)orth American customer base. This will allow Liberty Safe to capture additional market share, growing its revenue base and adding more margin dollars to the bottom line. We purchased a majority interest in Liberty Safe on March 31, 2010. Industry Liberty Safe competes in the broadly defined (cid:2)orth American safe industry which includes fire and document safes, media and data safes, depository safes, gun safes and cabinets, home safes and hotel safes. According to Global Industry Analysts, (“GIA”) March 2008 report, the global safe industry was estimated to be approximately $2.9 billion of wholesale sales in 2008, and grew consistently at an estimated CAGR of 4.3% from 2000 to 2009. Consistent growth has been one of the defining characteristics of this industry, and GIA anticipates it will continue at a rate of 4.4% from 2009 through 2015. The safe industry experienced a boom and bust cycle in 2013 and 2014 as a result of the threat of increased legislation regulating gun ownership prompting significant demand in 2013. The significant increase in demand experienced in 2013 subsided in 2014 as retail chains over bought inventory in late 2013, resulting in depressed sales throughout 2014 for gun safe manufacturers. Products & Services Liberty Safe offers home, office and gun safes with retail prices ranging from $400 to $8,000. Liberty Safe produces 39 home and gun safe models with the most varied assortment of sizes, feature upgrades, accessories and styling options in the industry. Liberty Safe’s premium home and gun safe product line covers sizes from 12 cu. ft. to 50 cu. ft. with smaller sizes available for its personal home safe. Liberty also imports over 40 home and gun safe models primarily for sales to (cid:2)on-Dealer accounts. Liberty Safe markets its products under Company-owned brands and a portfolio of licensed and private label brands, including Remington, Cabela’s, John Deere and others. Liberty Safe also sells commercial safes, vault doors, handgun vaults, and a number of accessories and options. The overwhelming majority of revenue is derived from the sales of safes. Competitive Strengths #1 Premium Home and Gun Safe Brand with Strong Momentum in the Market—Liberty Safe achieved the status of #1 selling safe company in America in 1994 (per statistics provided by Sargent & Greenleaf, the primary lock supplier to the industry) and maintains this prominent position today. Management estimates that Liberty Safe’s net sales are over twice those of its next largest competitor in the category. Liberty Safe continues to gain market share from the various smaller participants who lack the distribution and sales and marketing capabilities of Liberty Safe. State-of-the-Art and Scalable Operations—Over the past five years, management has constructed a highly scalable operational platform and infrastructure that has positioned Liberty Safe for substantial sales growth and enhanced profitability in the coming years. Liberty Safe transitioned itself from a manufacturing oriented operating culture to a demand-based, sales-oriented organization. It’s strategic transition required the implementation of a demand-based sales and operating platform, which included (i) new equipment to drive automation and capacity improvements; (ii) re-engineered product lines and production processes to drive efficiency through greater standardization in production; and (iii) new employee incentives tied to labor efficiency, which has improved worker performance as well as employee attitude. These initiatives are enhanced by an experienced senior executive team, a balanced sourcing and in-house manufacturing production strategy, advanced distribution capabilities and sophisticated IT systems. Liberty has combined its demand-based sales and operating initiatives with upgraded production equipment to drive 28 multiple operational improvements. Since 2007, Liberty has reduced its lead times from 4 – 6 weeks to approximately fourteen days. These shorter production cycles coupled with better demand forecasting have significantly reduced working capital needs for the business by reducing domestic inventory from approximately 7,000 units to 3,000 units since 2007. During a period of 2013 lead times actually increased due to a significant spike in demand for safes from its customers. That demand spike subsided towards the end of fiscal 2013 where again, shorter lead times were experienced. Improved automation and workflow organization have decreased labor hours over 20% per safe from 8.3 in 2005 to 6.3 in 2012 for rolled steel safes. These recent initiatives combined with Liberty’s cumulative historical investments in operational capabilities have created a lasting competitive advantage over its smaller competitors, who utilize labor-intensive operations and lack the company’s lean manufacturing culture. Historically, Liberty Safe maintained an optimal mix of in-house and Asian-sourced manufacturing in order to improve its ability to meet customer inventory needs. Beginning in 2012, Liberty Safe began manufacturing entry level safes that were previously completely sourced from an Asian manufacturer, on its new production line. In 2013, the market enjoyed unprecedented heightened demand related to gun sales resulting from threats of additional gun legislation. This caused Liberty Safe to reinstitute its import channel of safes. In 2014, approximately 84% of safes were made in the United States while the balance came from imported product. This was necessary as demand exceeded Liberty’s manufacturing capacity in 2013. As a result of the boom and bust cycle experienced by Liberty, and the return to more normalized levels of demand, Liberty canceled its import channel of safes during the second half of 2014. Liberty Safe has leased for the past ten years a manufacturing and distribution facility in Payson, Utah that management believes represents the most scalable domestic facility in the industry. Liberty Safe’s multi-faceted production capabilities allow for substantial flexibility and scalable capacity, thus assuring a level of supply chain execution far superior to any of its competitors. Reputation for High Quality Products—Liberty Safe offers only the highest quality products on a consistent basis, which over the years has gained it an enviable reputation and a key point of differentiation from its competitors. Liberty Safe distinguishes its products through tested security and fire protection features and industry leading design focused on functionality and aesthetics. The design of its safes meet rigorous internal benchmarks for security and fire protection, with most receiving certification from Underwriters Laboratory, Inc. (“UL”), the leading product safety standard certification, for its security capabilities. Additionally, Liberty Safe’s investment in accessories and feature options have made Liberty safes the most visually appealing and functional in the industry, while providing more customized solutions for retailers and consumers. Trusted Supplier to (cid:2)ational Retailer and Dealer Accounts—Liberty Safe’s comprehensive, high-quality product offering and sophisticated sales and marketing programs have made it a critical supplier to a diverse group of national accounts and dealers. Initially a key supplier primarily to the dealer channel, it has expanded its business with national accounts, such as Gander Mountain, Cabela’s and John Deere. Liberty Safe provides a superior value proposition as a supplier for its national retailers and dealers via its well-recognized brands, lifetime product warranty, tailored merchandising, category management solutions and superior supply chain execution. Further, Liberty Safe’s products generate more profitable floor-space, with both high absolute gross profit and retail margins over 30%. High retail profitability plus increased inventory turns has entrenched Liberty Safe as a key partner in customers’ success in the safe category. As a core element of building its relationships, Liberty Safe has invested significantly in making its retailers better salespeople through a proprietary suite of training tools, including in-store training, new product demonstrations, online education programs and sales strategy literature. Business Strategies Liberty Safe has experienced strong historical growth while executing on multiple new sales and operational initiatives, positioning it to continue to increase its scale and improve profitability. Liberty’s growth strategy is rooted in the sales and marketing and operational initiatives that have spurred its expansion into new accounts and increased penetration of existing accounts. Liberty has significant opportunity in its existing channels to continue to build upon its already strong market share. In addition to growth within its current channels, Liberty’s core competencies can be successfully applied to ventures in the broader security equipment market. Liberty has explored certain of these opportunities, but due to the prioritization of operational initiatives and expansion opportunities within existing channels, they have not been aggressively pursued. Potential near-to-medium term areas for expansion of Liberty’s platform include: • Expand Liberty’s product line into the broader home and office safe market through current customers or new distribution strategies; • Further develop international distribution by entering new countries and expanding current limited presence in Canada, Mexico and Europe; 29 • Enter the residential security market through a strategic partnership with a provider of residential security service solutions to provide a more complete physical and electronic security solution; • Acquire businesses within the premium home and gun safe industry and/or leverage Liberty’s platform into new products or channels; and • Offer additional accessory products to existing distribution networks Research and Development Liberty Safe is the engineering and design leader in its sector, due to a history of first-to-market features and standard-setting design improvements. Liberty’s proactive solicitation of feedback and constant interaction with consumers and retail customers across diverse channels and geographies enables Liberty Safe to stay at the forefront of customer demands. Liberty’s approach to product development increases the likelihood of market acceptance by creating products that are more relevant to consumers’ demands. Research and development costs were $1.0 million in 2014, $0.7 million in 2013 and $0.8 million in 2012. The below charts represents some of the recent innovations in product design (and functionality) that have come about from Liberty’s dedication to R&D: Product Cool Pocket ™ Integrated lighting system Palusol Heat activated door Liberty Tough Doors Marble gloss powder coat paint 4 in 1 Flex storage system Door panels Magnetic magazine mount Bright view wand light kit Bow hanger Safe Alert sensor Function/Benefit Keeps documents 50% cooler than rest of safe Automatic on/off interior lights Seal expands seven times its size in fire Enhanced protection against side bolt prying Provides smooth glass finish Adjustable shelving configurations Pocket variety to store handguns and other items Ammunition storage that adhere to any surface Provides better lighting solution. Allows bow to hang in safe Moniters and alerts owners of temperatures inside the safe In addition to product enhancements, new products, such as the Fatboy® Series and the plate-door (cid:2)ational Security Classic, have been launched from Liberty’s commitment to R&D. Based on consumer feedback, Liberty saw demand for safes that were capable of holding more valuables within the safe but at a lower price point than Liberty’s current large safe models. Within 3 months of conception, Liberty introduced the successful Fatboy® series in February 2010. The Fatboy® and Fatboy Jr.® models, which are wider and deeper than traditional safes, were a natural complement to Liberty’s current products, targeted at a specific customer need. The introduction and success of the Fatboy® series demonstrates Liberty’s proven ability to recognize market opportunities, engineer a responsive product and execute market delivery. Beginning in 2012 Liberty Safe introduced five new SKUs, manufactured on its new production line, with a unique locking system to service the entry level safe market. Customers Liberty Safe has fostered long-term relationships with leading national retailers ((cid:2)ational or (cid:2)on-Dealer) as well as numerous Dealers, enabling Liberty Safe to achieve considerable brand awareness and channel exposure. Traditionally, the Dealer channel has accounted for the majority of the Liberty Safe’s sales, but through significant investment in its national accounts sales and marketing efforts, Liberty Safe has also become the leading supplier to (cid:2)ational accounts. Expansion into (cid:2)ational accounts is part of Liberty Safe’s strategy to reach a broader customer base and more varied demographics. (cid:2)ational account customers include sporting goods retailers, farm & fleet retailers, home improvement retailers and club retailers. As of December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, Liberty Safe had 14, 15 and 16 (cid:2)on-Dealer account customers, respectively, that are estimated to have accounted for approximately 56%, 59% and 57% of net sales, respectively. 30 Dealer customers include local hunting and fishing stores, hardware stores and numerous other local, independent store models. As of December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, there were 321, 306 and 343 Dealers that accounted for 44%, 41% and 43% of net sales, respectively. Liberty Safe’s largest customer accounted for approximately16.7%, 18.0% and 15.0% of net sales in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Sales & Marketing Liberty Safe possesses robust sales and marketing capabilities in the safe industry. Liberty Safe utilizes separate sales teams for (cid:2)ational accounts and Dealers, which enables it to provide more focused and effective strategies to manage and develop relationships within different channels. Liberty Safe has made significant recent investments in the development of a comprehensive sales and marketing program including merchandising, sales training and tools, promotions and supply chain management. Through these various initiatives, Liberty Safe offers highly adaptable programs to suit the varying needs of its retailers. This has enabled Liberty Safe to become a key supplier across diverse channels. Liberty Safe began advertising nationally on the Glenn Beck radio show in the second half of 2010. This advertising has been highly successful and Liberty has continued this advertising in each of the following years and intends on continuing this advertisement in the future. Liberty Safe’s comprehensive service offering makes it uniquely suited to service national retailers in a variety of channels. Liberty Safe has designed a Store-within-a-Store program and a more comprehensive Safe Category Management program to build relationships and increase its importance to retailers. Primarily utilized with sporting goods retailers, the Store-within-a-Store concept successfully integrates the effective sales strategies of its dealers for selling a high-price point, niche product into a larger store format. Centered on communicating the benefits of its products to customers, the program enables retailers to more effectively up-sell customers through a good-better-best merchandising platform, increasing margin and inventory turns for its retailers. Liberty’s Safe Category Management program builds on the Store-within-a-Store concept to provide greater sales and marketing control and more complete inventory management solutions. This program facilitates Liberty Safe becoming the sole supplier to retailers, providing large incremental expansion and stronger relationships at accounts. (cid:2)o other market participant has the capabilities to provide a comprehensive suite of customer service solutions to national retailers, such as customized SKU programs, a Store-within-a-Store program and a Safe Category Management program. Liberty’s sales are typically lowest in the second fiscal quarter due to lower demand for safes at the onset of summer, although this was not the case in 2013 due to significant sales backlog experienced throughout the year. Competition Liberty Safe is the premier brand in the premium home and gun safe industry, with an estimated 34% market share in the category. Liberty is in a class by itself when it comes to manufacturing technology and efficiency and supply chain capabilities. Competitors are generally more heavily focused on either smaller, sourced safes or large, domestically produced safes. Competitive domestic manufacturers run “blacksmith” type factories that are small, inefficient and require a tremendous amount of manual labor that produces inconsistent product. In addition, many of Liberty’s competitors are directly tied to a third-party brand, such as Browning, Winchester or RedHead / Bass Pro. Liberty competes with other safe manufacturers based on price, breadth of product line, technology, product supply chain capabilities and marketing capabilities. Channel diversity in the premium home and gun safe industry is rare, with most companies having greater concentration in either the dealer channel or national accounts, but rarely having the supply chain capabilities or sales and marketing programs to service both channels effectively such as Liberty Safe does. Major competitors have limited sales and marketing departments and programs, making it difficult for them to expand sales and gain market share. Suppliers Liberty’s primary raw materials are steel, sheetrock, wood, locks, handles and fabric, for which it receives multiple shipments per week. Materials, on average, account for approximately 60% of the total cost of a safe, with steel accounting for approximately 40% of material costs. Liberty purchases its materials from a combination of domestic and foreign suppliers. Historically, Liberty Safe has been able to pass on raw material price increases to its customers. Liberty purchased 28.5 million pounds of steel in 2014 primarily from domestic suppliers, using contracts that lock in prices two to three fiscal quarters in advance. Liberty Safe purchases coiled and flat steel in gauges from four to fourteen. Liberty Safe 31 specifies rigorous requirements related to surface and edge finish and grain direction. All steel products are checked to ASTM specification and dimensional tolerances before entering the production process. Liberty Safe had approximately $9.5 million and $9.1 million in firm backlog orders at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Intellectual Property Liberty Safe relies upon a combination of patents and trademarks in order to secure and protect its intellectual property rights. Liberty Safe currently owns 32 trademarks and 4 patents on proprietary technologies for safe products. Regulatory Environment Liberty Safes’ management believes that Liberty Safe is in compliance with applicable environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. Liberty Safe has recently moved to a powder paint application in order to reduce hazardous VOC emissions. Employees As of December 31, 2014, Liberty Safe had 315 full-time employees and 92 temporary employees. Liberty’s labor force is non- union. Management believes that Liberty Safe has an excellent relationship with its employees. (cid:2)iche Industrial Businesses Advanced Circuits Overview Advanced Circuits, headquartered in Aurora, Colorado, is a provider of small-run, quick-turn and production rigid PCBs, throughout the United States. Advanced Circuits also provides its customers with assembly services in order to meet its customers’ complete PCB needs. The small-run and quick-turn portions of the PCB industry are characterized by customers requiring high levels of responsiveness, technical support and timely delivery. Due to the critical roles that PCBs play in the research and development process of electronics, customers often place more emphasis on the turnaround time and quality of a customized PCB than on the price. Advanced Circuits meets this market need by manufacturing and delivering custom PCBs in as little as 24 hours, providing customers with over 98% error-free production and real-time customer service and product tracking 24 hours per day. In each of the years 2014, 2013 and 2012, over 60% of Advanced Circuits’ sales were derived from highly profitable small-run and quick- turn production PCBs. Advanced Circuits’ success is demonstrated by its broad base of over 11,000 customers with which it does business throughout the year. For the full fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, Advanced Circuits had net sales of approximately $85.9 million, $87.4 million and $84.1 million, respectively, and operating income of $22.5 million, $22.9 million and $24.0 million, respectively. Advanced Circuits had total assets of $82.1 million and $84.7 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. (cid:2)et sales from Advanced Circuits represented 8.7%, 8.9% and 9.5% of our consolidated net sales for the years 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. History of Advanced Circuits Advanced Circuits commenced operations in 1989 through the acquisition of a small Denver based PCB manufacturer, Seiko Circuits. During its first years of operations, Advanced Circuits focused exclusively on manufacturing high volume, production run PCBs with a small group of proportionately large customers. In 1992, after the loss of a significant customer, Advanced Circuits made a strategic shift to limit its dependence on any one customer. As a result, Advanced Circuits began focusing on developing a diverse customer base, and in particular, on meeting the demands of equipment manufacturers with low volume, high margin, customized small-run and quick-turn PCBs. In 1997, Advanced Circuits increased its capacity and consolidated its facilities into its current headquarters in Aurora, Colorado. In 2003, to support its growth, Advanced Circuits expanded its PCB manufacturing facility by approximately 37,000 square feet or approximately 150%. In 2013 Advanced Circuits added approximately 50,000 square feet and moved its administrative and engineering group next door to its production facilities. 32 In March 2010, Advanced Circuits acquired Circuit Express, Inc. (“CEI”) for approximately $16.1 million. Based in Tempe, Arizona and founded in 1987, CEI focuses on quick-turn and small-run manufacturing of rigid PCBs primarily for aerospace and defense related industry customers. CEI also specializes in expedited delivery in as fast as 24 hours. On May 23, 2012, Advanced Circuits acquired Universal Circuits, Inc. (“UCI”) for approximately $2.3 million. UCI supplies PCBs to major military, aerospace, and medical original equipment manufacturers and contract manufacturers. UCI’s Minnesota facility meets certain Department of Defense clearance requirements and is noted for custom and advanced technologies. Universal Circuits’ sales are primarily in the long-lead sector. We purchased a controlling interest in Advanced Circuits on May 16, 2006. Industry The PCB industry, which consists of both large global PCB manufacturers and small regional PCB manufacturers, is a vital component to all electronic equipment supply chains, as PCBs serve as the foundation for virtually all electronic products, including cellular telephones, appliances, personal computers, routers, switches and network servers. PCBs are used by manufacturers of these types of electronic products, as well as by persons and teams engaged in research and development of new types of equipment and technologies. Production of PCBs in (cid:2)orth America has declined since 2000 and was flat in fiscal 2014, with a less than 1% decrease as compared to 2013, according to the IPC 2014 Analysis. Orders for the fourth quarter of 2014 increased as compared to the fourth quarter in 2013, indicating that 2015 (cid:2)orth American PCB production should have modest growth compared to 2014. The rapid decline in United States production was caused by (i) reduced demand for and spending on PCBs following the technology and telecom industry decline in early 2000; and (ii) increased competition for volume production of PCBs from Asian competitors benefiting from both lower labor costs and less restrictive waste and environmental regulations. While Asian manufacturers have made large market share gains in the PCB industry overall, small-run and quick-turn production, some of the more complex volume production and military production have remained strong in the United States. Both globally and domestically, the PCB market can be separated into three categories based on required lead time and order volume: • Small-run PCBs — These PCBs are typically manufactured for customers in research and development departments of original equipment manufacturers, or OEMs, and academic institutions. Small-run PCBs are manufactured to the specifications of the customer, within certain manufacturing guidelines designed to increase speed and reduce production costs. Prototyping is a critical stage in the research and development of new products. These small-runs are used in the design and launch of new electronic equipment and are typically ordered in volumes of 1 to 50 PCBs. Because the small- run is used primarily in the research and development phase of a new electronic product, the life cycle is relatively short and requires accelerated delivery time frames of usually less than five days and very high, error-free quality. Order, production and delivery time, as well as responsiveness with respect to each, are key factors for customers as PCBs are indispensable to their research and development activities. • Quick-Turn Production PCBs — These PCBs are used for intermediate stages of testing for new products prior to full scale production. After a new product has successfully completed the small-run phase, customers undergo test marketing and other technical testing. This stage requires production of larger quantities of PCBs in a short period of time, generally 10 days or less, while it does not yet require high production volumes. This transition stage between low-volume small- run production and volume production is known as quick-turn production. Manufacturing specifications conform strictly to end product requirements and order quantities are typically in volumes of 10 to 500. Similar to small-run PCBs, response time remains crucial as the delivery of quick-turn PCBs can be a gating item in the development of electronic products. Orders for quick-turn production PCBs conform specifically to the customer’s exact end product requirements. • Volume Production PCBs — These PCBs, which we sometimes refer to as “long lead” and “sub-contract” are used in the full scale production of electronic equipment and specifications conform strictly to end product requirements. Volume Production PCBs are ordered in large quantities, usually over 100 units, and response time is less important, ranging between 15 days to 10 weeks or more. These categories can be further distinguished based on board complexity, with each portion facing different competitive threats. Advanced Circuits competes largely in the small-run and quick-turn production portions of the (cid:2)orth American market, which have not been significantly impacted by Asian based manufacturers due to the quick response time required for these products. Management believes the (cid:2)orth American PCB market is estimated to be approximately $3.5 billion in 2015. 33 Several significant trends are present within the PCB manufacturing industry, including: • • • Increasing Customer Demand for Quick-Turn Production Services — Rapid advances in technology are significantly shortening product life-cycles and placing increased pressure on OEMs to develop new products in shorter periods of time. In response to these pressures, OEMs invest heavily in research and development, which results in a demand for PCB companies that can offer engineering support and quick-turn production services to minimize the product development process. Increasing Complexity of Electronic Equipment — OEMs are continually designing more complex and higher performance electronic equipment, requiring sophisticated PCBs. To satisfy the demand for more advanced electronic products, PCBs are produced using exotic materials and increasingly have higher layer counts and greater component densities. Maintaining the production infrastructure necessary to manufacture PCBs of increasing complexity often requires significant capital expenditures and has acted to reduce the competitiveness of local and regional PCB manufacturers lacking the scale to make such investments. Shifting of High Volume Production to Asia — Asian based manufacturers of PCBs are capitalizing on their lower labor costs and are increasing their market share of volume production of PCBs used, for example, in high-volume consumer electronics applications, such as personal computers and cell phones. Asian based manufacturers have been generally unable to meet the lead time requirements for small-run or quick-turn PCB production or the volume production of the most complex PCBs. This “off shoring” of high-volume production orders has placed increased pricing pressure and margin compression on many small domestic manufacturers that are no longer operating at full capacity. Many of these small producers are choosing to cease operations, rather than operate at a loss, as their scale, plant design and customer relationships do not allow them to focus profitably on the small-run and quick-turn sectors of the market. Products and Services A PCB is comprised of layers of laminate and contains patterns of electrical circuitry to connect electronic components. Advanced Circuits typically manufactures 2 to 20 layer PCBs, and has the capability to manufacture up even higher layer PCBs. The level of PCB complexity is determined by several characteristics, including size, layer count, density (line width and spacing), materials and functionality. Beyond complexity, a PCB’s unit cost is determined by the quantity of identical units ordered, as engineering and production setup costs per unit decrease with order volume, and required production time, as longer times often allow increased efficiencies and better production management. Advanced Circuits primarily manufactures lower complexity PCBs. To manufacture PCBs, Advanced Circuits generally receives circuit designs from its customers in the form of computer data files emailed to one of its sales representatives or uploaded on its interactive website. These files are then reviewed to ensure data accuracy and product manufacturability. While processing these computer files, Advanced Circuits generates images of the circuit patterns that are then physically developed on individual layers, using advanced photographic processes. Through a variety of plating and etching processes, conductive materials are selectively added and removed to form horizontal layers of thin circuits, called traces, which are separated by insulating material. A finished multilayer PCB laminates together a number of layers of circuitry. Vertical connections between layers are achieved by metallic plating through small holes, called vias. Vias are made by highly specialized drilling equipment capable of achieving extremely fine tolerances with high accuracy. Advanced Circuits assists its customers throughout the life-cycle of their products, from product conception through volume production. Advanced Circuits works closely with customers throughout each phase of the PCB development process, beginning with the PCB design verification stage using its unique online FreeDFM.com tool, FreeDFM.com™, which was launched in 2002, enables customers to receive a free manufacturability assessment report within minutes, resolving design problems that would prohibit manufacturability before the order process is completed and manufacturing begins. The combination of Advanced Circuits’ user-friendly website and its design verification tool reduces the amount of human labor involved in the manufacture of each order as PCBs move from Advanced Circuits’ website directly to its computer numerical control, or C(cid:2)C, machines for production, saving Advanced Circuits and customers cost and time. As a result of its ability to rapidly and reliably respond to the critical customer requirements, Advanced Circuits receives a premium for their small-run and quick-turn PCBs as compared to volume production PCBs. Advanced Circuits manufactures all high margin small-runs and quick-turn orders internally but often utilizes external partners to manufacture production orders that do not fit within its capabilities or capacity constraints at a given time. As a result, Advanced Circuits constantly adjusts the portion of volume production PCBs produced internally to both maximize profitability and ensure that internal capacity is fully utilized. 34 The following table shows Advanced Circuits’ gross revenue by products and services for the periods indicated: Gross Sales by Products and Services(1) Small-run Production Quick-Turn Production Volume Production (including assembly) Third Party Total (1) As a percentage of gross sales, exclusive of sale discounts. Competitive Strengths Year Ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 23.5% 31.3% 44.9% 0.3% 24.3% 30.6% 44.7% 0.4% 28.4% 31.9% 38.1% 1.6% 100.0% 100.0% 100.0% Advanced Circuits has established itself as a leading provider of small-run and quick-turn PCBs in (cid:2)orth America and focuses on satisfying customer demand for on-time delivery of high-quality PCBs. Advanced Circuits’ management believes the following factors differentiate it from many industry competitors: • (cid:2)umerous Unique Orders Per Day — For the year ended December 31, 2014, Advanced Circuits received on average over 300 customer orders per day. Due to the large quantity of orders received, Advanced Circuits is able to combine multiple orders in a single panel design prior to production. Through this process, Advanced Circuits is able to reduce the number of costly, labor intensive equipment set-ups required to complete several manufacturing orders. As labor represents the single largest cost of production, management believes this capability gives Advanced Circuits a unique advantage over other industry participants. Advanced Circuits maintains proprietary software that maximizes the number of units placed on any one panel design. A single panel set-up typically accommodates 1 to 12 orders. Further, as a “critical mass” of like orders is required to maximize the efficiency of this process, management believes Advanced Circuits is uniquely positioned as an efficient manufacturer of small-run and quick-turn PCBs. • Diverse Customer Base — Advanced Circuits possesses a customer base with little industry or customer concentration exposure. During fiscal year ended December 31, 2014, Advanced Circuits did business with over 11,000 customers and added over 180 new customers per month. For each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, no customer represented over 2% of net sales. • Highly Responsive Culture and Organization — A key strength of Advanced Circuits is its ability to quickly respond to customer orders and complete the production process. In contrast to many competitors that require a day or more to offer price quotes on small-run or quick-turn production, Advanced Circuits offers its customers quotes within seconds and the ability to place or track orders any time of day. In addition, Advanced Circuits’ production facility operates three shifts per day and is able to ship a customer’s product within 24 hours of receiving its order. • Proprietary FreeDFM.com Software — Advanced Circuits offers its customers unique design verification services through its online FreeDFM.com tool. This tool, which was launched in 2002, enables customers to receive a free manufacturability assessment report, within minutes, resolving design problems before customers place their orders. The service is relied upon by many of Advanced Circuits’ customers to reduce design errors and minimize production costs. Beyond improved customer service, FreeDFM.com has the added benefit of improving the efficiency of Advanced Circuits’ engineers, as many routine design problems, which typically require an engineer’s time and attention to identify, are identified and sent back to customers automatically. • Established Partner (cid:2)etwork — Advanced Circuits has established third party production relationships with PCB manufacturers in (cid:2)orth America and Asia. Through these relationships, Advanced Circuits is able to offer its customers a complete suite of products including those outside of its core production capabilities. Additionally, these relationships allow Advanced Circuits to outsource orders for volume production and focus internal capacity on higher margin, short lead time, production and quick-turn manufacturing. 35 Business Strategies Advanced Circuits’ management is focused on strategies to increase market share and further improve operating efficiencies. The following is a discussion of these strategies: Increase Portion of Revenue from Small-run and Quick-Turn Production — Advanced Circuits’ management believes it can grow revenues and cash flow by continuing to leverage its core small-run and quick-turn capabilities. Over its history, Advanced Circuits has developed a suite of capabilities that management believes allow it to offer a combination of price and customer service unequaled in the market. Though reductions in military spending have created headwinds recently, Advanced Circuits intends to leverage this factor, as well as its core skill set, to increase net sales derived from higher margin small-run and quick- turn production PCBs. In this respect, marketing and advertising efforts focus on attracting and acquiring customers that are likely to require these premium services. And while production composition may shift, growth in these products and services is not expected to come at the expense of declining sales in volume production PCBs, as Advanced Circuits intends to leverage its extensive network of third-party manufacturing partners to continue to meet customers’ demand for these services. Acquire Customers from Local and Regional Competitors — Advanced Circuits’ management believes the majority of its competition for small-run and quick-turn PCB orders comes from smaller scale local and regional PCB manufacturers. As an early mover in the small-run and quick-turn sector of the PCB market, Advanced Circuits has been able to grow faster and achieve greater production efficiencies than many industry participants. Management believes Advanced Circuits can continue to use these advantages to gain market share. Further, Advanced Circuits continues to enter into small-run and quick-turn manufacturing relationships with several subscale local and regional PCB manufacturers. Management believes that while many of these manufacturers maintain strong, longstanding customer relationships, they are unable to produce PCBs with short turn-around times at competitive prices. As a result, Advanced Circuits sees an opportunity for growth by providing production support to these manufacturers or direct support to the customers of these manufacturers, whereby the manufacturers act more as a broker for the relationship. Remain Committed to Customers and Employees — Advanced Circuits has remained focused on providing the highest quality products and services to its customers. We believe this focus has allowed Advanced Circuits to achieve its outstanding delivery and quality record. Advanced Circuits’ management believes this reputation is a key competitive differentiator and is focused on maintaining and building upon it. Similarly, management believes its committed base of employees is a key differentiating factor. Advanced Circuits currently has a profit sharing program and tri-annual bonuses for all of its employees. Management also occasionally sets additional performance targets for individuals and departments and establishes rewards, such as lunch celebrations or paid vacations, if these goals are met. Management believes that Advanced Circuits’ emphasis on sharing rewards and creating a positive work environment has led to increased loyalty. Advanced Circuits plans to continue to focus on similar programs to maintain this competitive advantage. Opportunistically Acquire Smaller PCB Manufacturers — Historically Advanced Circuits has selectively made tuck-in acquisitions of regional PCB manufacturers, including the acquisitions of Circuit Express, Inc. in 2010 and Universal Circuits, Inc. in 2012. Management will continue to seek tuck-in acquisitions of smaller PCB manufacturers where sales and operational efficiencies can be realized, or strategic technical capabilities expanded. Research and Development Advanced Circuits engages in continual research and development activities in the ordinary course of business to update or strengthen its order processing, production and delivery systems. By engaging in these activities, Advanced Circuits expects to maintain and build upon the competitive strengths from which it benefits currently. Research and development expenses were not material in each of the last three years. 36 Customers Advanced Circuits’ focus on customer service and product quality has resulted in a broad base of customers in a variety of end markets, including industrial, consumer, telecommunications, aerospace/defense, biotechnology and electronics manufacturing. These customers range in size from large, blue-chip manufacturers to small, not-for-profit university engineering departments. The following table sets forth management’s estimate of Advanced Circuits’ approximate customer breakdown by industry sector for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012: Industry Sector Electrical Equipment and Components Measuring Instruments Electronics Manufacturing Services Engineer Services Industrial and Commercial Machinery Business Services Wholesale Trade-Durable Goods Educational Institutions Transportation Equipment All Other Sectors Combined Total Customer Distribution 2014 2013 2012 22% 5% 24% 5% 11% 1% 1% 14% 11% 6% 100% 24% 7% 22% 4% 12% 1% 1% 12% 10% 7% 100% 28% 8% 20% 5% 12% 1% 1% 10% 9% 6% 100% Management estimates that over 90% of its orders are generated from existing customers. Moreover, more than half of Advanced Circuits’ orders in each of the years 2014, 2013 and 2012 were delivered within five days (not including CEI orders). In a typical year, no single customer represents more than 2% of Advanced Circuits’ sales, although in 2013, one customer represented approximately 4.5% of Advanced Circuit's sales. Sales and Marketing Advanced Circuits has established a “consumer products” marketing strategy to both acquire new customers and retain existing customers. Advanced Circuits uses initiatives such as direct mail postcards, web banners, aggressive pricing specials and proactive outbound customer call programs as part of this strategy. Advanced Circuits spends approximately 1% of net sales each year on its marketing initiatives and advertising and has 59 employees dedicated to its marketing and sales efforts. These individuals are organized geographically and each is responsible for a region of (cid:2)orth America. The sales team takes a systematic approach to placing sales calls and receiving inquiries and, on average, will place over 200 outbound sales calls and receive approximately 140 inbound phone inquiries per day. Beyond proactive customer acquisition initiatives, management believes a substantial portion of new customers are acquired through referrals from existing customers. In addition, other customers are acquired on-line where Advanced Circuits generates over 90% of its orders from its website. Once a new client is acquired, Advanced Circuits offers an easy to use customer-oriented website and proprietary online design and review tools to ensure high levels of retention. By maintaining contact with its customers to ensure satisfaction with each order, Advanced Circuits believes it has developed strong customer loyalty, as demonstrated by over 90% of its orders being received from existing customers. Included in each customer order is an Advanced Circuits prepaid “bounce-back” card on which a customer can evaluate Advanced Circuits’ services and send back any comments or recommendations. Each of these cards is read by senior members of management, and Advanced Circuits adjusts its services to respond to the requests of its customer base. Substantially all revenue is derived from sales within the United States. Advanced Circuits, due to the volume of small-run and quick turn sales, had a negligible amount in firm backlog orders at December 31, 2014 and 2013. 37 Competition There are currently an estimated 238 active domestic PCB manufacturers. Advanced Circuits’ competitors differ amongst its products and services. Competitors in the small-run and quick-turn PCBs production industry include larger companies as well as small domestic manufacturers. The two largest independent domestic small-run and quick-turn PCB manufacturers in (cid:2)orth America are TTM Technologies, Inc. and Viasystems Group, Inc. Though each of these companies produces small-run PCBs to varying degrees, in many ways they are not direct competitors with Advanced Circuits. In recent years, each of these firms has primarily focused on producing boards with greater complexity in response to the off shoring of low and medium layer count technology to Asia. Compared to Advanced Circuits, small-run and quick-turn PCB production accounts for much smaller portions of each of these firm’s revenues. Further, these competitors often have much greater customer concentrations and a greater portion of sales through large electronics manufacturing services intermediaries. Beyond large, public companies, Advanced Circuits’ competitors include numerous small, local and regional manufacturers, often with revenues under $20 million that have long-term customer relationships and typically produce both small-run and quick-turn PCBs and production PCBs for small OEMs and EMS companies. The competitive factors in small-run and quick-turn production PCBs are response time, quality, error-free production and customer service. Competitors in the long lead-time production PCBs generally include large companies, including Asian manufacturers, where price is the key competitive factor. (cid:2)ew market entrants into small-run and quick-turn production PCBs confront substantial barriers including significant investments in equipment, highly skilled workforce with extensive engineering knowledge and compliance with environmental regulations. Beyond these tangible barriers, Advanced Circuits’ management believes that its network of customers, established over the last two decades, would be very difficult for a competitor to replicate. Suppliers Advanced Circuits’ raw materials inventory is small relative to sales and must be regularly and rapidly replenished. Advanced Circuits uses a just-in-time procurement practice to maintain raw materials inventory at low levels. Additionally, Advanced Circuits has established consignment relationships with several vendors allowing it to pay for raw materials as used. Because it provides primarily lower-volume quick-turn services, this inventory policy does not hamper its ability to complete customer orders. Raw material costs constituted approximately 20%, 21% and 20% of net sales for each of the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The primary raw materials that are used in production are core materials, such as copper clad layers of glass and chemical solutions, and copper and gold for plating operations, photographic film and carbide drill bits. Multiple suppliers and sources exist for all materials. Adequate amounts of all raw materials have been available in the past, and Advanced Circuits’ management believes this will continue in the foreseeable future. Advanced Circuits works closely with its suppliers to incorporate technological advances in the raw materials they purchase. Advanced Circuits does not believe that it has significant exposure to fluctuations in raw material prices. The fact that price is not the primary factor affecting the purchase decision of many of Advanced Circuits’ customers has allowed management to historically pass along a portion of raw material price increases to its customers. Advanced Circuits does not knowingly purchase material originating in the Democratic Republic of the Congo or adjoining countries. Intellectual Property Advanced Circuits seeks to protect certain proprietary technology by entering into confidentiality and non-disclosure agreements with its employees, consultants and customers, as needed, and generally limits access to and distribution of its proprietary information and processes. Advanced Circuits’ management does not believe that patents are critical to protecting Advanced Circuits’ core intellectual property, but, rather, its effective and quick execution of fabrication techniques, its website FreeDFM.com™ and its highly skilled workforce are the primary factors in maintaining its competitive position. Advanced Circuits uses the following brand names: FreeDFM.com™, 4pcb.com™, 4PCB.com™, 33each.com™, barebonespcb.com™ and Advanced Circuits™. These trade names have strong brand equity and are material to Advanced Circuits’ business. Regulatory Environment Advanced Circuits’ manufacturing operations and facilities are subject to evolving federal, state and local environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. These include laws and regulations governing air emissions, wastewater discharge and the storage and handling of chemicals and hazardous substances. Management believes that Advanced Circuits is in compliance, in all material respects, with applicable environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. 38 (cid:2)ew requirements, more stringent application of existing requirements, or discovery of previously unknown environmental conditions may result in material environmental expenditures in the future. Advanced Circuits has been recognized three times for exemplary environmental compliance as it was awarded the Denver Metro Wastewater Reclamation District Gold Award for the seven of the last ten years. Employees As of December 31, 2014, Advanced Circuits employed 514 persons. Of these employees, there were 59 in sales and marketing. (cid:2)one of Advanced Circuits’ employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. Advanced Circuits believes its relationship with its employees is good. American Furniture Overview American Furniture, headquartered in Ecru, Mississippi, is a low cost manufacturer of upholstered furniture sold to major and mid-sized retailers. American Furniture operates in the promotional-to-moderate priced upholstered segment of the furniture industry, which is characterized by affordable prices, fresh designs and fast delivery to the retailers. American Furniture was founded in 1998 and focuses on three product categories: (i) stationary, (ii) motion (reclining sofas/loveseats) and (iii) recliners. For the full fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, American Furniture had net sales of approximately $129.7 million, $104.9 million and $91.5 million, respectively, and operating income of $3.7 million and $0.2 million, and an operating loss of $1.5 million, respectively. American Furniture had total assets of $44.0 million and $43.8 million at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. (cid:2)et sales from American Furniture represented 13.2%, 10.6% and 10.3% of our consolidated net sales for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. History of American Furniture American Furniture was founded in 1998 with a focus on promotional upholstered furniture, offering a unique value proposition combining consistent high-quality, attractively priced products and quick delivery/service to its’ customers. AFM began operations with four assembly lines housed in a 60,000 sq. ft. facility. By 2002, American Furniture had achieved revenues in excess of $120 million and grew operations into a 600,000 sq. ft. facility in Houlka, MS. In 2004, American Furniture was sold by its founder to a group of private investors who installed a new management structure and hired a new executive team and grew American Furniture’s administrative infrastructure in order to build a solid foundation to support future growth. In 2005, American Furniture aggressively pursued Asian sourcing for fabrics and other assorted materials. Today American Furniture is a leading manufacturer of promotional upholstered furniture operating from an approximately 1.1 million sq. ft. manufacturing and warehouse facility. We acquired a controlling interest in American Furniture on August 31, 2007. Industry AFM is a manufacturer of upholstered furniture serving the promotional segment of the U.S. furniture industry. Overall conditions for the furniture industry have been difficult over the past several years. (cid:2)ew housing starts are down significantly and consumers continue to be faced with general economic uncertainty fueled by deteriorating consumer credit markets, rising fuel costs and lagging consumer confidence as a result of erratic financial markets. All of this has significantly impacted big ticket consumer purchases such as furniture over the last several years. AFM participates exclusively in the promotional to moderate priced upholstered furniture industry. Within the U.S. residential retail furniture marketplace, products are typically positioned in the “promotional”, “good”, “better”, or “best” category. The scale of the categories is intended to reflect an increasing level of quality, appearance and corresponding price. At the wholesale level, the promotional to moderate priced segment of the upholstered furniture industry we believe accounts for over $5.0 billion in sales. Promotional to moderate priced upholstered furniture manufacturers typically offer a limited range of products in a discrete number of styles and/or designs, allowing immediate delivery to retail customers at well-established retail price points. Specifically, promotional upholstered furniture is generally priced by product at the retail level from $199 for recliners and up to $1,500 for motion sectionals. 39 The popularity of promotional furniture is attributable to (i) the segment’s consistent product quality (based on focused manufacturing of a few key furniture pieces), and (ii) its value pricing, which appeals to the broadest cross-section of the furniture consumers. AFM competes exclusively in the promotional to moderate priced segment, selling upholstered furniture in both the stationary and motion categories. In the retail furniture landscape, promotional furniture can be a growing catalyst of floor traffic and sales volumes for mass market furniture retailers. The moderate category allows for adding additional floor space on current dealer floors with better margins. Recurring promotional programs have often become core to retailer strategies given its immediate availability to customers and just-in-time strategies employed within the industry which limit retailer inventory requirements. Within the wholesale market, wholesale shipments from Asian suppliers, we believe, have grown steadily as a percent of total wholesale shipments. Asian upholstered imports have grown significantly in the past ten years. We believe their impact on AFM has been far less than the industry as a whole within the promotional upholstered furniture, due to the low price points and resulting shipping costs as a percent of a piece’s total value. Off-shore Imports Furniture manufactured in Asia emerged as an important driver of the U.S. residential furniture market beginning in the mid-1990s. While off-shore manufacturers, particularly Chinese and Vietnamese manufacturers, have affected the entire industry, the import trend, has impacted different segments of the industry at varying levels. Case-goods and metal furniture have proven to be more susceptible to Asian competition than upholstered furniture, due to the stack ability and assembly characteristics, resulting in efficient freight consolidation. Upholstered furniture cannot be broken down and shipped efficiently to the U.S. such that the resulting freight costs tend to outweigh the labor and material savings achieved through offshore manufacturing. As a result, domestic upholstered manufacturers have largely managed to compete effectively against Asian competitors when compared to other segments of the furniture industry. In addition, manufacturers in the promotional segment of the upholstered industry are even further insulated from offshore competition due not only to overall freight costs but also freight costs when compared to wholesale price of the product together with the prolonged lead-times to retailers and end customers in a market segment characterized by very short lead-times and immediate delivery to the end consumer. Retail price points in the promotional segment of the upholstered industry range from $199 - $1,500, whereas shipping costs from Asia on a per piece basis are generally in excess of $100 per piece ($3,000 - $4,000) per standard 40 foot container not including domestic shipping and insurance costs. Lead times also hinder Asian manufacturers’ ability to effectively compete in the promotional upholstered industry. As mentioned previously, Retailers use promotional furniture to drive store traffic and provide immediate delivery to the end-user of value- priced, quality upholstered furniture products. AFM aims to ship customer orders on time following receipt of an order and has the ability to deliver product within a customers requested ship date depending on the customers’ location within the U.S. Asian manufacturers typically require at least 50 days (or 7 - 8 weeks depending on business days) from order receipt to customer delivery, resulting in a significant amount of increased inventory management and advertising planning in order to effectively source upholstered product from overseas manufacturers. Products and Services AFM manufactures two basic categories of promotional and moderate priced upholstered products, stationary and motion. Stationary products include sofas, loveseats and sectionals, these products accounted for approximately 66%, 68% and 72% of sales in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Motion products include single rocking recliner chairs, sofas with reclining end seats, loveseats with seats that rock together or separately and reclining sectionals with storage compartments. Motion and reclining products contributed approximately 34%, 28% and 27% of fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012 gross sales, respectively. For 2014, 2013 and 2012, accent tables and other miscellaneous revenue accounted for less than 2% of gross sales. AFM’s core product offerings with average retail prices are summarized below: • • • • • 25 styles of stationary sofas, loveseats and chairs - $299 - $599 10 styles of recliners -$199 - $399 5 styles of motion sofas - $599 - $899 6 styles of stationary sectionals - Up to $999 1 style of motion sectional - $999 - $1,499 40 AFM’s products utilize common components and frames with limited fabric options, allowing AFM to reproduce established styles at value prices. Since its inception, AFM has continuously introduced new styles which typically replace older designs and are primarily slight variations to existing products. AFM builds its products to stock and maintains adequate inventory levels to facilitate shipment to customers on time. AFM’s quick-ship strategy allows customers to better manage inventory and product promotions, yet maintain the ability to provide immediate availability to retail customers, a key attribute within the promotional furniture segment of the furniture industry. Product Development AFM can re-engineer a new design, create a prototype and begin to solicit customer feedback within two weeks. AFM carefully controls its product line such that new styles typically replace older designs. As a result, AFM requires up to 120 days wind-down a discontinued line and beginning shipping truckload quantities of new designs to customers. Manufacturing AFM utilizes an assembly-line manufacturing process with a four day production cycle divided into four functions, cutting, sewing, backfill and upholstery. Employees are specialized by function and are compensated on a piece-rate basis. The limited number of styles and designs minimizes scheduling and line changes and each function is simplified by the use of common components. AFM uses one standard seat spring, one standard back spring and one standard cushion in each category of upholstery. AFM’s piece-rate compensation plan and streamlined manufacturing process combine to give AFM a low cost structure. Prior to 2009, American Furniture utilized pre-assembled cut and sewn fabric kits for approximately 20% of its upholstered furniture. These fabric kits replace the cutting and sewing function in the manufacturing process. Over the past several years AFM has increased the use of these fabric kits and virtually all of the upholstered furniture that it manufactures now uses the imported cut and sewn fabric kit. The use of these fabric kits reduces the labor component related to the cutting and sewing process in-house. These fabric kits are imported from Asia. American Furniture also eliminated its in-house frame cutting operations in 2012 and currently 100% of the frames for upholstered furniture are cut by third party providers. AFM currently delivers its products through third-party freight service providers. Freight costs are generally paid by the customer, including fuel surcharges. AFM utilized third-party freight providers for approximately 80% of its customer shipments over the last three years compared to approximately 50% or lower in prior years. We estimate that this saved approximately $1.0 million in 2010 and 2011 in overall freight costs when this strategy was first instituted. American Furniture eliminated its in-house trucking operations in 2012. Competitive Strengths Management believes that AFM is among the lowest-cost domestic manufacturers of promotional to moderate priced upholstered furniture. AFM maintains a competitive cost basis through an assembly-line production model and build-to-stock strategy. Specifically, AFM generates economies of scale through: • Long runs of a limited number of standardized frames; • The application of common components throughout the entire production line; and • A standard offering of only two to four fabric options per frame. Management has aligned AFM’s high-volume manufacturing strategy with a piece-rate incentive structure for its direct labor force. This structure drives workforce productivity. The incentive system also provides floor personnel with the opportunity to earn annual compensation at or above local standards, thereby facilitating AFM’s recruiting and retention efforts. AFM’s efficient build-to-stock manufacturing operation facilitates AFM’s strategy of offering its customers on -time shipment of product. In turn, AFM’s customers are able to offer their retail customers quality, value-priced, upholstered furniture for immediate delivery upon the day of sale, while only maintaining limited quantities of product inventory. AFM serves a diverse base of approximately 700 customers. Within its broader customer base, AFM specifically targets independent furniture retailers at the national, multi-regional and regional levels. AFM’s value proposition and the ability to ship most products within their customers’ time frame, is highly valued by this segment of the marketplace that focuses broadly on demographic segments that demand immediate delivery of popular styles at competitive prices. 41 Barriers to Significant Asian Competition The availability of low-cost Asian products has had a far-reaching impact on the broader home furnishings market in the United States over the past ten years, contrasted to manufacturers serving other segments. Until recently, AFM has had minimal exposure to off-shore competition due to the following: • AFM’s efficient, low-cost production model; • Mass retailers’ short lead-time demands and unwillingness to accept excess inventory risk; and • High costs (e.g., freight, damage, shrink) of shipping upholstered furniture direct from Asia. Recently, AFM has have begun to see more competition in the motion product category from imported Asian product. These products typically offer customers better value in terms of construction and price when compared to our motion product. AFM’s margin for motion product has typically been less than stationary. Business Strategies Increase profit with new and existing customers —While AFM currently supplies many of the top furniture retailers, AFM believes it can further augment its customer base and is pursuing new business opportunities with selected national and regional furniture retailers, as well as in other channels. In addition, many existing customers currently purchase only a portion of AFM’s product line, representing an opportunity for AFM to increase sales to existing customers by augmenting customers’ entire promotional product line. In order to focus additional attention to major customers and expand product–line sell-through to these customers, AFM added significant infrastructure to its sales and marketing organization since 2005, increasing its sales representative network while also subdividing sales territories to allow representatives to focus more closely on the expansion of existing relationships and the addition of new customers. Product development—AFM’s merchandising strategy focuses on satisfying the changing needs of retailers and consumers in a manner that meets AFM’s production strategy. AFM’s management and sales staff monitor the furniture market to identify new trends and popular styles at higher price points. AFM subsequently ensures that it can cost effectively replicate a new style with standardized components and limited cover options, after which AFM will build a prototype to determine if the product can be reproduced at acceptable margin levels. Pursue cost savings initiatives—Aggressively pursue expense reduction in the manufacturing process and overhead areas, cost cutting programs and cash preservation initiatives throughout all parts of its business. Limit the number of SKUs – American Furniture manufactures a limited number of SKUs in three categories: stationary, recliners and motion. The strategy has been to continually manage the number of groups or styles in each category so that American Furniture can mitigate the costs associated with slow moving and outdated styles. Revise kit purchasing – American Furniture, with the help of an outside consultant, has revised the manner in which it orders fabric kits to provide a more efficient flow of kits and reduce the possibility of obsolescence. A process has been developed taking into account rate of sale, customer projections, current inventory levels, delivery lead times and safety stock for each individual SKU. A review is completed no less than weekly by SKU and orders are placed accordingly. Managing this process ties kit acquisition more closely to actual production needs and either increases or decreases the quantity of kits based on demand for the particular SKU. Monetize excess stock – During 2013, American Furniture aggressively moved to reduce excess levels of finished goods and raw materials. This was done through a series of product promotions that have been successful while not impairing the sales of the current product line. American Furniture developed a new system to monitor each category on an ongoing basis to more quickly identify potential slow-down in specific SKU activity. This process has been integrated with the kit purchasing procedure mentioned above. Customers AFM serves a base of approximately 700 customers comprised of retailers and distributors at the regional, multi-regional and national levels. In 2014, 2013 and 2012, AFM’s top 20 customers accounted for approximately 73%, 70% and 67%, respectively, of AFM’s total sales. 42 Sales and Marketing AFM has a sales force consisting of independent, outside representatives that exclusively sell AFM’s products in an assigned geographic territory of up to six states. Sales representatives are compensated on a 100% commission basis. AFM maintains two permanent showrooms in High Point, (cid:2)C and Las Vegas, (cid:2)V, host cities for furniture industry trade shows (High Point in April and October and Las Vegas in January and July). American Furniture’s business is seasonal. (cid:2)et sales have historically been higher in the period of January through April of each fiscal year. We believe this seasonality is due in part to consumer demand increasing resulting from income tax refunds. Substantially all revenue is derived from sales within the United States. Marketing at the retail level is typically handled by AFM’s customers. AFM does not advertise specific products on its own, but provides product information and pictures for retailers to include in newspaper and various insert advertisements. AFM’s products are typically included in retailers’ recurring promotional programs as the products drive floor traffic and sales volume due to low price points. American Furniture had approximately $24.6 million and $11.2 million in firm backlog orders at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Competition AFM competes with selected large national manufacturers that produce and sell promotional products. However, promotional upholstered furniture often represents only a small percentage of revenue for these participants. Also, large diversified manufacturers tend not to place specific emphasis on developing quick-ship capabilities specifically for their promotional offerings. Therefore, AFM competes primarily with several smaller manufacturers that are typically thinly-capitalized, family owned businesses that we believe do not have the capacity, manufacturing capabilities, sourcing expertise or access to capital in order to build critical production volumes. Competition within the segment is largely based on value and delivery lead times, as opposed to product differentiation, providing AFM and its quick-ship capabilities with a key competitive advantage within the industry. AFM’s primary competitors include United Furniture Industries, Albany Industries and Hughes Furniture, Ashley Furniture and Affordable Furniture. Suppliers A majority of AFM’s domestic suppliers are located near AFM due to a concentration of furniture manufacturers in northeastern Mississippi. Several of AFM’s key raw materials, including wood and polyfoam, are sourced locally with alternative suppliers available at competitive prices, if necessary. In order to continually manage material costs, AFM actively sources products from Asia. AFM imports legs, show wood, accent tables and the majority of its fabric from China-based suppliers. The prices charged by manufacturers of products such as petro-chemicals and wire rod, which are the primary materials purchased by our suppliers of foam and drawn wire effect the ongoing cost of our raw materials. Raw material cost as a percentage of sales was approximately 74% in 2014, and 67% in 2013 and 2012, respectively. Regulatory Environment AFM’s manufacturing operations, facilities and operations are subject to evolving federal, state and local environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. Such laws and regulations govern air emissions, wastewater discharge and the storage and handling of chemicals and hazardous substances. AFM believes that it is in compliance, in all material respects, with applicable environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. (cid:2)ew requirements, more stringent application of existing requirements, or discovery of previously unknown environmental conditions could result in material environmental expenditures in the future. Employees As of December 31, 2014, American Furniture employed 556 persons. Of these employees, 482 were in production, shipping and purchasing with the remainder serving in executive, administrative office and other capacities. (cid:2)one of AFM’s employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. We believe that AFM’s relationship with its employees is good. 43 Arnold Overview Founded in 1895 and now headquartered in Rochester, (cid:2)ew York, Arnold Magnetic Technologies Corporation is a manufacturer of engineered, application specific magnet solutions. Arnold manufactures a wide range of permanent magnets and precision magnetic assemblies with facilities in the United States, the United Kingdom, Switzerland and China. Arnold has hundreds of customers in its primary markets including aerospace and defense, consumer, industrial, medical, automotive as well as oil and gas exploration. Arnold is the largest and, we believe, most technically advanced U.S. manufacturer of engineered magnets. Arnold is one of two domestic producers to design, engineer and manufacture rare earth magnetic solutions. Arnold serves customers and generates revenues via three business units: • • • PMAG – Permanent Magnet and Assemblies Group- High performance magnets and assemblies for precision motors/ generators, Hall Effect sensor and beam focusing applications. PMAG also manufactures assemblies for the reprographic industry used in printing and copying systems. Precision Thin Metals - Ultra thin gauge metal strip and foil products utilizing magnetic and non-magnetic alloys Flexmag™ - Flexible bonded magnets for specialty advertising, industrial and medical applications. Arnold operates a 70,000 sq. ft. manufacturing assembly and distribution facility in Rochester, (cid:2)ew York with nine additional facilities worldwide in countries including the UK, Switzerland and China. For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, (from date of acquisition), Arnold had net sales of approximately $123.2 million, $126.6 million and $104.2 million, respectively, with operating income of $7.1 million in 2014, $8.9 million in 2013 and operating loss of $0.5 million in 2012. Arnold had total assets of $144.8 million and $156.4 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. (cid:2)et sales from Arnold represented 12.5% and 12.8% and of our consolidated net sales for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, and 11.8% of our consolidated net sales from acquisition date to December 31, 2012. History of Arnold Arnold was founded in 1895 as the Arnold Electric Power Station Company. Arnold began producing Al(cid:2)iCo permanent magnets in its Marengo, Illinois facility in the mid-1930s. In 1946, Allegheny Ludlum Steel Corporation (Allegheny) purchased Arnold, and over the next few years began production of several additional magnetic product lines under license agreement with the Western Electric Company. In 1970, Arnold acquired Ogallala Electronics, which manufactured high power coils and electromagnets. SPS Technologies (SPS), at the time a publicly traded company, purchased Arnold Engineering Company from Allegheny in 1986. Under SPS, Arnold made a series of acquisitions and partnerships to expand its portfolio and geographic reach. At the end of 2003, Precision Castparts, also a publicly traded company acquired SPS. In January 2005, Audax, a Boston-based private equity firm acquired Arnold from Precision Castparts. In February 2007, Arnold Magnetic Technologies completed the acquisition of Precision Magnetics with operations in Sheffield, England; Lupfig, Switzerland; and Wayne, (cid:2)ew Jersey. The Wayne, (cid:2)ew Jersey facility was relocated to Rochester, (cid:2)Y later that year. In addition, Arnold’s Lupfig, Switzerland operation is a joint venture partner with a Chinese rare earth producer. The joint venture manufactures RECOMA® Samarium Cobalt blocks for the Asian market. We purchased a majority interest in Arnold on March 5, 2012. Industry Permanent Magnets There exists a broad range of permanent magnets which include Rare Earth Magnets and magnets made from specialty magnetic alloys. Magnets produced from these materials may be sliced, ground, coated and magnetized to customer requirements. Those industry players with the broadest portfolio of these magnets, such as Arnold, maintain a significant competitive advantage over competitors as they are able to offer one-stop shop capabilities to customers. Rare Earth Magnets • Samarium Cobalt (SmCo) – SmCo magnets are typically used in critical applications that require corrosion resistance or high temperature stability, such as motors, generators, actuators and sensors. Arnold markets its SmCo magnets under the trade name of RECOMA ®. • (cid:2)eodymium ((cid:2)eo) – (cid:2)eo magnets offer the highest magnetic energy level of any material in the market. Applications include motors and generators, VCM’s, magnetic resonance imaging, sensors and loudspeakers. 44 Other Permanent Magnet Types • Al(cid:2)iCo – The Al(cid:2)iCo family of magnets remains a preferred material for many mission critical applications. Its favorable linear temperature characteristics, high magnetic flux density and good corrosion resistance are ideally suited for use in applications requiring magnetic stability. • Hard Ferrite – Hard ferrite (ceramic) magnets were developed as a low cost alternative to metallic magnets (steel and Al(cid:2)iCo). Although they exhibit lower energy when compared to other materials available today and are relatively brittle, ferrite magnets have gained acceptance due to their low price per magnetic output. Injection Molded – Injection molded magnets are a composite of various types of resin and magnetic powders. The physical and magnetic properties of the product depend on the raw materials, but are generally lower in magnetic strength and resemble plastics in their physical properties. However, a major benefit of the injection molding process is that magnet material can be injection or over-molded, eliminating subsequent manufacturing steps. • Magnetic Assemblies- Arnold offers complex, customized value added magnetic assemblies. These assemblies are used in devices such as motors, generators, beam focusing arrays, sensors, and solenoid actuators. Magnetic assembly production capabilities include magnet fabrication, machining, encapsulation or sleeving, balancing, and field mapping. Precision Strip and Foil Precision rolled thin metal foil products are manufactured from a wide range of materials for use in applications such as transformers, motor laminations, honeycomb structures, shielding, and composite structures. These products are commonly found in security tags, medical implants, aerospace structures, batteries and speaker domes. Arnold has the expertise and capability to roll, anneal, slit and coat a wide range of materials to extremely thin gauges (2.5 microns) and exacting tolerances. Flexible Magnets Flexible magnet products span the range of applications from advertising (refrigerator magnets) to medical applications (surgical drapes) to sealing and holding applications (door gaskets). Products and Services PMAG Arnold’s Precision Magnets and Assemblies (PMAG) segment is a leading global manufacturer of precision magnetic assemblies and high-performance magnets. The segment’s products include tight tolerance assemblies consisting of many dozens of components and employing RECOMA® SmCo, (cid:2)eo, and Al(cid:2)iCo magnets. These products are sold to a wide range of industries including aerospace and defense, alternative energy (hybrids/wind), automotive, medical, oil and gas, and general industrial. PMAG is Arnold’s largest business unit representing approximately 75% of Arnold sales on an annualized basis (including Reprographics) with a global footprint including manufacturing facilities in the U.S., U.K., Switzerland, and China. PMAG—Products and Applications: • High precision magnetic rotors for use in electric motors and generators. Typically used in demanding applications such as aerospace, oil and gas exploration, energy recovery systems and under the hood automotive Sealed pump couplings • • Beam focusing assemblies such as traveling wave tubes • Oil & Gas (cid:2)MR tools as well as pipeline inspection and down hole power generation • Hall affect sensor systems Arnold’s reprographics unit, which is part of the PMAG segment, produces systems and components for copier systems. The business unit’s state-of-the-art, high-volume precision magnetic assembly facility produces over 150,000 assemblies per year. The reprographics unit utilizes components produced by the Flexmag segment. Reprographics—products and applications: • Complex, multi-component, high-accuracy copier assemblies • Toner rolls • Toner and fuser assemblies 45 Precision Thin Metals Arnold’s precision thin metals segment manufactures precision thin strip and foil products from an array of materials and represents approximately 5% of Arnold sales on an annualized basis. The precision thin metals segment serves the aerospace & defense, power transmission, alternative energy (hybrids, wind, battery, solar), medical, security, and general industrial end-markets. With top-of-the-line equipment ( Sendzimir mills ) and superior engineering, precision thin metals has developed unique processing capabilities that allow it to produce foils and strip with precision and quality that are unmatched in the industry (down to 1/10th thickness of a human hair). In addition, the segment’s facility is capable of increasing production from current levels with its existing equipment and is, we believe, well-positioned to realize future growth with little incremental investment required. Precision Thin Metals—Products and Applications: Security and product ID tags • Electrical steels for hybrid propulsion systems, electric motors, and micro turbines • • Honeycomb structures for aerospace applications • • Batteries • Military countermeasures Irradiation windows Flexmag Arnold is one of two (cid:2)orth American manufacturers of flexible rubber magnets for specialty advertising, medical, and reprographic applications. Flexmag represents approximately 20% of Arnold sales on an annualized basis. It primarily sells its products to specialty advertisers and original equipment manufacturers. With highly automated manufacturing processes, Flexmag can accommodate customer’s required short lead times. Flexmag benefits from a loyal customer base and significant barriers to entry in the industry. Flexmag’s success is driven by superior customer service, and proprietary formulations offering enhanced product performance. Flexmag—products and applications: • Extruded and calendared flexible rubber magnets with optional laminated printable substrates • Retail displays • • Seals and enclosures Signage for various advertising and promotions Competitive Strengths Competitive Landscape The specialty magnets industry is highly fragmented, creating a competitive landscape with a variety of magnetic component manufacturers. However, few have the breadth of capabilities that Arnold possesses. Manufacturers compete on the basis of technical innovation, co-development capabilities, time-to-market, quality, geographic reach and total cost of ownership. Industry competitors relevant to Arnold’s served markets range from large multinational manufacturers to small, regional participants. Given these dynamics, we believe the industry will likely favor players that are able to achieve vertical integration and a diversification of offerings across a breadth of products along with magnet engineering and design expertise. Barriers to Entry • Low Substitution Risk – Arnold’s solutions are typically specified into its customers’ program designs through a co- development and qualification process that often takes 6-18 months. Arnold’s customers are typically contractors and component manufacturers whose products are integrated into end-customers’ applications. The high cost of failure, relatively low proportionate cost of magnets to the final product, sometimes lengthy testing and qualification process, and substantial upfront co-engineering investment required, represent significant barriers to customers changing solution providers such as Arnold. • Equipment and Processing – Arnold’s existing base of production equipment has a significant estimated replacement cost. A new entrant could require as much as 2-3 years of lead time to match the process performance requirements, customization of equipment and material formulations necessary to effectively compete in the specialty magnet industry. Further, given the program nature of a majority Arnold’s sales, management estimates that it could take 5-10 years to build a sufficient book of business and base of institutional knowledge to generate positive cash flow out of a new manufacturing plant. 46 Business Strategies Engineering and Product Development Arnold’s engineers work closely with the customer to co-develop a product or process to provide system solutions, representing a significant competitive advantage. Arnold’s engineering expertise is leveraged by the state-of-the-art Technology Center working together with the various business units located in (cid:2)orth America, Europe and Asia Pacific. This cooperative engineering effort allows Arnold to support customers and projects on a global basis. Arnold’s engineers work with customers on a global basis to optimize designs, guide material choices, and create magnetic models resulting in Arnold’s products being specified into customer designs. Arnold has a talented and experienced engineering staff of design and application experts, quality personnel and technicians. Included in this team are engineers with backgrounds in materials science, physics, and metallurgical engineering. Other members of the team bring backgrounds in ceramics, mechanical engineering, chemical engineering and electrical engineering. Arnold continues to be an industry leader with regard to new product formulations and innovations. As evidence of this, Arnold currently relies on a deep portfolio of “trade secrets” and internal intellectual property. Arnold continuously endeavors to introduce magnet solutions that exceed the performance of current offerings and meet customer design specifications. Growth in Arnold’s business is primarily focused in three areas: (i) Growing market share in existing end-markets and geographies (ii) Developing new products and technologies (iii) Completing opportunistic acquisitions Existing End-Markets and Geographies Oil & Gas Arnold currently provides magnets and precision assemblies for use in oil and gas exploration and production, applications which typically require exceptional collaboration and co-development with its customers. Arnold supplies products used in applications such as a new oil well shutoff valve, a new down-hole logging while drilling tool, and a down-hole magnetic transfer coupling. Other applications for which Arnold is actively involved include pipeline inspection, wireless tomography tools, and chip collection. Power Transmission Arnold’s Precision Thin Metals segment supplies grain-oriented silicon steel produced with proprietary methods for use in transformers and inductors. These cores allow for the production of very efficient transformers and inductors while minimizing size. In addition, Arnold’s magnet solutions can be found in advanced automatic circuit re-closer solutions that substantially reduce the stress on system components on the grid. Arnold’s solutions are also present in new power storage systems. The permanent magnet bearings used in new designs improve the efficiency of the flywheel energy storage system. Automotive In the automotive sector, Arnold is selling magnets and magnetic assemblies primarily to Tier 1 and 2 companies. It is estimate that the current automobile contains over 50 magnetic systems, and this number is expected to grow due to vehicle electrification initiatives in order to meet increasing fuel efficiency standards. Typical applications include magnets for Hall Effect sensors that are used in braking, passenger restraint, and steering and engine control systems. Emerging magnetic applications include electric traction drives, regenerative braking systems, starter generators, and electric turbo charging. The auto industry continues to adopt increasingly sophisticated technology to reduce vehicle weight and improve fuel efficiency. As much of this technology utilizes magnetic systems, Arnold expects to benefit from this trend. Aerospace and Defense In the aerospace and defense sector, Arnold is selling magnets, magnetic assemblies and ultra-thin foil solutions. Specifically, in the aerospace industry, Arnold’s assemblies have been designed into products, which enables Arnold to benefit from the market growth and a healthy flow of business based on current airframe orders. Through its OEM customers, essentially all new commercial aircraft placed in service contain assemblies produced by Arnold. Arnold’s sales to large aerospace and defense manufactures includes magnetic assemblies used in applications such as motors and generators, actuators, trigger mechanisms, and guidance 47 systems, as well as magnets for these and other uses. In addition it sells its ultra-thin foil for use in military countermeasures, honeycomb structures, brazing alloys, and motor laminations. General Industrial Within the industrial sector Arnold provides magnet assemblies as well as magnets for custom made motor systems. These include stepper motors, pick and place robotic systems, and new designs that are increasingly being required by regulation to meet energy efficiency standards. An example is a motor utilizing Arnold’s bonded magnets for use in commercial refrigeration systems. Arnold also produces magnetic couplings for seal-less pumps used in chemical and oil & gas applications that allow chemical companies to meet environmental requirements. Medical Within the medical sector, Arnold provides magnetic assemblies, magnets, flexible magnets, and ultrathin foils. Its magnet assemblies and magnets are critical parts of motor systems for dental instruments as well as saws and grinders. Magnet assemblies are also provided for skin expansion systems, shunt valves, and position sensors. In addition, its Precision Thin Metals business unit is providing a specialty alloy for advanced breast cancer treatment. (cid:2)ew Products & Technologies Flexcoat - launched in April 2010, this product was engineered to eliminate the issues associated with the conventional flexible magnetic product laminated with a printable surface. The solution is a printable coating that is applied to the magnet, which replaces substrates such as vinyl and paper that are currently adhered to the base magnet material. This results in a printed magnet that is now completely recyclable and is easier to process. Research and Development Arnold has a core research and development team, which has collectively over 30 years of combined industry experience. In addition to the core engineering group, a large number of other Arnold staff members assigned to the business units contribute to the research and development effort at various stages. Product development also includes collaborating with customers and field testing. This feedback helps ensure products will meet Arnold’s demanding standards of excellence as well as the constantly changing needs of end users. Arnold’s research and development activities are supported by state-of-the-art engineering software design tools, integrated manufacturing facilities and a performance testing center equipped to ensure product safety, durability and superior performance. Arnold spent approximately $1.0 million, $0.9 million and $0.2 million in research and development activities in each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. Customers Arnold’s focus on customer service and product quality has resulted in a broad base of customers in a variety of end markets. Products are used in applications such as general industrial, reprographic systems, aerospace & defense, advertising and promotion, consumer and appliance, energy, automotive and medical. 48 The following table sets forth management’s estimate of Arnold’s approximate customer breakdown by industry sector for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012: Industry Sector General industrial Aerospace and defense Advertising and promotion Consumer and appliance Energy Automotive Medical Reprographic All Other Sectors Combined Total Customer Distribution 2014 2013 2012 30% 21% 12% 2% 5% 9% 2% 16% 3% 100% 30% 18% 13% 2% 5% 8% 2% 19% 3% 100% 30% 15% 12% 5% 7% 4% 3% 21% 3% 100% Arnold has a large and diverse, blue-chip customer base. (cid:2)o customer represented greater that 10% of Arnold’s annual revenue in 2014. Sales to Arnold’s top ten customers were 33%, 33% and 31% of total sales for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Competition Management believes the following companies represent Arnold’s top competitors: • Thomas & Skinner • Magnum Magnetics • Electron Energy • Vacuumschmelze Gruner, Germany-based Sales and Marketing PMAG - Arnold’s PMAG segment supports a global team of direct sales and marketing professionals and critical design and application engineers. The PMAG sales force is organized for regional coverage with a focus on sales in U.S., Europe, and South East Asia. Arnold serves over 850 active customers globally. As the majority of revenues are project based in the PMAG business unit, technical sales are critical to the segment’s success. Arnold’s highly-qualified application engineers are often integrated into its customers’ product design, planning, and implementation phases, offering the most cost effective solution for demanding clients. The resulting intimate customer relationships yield a high close rate, with revenue achieved primarily after the prototype phase. Precision Thin Metals – Similar to Arnold’s PMAG segment, the vast majority of Precision Thin Metals’ sales are technically driven engineered solutions. These teams communicate closely in order to take advantage of potential cross-selling opportunities. Approximately 70% of sales are domestic, with the balance of sales to Western Europe. Flexmag Products - The Flexmag business segment services over 625 customers globally. Its sales force is comprised of seven total sales professionals and supported by seven design and application engineers. This segment is primarily book/bill and has limited revenue subject to long-term purchase commitments. 49 The following table sets forth Arnold’s net sales by geographic location for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012: Geographic location (cid:2)orth America Europe Asia Pacific All Other Locations Combined Total 2014 2013 2012 58% 33% 9% —% 100% 54% 34% 12% —% 100% 56% 34% 8% 2% 100% Arnold had firm backlog orders totaling approximately $28.3 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013. Suppliers Raw materials utilized by Arnold include nickel and cobalt, stainless steel shafts, Inconel sleeves, adhesives, laminates, aluminum extrusions and binders. Although Arnold considers its relationships with vendors to be strong, Arnold’s management team also maintains a variety of alternative sources of comparable quality, quantity and price. The management team therefore believes that it is not dependent upon any single vendor to meet its sourcing needs. Arnold is generally able to pass through material costs to its customers and believes that in the event of significant price increases by vendors that it could pass the increases to its customers. Intellectual Property Arnold currently relies on a deep portfolio of “trade secrets” and internal intellectual property. Patents Arnold currently has thirteen patents and seven in process; over half of the patents were granted in the U.S. with the remaining patents granted in European countries such as Germany, Great Britain, France and the (cid:2)etherlands. Ten of the patents are related to methods of making magnetic strips. In 2004, Arnold was granted a patent related to a thermally-stable, high-temperature, SmCo molding compound. The most recent pending patents are related to the methods of production involving flexible magnets having a printable surface as well as shaped field magnets Trademarks Arnold currently has 86 trademarks, 12 of which are in the U.S. The most notable trademarked items are the following: “RECOMA”, “PLASTIFORM”, “FLEXMAG” & “AR(cid:2)OLD”. Application dates for various trademarks date back to as early as 1961. Regulatory Environment Arnold’s domestic manufacturing and assembly operations and its facilities are subject to evolving Federal, state and local environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. These include laws and regulations governing air emissions, wastewater discharge and the storage and handling of chemicals and hazardous substances. Arnold’s foreign manufacturing and assembly operations are also subject to local environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. Management believes that Arnold is in compliance, in all material respects, with applicable environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. (cid:2)ew requirements, more stringent application of existing requirements, or discovery of previously unknown environmental conditions could result in material environmental expenditures in the future. Arnold is a major producer of both Samarium Cobalt permanent magnets under its brand name RECOMA® and Alnico (in both cast and sintered forms). Both materials from Arnold meet the current Berry Amendment or Defense Acquisition Regulations Systems (DFARS) requirements per clause 252.225.7014 further described under 10 U.S.C. 2533b. This provision covers the protection of strategic materials critical to national security. These magnet types are considered “specialty metals” under these regulations. 50 Employees Arnold is led by a capable management team of industry veterans that possess a balanced combination of industry experience and operational expertise. The current senior management team has approximately 100 years of cumulative experience with an average tenure of approximately 16 years at Arnold. Current management has implemented numerous operational, strategic, and financial initiatives over the past several years, including almost 100 unique lean initiatives and kaizen events. Arnold employs approximately 723 hourly and salaried employees located throughout (cid:2)orth America, Europe and Asia. Arnold’s employees are compensated at levels commensurate with industry standards, based on their respective position and job grade. Arnold’s workforce is non-union except for approximately 63 hourly employees at its Marengo, Illinois facilities, which are represented by the International Association of Machinists (IAM). Arnold enjoys good labor relations with its employees and union and has a three year contract in place with the IAM, which will expire in June of 2016. Clean Earth Overview Headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, Clean Earth provides environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials including soils, dredged material, hazardous waste and drill cuttings. Clean Earth analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste streams generated in multiple end markets such as power, construction, oil and gas, infrastructure, industrial and dredging. Treatment includes thermal desorption, dredged material stabilization, bioremediation, physical treatment/screening and chemical fixation. Before the company accepts contaminated materials, it identifies a third party “beneficial reuse” site such as commercial redevelopment or landfill capping where the materials will be sent after they are treated. Clean Earth operates 14 permitted facilities in the Eastern United States. Revenues from the environmental recycling facilities are generally recognized at the time of treatment. For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014 (from date of acquisition), Clean Earth had net sales of approximately $68.4 million and operating income of $2.7 million. Clean Earth had total assets of $365.5 million million at December 31, 2014. (cid:2)et sales from Clean Earth (from acquisition date to December 31, 2014) represented 7.0% of our consolidated net sales for the year ended December 31, 2014. We purchased a majority interest in Clean Earth on August 26, 2014. History of Clean Earth Clean Earth was founded in 1990 with the establishment of a contaminated material treatment facility in (cid:2)ew Castle, Delaware focused on processing soils. The treatment of contaminated materials has diversified significantly over the years as Clean Earth now also processes dredged material, coal ash, hazardous waste and drill cuttings. Clean Earth has been able to grow consistently via both organic initiatives and acquisition. In 1997 the Company opened Clean Earth of Carteret, which was the first “fixed- based” bioremediation facility permitted in the State of (cid:2)ew Jersey. In 1998, Clean Earth started offering hazardous waste treatment after acquiring S&W Waste, now Clean Earth of (cid:2)orth Jersey, a fully permitted commercial Resource Conservation and Recovery Act (“RCRA”) Part B Treatment, Storage & Disposal Facility (“TSDF”). That same year Clean Earth also expanded services into the treatment of dredged material through the acquisition of Consolidated Technologies Inc. (now Clean Earth Dredging Technologies). Today, Clean Earth is one of the largest providers of contaminated materials treatment in the East. In addition to diversifying the number of contaminated materials it handles Clean Earth has also significantly expanded its geography. The Company now operates permitted facilities from (cid:2)ew York to Florida, and with the December 2014 acquisition of AES Environmental Services, Clean Earth has expanded their footprint of permitted facilities to Kentucky and West Virginia as well. Industry Overview The U.S. environmental services industry is highly fragmented, with Clean Earth most closely correlated with the remediation and hazardous waste management segments of the industry. Historically, growth in these sectors has been primarily driven by increasing regulations and growing volume of waste generated, and is now positively affected by increases in waste disposal costs and resulting landfill avoidance trends. Other trends driving growth include increasing concern in corporate America regarding environmental liabilities and a push by companies to outsource a larger amount of environmental services to a smaller number of service providers due to increasing compliance costs. 51 Contaminated Materials Contamination of soils and other materials is prevalent and often caused by the introduction of chemicals, petroleum hydrocarbons, solvents, pesticides, lead and other heavy metals into the earth. These contaminants are common in areas of industrialization and severely impact the environment as a result of inadequate containment or improper disposal. As a result of their prevalence and impact, these contaminates are subject to ever more stringent environmental regulations which now govern the handling, treatment, and disposal of these contaminants. As a result, when soil or other materials are removed from a site, they must be tested. The strong likelihood that materials will contain some level of contamination generates consistent demand for treatment and beneficial reuse solutions. Contaminated materials are routinely associated with infrastructure, commercial development, and other excavation projects, heavy industrial activity, spill clean-up or environmental remediation projects, locations with former manufactured gas plants (“MGP”), underground storage tanks (“UST”) or aboveground storage tanks, and a wide variety of increasingly regulated waste streams. Dredge Market Dredging is the act of removing sediment from the bottom of waterways, both inland (rivers and canals) and ocean (floors, harbors, channels, etc.), and is performed for both navigational and environmental purposes. Like soil, most dredged material largely contains some level of contamination, particularly in current or historically industrially active areas. Accordingly, the Environmental Protection Agency (the "EPA") has established regulations that govern the disposal methods of dredged material, including the Marine Protection, Research and Sanctuaries Act (“MPRSA”), and the Federal Water Pollution Control Act, or the Clean Water Act. The treatment and beneficial reuse of dredged material began in 1995, when various government entities in (cid:2)ew Jersey and (cid:2)ew York permitted a unique project to demonstrate the feasibility of using treated and processed dredged material to reclaim a former landfill and repurpose it for a new building project. Regulations require contaminated dredge spoils to be taken upland for treatment or disposal in accordance with Title 33 as administered by the United States Army Corps of Engineers and the EPA. Once treated, dredged material is used for structural fill and development purposes. Hazardous Waste The hazardous waste services industry encompasses the generation, collection, treatment, and ultimate disposal of wastes classified as hazardous by RCRA. RCRA, the primary law governing the disposal of solid and hazardous waste, was passed by Congress in 1976 to address increasing problems associated with growing volumes of municipal and industrial waste. Accidents, spills, leaks, and improper handling and disposal of hazardous materials and waste have resulted in the contamination of land, water and air in the U.S. The U.S. generated 34 million tons of hazardous waste in 2011, according to the EPA. These wastes come primarily from three sources, Superfund sites, routine business and the increasingly expanding waste regulations. In order to address these environmental hazards, the EPA established a program known as the Superfund, which allows the EPA to clean up such sites, or to compel responsible parties to perform clean-ups or reimburse the EPA for its clean-up expenses. This includes regulatory requirements that raise both the monetary and reputational costs for non-compliance. The Superfund program has identified tens of thousands of sites that require treatment over its more than 20-year history. Outside of the known Superfund sites, hazardous waste is also generated during the routine course of business and manufacturing, requiring the same care of handling by a specialized treatment facility. The generation of hazardous waste is common throughout the chemicals and petrochemical, steel, general manufacturing, government, aerospace and public utilities industries. Within the U.S., the (cid:2)ortheast region is one of the most densely concentrated areas for generators of hazardous waste. In addition to hazardous waste generated by industrial activity, increasingly complex regulations have expanded the scope of what is considered hazardous waste from non-traditional sources, such as retailers and households. For instance, environmental regulations require large quantity generators such as big box retailers to dispose of all returned or damaged products that include pesticides, aerosols, fertilizers and cleaners through a permitted hazardous waste disposal program. Similarly, household products, such as paints, oils, batteries, fluorescent light bulbs and pesticides, which contain potentially hazardous ingredients, require special treatment and disposal. Growing and Increasingly Regulated Waste Streams Federal, state and local regulators have continuously expanded legal guidelines to include additional waste streams, becoming increasingly vigilant to ensure the proper treatment and disposal of an ever-increasing number of contaminants. Two of the most prevalent increasingly regulated waste streams include drill cuttings from natural gas drilling and coal ash, a byproduct of fossil fuel power plants. 52 Services Clean Earth provides services to a variety of customers handling numerous unique sites that often require a range of custom solutions based upon project-specific factors. Clean Earth provides its core material treatment capabilities and complementary services. In addition to its treatment offerings, Clean Earth also provides turnkey services that include proper identification of waste services, management of all transportation and logistics, appropriate testing and analytics, manifesting/documentation and environmentally compliant placement of treated materials at backend locations. Site Planning and Sampling Before work commences, Clean Earth has the ability to conduct waste characterization services consisting of field sampling, contaminated material collection and laboratory analysis. Properly identifying waste contaminants upfront can be important, as misclassification leads to mishandling of the waste, which can be costly in terms of fines, penalties, reduced recycling rates (increased disposal fees), and lost project time. Results are analyzed to assess time, cost and logistics, which give Clean Earth the ability to provide customers with a disposal recommendation and a cost-effective solution. Testing and Analytics Clean Earth utilizes internal and external, fully-certified and approved laboratories that perform field sampling and contaminated material collection, laboratory analysis, site sampling plans and sampling location diagrams. Laboratory testing is customizable, and Clean Earth determines appropriate testing methods to assess the quantity and type of contaminant in the material. Clean Earth analyzes the results to determine an appropriate treatment and beneficial reuse plan specific to each material. Clean Earth maintains a state-certified hazardous waste laboratory in the (cid:2)ew York metropolitan area at its Kearny, (cid:2)ew Jersey facility. Transportation and Logistics Clean Earth operates an asset-light business model in which it arranges for transportation of the materials on behalf of its customers via pre-qualified independent hauling companies. Due to Clean Earth’s ability to provide year-round work for transportation companies and its consistent payment practices, it has developed very strong and long-standing relationships with its vendors, providing a large pool of available trucks to complete projects efficiently. Manifesting and Documentation Clean Earth provides uniform manifests for customer projects that can be used throughout its network of facilities. These manifests provide tracking of all material moved from a customer site to its facilities and eventually to the final beneficial use site. Furthermore, these documents are maintained and submitted to regulatory agencies such as the EPA for their review. Treatment Clean Earth offers several processes to treat, stabilize and/or decharacterize waste material and subsequently avoid costly landfill disposal and meet strict regulatory and site-specific requirements before being beneficially reused. • Thermal Desorption Primarily used to treat soil with high levels of volatile contaminants by heating it in a rotating dryer to volatilize and then subsequently destroy the contaminants The treated material then enters a soil conditioner (called a pugmill), where it is cooled and rehydrated Finally, the cooled soil is stockpiled, sampled, and tested by an independent certified laboratory to ensure effective treatment and fulfillment of reuse standards This treatment method is primarily used for soils that contain high levels of contaminants, such as soil from manufactured gas plant sites • Stabilization of Dredged Material Dredged sediments are screened to remove large objects and excess water The remaining material is fed through a conveyor belt to a pugmill mixing system, where proprietary reagent admixtures are introduced The resulting material is valued for its geotechnical properties and is often beneficially reused as fill material • Bioremediation Used to treat soil that is contaminated with petroleum hydrocarbons Involves inoculating the contaminated material with engineered bacteria and nutrients to break down the contaminants The bacteria consume and process the nutrients and the hydrocarbons thereby remediating the contaminants • Chemical Fixation Used for light to medium hydrocarbon and/or contaminated material impacted by light or heavy metals Soil is screened, and paired with chemical additives to formulate a chemically stable and geotechnically desirable material 53 • Physical Treatment/Screening Special sizing and segregation processes remove unsuitable materials from inbound materials to meet site-specific geotechnical specifications The segregated material, often rock, can be mixed with other material for reuse or crushed to create aggregate material for resale Placement at Backend Sites Clean Earth maintains a vast network of permitted, active backend locations owned by third parties that utilize its treated materials to achieve site specifications and/or meet regulatory obligations. Clean Earth operates a system in which before accepting any material it identifies which specific backend site will accept it and how much it will cost to treat, transport, and place. Its beneficial reuse solutions serve as an alternative to permitted landfill disposal and incineration. In order to ensure sufficient capacity for any future project, the Clean Earth continuously seeks to add backend sites to its network. Competition Competitive Landscape The environmental services market is highly fragmented with numerous participants. However, a majority of these companies specialize in a narrower scope of services or treatment capabilities. Industry competitors relevant to Clean Earth’s served markets range from large public companies to small, single-service participants. Competition primarily includes processors of contaminated soils, dredging companies (to a limited extent), waste treatment providers and waste management companies. In Clean Earth’s core markets, competition tends to be primarily comprised of regional services providers or single-service companies with limited scale. Given these dynamics, we believe the industry will likely favor players such as Clean Earth that have large scale and management teams with many years of experience and extensive familiarity with the regulatory landscape. Barriers to Entry • Permits - Clean Earth maintains an extensive portfolio of regulatory permits, including 107 active permits and 140 permit modifications. Each facility maintains various local, state, and federal authorizations for the acceptance, treatment, and beneficial reuse of a wide variety of hazardous and nonhazardous materials, as well as all necessary air and water discharge permits required for operation. These permits are extremely difficult to obtain due to the complex navigation of multiple layers of regulation, lengthy and costly public review periods and typical public (cid:2)IMBY opposition. Clean Earth maintains a large team of environmental, health and safety experts that have developed trusted relationships and credibility with local, state and federal regulatory agencies over the last 25 years. • Extensive (cid:2)etwork - The Company’s extensive network of 14 permitted facilities is strategically located near major waste generation centers with an abundance of regulations governing waste treatment and disposal. Given transportation costs, the proximity of Clean Earth’s facilities to key markets and convenient access to rail, barge, and trucking transportation are significant competitive advantages that drive profitability. Furthermore, its maintenance of multiple backend beneficial reuse sites provides flexibility to direct volume to the most appropriate facilities based on available processing and placement capacity. Business Strategies Growth in Clean Earth’s business is primarily focused in five areas: Continued participation in large and growing end markets Within the U.S. environmental services market, Clean Earth primarily operates within the remediation and hazardous waste management segments. Growth in the industry will be driven by numerous secular trends, including an increasing national awareness and dedication to environmental stewardship, regulatory guidelines for a growing number of contaminated waste streams, and increasing prevalence of and preference for cost-effective landfill avoidance and recycling strategies. As a result of these market trends, generators or those responsible for contaminated waste streams will likely seek to utilize service providers like Clean Earth that can offer environmentally compliant and cost-effective solutions for their treatment and disposal needs. Contaminated Materials Clean Earth’s operations are diversified across a variety of stable end markets focused primarily in the power, oil & gas, infrastructure and industrial industries. Clean Earth has also positioned itself to capitalize on future increases in the commercial development sector. Dredged Material Clean Earth has maintained a strong position in the (cid:2)ew York and (cid:2)ew Jersey harbors for its dredged material management and recycling services. Demand for Clean Earth’s services has grown such that it constructed a second dredge processing facility in 54 2009. Outside of the (cid:2)ew York and (cid:2)ew Jersey harbors, increased demand for maintenance projects is expected to be driven largely by the increasing size of heavy shipping vessels and expansion of the Panama Canal. As waterways are deepened, sediment accumulates in greater volume, which must be regularly removed to maintain the new depth. Hazardous Waste Clean Earth maintains unique hazardous waste operations in an active region of the United States. There are significant number of hazardous waste generators in the U.S. that are located in (cid:2)ew York and (cid:2)ew Jersey and Clean Earth operates one the few commercial RCRA Part B permitted TSDFs in the (cid:2)ew York metro area. Clean Earth is currently able to accept hazardous liquids, solids and gasses, as well as a variety of other specialty waste classes, including lab-packs, electronic waste, universal waste, wastewater, household hazardous waste, used oils and antifreeze. Clean Earth can also accept nonhazardous waste at this facility. Increasing share in existing markets Clean Earth has historically increased the volume of materials processed at its existing facilities by expanding the scope of its existing permits and developing new treatment and processing techniques. The permitting expertise of its environmental, health, and safety organization allows Clean Earth to be proactive in seeking additional waste streams and adaptable to changing contaminants found in the materials it manages, as well as in newly regulated materials. (cid:2)umerous dynamics have made the market increasingly beneficial for Clean Earth in its core markets. These dynamics include stricter regulations, increasing levels of enforcement and a more discerning customer base. Accelerating participation in increasingly regulated end markets Within its current footprint, there are opportunities for Clean Earth to continue to expand the scope of its service offering by adding additional specialty waste streams. Continued tuck-in acquisition growth Since 2011, Clean Earth has expanded its footprint by launching operations in Florida (acquired), the Marcellus Shale (greenfield), Georgia (acquired), Kentucky (acquired), West Virginia (acquired) and the Greater Washington, D.C. region (acquired and repurposed). The market for waste management services is highly fragmented, with many companies operating a single facility. Accordingly, there are several tuck-in acquisition opportunities in Clean Earth’s marketplace that would enable it to continue growing in existing and adjacent markets, as well as in new geographies. Platform expansion opportunities While Clean Earth has historically remained focused on its core markets, many opportunities exist to diversify and augment its environmental service offering using Clean Earth as a platform. Clean Earth can acquire select competitors and industrial services companies, as well as pursue vertical integration prospects and new treatment technologies. Customers Clean Earth serves approximately 1200 customers at more than 5500 discrete sites. The Company maintains strong relationships with customers at various levels of the decision and supply chain, including public and private corporations and property owners, as well as environmental consultants, brokers, construction firms, municipalities, and regulatory agencies, among others. In 2014, the top 10 customers accounted for approximately 45% of net sales. While Clean Earth works with certain customers that have recurring needs for disposal and recycling solutions, its revenue per customer changes frequently. Many of the Clean Earth's customers are long-time customers, but do not generate a consistent amount of revenue year in, year out. Consequently, Clean Earth is more focused on winning specific “projects” as opposed to winning the business of a particular customer. Sales and Marketing Clean Earth’s team is comprised of 31 sales and marketing professionals that are primarily focused on direct selling to customers. Clean Earth is focused on servicing customers at various levels of the decision and supply chain, including waste generators, environmental service companies, consultants, construction and engineering firms, commercial developers, municipalities and government-sponsored organizations, and regulatory agencies, among others. Clean Earth has spent years developing direct relationships with its clients, many of whom routinely generate large volumes of waste and demand treatment and disposal solutions at various sites and locations. 55 The large dredging contractors manage the vast majority of the dredging activity. Clean Earth has built relationships with these contractors to ensure it is well-positioned to serve as many of the large or small dredging projects in the (cid:2)ew York/(cid:2)ew Jersey harbor and surrounding waterways, as possible. Clean Earth is a longstanding member of multiple national, regional, and local organizations throughout the U.S. The Company also conducts annual customer surveys, manages a focused advertising campaign, participates in trade shows, and has an extensive web presence. Regulatory Environment Clean Earth’s facility operations are subject to various local, state, and federal authorizations for the acceptance, treatment, and beneficial reuse of a wide variety of hazardous and nonhazardous materials, as well as all necessary air and water discharge permits required for operation. These permits are extremely difficult to obtain due to the complex navigation of multiple layers of regulation, lengthy and costly public review periods, and typical public (cid:2)IMBY opposition. Clean Earth maintains a large team of environmental, health, and safety experts that have developed trusted relationships and credibility with local, state, and federal regulatory agencies over the last 25 years. Management believes that Clean Earth is in compliance, in all material respects, with applicable environmental and occupational health and safety laws and regulations. Employees Clean Earth is led by a capable management team of industry veterans that possess a balanced combination of industry experience and operational expertise. The current senior management team has over 150 years of cumulative experience with an average tenure of approximately 10 years at Clean Earth. Current management has implemented numerous operational, strategic, and financial initiatives over the past several years. In addition to the senior management team, there are operational managers that hold significant responsibilities across the business and work closely with management on a daily basis. Clean Earth employs approximately 327 hourly and salaried employees located throughout the United States. Clean Earth’s employees are compensated at levels commensurate with industry standards, based on their respective position and job grade. Clean Earth’s workforce is non-union except for approximately 25 hourly employees at its dredge facilities, who are represented by International Union of Operating Engineers Local (cid:2)o. 825 (IUOE Local 825). Clean Earth enjoys good labor relations with its employees and union and has a three year contract in place with the IUOE Local 825, which will expire in July of 2016. SternoCandleLamp Overview SternoCandleLamp, headquartered in Corona, California, is a manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative table lighting solutions for the foodservice industry. SternoCandleLamp offers a broad range of wick and gel chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories, liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps. As the leading supplier of canned chaffing fuel to the foodservice distributors and foodservice group purchasing organizations, SternoCandleLamp maintains the leading market share position in the foodservice channel. For over 100 years, the iconic "Sterno" brand has been synonymous with quality canned heat. The heritage of reliability and innovation continues today, as SternoCandleLamp continues to bring to market new products that give foodservice industry professionals greater control over food quality and décor. For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014 (from date of acquisition) SternoCandleLamp had net sales of approximately $36.7 million and an operating loss of $1.8 million. SternoCandleLamp had total assets of $180.8 million at December 31, 2014. SternoCandleLamp's net sales (from acquisition date to December 31, 2014) represented 3.7% of our consolidated net sales for the year ended December 31, 2014. History SternoCandleLamp was formed in 2012 with the merger of two manufacturers and marketers of portable food warming fuel products, The Sterno Group LLC and the Candle Lamp Company, LLC. 56 Sterno’s history dates back to 1893 when S. Sternau & Co. began making chafing dishes and coffee percolators in Tenafly, (cid:2)ew Jersey. In 1914, S. Sternau & Co. introduced “canned heat” with the launch of its gelled ethanol product under the “Sterno” brand. Since then, the Sternau and Sterno names have been the most well-known names in portable food warming fuel. In 1917 S. Sternau & Co. was renamed The Sterno Corporation. During World War I, Sterno portable stoves were promoted as an essential gift for soldiers going to fight in the trenches of Europe. Sterno stoves heated water and rations, sterilized surgical instruments, and provided light and warmth in bunkers and foxholes. During World War II, Sterno produced ethanol and methanol chafing fuels under contract with the U.S. military. Sterno's production facilities were moved from (cid:2)ew Jersey to Texarkana, Texas in the early 1980s. The Candle Lamp Company, LLC was founded in Riverside, California in 1978, focusing initially on the liquid wax candle market. Over the next several decades, CandleLamp began to supply chaffing fuel in addition to lighting products. The Candle Lamp Company operated manufacturing facilities in Riverside, California and Memphis, Tennessee. In 2012, the Candle Lamp Company entered into negotiations to acquire The Sterno Group LLC, consummating a transaction in October of 2012, and immediately rebranded the new Company SternoCandleLamp. Today, SternoCandleLamp operates out of its corporate headquarters in Corona California and two manufacturing facilities in Texarkana, Texas and Memphis, Tennessee. We purchased SternoCandleLamp on October 10, 2014. Industry SternoCandleLamp competes in the broadly defined U.S. foodservice industry which is expected to grow to at a 3% compounded annual rate through 2015. Restaurant, catering and hospitality sales accounted for approximately 67% of the market with the remainder comprised of the travel and leisure, education and healthcare related sales. At present, the SternoCandleLamp's sales are concentrated in the U.S. foodservice industry; specifically, SternoCandleLamp’s focus is on safe, portable fire solutions for cooking and warming, as well as tabletop lighting décor. Within the foodservice industry, the catering market represents over $45 billion dollars in sales in 2013, with industry revenues doubling over the last 10 years according to the 2013 (cid:2)ational Restaurant Association Industry Forecast. According to an IBISWorld (cid:2)ovember 2014 report, demand for catering will take a positive turn in the next five years, after the recession and low consumer sentiment temporarily stifled revenue. A rise in demand from high-income households and businesses will bolster growth, with consumers spending more money on parties and other catered functions and corporate budgets loosening in line with stronger corporate profit. Products and markets SternoCandleLamp is a “full-line” supplier offering a broad array of portable chaffing fuels and table lighting products with approximately 400 SKUs serving both the foodservice and retail markets. The Company originally focused on chaffing fuel (“canned heat”) products and later expanded its offerings to include table ambiance products such as liquid wax, wax candles and votive lamps. SternoCandleLamp’s 100 year history of providing the highest quality chaffing fuel products has cemented its position as the go to supplier for chaffing fuel products. SternoCandleLamp’s products fall into four major categories: canned heat, table lighting, catering equipment and butane products. Canned Heat - The canned heat product line is composed of various chaffing fuels packaged in small, portable cans. The portable warming (canned heat) line is composed of various wick-based and gel-based chafing fuels packaged in steel cans. These products are used by foodservice professionals in a variety of food serving and holding applications and are designed to keep food products at an optimal food-safe serving temperature of 140-165 Fahrenheit. The canned heat product line is composed of two subcategories: wick chaffing fuel and gel chaffing fuel. The subcategories are distinguished based on the type of chaffing fuel being used; the four primary chaffing fuels are diethylene glycol (“DEG”), propylene glycol, ethanol and methanol. Each fuel contains unique characteristics and properties that allow the Company to offer a broad array of configurations to suit varying user requirements. Wick Chaffing Fuel The wick chaffing fuel line (“Wick”) is composed of either DEG or propylene glycol chaffing fuel. DEG and propylene glycol chaffing fuels have higher heat output than alternatives such as ethanol and methanol. The liquid Wick products feature a variety of wick types and burn times to meet the specific needs of the user. Wick fuels are clean burning, biodegradable, nonflammable if spilled (will not ignite without a wick) and the can stays cool to the touch when lit. Gel Chaffing Fuel The gel chaffing fuel line (“Gel”) is composed of either gelled ethanol or gelled methanol chaffing fuel. Ethanol chaffing fuel has a higher heat output than methanol fuel; both ethanol and methanol fuels have lower heat output than DEG and propylene glycol. The Gel product line tends to have shorter burn times than the Wick product. 57 Additionally, the Company offers a patented line of “Green” chafing fuels featuring USDA Certified Biobased Product formulas that are also endorsed by the Green Restaurant Association. The “Green Heat” and “Green Wick” products perform similar to the Wick and Gel chafing fuels, but are made from renewable resources that are biodegradable and more environmentally friendly. Table Lighting - SternoCandleLamp sells a variety of products designed to enhance lighting and ambiance at meal settings. Products include liquid wax, traditional hard wax and flameless electronic candles, as well as votive lamps, shaded lamps and accent lamps. Catering Equipment - Catering equipment products are designed to provide a complete commercial catering solution whether indoor or outdoor. Products include chaffing dish frames and lids, wind guards and buffet sets. Butane - SternoCandleLamp produces a full line of professional quality portable butane stoves, ideal for action stations, made- to-order omelet lines, tableside and off-site cooking, outdoor events and more. Products also include select butane accessories for special culinary applications such as the culinary torch. SternoCandleLamp sells into FoodService, Retail and OEM markets with foodservice accounts comprising approximately 75% of sales and Retail and OEM comprising approximately 25% of sales. Competitive Strengths Leading Brand Recognition & Market Share - SternoCandleLamp is the market share leader in the canned chaffing fuel market. SternoCandleLamp enjoys outstanding awareness and a reputation for superior quality and performance with distributors, caterers, hotels and other end users. Low Cost versus Alternatives - SternoCandleLamp’s customers are typically caterers, hotels or restaurants who utilize canned chaffing fuel to maintain prepared food at a safe and enjoyable serving temperature. The risk of ruining a dining experience and the low proportionate cost of canned chaffing fuel relative to the cost of a catered event represent significant barriers to customers switching out of SternoCandleLamp’s canned chaffing fuel products. Additionally, management believes that there is no other technology available today that offers the portability, reliability and low cost of the SternoCandleLamp canned chaffing fuel products. Business Strategies Defend Leading Market Position - SternoCandleLamp’s brand position and scale relative to competitors allows for unmatched customer service and product selection. In a market characterized by fragmented competition, SternoCandleLamp will continue to leverage its scale to provide best in class service to its customers. SternoCandleLamp has been the recipient of numerous vendor awards for its high degree of customer service. Pursue Selective Acquisitions - SternoCandleLamp views acquisitions as a potentially attractive means to expand its product offerings in the foodservice and retail channels as well as enter new international markets. Expand Retail Distribution - SternoCandleLamp’s management believes that there is an opportunity to leverage the iconic nature of the “Sterno” brand to expand its retail product offering and to expand distribution into additional retailers. Customers SternoCandleLamp’s products are sold primarily through the foodservice and consumer retail channels. SternoCandleLamp’s product distribution network is comprised of long-standing, entrenched relationships with a diversified set of customers. SternoCandleLamp’s top ten customers comprised approximately 68% and 65% of gross sales in the year ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Foodservice - The foodservice channel consists of multiple layers of distribution comprised of broadline distributors, equipment and supply dealers and cash and carry dealers. Within the foodservice channel, SternoCandleLamp’s products are predominantly used in the restaurant, hotel and catering markets. Retail - The retail channel consists of club stores, mass merchants, specialty retailers and grocers. The Company’s retail products are used in home, camping and emergency applications. The Company’s retail products appeal to a wide variety of consumers, from home entertainers to recreational campers and extreme outdoorsmen. 58 Sales and marketing Within the foodservice channel, SternoCandleLamp directly employ sales professionals and utilizes a broad network of independent sales representative firms assigned to differing U.S. territories managed by in-house sales management professionals. The independent sales representatives have long standing relationships with distributors and end-users and typically represent 10 to 20 of the best non-food product lines alongside the Company’s products. The independent sales representatives are used primarily to manage the day to day order fulfillment and customer relationships. The independent sales representative firms are paid on a commission basis based on customer type and sales territory. Within the retail channel, SternoCandleLamp directly employ sales professionals and utilizes a network of independent retail sales broker firms. The independent retail sales brokers are paid on a commission basis based on customer type and sales territory. SternoCandleLamp maintains direct sales relationships with all key customers. SternoCandleLamp has implemented a multi-faceted marketing plan which includes (i) targeted print advertising; (ii) tradeshows, (iii) increasing online education through the SternoCandleLamp University and (iv) social media. Suppliers SternoCandleLamp’s product manufacturing is based on a dual strategy of in-house manufacturing and strategic alliances with select vendors. SternoCandleLamp operates an efficient, low-cost supply chain, sourcing materials and employing contract manufacturers from across the Asia-Pacific region and the U.S. SternoCandleLamp’s primary raw materials are Diethylene glycol, ethanol, liquid paraffin and steel cans for which it receives multiple shipments per month. SternoCandleLamp purchases its materials from a combination of domestic and foreign suppliers. Historically, SternoCandleLamp has been able to pass on raw material price increases to its customers. Intellectual Property SternoCandleLamp relies upon a combination of trademarks and patents in order to secure and protect its intellectual property rights. SternoCandleLamp currently owns 44 trademarks and 6 patents in the U.S. and has 1 patent pending application at the U.S. Patent Offices. Regulatory Environment SternoCandleLamp is proactive regarding regulatory issues and is in compliance with all relevant regulations. SternoCandleLamp maintains adequate product liability insurance coverage. Management is not aware of any potential environmental issues. Employees As of December 31, 2014 SternoCandleLamp employed 370 persons in 3 locations. (cid:2)one of SternoCandleLamp’s employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. We believe that SternoCandleLamp’s relationship with its employees is good. Tridien Overview Tridien, headquartered in Coral Springs, Florida, is a leading developer, manufacturer and marketer of powered and non-powered medical therapeutic support surfaces and surgical patient positioning devices serving the acute care, long-term care and home health care markets. Tridien’s therapeutic support surfaces are used for the prevention and treatment of pressure ulcers and its patient positioning devices are used during surgical procedures to align various parts of the human body that must be fixed in place or require protection from injury. Tridien manufactures products as an Original Equipment Manufacturer (OEM), Contract Manufacturer (CM) and Branded/Private Label Manufacturer in multiple locations across the U.S. to serve a national customer base in an efficient, cost-effective manner. Manufacturing plants are located in Corona, California, Fishers, Indiana, and Coral Springs, Florida. Tridien, together with its subsidiary companies, provides its OEM and CM customers the opportunity to source or co-develop innovative support surface technologies directly from the designer and manufacturer. Tridien’s customers include some of the largest and most respected providers of support surfaces and surgical patient positioners across the globe. These companies have come to rely on Tridien’s extensive experience, which spans decades and stems from multiple acquisitions of leading niche players in the mid-2000s. The consolidation of these acquired companies under the Tridien brand has uniquely positioned Tridien to provide a differentiated and value-added portfolio of products and services to its customers. 59 In its branded/private label category, Tridien develops and markets products independently and in partnership with large distribution intermediaries, primarily Home Medical Equipment (HME) and Durable Medical Equipment (DME) suppliers. These suppliers sell or rent therapeutic support surfaces to clinical care facilities and to patients for use in home health care, usually on a regional level, but also on a national basis with some of our largest distribution customers. The level of product sophistication varies according to the targeted care environment and the clinical needs of the patient. For example, many patients in long-term care facilities require foam mattresses (“non-powered” support surfaces) while patients in higher acuity settings such as the hospital may require surfaces with advanced features like alternating pressure (AP), low air loss (LAL), lateral rotation, pulmonary therapy and customized patient settings based on height and weight (“powered” support surfaces). All of Tridien’s products comply with FDA standards, and the majority of products are designed, developed, and manufactured in-house using a specialized team of engineers who work in close collaboration with staffed professionals in quality, regulatory, operations and account management. A minority group of products is outsourced from Taiwan; these products are also Food and Drug Administration ("FDA") compliant, and their development is usually a collaborative process between Tridien and the chosen supplier. For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, Tridien had net sales of approximately $67.3 million, $60.1 million and $55.9 million, respectively, and $2.2 million in operating income for the year ended December 31, 2014, an operating loss of $10.2 million in 2013 and operating income of $3.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. Tridien had total assets of $38.6 million, $39.2 million, and $44.5 million at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. (cid:2)et sales from Tridien represented 6.8%, 6.1% and 6.3% of our consolidated net sales for fiscal years 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. History Tridien was initially formed in February 2006 by CGI and Hollywood Capital, Inc., a private investment management firm led by Tridien’s former Chief Executive Officer, to acquire AMF Support Surfaces, Inc. ("AMF") and SenTech Medical Systems ("Sentech"), located in Corona, CA and Coral Springs, FL, respectively. AMF is a leading manufacturer of foam mattress systems, seating cushions and surgical patient positioning devices. SenTech is a leading developer, manufacturer and marketer of advanced electronically controlled (“powered”) support surfaces for the prevention and treatment of pressure ulcers (bed sores). Prior to its acquisition, SenTech had established itself as a premium brand due to its innovative proprietary technologies that set a new standard in pressure ulcer treatment in higher acuity care environments, while AMF competed in the price-sensitive, post-acute environment with the fundamental goal of pressure ulcer prevention. On October 5, 2006, Tridien acquired Anatomic Concepts ("Anatomic") and merged its operations with those of AMF in Corona, CA. Anatomic is a leading supplier of surgical patient positioning devices which are sold primarily into hospitals and outpatient surgery centers. These products properly align various parts of the human body that must be fixed in place during surgery, and/or require protection from injury (such as a pressure ulcer or other deep tissue injury) during the procedure. On June 27, 2007, Tridien purchased PrimaTech Medical Systems ("Primatech"), a lower price-point developer and distributor of powered therapeutic support surfaces to the long-term care and home healthcare markets. PrimaTech’s products are predominately designed in the U.S. and manufactured pursuant to an agreement with an FDA registered manufacturing partner located in Taiwan. We purchased a controlling interest in Tridien from CGI on August 1, 2006. Industry The market for manufacturing medical support surfaces is fragmented and comprised of many participants. Tridien’s consolidated platform allows its customers to purchase a wide variety of surface technologies for acute care, long term care and home health care from a single source. Tridien is a full-service supplier with in-house engineering, quality, regulatory, manufacturing and customer support to quickly and cost effectively bring new, innovative products and technologies to market while maintaining high quality standards in compliance with FDA regulations and our ISO 13485 manufacturing certification. iData Research, in its 2012 report titled, “U.S. Market for Therapeutic Support Surfaces”, calculated that the total market for therapeutic mattresses exceeded $1.4 billion in 2011, an increase of 3.2% over 2010. Therapeutic mattresses are identified as foam and foam/air hybrid systems (“non-powered”) and controller-based air and air/foam hybrid systems (“powered”). These are the types of therapeutic support surfaces offered by Tridien. In 2011, also as reported by iData Research, the powered mattress segment was valued at $861.4 million, and represented 59.1% of the total market. By 2018, this segment is expected to increase at a compounded annual growth rate of 2.6%, exceeding $1 billion and accounting for 58.5% of the total market. The non-powered mattress market was valued at $595 million in 2011, representing 40.9% of the total market. By 2018, the non-powered mattress segment is expected to grow slightly more rapidly than the powered mattress segment, and will comprise 41.5% of the total market. 60 Immobility caused by injury, old age, chronic illness, obesity and/or improper care is the main cause for the development of pressure ulcers. In these cases, a person lying in the same position for an extended period of time puts pressure on the bony prominences of the body surface. This pressure, if continued for a sustained period, can close blood capillaries that provide oxygen and nutrition to the skin. Over a period of time, these oxygen-deprived cells and tissues begin to break down and form sores. In addition to constant or excessive pressure, other contributing factors to the development of pressure ulcers include heat, moisture, friction and sheer. Pressure ulcers impose a significant burden not only on the patient, but on the entire health care system. According to a study by Reddy et al. published in the Journal of American Medicine ("JAMA") in 2006, an estimated 2.5 million pressure ulcers are treated each year in the United States alone. As reported in Advances in Skin and Wound Care in 2010 by Jenkins et al., pressure ulcer prevalence in U.S. hospitals ranged from 12% to 19.7%. The (cid:2)ational Pressure Ulcer Advisory Panel ("(cid:2)PUAP") estimates that pressure ulcer incidence can range as high as 38 percent in hospitals, 23.9 percent in skilled nursing facilities, and 17 percent for home health agencies. The Agency for Healthcare Research and Quality (AHRQ), part of the Department of Health and Human Services ("HHS"), reported in 2011 that pressure ulcers cost $9.1 billion to $11.6 billion per year in the United States, with the cost of individual patient care ranging from $20,900 to $151,700 per pressure ulcer. Medicare estimated in 2007 that each pressure ulcer added $43,180 in costs to a hospital stay. Demographic conditions are also favorable to the market for medical support surfaces. The Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (the "CDC") in its report titled, “The State of Aging & Health in America 2013”, states that the growth in the number and proportion of older adults is unprecedented in the history of the United States. Two factors, longer life spans and aging baby boomers, will combine to double the population of Americans aged 65 years or older to about 72 million by 2030, when older adults will account for roughly 20% of the U.S. population. The growth in the elderly population should increase the number of patients requiring facility or home care beds. In addition, as individual’s age, skin becomes more susceptible to breakdown, increasing the likelihood of developing pressure ulcers. Additionally, as reported by the (cid:2)ational Center for Health Statistics in its 2013 report titled, “Long-Term Care Services in the United States: 2013 Overview”, the number of people using nursing facilities, alternative residential care places, or home care services is projected to increase from 15 million in 2000 to 27 million in 2050. This is a favorable trend for Tridien’s branded/ private label portfolio of support surfaces which is targeted for post-acute care, including long-term care facilities and home health care. Poor lifestyle choices may also fuel the need for Tridien’s products and services. According to the CDC, more than one-third (34.9% or 78.6 million) of U.S. adults in 2014 were obese. As published in the American Journal of Preventative Medicine in 2009, Finkelstein et al. reported that by 2030, 51% of the total U.S. population will be obese, a 33% increase in obesity prevalence and a 130% increase in severe obesity prevalence from 2010 levels. They further estimated that this forecasted increase in obesity would increase medical expenditures over the next 20 years by $550 billion. And research published in Health Affairs in 2009 concluded that the annual medical cost of obesity in the U.S. was $147 billion in 2008. On average, the medical costs for people who are obese were $1,429 higher than those of normal weight. As an individual’s weight increases, so too does the probability that the individual will become immobile. Immobility increases the likelihood that high-risk areas of the body will be subjected to prolonged periods of constant pressure. These patients are more likely to require therapeutic support surfaces. Management believes that its differentiated, value-added business model, combined with several favorable demographic and industry trends, including an aging U.S. population, increasing life expectancies, rising obesity rates, and mounting reimbursement pressure on hospitals and long-term care facilities to prevent pressure ulcers, will provide opportunity for future growth. Products and Services Specialty beds, mattress replacements and mattress overlays are the primary products currently available for pressure reduction and pressure redistribution to prevent and treat pressure ulcers. The market for specialty beds and therapeutic surfaces include the acute care hospitals, long-term facilities (i.e. skilled nursing facilities), and home healthcare settings. The basic product categories are as follows: • Powered Support Surfaces - these are mattresses that can be used for therapy or prevention and typically use an electronic power source with air cylinders or a combination of air cylinders and foam. These products provide Alternating Pressure, Low Air Loss therapy, or Lateral Rotation. Alternating Pressure Systems are designed to inflate specific air bladders cylinders while adjoining cylinders deflate in an alternating pattern. The alternating pattern of inflation and deflation prevents sustained pressure on an area of skin by 61 shifting pressure from one area to another. This type of therapy provides movement under the patient’s skin to eliminate both excessive and constant pressure, the leading causes of pressure ulcers. Alternating Pressure Systems in the SenTech line incorporate Tridien’s intellectual property governing how the alternating pressure operates. This patented technology permits a maximum reduction of pressure in the deflated cells, thus nearly completely eliminating pressure on the areas of the body in contact with the cells. A desirable feature often found in Powered Surfaces is Low Air Loss, which allows air to flow from the mattress to the patient’s skin. This helps control moisture and temperature at the mattress-skin interface in a process called “microclimate management”. Excessive moisture, temperature, and humidity are contributing factors to pressure ulcer formation and treatment hindrance. Tridien also employs patented technology in its LAL mattress systems, which many caregivers believe provides optimum healing therapy for the patient. Another typical powered surface is Lateral Rotation, which can aid in turning a patient to reduce the risks associated with fluid build-up in a patient’s lungs. Tridien manufactures a Lateral Rotation system, which is positioned to help patients with pulmonary conditions or risk. • (cid:2)on-Powered Support Surfaces - these are mattresses that have no powered elements. These products address the excessive pressure under a patient, but do not traditionally alternate pressure over various areas of the body. (cid:2)on-powered surfaces are generally used for prevention rather than treatment and currently comprise the majority of support surfaces. Tridien manufactures a broad range of non-powered mattress systems using air, foam and gel. (cid:2)on- powered support surfaces represented 60.8%, 53.7% and 53.6% of net sales in each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. • Positioning Devices - these products are used to position patients during surgical procedures as well as to minimize the likelihood of pressure ulcer formation during those procedures. Tridien offers a complete range of foam positioning devices. Patient positioning devices represented 21.6%, 24.9% and 27.7% of net sales in each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Business Strategies Tridien’s management is concentrating on near-term strategies to improve operating efficiency while growing revenues and improving gross margins. The following is a discussion of these strategies: Offer customers high quality, consistent product, on a national basis - Products produced by Tridien and its competitors are typically bulky in nature and may not be conducive to shipping. Management believes that many of its competitors do not have the scale or resources required to produce support surfaces for national distributors and believes that customers value manufacturers with the scale and sophistication required to meet these needs. Tridien offers its customers the highest standards of quality through its robust Quality Management Systems. All Tridien facilities are ISO 13485 registered. Leverage scale to provide industry leading research and development - Higher acuity medical therapeutic surfaces are becoming increasingly technologically advanced. Tridien’s management believes that many smaller competitors do not have the resources required to effectively meet the increasing needs of the industry and believes that increased scale and investments in engineering and technology will allow it to better serve its customers through industry leading research, technology and development. Pursue cost savings through scale purchasing and operational improvements - Many of the products used to manufacture medical support surfaces are standard in nature and management believes that increased scale achieved through acquisitions will allow it to benefit from lower cost of materials and therefore lower cost of sales. Research and Development Tridien develops therapeutic support surfaces independently (branded products) and in partnership with large manufacturers and distributors (OEM and CM products). Tridien’s offerings are comprehensive and include powered, non-powered and hybrid support surfaces. Tridien employs a team of dedicated professionals across the disciplines of engineering, quality, operations, marketing and project management. This team has expertise in the latest global standards and adheres to a multi-phase design process. Customers value Tridien’s ability to adapt to changing project needs, to conduct rapid concept and feasibility prototyping, to integrate new technology quickly and seamlessly, and to problem solve in a collaborative way. This is how Tridien stays on the cutting edge of new product development and can continually offer the next generation of support surfaces. During the years ended 62 December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, Tridien incurred $3.1 million, $2.4 million and $2.1 million, respectively, in research and development costs. Customers Approximately 73.2%, 68.4% and 66.6% of Tridien’s sales have been to its three largest customers in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Tridien’s top ten customers accounted for 84.0%, 85.1% and 79.7% of gross sales in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Substantially all revenue is derived from sales within the United States. During the second quarter of 2013, one of Tridien’s largest customers lost a large contract program that was being serviced substantially with Tridien product. The expected lost sales and net income were significant enough to trigger an interim goodwill and indefinite-lived asset impairment analysis. The result of these analyses supported the carrying value of goodwill but indicated that sales of product, reliant on trade names, could not fully support the carrying value of Tridien’s trade names. As such we wrote down the value of the trade names by $0.9 million to a carrying value of approximately $0.6 million at that time. At December 31, 2013, further revenue decreases together with a revised 2014 forecast that indicated little to no growth prompted an additional interim impairment analysis as of December 31, 2013. The result of the year end goodwill impairment analysis (step 1) indicated that goodwill was impaired. Further testing (step 2) resulted in the following; (i) goodwill was written down $11.5 million to a balance of $16.8 million; (ii) trade names were written down $0.4 million to a balance of $0.2 million and; (iii) technology assets were written down $0.1 million to a balance of $0.8 million. In January 2015, one of Tridien’s largest customers informed Tridien that they will not renew their purchase agreement when it expires on September 30, 2015. This customer represented 20% of Tridien’s sales in 2014. The expected lost sales and net income are significant enough to trigger an interim goodwill and indefinite-lived asset impairment analysis which will be performed during the first quarter of 2015. Tridien had approximately $4.0 million and $3.4 million in firm backlog orders at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Sales and Marketing Tridien’s Support surfaces are primarily sold through distributors and through Durable Medical Equipment ("DME") suppliers. These customers either rent or sell to acute care (hospitals) facilities, long term care facilities and home health care organizations. The acute care distribution market for support surfaces is dominated by large suppliers such as Stryker Corporation and Hill-Rom Holdings Inc. Other national distributors usually provide specific types of support surface technology. Beyond national distribution intermediaries there are numerous smaller regional distributors who will purchase support surfaces developed by Tridien as certain brand lines are known in the market as providing proven therapy. Tridien has a full range of support surface products that are sold or rented to healthcare distributors and occasionally sold directly to the end customer. Tridien also provides technical support and repair services for its products, an offering valued by customers. Competition Competition in the medical support surfaces and patient positioner market is based predominantly on product performance, features, warranties, service, price and durability. Other factors may include the ability of a manufacturer to customize their product offerings to meet the needs of large distributors. Tridien competes with manufacturers of varying sizes who then sell predominantly through distributors to the acute care, long term care and home health care markets. Tridien differentiates itself from these competitors based on its breadth of product offerings, patented technologies, quality of the products it manufacturers as well as its design and engineering capabilities to produce a full spectrum of surfaces that provide the greatest therapeutic outcome for every price point. While many competitors specialize in the production of a single type of support surface, and often outsource certain manufacturing skills required to develop and manufacture products, Tridien is able to offer its customers a full spectrum of support surfaces. Suppliers Tridien’s two primary raw materials used in manufacturing are polyurethane foam and fabric (primarily nylon and polycarbonate fabrics). Among Tridien’s largest raw material suppliers are Foamex International, Inc., Carpenter Company, and Dartex Coatings, Inc. Tridien uses multiple suppliers for foam and fabric and believes that these raw materials are in adequate supply and are available from many suppliers at competitive prices. The cost of raw materials as a percentage of sales was approximately 53% of gross sales in 2014, 51% of gross sales in fiscal 2013, and 48% of gross sales in fiscal 2012. 63 Intellectual Property Tridien has 19 patents issued, filed from 1996 to 2014, and has 2 filed and pending patents. Regulatory Environment The Federal Food, Drug and Cosmetic Act (the "FFDCA"), and regulations issued or proposed there under, provide for regulation by the FDA of the marketing, manufacture, labeling, packaging and distribution of medical devices, including Tridien’s products. These regulations require, among other things that medical device manufacturers register with the FDA, list devices manufactured by them, and file various inspections by regulatory authorities and must comply with good manufacturing practices as required by the FDA and state regulatory authorities. Tridien’s management believes that Tridien is in substantial compliance with all applicable regulations. Employees As of December 31, 2014, Tridien employed 306 persons in all its locations together with 126 temporary employees. (cid:2)one of Tridien’s employees are subject to collective bargaining agreements. We believe that Tridien’s relationship with its employees is good. 64 ITEM 1A – RISK FACTORS Risks Related to Our Business and Structure We are a Company with limited history and may not be able to continue to successfully manage our businesses on a combined basis. We were formed on (cid:2)ovember 18, 2005 and have conducted operations since May 16, 2006. Although our management team has extensive experience in acquiring and managing small and middle market businesses, our failure to continue to develop and maintain effective systems and procedures, including accounting and financial reporting systems, to manage our operations as a consolidated public company, may negatively impact our ability to optimize the performance of our Company, which could adversely affect our ability to pay distributions to our shareholders. In addition, in that case, our consolidated financial statements might not be indicative of our financial condition, business and results of operations. Our future success is dependent on the employees of our Manager and the management teams of our businesses, the loss of any of whom could materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations. Our future success depends, to a significant extent, on the continued services of the employees of our Manager, most of whom have worked together for a number of years. While our Manager will have employment agreements with certain of its employees, including our Chief Financial Officer, these employment agreements may not prevent our Manager’s employees from leaving or from competing with us in the future. Our Manager does not have an employment agreement with our Chief Executive Officer. The future success of our businesses also depends on their respective management teams because we operate our businesses on a stand-alone basis, primarily relying on existing management teams for management of their day-to-day operations. Consequently, their operational success, as well as the success of our internal growth strategy, will be dependent on the continued efforts of the management teams of the businesses. We provide such persons with equity incentives in their respective businesses and have employment agreements and/or non-competition agreements with certain persons we have identified as key to their businesses. However, these measures may not prevent the departure of these managers. The loss of services of one or more members of our management team or the management team at one of our businesses could materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations. We face risks with respect to the evaluation and management of future platform or add-on acquisitions. A component of our strategy is to continue to acquire additional platform subsidiaries, as well as add-on businesses for our existing businesses. Generally, because such acquisition targets are held privately, we may experience difficulty in evaluating potential target businesses as the information concerning these businesses is not publicly available. In addition, we and our subsidiary companies may have difficulty effectively managing or integrating acquisitions. We may experience greater than expected costs or difficulties relating to such acquisition, in which case, we might not achieve the anticipated returns from any particular acquisition, which may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, business and results of operations. We may not be able to successfully fund future acquisitions of new businesses due to the lack of availability of debt or equity financing at the Company level on acceptable terms, which could impede the implementation of our acquisition strategy and materially adversely impact our financial condition, business and results of operations. In order to make future acquisitions, we intend to raise capital primarily through debt financing at the Company level, additional equity offerings, the sale of stock or assets of our businesses, and by offering equity in the Trust or our businesses to the sellers of target businesses or by undertaking a combination of any of the above. Since the timing and size of acquisitions cannot be readily predicted, we may need to be able to obtain funding on short notice to benefit fully from attractive acquisition opportunities. Such funding may not be available on acceptable terms. In addition, the level of our indebtedness may impact our ability to borrow at the Company level. Another source of capital for us may be the sale of additional shares, subject to market conditions and investor demand for the shares at prices that we consider to be in the interests of our shareholders. These risks may materially adversely affect our ability to pursue our acquisition strategy successfully and materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations. While we intend to make regular cash distributions to our shareholders, the Company’s board of directors has full authority and discretion over the distributions of the Company, other than the profit allocation, and it may decide to reduce or eliminate distributions at any time, which may materially adversely affect the market price for our shares. To date, we have declared and paid quarterly distributions, and although we intend to pursue a policy of paying regular distributions, the Company’s board of directors has full authority and discretion to determine whether or not a distribution by the Company 65 should be declared and paid to the Trust and in turn to our shareholders, as well as the amount and timing of any distribution. In addition, the management fee and profit allocation will be payment obligations of the Company and, as a result, will be paid, along with other Company obligations, prior to the payment of distributions to our shareholders. The Company’s board of directors may, based on their review of our financial condition and results of operations and pending acquisitions, determine to reduce or eliminate distributions, which may have a material adverse effect on the market price of our shares. We will rely entirely on receipts from our businesses to make distributions to our shareholders. The Trust’s sole asset is its interest in the Company, which holds controlling interests in our businesses. Therefore, we are dependent upon the ability of our businesses to generate earnings and cash flow and distribute them to us in the form of interest and principal payments on indebtedness and, from time to time, dividends on equity to enable us, first, to satisfy our financial obligations and, second to make distributions to our shareholders. This ability may be subject to limitations under laws of the jurisdictions in which they are incorporated or organized. If, as a consequence of these various restrictions, we are unable to generate sufficient receipts from our businesses, we may not be able to declare, or may have to delay or cancel payment of, distributions to our shareholders. We do not own 100% of our businesses. While we receive cash payments from our businesses which are in the form of interest payments, debt repayment and dividends, if any dividends were to be paid by our businesses, they would be shared pro rata with the minority shareholders of our businesses and the amounts of dividends made to minority shareholders would not be available to us for any purpose, including Company debt service or distributions to our shareholders. Any proceeds from the sale of a business will be allocated among us and the non-controlling shareholders of the business that is sold. The Company’s board of directors has the power to change the terms of our shares in its sole discretion in ways with which you may disagree. As an owner of our shares, you may disagree with changes made to the terms of our shares, and you may disagree with the Company’s board of directors’ decision that the changes made to the terms of the shares are not materially adverse to you as a shareholder or that they do not alter the characterization of the Trust. Your recourse, if you disagree, will be limited because our Trust Agreement gives broad authority and discretion to our board of directors. However, the Trust Agreement does not relieve the Company’s board of directors from any fiduciary obligation that is imposed on them pursuant to applicable law. In addition, we may change the nature of the shares to be issued to raise additional equity and remain a fixed-investment trust for tax purposes. Certain provisions of the LLC Agreement of the Company and the Trust Agreement make it difficult for third parties to acquire control of the Trust and the Company and could deprive you of the opportunity to obtain a takeover premium for your shares. The amended and restated LLC Agreement of the Company, which we refer to as the LLC Agreement, and the amended and restated Trust Agreement of the Trust, which we refer to as the Trust Agreement, contain a number of provisions that could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire, or may discourage a third party from acquiring, control of the Trust and the Company. These provisions include, among others: • • • • • • • • restrictions on the Company’s ability to enter into certain transactions with our major shareholders, with the exception of our Manager, modeled on the limitation contained in Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law, or DGCL; allowing only the Company’s board of directors to fill newly created directorships, for those directors who are elected by our shareholders, and allowing only our Manager, as holder of a portion of the Allocation Interests, to fill vacancies with respect to the class of directors appointed by our Manager; requiring that directors elected by our shareholders be removed, with or without cause, only by a vote of 85% of our shareholders; requiring advance notice for nominations of candidates for election to the Company’s board of directors or for proposing matters that can be acted upon by our shareholders at a shareholders’ meeting; having a substantial number of additional authorized but unissued shares that may be issued without shareholder action; providing the Company’s board of directors with certain authority to amend the LLC Agreement and the Trust Agreement, subject to certain voting and consent rights of the holders of trust interests and Allocation Interests; providing for a staggered board of directors of the Company, the effect of which could be to deter a proxy contest for control of the Company’s board of directors or a hostile takeover; and limitations regarding calling special meetings and written consents of our shareholders. These provisions, as well as other provisions in the LLC Agreement and Trust Agreement may delay, defer or prevent a transaction or a change in control that might otherwise result in you obtaining a takeover premium for your shares. 66 We may have conflicts of interest with the noncontrolling shareholders of our businesses. The boards of directors of our respective businesses have fiduciary duties to all their shareholders, including the Company and noncontrolling shareholders. As a result, they may make decisions that are in the best interests of their shareholders generally but which are not necessarily in the best interest of the Company or our shareholders. In dealings with the Company, the directors of our businesses may have conflicts of interest and decisions may have to be made without the participation of directors appointed by the Company, and such decisions may be different from those that we would make. Our third party credit facility exposes us to additional risks associated with leverage and inhibits our operating flexibility and reduces cash flow available for distributions to our shareholders. At December 31, 2014, we had approximately $323.4 million outstanding under our 2014 Term Loan Facility and $174.2 million outstanding under our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility (representing draws under our revolver and outstanding letters of credit). We expect to increase our level of debt in the future. The terms of our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility contains a number of affirmative and restrictive covenants that, among other things, require us to: • maintain a minimum level of cash flow; leverage new businesses we acquire to a minimum specified level at the time of acquisition; • • keep our total debt to cash flow at or below a ratio of 3.5 to 1; and • make acquisitions that satisfy certain specified minimum criteria. If we violate any of these covenants, our lender may accelerate the maturity of any debt outstanding and we may be prohibited from making any distributions to our shareholders. Such debt is secured by all of our assets, including the stock we own in our businesses and the rights we have under the loan agreements with our businesses. Our ability to meet our debt service obligations may be affected by events beyond our control and will depend primarily upon cash produced by our businesses. Any failure to comply with the terms of our indebtedness could materially adversely affect us. Changes in interest rates could materially adversely affect us. Our Credit Facility bears interest at floating rates which will generally change as interest rates change. We bear the risk that the rates we are charged by our lender will increase faster than the earnings and cash flow of our businesses, which could reduce profitability, adversely affect our ability to service our debt, cause us to breach covenants contained in our Revolving Credit Facility and reduce cash flow available for distribution, any of which could materially adversely affect us. We may engage in a business transaction with one or more target businesses that have relationships with our officers, our directors, our Manager or CGI, which may create potential conflicts of interest. We may decide to acquire one or more businesses with which our officers, our directors, our Manager or CGI have a relationship. While we might obtain a fairness opinion from an independent investment banking firm, potential conflicts of interest may still exist with respect to a particular acquisition, and, as a result, the terms of the acquisition of a target business may not be as advantageous to our shareholders as it would have been absent any conflicts of interest. We are exposed to risks relating to evaluations of controls required by Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. We are required to comply with Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. While we have concluded that at December 31, 2014 that we have no material weaknesses in our internal controls over financial reporting we cannot assure you that we will not have a material weakness in the future. A “material weakness” is a control deficiency, or combination of significant deficiencies that results in more than a remote likelihood that a material misstatement of the annual or interim financial statements will not be prevented or detected. If we fail to maintain a system of internal controls over financial reporting that meets the requirements of Section 404, we might be subject to sanctions or investigation by regulatory authorities such as the SEC or by the (cid:2)ew York Stock Exchange. Additionally, failure to comply with Section 404 or the report by us of a material weakness may cause investors to lose confidence in our financial statements and our stock price may be adversely affected. If we fail to remedy any material weakness, our financial statements may be inaccurate, we may not have access to the capital markets, and our stock price may be adversely affected. CGI may exercise significant influence over the Company. CGI, through a wholly owned subsidiary, owns 7,931,000 or approximately 14.6% of our shares and may have significant influence over the election of directors in the future. 67 We could be negatively impacted by cybersecurity attacks. We, and our businesses, use a variety of information technology systems in the ordinary course of business, which are potentially vulnerable to unauthorized access, computer viruses and cyber attacks, including cyber attacks to our information technology infrastructure and attempts by others to gain access to our propriety or sensitive information, and ranging from individual attempts to advanced persistent threats. The procedures and controls we use to monitor these threats and mitigate our exposure may not be sufficient to prevent cyber security incidents. The results of these incidents could include misstated financial data, theft of trade secrets or other intellectual property, liability for disclosure of confidential customer, supplier or employee information, increased costs arising from the implementation of additional security protective measures, litigation and reputational damage, which could materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations. Any remedial costs or other liabilities related to cybersecurity incidents may not be fully insured or indemnified by other means. If, in the future, we cease to control and operate our businesses, we may be deemed to be an investment company under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended. Under the terms of the LLC Agreement, we have the latitude to make investments in businesses that we will not operate or control. If we make significant investments in businesses that we do not operate or control or cease to operate and control our businesses, we may be deemed to be an investment company under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, or the Investment Company Act. If we were deemed to be an investment company, we would either have to register as an investment company under the Investment Company Act, obtain exemptive relief from the SEC or modify our investments or organizational structure or our contract rights to fall outside the definition of an investment company. Registering as an investment company could, among other things, materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations, materially limit our ability to borrow funds or engage in other transactions involving leverage and require us to add directors who are independent of us or our Manager and otherwise will subject us to additional regulation that will be costly and time-consuming. Risks Relating to Our Manager Our Chief Executive Officer, directors, Manager and management team may allocate some of their time to other businesses, thereby causing conflicts of interest in their determination as to how much time to devote to our affairs, which may materially adversely affect our operations. While the members of our management team anticipate devoting a substantial amount of their time to the affairs of the Company, only Mr. Ryan Faulkingham, our Chief Financial Officer, devotes substantially all of his time to our affairs. Our Chief Executive Officer, directors, Manager and members of our management team may engage in other business activities. This may result in a conflict of interest in allocating their time between our operations and our management and operations of other businesses. Their other business endeavors may be related to CGI, which will continue to own several businesses that were managed by our management team prior to our initial public offering, or affiliates of CGI as well as other parties. Conflicts of interest that arise over the allocation of time may not always be resolved in our favor and may materially adversely affect our operations. See the section entitled “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” for the potential conflicts of interest of which you should be aware. Our Manager and its affiliates, including members of our management team, may engage in activities that compete with us or our businesses. While our management team intends to devote a substantial majority of their time to the affairs of the Company, and while our Manager and its affiliates currently do not manage any other businesses that are in similar lines of business as our businesses, and while our Manager must present all opportunities that meet the Company’s acquisition and disposition criteria to the Company’s board of directors, neither our management team nor our Manager is expressly prohibited from investing in or managing other entities, including those that are in the same or similar line of business as our businesses. In this regard, the management services agreement and the obligation to provide management services will not create a mutually exclusive relationship between our Manager and its affiliates, on the one hand, and the Company, on the other. Our Manager need not present an acquisition or disposition opportunity to us if our Manager determines on its own that such acquisition or disposition opportunity does not meet the Company’s acquisition or disposition criteria. Our Manager will review any acquisition or disposition opportunity presented to the Manager to determine if it satisfies the Company’s acquisition or disposition criteria, as established by the Company’s board of directors from time to time. If our Manager 68 determines, in its sole discretion, that an opportunity fits our criteria, our Manager will refer the opportunity to the Company’s board of directors for its authorization and approval prior to the consummation thereof; opportunities that our Manager determines do not fit our criteria do not need to be presented to the Company’s board of directors for consideration. If such an opportunity is ultimately profitable, we will have not participated in such opportunity. Upon a determination by the Company’s board of directors not to promptly pursue an opportunity presented to it by our Manager in whole or in part, our Manager will be unrestricted in its ability to pursue such opportunity, or any part that we do not promptly pursue, on its own or refer such opportunity to other entities, including its affiliates. We cannot remove our Manager solely for poor performance, which could limit our ability to improve our performance and could materially adversely affect the market price of our shares. Under the terms of the management services agreement, our Manager cannot be removed as a result of under performance. Instead, the Company’s board of directors can only remove our Manager in certain limited circumstances or upon a vote by the majority of the Company’s board of directors and the majority of our shareholders to terminate the management services agreement. This limitation could materially adversely affect the market price of our shares. Our Manager can resign on 180 days’ notice and we may not be able to find a suitable replacement within that time, resulting in a disruption in our operations that could materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations as well as the market price of our shares. Our Manager has the right, under the management services agreement, to resign at any time on 180 days’ written notice, whether we have found a replacement or not. If our Manager resigns, we may not be able to contract with a new manager or hire internal management with similar expertise and ability to provide the same or equivalent services on acceptable terms within 90 days, or at all, in which case our operations are likely to experience a disruption, our financial condition, business and results of operations as well as our ability to pay distributions are likely to be adversely affected and the market price of our shares may decline. In addition, the coordination of our internal management, acquisition activities and supervision of our businesses is likely to suffer if we are unable to identify and reach an agreement with a single institution or group of executives having the expertise possessed by our Manager and its affiliates. Even if we are able to retain comparable management, whether internal or external, the integration of such management and their lack of familiarity with our businesses may result in additional costs and time delays that could materially adversely affect our financial condition, business and results of operations. We must pay our Manager the management fee regardless of our performance. Our Manager is entitled to receive a management fee that is based on our adjusted consolidated net assets, as defined in the management services agreement, regardless of the performance of our businesses. The calculation of the management fee is unrelated to the Company’s net income. As a result, the management fee may incentivize our Manager to increase the amount of our assets, for example, the acquisition of additional assets or the incurrence of third party debt rather than increase the performance of our businesses. We cannot determine the amount of the management fee that will be paid over time with any certainty. The management fee paid to CGM for the year ended December 31, 2014, was $22.7 million. The management fee is calculated by reference to the Company’s adjusted net assets, which will be impacted by the acquisition or disposition of businesses, which can be significantly influenced by our Manager, as well as the performance of our businesses and other businesses we may acquire in the future. Changes in adjusted net assets and in the resulting management fee could be significant, resulting in a material adverse effect on the Company’s results of operations. In addition, if the performance of the Company declines, assuming adjusted net assets remains the same, management fees will increase as a percentage of the Company’s net income. We cannot determine the amount of profit allocation that will be paid over time with any certainty. We cannot determine the amount of profit allocation that will be paid over time with any certainty. Such determination would be dependent on the potential sale proceeds received for any of our businesses and the performance of the Company and its businesses over a multi-year period of time, among other factors that cannot be predicted with certainty at this time. Such factors may have a significant impact on the amount of any profit allocation to be paid. Likewise, such determination would be dependent on whether certain hurdles were surpassed giving rise to a payment of profit allocation. Any amounts paid in respect of the profit allocation are unrelated to the management fee earned for performance of services under the management services agreement. 69 The fees to be paid to our Manager pursuant to the management services agreement, the offsetting management services agreements and integration services agreements and the profit allocation to be paid to certain persons who are employees and partners of our Manager, as holders of the Allocation Interests, pursuant to the LLC Agreement may significantly reduce the amount of cash available for distribution to our shareholders. Under the management services agreement, the Company will be obligated to pay a management fee to and, subject to certain conditions, reimburse the costs and out-of-pocket expenses of our Manager incurred on behalf of the Company in connection with the provision of services to the Company. Similarly, our businesses will be obligated to pay fees to and reimburse the costs and expenses of our Manager pursuant to any offsetting management services agreements entered into between our Manager and one of our businesses, or any integration services agreements to which such businesses are a party. In addition, Sostratus LLC, as holder of the Allocation Interests, will be entitled to receive profit allocations. While it is difficult to quantify with any certainty the actual amount of any such payments in the future, we do expect that such amounts could be substantial. See the section entitled “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” for more information about these payment obligations of the Company. The management fee and profit allocation and will be payment obligations of the Company and, as a result, will be paid, along with other Company obligations, prior to the payment of distributions to shareholders. As a result, the payment of these amounts may significantly reduce the amount of cash flow available for distribution to our shareholders. Our Manager’s influence on conducting our operations, including on our conducting of transactions, gives it the ability to increase its fees, which may reduce the amount of cash flow available for distribution to our shareholders. Under the terms of the management services agreement, our Manager is paid a management fee calculated as a percentage of the Company’s adjusted net assets for certain items and is unrelated to net income or any other performance base or measure. Our Manager, controls, may advise us to consummate transactions, incur third party debt or conduct our operations in a manner that, in our Manager’s reasonable discretion, are necessary to the future growth of our businesses and are in the best interests of our shareholders. These transactions, however, may increase the amount of fees paid to our Manager. Our Manager’s ability to increase its fees, through the influence it has over our operations, may increase the compensation paid by our Manager. Our Manager’s ability to influence the management fee paid to it by us could reduce the amount of cash flow available for distribution to our shareholders. Fees paid by the Company and our businesses pursuant to integration services agreements do not offset fees payable under the management services agreement and will be in addition to the management fee payable by the Company under the management services agreement. The management services agreement provides that our businesses may enter into integration services agreements with our Manager pursuant to which our businesses will pay fees to our Manager for services provided by our Manager relating to the integration of a business’s financial reporting, computer systems and decision making and management processes into our operations following an acquisition of such business. See the section entitled “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” for more information about these agreements. Unlike fees paid under the offsetting management services agreements, fees that are paid pursuant to such integration services agreements will not reduce the management fee payable by the Company. Therefore, such fees will be in excess of the management fee payable by the Company. The fees to be paid to our Manager pursuant to these integration service agreements will be paid prior to any principal, interest or dividend payments to be paid to the Company by our businesses, which will reduce the amount of cash flow available for distributions to shareholders. Our profit allocation may induce our Manager to make suboptimal decisions regarding our operations. Sostratus LLC, as holder of our Allocation Interests, will receive a profit allocation based on ongoing cash flows and capital gains in excess of a hurdle rate. Certain persons who are employees and partners of our Manager are owners of Sostratus LLC. In this respect, a calculation and payment of profit allocation may be triggered upon the sale of one of our businesses. As a result, our Manager may be incentivized to recommend the sale of one or more of our businesses to the Company’s board of directors at a time that may not be optimal for our shareholders. The obligations to pay the management fee and profit allocation may cause the Company to liquidate assets or incur debt. If we do not have sufficient liquid assets to pay the management fee and profit allocation when such payments are due, we may be required to liquidate assets or incur debt in order to make such payments. This circumstance could materially adversely affect our liquidity and ability to make distributions to our shareholders. 70 Risks Related to Taxation Our shareholders will be subject to tax on their share of the Company’s taxable income, which taxes or taxable income could exceed the cash distributions they receive from the Trust. For so long as the Company or the Trust (if it is treated as a tax partnership) would not be required to register as an investment company under the Investment Company Act of 1940 and at least 90% of our gross income for each taxable year constitutes ‘‘qualifying income’’ within the meaning of Section 7704(d) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the ‘‘Code’’), on a continuing basis, we will be treated, for U.S. federal income tax purposes, as a partnership and not as an association or a publicly traded partnership taxable as a corporation. In that case our shareholders will be subject to U.S. federal income tax and, possibly, state, local and foreign income tax, on their share of the Company’s taxable income, which taxes or taxable income could exceed the cash distributions they receive from the Trust. There is, accordingly, a risk that our shareholders may not receive cash distributions equal to their portion of our taxable income or sufficient in amount even to satisfy their personal tax liability those results from that income. This may result from gains on the sale or exchange of stock or debt of subsidiaries that will be allocated to shareholders who hold (or are deemed to hold) shares on the day such gains were realized if there is no corresponding distribution of the proceeds from such sales, or where a shareholder disposes of shares after an allocation of gain but before proceeds (if any) are distributed by the Company. Shareholders may also realize income in excess of distributions due to the Company’s use of cash from operations or sales proceeds for uses other than to make distributions to shareholders, including funding acquisitions, satisfying short- and long-term working capital needs of our businesses, or satisfying known or unknown liabilities. In addition, certain financial covenants with the Company’s lenders may limit or prohibit the distribution of cash to shareholders. The Company’s board of directors is also free to change the Company’s distribution policy. The Company is under no obligation to make distributions to shareholders equal to or in excess of their portion of our taxable income or sufficient in amount even to satisfy the tax liability that results from that income. All of the Company’s income could be subject to an entity-level tax in the United States, which could result in a material reduction in cash flow available for distribution to holders of shares of the Trust and thus could result in a substantial reduction in the value of the shares. We do not expect the Company to be characterized as a corporation so long as it would not be required to register as an investment company under the Investment Company Act of 1940 and 90% or more of its gross income for each taxable year constitutes “qualifying income.” The Company expects to receive more than 90% of its gross income each year from dividends, interest and gains on sales of stock or debt instruments, including principally from or with respect to stock or debt of corporations in which the Company holds a majority interest. The Company intends to treat all such dividends, interest and gains as “qualifying income.” If the Company fails to satisfy this “qualifying income” exception, the Company will be treated as a corporation for U.S. federal (and certain state and local) income tax purposes, and would be required to pay income tax at regular corporate rates on its income. Taxation of the Company as a corporation could result in a material reduction in distributions to our shareholders and after-tax return and, thus, could likely result in a reduction in the value of, or materially adversely affect the market price of, the shares of the Trust. A shareholder may recognize a greater taxable gain (or a smaller tax loss) on a disposition of shares than expected because of the treatment of debt under the partnership tax accounting rules. We may incur debt for a variety of reasons, including for acquisitions as well as other purposes. Under partnership tax accounting principles (which apply to the Company), debt of the Company generally will be allocable to our shareholders, who will realize the benefit of including their allocable share of the debt in the tax basis of their investment in shares. At the time a shareholder later sells shares, the selling shareholder’s amount realized on the sale will include not only the sales price of the shares but also the shareholder’s portion of the Company’s debt allocable to his shares (which is treated as proceeds from the sale of those shares). Depending on the nature of the Company’s activities after having incurred the debt, and the utilization of the borrowed funds, a later sale of shares could result in a larger taxable gain (or a smaller tax loss) than anticipated. Our structure involves complex provisions of U.S. federal income tax law for which no clear precedent or authority may be available. Our structure also is subject to potential legislative, judicial or administrative change and differing interpretations, possibly on a retroactive basis. The U.S. federal income tax treatment of holders of the Shares depends in some instances on determinations of fact and interpretations of complex provisions of U.S. federal income tax law for which no clear precedent or authority may be available. You should be aware that the U.S. federal income tax rules are constantly under review by persons involved in the legislative process, the IRS, and the U.S. Treasury Department, frequently resulting in revised interpretations of established concepts, statutory changes, revisions to regulations and other modifications and interpretations. The IRS pays close attention to the proper application 71 of tax laws to partnerships. The present U.S. federal income tax treatment of an investment in the Shares may be modified by administrative, legislative or judicial interpretation at any time, and any such action may affect investments and commitments previously made. For example, changes to the U.S. federal tax laws and interpretations thereof could make it more difficult or impossible to meet the qualifying income exception for us to be treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes that is not taxable as a corporation, affect or cause us to change our investments and commitments, affect the tax considerations of an investment in us and adversely affect an investment in our Shares. Our organizational documents and agreements permit the Board of Directors to modify our operating agreement from time to time, without the consent of the holders of Shares, in order to address certain changes in U.S. federal income tax regulations, legislation or interpretation. In some circumstances, such revisions could have a material adverse impact on some or all of the holders of our Shares. Moreover, we will apply certain assumptions and conventions in an attempt to comply with applicable rules and to report income, gain, deduction, loss and credit to holders in a manner that reflects such holders’ beneficial ownership of partnership items, taking into account variation in ownership interests during each taxable year because of trading activity. However, these assumptions and conventions may not be in compliance with all aspects of applicable tax requirements. It is possible that the IRS will assert successfully that the conventions and assumptions used by us do not satisfy the technical requirements of the Code and/or Treasury regulations and could require that items of income, gain, deductions, loss or credit, including interest deductions, be adjusted, reallocated, or disallowed, in a manner that adversely affects holders of the Shares. Risks Relating Generally to Our Businesses Impairment of our intangible assets could result in significant charges that would adversely impact our future operating results. We have significant intangible assets, including goodwill with an indefinite life, which are susceptible to valuation adjustments as a result of changes in various factors or conditions. The most significant intangible assets on our balance sheet are goodwill, technologies, customer relationships and trademarks we acquired when we acquired our businesses. Customer relationships are amortized on a straight line basis based upon the pattern in which the economic benefits of customer relationships are being utilized. Other identifiable intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. We assess the potential impairment of goodwill and indefinite lived intangible assets on an annual basis, as well as whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. We assess definite lived intangible assets whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. Factors that could trigger impairment include the following: • • • • • • significant under performance relative to historical or projected future operating results; significant changes in the manner of or use of the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business; significant negative industry or economic trends; significant decline in our stock price for a sustained period; changes in our organization or management reporting structure could result in additional reporting units, which may require alternative methods of estimating fair values or greater desegregation or aggregation in our analysis by reporting unit; and a decline in our market capitalization below net book value. As of December 31, 2014, we had identified indefinite lived intangible assets with a carrying value in our financial statements of $166.7 million, and goodwill of $359.2 million. At Tridien we wrote down approximately $12.9 million in goodwill and intangible assets during 2013 as a result of lower than anticipated sales and sales growth. Further adverse changes in the operations of our businesses or other unforeseeable factors could result in an additional impairment charge in future periods that would impact our results of operations and financial position in that period. Our businesses are subject to unplanned business interruptions which may adversely affect our performance. Operational interruptions and unplanned events at one or more of our production facilities, such as explosions, fires, inclement weather, natural disasters, accidents, transportation interruptions and supply could cause substantial losses in our production capacity. Furthermore, because customers may be dependent on planned deliveries from us, customers that have to reschedule their own operations due to our delivery delays may be able to pursue financial claims against us, and we may incur costs to correct such problems in addition to any liability resulting from such claims. Such interruptions may also harm our reputation among actual and potential customers, potentially resulting in a loss of business. To the extent these losses are not covered by insurance, our financial position, results of operations and cash flows may be adversely affected by such events. 72 Our businesses rely and may rely on their intellectual property and licenses to use others’ intellectual property, for competitive advantage. If our businesses are unable to protect their intellectual property, are unable to obtain or retain licenses to use other’s intellectual property, or if they infringe upon or are alleged to have infringed upon others’ intellectual property, it could have a material adverse effect on their financial condition, business and results of operations. Each businesses’ success depends in part on their, or licenses to use others’, brand names, proprietary technology and manufacturing techniques. These businesses rely on a combination of patents, trademarks, copyrights, trade secrets, confidentiality procedures and contractual provisions to protect their intellectual property rights. The steps they have taken to protect their intellectual property rights may not prevent third parties from using their intellectual property and other proprietary information without their authorization or independently developing intellectual property and other proprietary information that is similar. In addition, the laws of foreign countries may not protect our businesses’ intellectual property rights effectively or to the same extent as the laws of the United States. Stopping unauthorized use of their proprietary information and intellectual property, and defending claims that they have made unauthorized use of others’ proprietary information or intellectual property, may be difficult, time-consuming and costly. The use of their intellectual property and other proprietary information by others, and the use by others of their intellectual property and proprietary information, could reduce or eliminate any competitive advantage they have developed, cause them to lose sales or otherwise harm their business. Our businesses may become involved in legal proceedings and claims in the future either to protect their intellectual property or to defend allegations that they have infringed upon others’ intellectual property rights. These claims and any resulting litigation could subject them to significant liability for damages and invalidate their property rights. In addition, these lawsuits, regardless of their merits, could be time consuming and expensive to resolve and could divert management’s time and attention. The costs associated with any of these actions could be substantial and could have a material adverse effect on their financial condition, business and results of operations. The operations and research and development of some of our businesses’ services and technology depend on the collective experience of their technical employees. If these employees were to leave our businesses and take this knowledge, our businesses’ operations and their ability to compete effectively could be materially adversely impacted. The future success of some of our businesses depends upon the continued service of their technical personnel who have developed and continue to develop their technology and products. If any of these employees leave our businesses, the loss of their technical knowledge and experience may materially adversely affect the operations and research and development of current and future services. We may also be unable to attract technical individuals with comparable experience because competition for such technical personnel is intense. If our businesses are not able to replace their technical personnel with new employees or attract additional technical individuals, their operations may suffer as they may be unable to keep up with innovations in their respective industries. As a result, their ability to continue to compete effectively and their operations may be materially adversely affected. If our businesses are unable to continue the technological innovation and successful commercial introduction of new products and services, their financial condition, business and results of operations could be materially adversely affected. The industries in which our businesses operate, or may operate, experience periodic technological changes and ongoing product improvements. Their results of operations depend significantly on the development of commercially viable new products, product grades and applications, as well as production technologies and their ability to integrate new technologies. Our future growth will depend on their ability to gauge the direction of the commercial and technological progress in all key end-use markets and upon their ability to successfully develop, manufacture and market products in such changing end-use markets. In this regard, they must make ongoing capital investments. In addition, their customers may introduce new generations of their own products, which may require new or increased technological and performance specifications, requiring our businesses to develop customized products. Our businesses may not be successful in developing new products and technology that satisfy their customers’ demand and their customers may not accept any of their new products. If our businesses fail to keep pace with evolving technological innovations or fail to modify their products in response to their customers’ needs in a timely manner, then their financial condition, business and results of operations could be materially adversely affected as a result of reduced sales of their products and sunk developmental costs. These developments may require our personnel staffing business to seek better educated and trained workers, who may not be available in sufficient numbers. 73 Our businesses could experience fluctuations in the costs of raw materials as a result of inflation and other economic conditions, which fluctuations could have a material adverse effect on their financial condition, business and results of operations. Changes in inflation could materially adversely affect the costs and availability of raw materials used in our manufacturing businesses, and changes in fuel costs likely will affect the costs of transporting materials from our suppliers and shipping goods to our customers, as well as the effective areas from which we can recruit temporary staffing personnel. For example, for Advanced Circuits, the principal raw materials consist of copper and glass and represent approximately 20% of net sales in 2014. Prices for these key raw materials may fluctuate during periods of high demand. The ability by these businesses to offset the effect of increases in raw material prices by increasing their prices is uncertain. If these businesses are unable to cover price increases of these raw materials, their financial condition, business and results of operations could be materially adversely affected. Our businesses do not have and may not have long-term contracts with their customers and clients and the loss of customers and clients could materially adversely affect their financial condition, business and results of operations. Our businesses are and may be, based primarily upon individual orders and sales with their customers and clients. Our businesses historically have not entered into long-term supply contracts with their customers and clients. As such, their customers and clients could cease using their services or buying their products from them at any time and for any reason. The fact that they do not enter into long-term contracts with their customers and clients means that they have no recourse in the event a customer or client no longer wants to use their services or purchase products from them. If a significant number of their customers or clients elect not to use their services or purchase their products, it could materially adversely affect their financial condition, business and results of operations. Our businesses are and may be subject to federal, state and foreign environmental laws and regulations that expose them to potential financial liability. Complying with applicable environmental laws requires significant resources, and if our businesses fail to comply, they could be subject to substantial liability. Some of the facilities and operations of our businesses are and may be subject to a variety of federal, state and foreign environmental laws and regulations including laws and regulations pertaining to the handling, storage and transportation of raw materials, products and wastes, which require and will continue to require significant expenditures to remain in compliance with such laws and regulations currently in place and in the future. Compliance with current and future environmental laws is a major consideration for our businesses as any material violations of these laws can lead to substantial liability, revocations of discharge permits, fines or penalties. Because some of our businesses use hazardous materials and generate hazardous wastes in their operations, they may be subject to potential financial liability for costs associated with the investigation and remediation of their own sites, or sites at which they have arranged for the disposal of hazardous wastes, if such sites become contaminated. Even if they fully comply with applicable environmental laws and are not directly at fault for the contamination, our businesses may still be liable. Costs associated with these risks could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, business and results of operations. Defects in the products provided by our companies could result in financial or other damages to their customers, which could result in reduced demand for our companies’ products and/or liability claims against our companies. As manufacturers and distributors of consumer products, certain of our companies are subject to various laws, rules and regulations, which may empower governmental agencies and authorities to exclude from the market products that are found to be unsafe or hazardous. Under certain circumstances, a governmental authority could require our companies to repurchase or recall one or more of their products. Additionally, laws regulating certain consumer products exist in some cities and states, as well as in other countries in which they sell their products, where more restrictive laws and regulations exist or may be adopted in the future. Any repurchase or recall of such products could be costly and could damage the reputation of our companies. If any of our companies were required to remove, or voluntarily remove, their products from the market, their reputation may be tarnished and they may have large quantities of finished products that they cannot sell. Additionally, our companies may be subject to regulatory actions that could harm their reputations, adversely impact the values of their brands and/or increase the cost of production. Our companies also face exposure to product liability claims in the event that one of their products is alleged to have resulted in property damage, bodily injury or other adverse effects. Defects in products could result in customer dissatisfaction or a reduction in, or cancellation of, future purchases or liability claims against our companies. If these defects occur frequently, our reputation may be impaired permanently. Defects in products could also result in financial or other damages to customers, for which our companies may be asked or required to compensate their customers, in the form of substantial monetary judgments or otherwise. While our companies take the steps deemed necessary to comply with all laws and regulations, there can be no assurance that rapidly changing safety standards will not render unsaleable products that complied with previously-applicable safety standards. As a result, these types of claims could have a material adverse effect on our businesses, results of operations and financial condition. 74 Some of our businesses are subject to certain risks associated with the movement of businesses offshore. Some of our businesses are potentially at risk of losing business to competitors operating in lower cost countries. An additional risk is the movement offshore of some of our businesses’ customers, leading them to procure products or services from more closely located companies. Either of these factors could negatively impact our financial condition, business and results of operations. Loss of key customers of some of our businesses could negatively impact financial condition. Some of our businesses have significant exposure to certain key customers, the loss of which could negatively impact our financial condition, business and results of operations. Our businesses are subject to certain risks associated with their foreign operations or business they conduct in foreign jurisdictions. Some of our businesses have and may have operations or conduct business outside the United States. Certain risks are inherent in operating or conducting business in foreign jurisdictions, including exposure to local economic conditions; difficulties in enforcing agreements and collecting receivables through certain foreign legal systems; longer payment cycles for foreign customers; adverse currency exchange controls; exposure to risks associated with changes in foreign exchange rates; potential adverse changes in political environments; withholding taxes and restrictions on the withdrawal of foreign investments and earnings; export and import restrictions; difficulties in enforcing intellectual property rights; and required compliance with a variety of foreign laws and regulations. These risks individually and collectively have the potential to negatively impact our financial condition, business and results of operations. Regulations related to conflict minerals may force certain of our businesses to incur additional expenses, may make the supply chain of such businesses more complex and may result in damage to the customer relationships of such businesses. In August 2012, as mandated by the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010, the Securities and Exchange Commission promulgated final rules regarding disclosure of the use of certain minerals and their derivatives, including tin, tantalum, tungsten and gold, known as “conflict minerals,” if these minerals are necessary to the functionality or production of the company’s products. These regulations require such issuers to report annually whether or not such minerals originate from the Democratic Republic of Congo (DRC) and adjoining countries and in some cases to perform extensive due diligence on their supply chains for such minerals. Our businesses have incurred and will continue to incur additional costs to comply with the disclosure requirements, including costs related to determining the source of any of the relevant minerals used in the products of certain of our businesses. These requirements could adversely affect the sourcing, availability and pricing of conflict minerals used in the manufacturing processes for certain products of our businesses. We have determined that certain of our subsidiaries’ products contain conflict minerals and we have developed a process to identify where such minerals originated. As of the date of our conflict minerals report for the 2013 calendar year, we were unable to determine whether or not such minerals originated in the DRC or its adjoining countries. We may continue to face difficulties in gathering this information in the future since the supply chain of certain of our businesses is complex, and we may not be able to ascertain the origins for these minerals or determine that these minerals are DRC conflict- free, which may harm the reputation of some of our businesses. Some of our businesses may also face difficulties in satisfying customers who may require that our products be certified as DRC conflict-free, which could harm relationships with such customers and lead to a loss of revenue. Our pool of suppliers from which some of our businesses source these minerals may be limited, and we may be unable to obtain conflict-free minerals at competitive prices, which could increase costs and adversely affect the manufacturing operations and profitability of certain of our businesses. Any one or a combination of these various factors could negatively impact our financial condition, business and results of operations. The Budget Control Act of 2011 (“BCA”) could impact the operating results and profit of our businesses. The U.S. government continues to focus on developing and implementing spending, tax, and other initiatives to stimulate the economy, create jobs, and reduce the deficit. One of these initiatives, the BCA, imposes greater constraints on government spending. In an attempt to balance decisions regarding defense, homeland security, and other federal spending priorities, the BCA immediately imposed spending caps that contained reductions to the Department of Defense (“DoD”) base budgets over a ten-year period ending in 2021.The Bipartisan Budget Act of 2013, enacted on December 26, 2013, reduced the impact of the “sequestration” during the government’s 2014 and 2015 fiscal years by increasing the spending caps for those years, in exchange for extending sequestration into fiscal years 2022 and 2023. Sequestration is currently scheduled to resume in the government’s 2016 fiscal year, however the proposed DoD budget for fiscal year 2016 exceeds its imposed spending caps. , A significant decline in overall U.S. government or DoD spending, a substantial reduction or elimination of particular defense-related programs or significant delays 75 in contract or task order awards resulting from a sequestration could have a material adverse effect on our businesses, result of operations and financial condition. Risks Related to Advanced Circuits Unless Advanced Circuits is able to respond to technological change at least as quickly as its competitors, its services could be rendered obsolete, which could materially adversely affect its financial condition, business and results of operations. The market for Advanced Circuits’ services is characterized by rapidly changing technology and continuing process development. The future success of its business will depend in large part upon its ability to maintain and enhance its technological capabilities, retain qualified engineering and technical personnel, develop and market services that meet evolving customer needs and successfully anticipate and respond to technological changes on a cost-effective and timely basis. Advanced Circuits’ core manufacturing capabilities are for 2 to 12 layer printed circuit boards. Trends towards miniaturization and increased performance of electronic products are dictating the use of printed circuit boards with increased layer counts. If this trend continues Advanced Circuits may not be able to effectively respond to the technological requirements of the changing market. If it determines that new technologies and equipment are required to remain competitive, the development, acquisition and implementation of these technologies may require significant capital investments. It may be unable to obtain capital for these purposes in the future, and investments in new technologies may not result in commercially viable technological processes. Any failure to anticipate and adapt to its customers’ changing technological needs and requirements or retain qualified engineering and technical personnel could materially adversely affect its financial condition, business and results of operations. Advanced Circuits’ customers operate in industries that experience rapid technological change resulting in short product life cycles and as a result, if the product life cycles of its customers slow materially, and research and development expenditures are reduced, its financial condition, business and results of operations will be materially adversely affected. Advanced Circuits’ customers compete in markets that are characterized by rapidly changing technology, evolving industry standards and continuous improvement in products and services. These conditions frequently result in short product life cycles. As professionals operating in research and development departments represent the majority of Advanced Circuits’ net sales, the rapid development of electronic products is a key driver of Advanced Circuits’ sales and operating performance. Any decline in the development and introduction of new electronic products could slow the demand for Advanced Circuits’ services and could have a material adverse effect on its financial condition, business and results of operations. Electronics manufacturing services corporations are increasingly acting as intermediaries, positioning themselves between PCB manufacturers and OEMS, which could reduce operating margins. Advanced Circuits’ OEM customers are increasingly outsourcing the assembly of equipment to third party manufacturers. These third party manufacturers typically assemble products for multiple customers and often purchase circuit boards from Advanced Circuits in larger quantities than OEM manufacturers. The ability of Advanced Circuits to sell products to these customers at margins comparable to historical averages is uncertain. Any material erosion in margins could have a material adverse effect on Advanced Circuits’ financial condition, business and results of operations. Risks Related to American Furniture Manufacturing Competition from larger furniture manufacturers may adversely affect American Furniture Manufacturing’s business and operating results. The residential upholstered furniture industry is highly competitive. Certain of American Furniture Manufacturing’s competitors are larger, have broader product lines and offer widely-advertised, well-known, branded products. If such larger competitors introduce additional products in the promotional segment of the upholstered furniture market, the segment in which American Furniture Manufacturing primarily participates, it may negatively impact American Furniture Manufacturing’s market share and financial performance. Risks Related to Arnold Changes in the cost and availability of certain rare earth minerals and magnets could materially harm Arnold’s business, financial condition and results of operations. Arnold manufactures precision magnetic assemblies and high-performance rare earth magnets including Samarium Cobalt magnets. Arnold is especially susceptible to changes in the price and availability of certain rare earth materials. The price of these materials 76 has fluctuated significantly in recent years and we believe price fluctuations are likely to occur in the future. Arnold’s need to maintain a continuing supply of rare earth materials makes it difficult to resist price increases and surcharges imposed by its suppliers. Arnold’s ability to pass increases in costs for such materials through to its customers by increasing the selling prices of its products is an important factor in Arnold’s business. We cannot guarantee that Arnold will be able to maintain an appropriate differential at all times. If costs for rare earth materials increase, and if Arnold is unable to pass along, or is delayed in passing along, those increases to its customers, Arnold will experience reduced profitability. Rare earth minerals and magnets are available from a limited number of suppliers, primarily in China. Political and civil instability and unexpected adverse changes in laws or regulatory requirements, including with respect to export duties, quotas or embargoes, may affect the market price and availability of rare earth materials, particularly from China. If a substantial interruption should occur in the supply of rare earth materials, Arnold may not be able to obtain other sources of supply in a timely fashion, at a reasonable price or as would be necessary to satisfy its requirements. Accordingly, a change in the supply of, or price for, rare earth minerals and magnets could materially harm Arnold’s business, financial condition and results of operations. Risks Related to Clean Earth If Clean Earth is unable to renew its operating permits or lease agreements with regulatory bodies, its business would be adversely affected. Clean Earth’s facilities operate using permits and licenses issued by various regulatory bodies at various local, state and federal government levels. Failure to renew its permits and licenses necessary to operate Clean Earth’s facilities on a timely basis or failure to renew or maintain compliance with its permits and site lease agreements on a timely basis could prevent or restrict its ability to provide certain services, resulting in a material adverse effect on its business. There can be no assurance that Clean Earth will continue to be successful in obtaining timely permit or license applications approval, maintaining compliance with its permits and lease agreements and obtaining timely lease renewals. Clean Earth operates fourteen facilities that accept, process and/or treat materials provided by its customers. These facilities may be inherently dangerous workplaces. If Clean Earth fails to maintain safe worksites, it may be subject to significant operating risks and hazards that could result in injury or death to persons, which could result in losses or liabilities to it. Clean Earth’s safety record is an important consideration for it and its customers. If serious accidents or fatalities occur or its safety record was to deteriorate, it may be ineligible to bid on certain work, and existing service arrangements could be terminated. Further, regulatory changes implemented by OSHA could impose additional costs on Clean Earth. Adverse experience with hazards and claims could have a negative effect on Clean Earth’s reputation with its existing or potential new customers and its prospects for future work. If Clean Earth fails to comply with applicable environmental laws and regulations its business could be adversely affected. The changing regulatory framework governing Clean Earth’s business creates significant risks. Clean Earth could be held liable if its operations cause contamination of air, groundwater or soil or expose its employees or the public to contamination. Under current law, Clean Earth may be held liable for damage caused by conditions that existed before it acquired the assets, business or operations involved. Also, it may be liable if it arranges for the transportation, disposal or treatment of hazardous substances that cause environmental contamination at facilities operated by others, or if a predecessor made such arrangements and Clean Earth is a successor. Liability for environmental damage could have a material adverse effect on Clean Earth’s financial condition, results of operations and cash flows. Stringent regulations of federal, state or provincial governments have a substantial impact on Clean Earth’s contaminated soil, dredge material and solid and hazardous waste treatment, storage, disposal and beneficial use activities. Local government controls may also apply. Many complex laws, rules, orders and regulatory interpretations govern environmental protection, health, safety, noise, visual impact, odor, land use, zoning, transportation and related matters. Clean Earth also may be subject to laws concerning the protection of certain marine and bird species, their habitats, and wetlands. It may incur substantial costs in order to conduct its operations in compliance with these environmental laws and regulations. Changes in environmental laws or regulations or changes in the enforcement or interpretation of existing laws, regulations or permitted activities may require Clean Earth to make significant capital or other expenditures, to modify existing operating licenses or permits, or obtain additional approvals or limit operations. (cid:2)ew environmental laws or regulations that raise compliance standards or require changes in operating practices or technology may impose significant costs and/or limit Clean Earth’s operations. Clean Earth’s revenue is primarily generated as a result of requirements imposed on our customers under federal, state, and provincial laws and regulations to protect public health and the environment. If requirements to comply with laws and regulations 77 governing management of contaminated soils, dredge dmMaterial, and hazardous wastes were relaxed or less vigorously enforced, demand for Clean Earth’s services could materially decrease and its revenues and earnings could be significantly reduced. Risks Related to SternoCandleLamp SternoCandleLamp products operate at high temperatures and use flammable fuels, each of which could subject our business to product liability claims. SternoCandleLamp products expose it to potential product liability claims typical of fuel based heating products. The fuels SternoCandleLamp uses in its products are flammable and may be toxic if ingested. Although SternoCandleLamp products have comprehensive labeling and it follows government and third party based standards and protocols, it can not guarantee there will not be accidents due to misuse or otherwise. Accidents involving SternoCandleLamp products may have an adverse effect on its reputation and reduce demand for its products. In addition, SternoCandleLamp may be held responsible for damages beyond its insurance coverage and there can be no guarantee that it will be able to produce adequate insurance coverage in the future. Risks Related to Tridien Certain of Tridien’s products are subject to regulation by the FDA. Certain of Tridien’s mattress products are Class II devices within Section 201(h) of the Federal FDCA (21 USC §321(h), and, as such, are subject to the requirements of the FFDCA and certain rules and regulations of the FDA. Prior to our acquisition of Tridien, one of its subsidiaries received a warning letter from the FDA in connection with certain deficiencies identified during a regular FDA audit, including noncompliance with certain design control requirements, certain of the good manufacturing practice regulations defined in 21 C.F.R. 820 and certain record keeping requirements. Tridien’s subsidiary has undertaken corrective measures to address the deficiencies and continues to fully cooperate with the FDA. Tridien is vulnerable to actions that may be taken by the FDA which have a material adverse effect on Tridien and/or its business. The FDA has the authority to inspect without notice, and to take any disciplinary action that it sees fit. A change in Medicare Reimbursement Guidelines may reduce demand for Tridien’s products. Certain changes in Medicare Reimbursement Guidelines may reduce demand for medical support surfaces and have a material effect on Tridien’s operating performance. A small number of customers account for a large amount of Tridien’s sales, and Tridien’s operations may be adversely effected if it loses certain of these customers. During the year ended December 31, 2014, three customers accounted for approximately 73% of Tridien's total sales. A decision by any of Tridien’s top customers to significantly decrease the volume of products purchased from it could substantially reduce Tridien’s revenues and may have a material adverse effect on its business, results of operations, financial condition and cash flows. In January 2015, Tridien was notified by one of their top customers, whose sales comprised approximately 20% of Tridien's total sales in 2014, that they will not renew its contract with Tridien, which expires on October 1, 2015. In the event that Tridien is not able to replace any lost revenues from this customer with revenues from another source, the loss in revenues from this customer could lower revenues and operating earnings. Tridien expects that a small number of customers will continue to account for a significant portion of its sales for the foreseeable future. Section 4191 of the Internal Revenue Code imposes a 2.3% excise tax on the sale of certain medical devices (“MDET”) by the manufacturer or importer of the device beginning January 1, 2013. The majority of Tridien’s customers either qualify for the retail exemption under the MDET or are considered the manufacturers of the product, with Tridien acting as the subcontractor, in which case Tridien’s customer is responsible for the MDET. If Tridien is unable to continue to pass the MDET on to its customers, such tax may have a material adverse effect on gross profit, operating income and cash flow. 78 ITEM 1B. U(cid:2)RESOLVED STAFF COMME(cid:2)TS (cid:2)O(cid:2)E ITEM 2. – PROPERTIES CamelBak CamelBak’s headquarters is located in Petaluma, California where they lease approximately 33,000 square feet of office space and an additional 1,000 square feet of storage space. CamelBak also leases manufacturing and warehouse facilities in San Diego, California (124,000 square feet) and Tijuana, Mexico (53,000 square feet), and office space in Mareveles, Phillipines (10,000 square feet). Ergobaby Ergobaby operates out of five offices. Its corporate headquarters is in Los Angeles, California where it leases 8,800 square feet. Ergobaby moved into new corporate headquarters in February 2015 in Los Angeles, California where it leases 16,500 square feet. Ergobaby’s European headquarters is located in Hamburg, Germany where it leases approximately 2,411 square feet and a sales office in Paris, France. Ergobaby also leases 2,426 square feet of office space in Pukalani, Hawaii. Orbit Baby leases 41,400 square feet of office, manufacturing and warehouse space in (cid:2)ewark, California. Liberty Safe Liberty Safe leases offices and warehouse facilities at two locations in Payson, Utah. The corporate headquarters and manufacturing facility are located in a 314,000 square foot building. Liberty leases an additional warehouse facility totaling approximately 11,000 square feet. Advanced Circuits Advanced Circuits operations are located in an 113,000 square foot building in Aurora, Colorado, a 30,000 square foot building in Tempe, Arizona, and a 50,000 square foot building in Maple Grove, Minnesota. These facilities are leased and comprise both the factory and office space. The lease terms are for approximately 15 years with a renewal option at the Aurora, Colorado location for an additional 10 years. American Furniture American Furniture operates primarily from a manufacturing and warehousing facility located in Ecru, MS, of which approximately 750,000 square feet was refurbished in 2008 as a result of damage caused by a fire in 2008. This 1.1 million square foot facility includes 350,000 square feet of manufacturing space, 750,000 square feet of warehouse space and 82 shipping docks. AFM also leases approximately 19,000 square feet of showroom space in High Point, (cid:2)orth Carolina, and Las Vegas, (cid:2)evada allowing it to showcase its products to buyers during trade shows held in those cities. 79 Arnold Arnold is headquartered in Rochester, (cid:2)ew York and has nine manufacturing facilities. The summary below outlines Arnold’s property locations. Arnold owns the Ogallala, (cid:2)ebraska location and the others are leased. Location Marengo, IL Marietta, OH Marietta, OH Marengo, IL (cid:2)orfolk, (cid:2)E Rochester, (cid:2)Y Ogallala, (cid:2)E Bingham Farms, MI Guangdong Province, Peoples Republic of China Sheffield, England Lupfig, Switzerland Hanau, Germany Crolles, France Clean Earth Sq. Ft. Use 94,220 Office/Warehouse 81,000 Office/Warehouse 22,646 Warehouse 55,200 Office/Warehouse 109,000 Office/Warehouse 73,000 Office/Warehouse 25,000 Office/Warehouse 675 Office 154,210 Office/Warehouse 25,000 Office/Warehouse 58,405 Office/Warehouse 1,092 Office 215 Office Clean Earth is headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania and has fourteen permitted facilities as well as several offices. The summary below outlines Clean Earth's property locations. Location (County, State) Operation Size Leased or Owned Montgomery, PA Corporate Headquarters Butler, PA (cid:2)assau, (cid:2)Y Middlesex, (cid:2)J Hudson, (cid:2)J Hudson, (cid:2)J Hudson, (cid:2)J Offices Waste Brokerage Fixed Base Remediation Dredging Services RCRA TSDF Philadelphia, PA Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption Bucks, PA Lycoming, PA (cid:2)ew Castle, DE Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption Drill Cuttings Stabilization Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption Prince Georges, MD Chemical Stabilization Washington, MD Chemical Stabilization Dredging Services and Beneficial Reuse ~ 20 acres Glades, FL Camden, GA Marshall, KY Monongalia, WV Allegheny, PA Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption Med. Temperature Thermal Desorption 2.92 acres RCRA TSDF RCRA TSDF - Aerosol Recycling Transportation facility ~ 25.2 acres ~ 1 acres ~ 3500 sq. ft. 80 16,669 sq. ft. 7500 sq. ft. 1,596 sq. ft. ~ 16 acres ~ 7 acres Leased Leased Leased Leased Leased ~ 14.5 acres Owned/ Leased 8.5 acres 7.8 acres ~ 2 acres 7.6 acres 42.49 acres 13.67 acres 11.29 acres Lease Owned Owned Leased Leased Owned Owned Owned Owned Owned Owned Leased SternoCandleLamp SternoCandleLamp owns a 103,000 square foot manufacturing and production facility in Memphis, Tennessee, and a 214,000 square foot manufacturing and production facility in Texarkana, Texas. The Company also leases 12,330 square feet of office space in Corona, California for its corporate headquarters. Tridien Tridien leases a 33,000 square foot facility in Coral Springs, Florida, which houses its manufacturing and distribution operations for the east coast and an 81,000 square foot facility in Corona, California, which houses the manufacturing and distribution facilities for the west coast. Tridien also leases a 105,000 square foot manufacturing facility and warehouse facility in Fishers, Indiana. Our corporate offices are located in Westport, Connecticut, where we lease approximately 1,500 square feet from our Manager. We believe that our properties and the terms of their leases at each of our businesses are sufficient to meet our present needs and we do not anticipate any difficulty in securing additional space, as needed, on acceptable terms. ITEM 3. – LEGAL PROCEEDI(cid:2)GS Tridien Our majority owned subsidiary, Tridien, through its subsidiary, AMF Support Services, Inc. ("AMF") is subject to a workers' compensation claim in the State of California, being adjudicated by the Riverside County Workers' Compensation Appeals Board. The claim is the result of an industrial accident that occurred on March 2, 2013, and the injuries sustained by a contract employee working at Tridien's Corona, California facility. The employee is seeking workers' compensation benefits from AMF, as the special employer, and the staffing company who employed the worker, as the general employer. The employee has also alleged that the employee's injuries are the result of the employer's "serious and willful misconduct", and has made a claim under California Labor Code § 4553 for damages. If proven, the "serious and willful" penalty is fixed by statute at either $0 or 50% of the value of all workers' compensation benefits paid as a result of the injury and is not insurable. The underlying workers' compensation claims are still being adjudicated. At this stage, it is not feasible to predict the outcome of or a range of loss, should a loss occur, from these proceedings. Accordingly, no amounts in respect of this matter have been provided in the Company's accompanying financial statements. We believe that we have meritorious defenses to the allegations and will continue to vigorously defend against the claims. In the normal course of business, we are involved in various claims and legal proceedings. While the ultimate resolution of these matters has yet to be determined, we do not believe that their outcome will have a material adverse effect on our financial position or results of operations. ITEM 4. – MI(cid:2)E SAFETY DISCLOSURES (cid:2)ot Applicable. 81 PART II Item 5. – Market for Registrants’ Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities Market Information Our Trust stock has traded on the (cid:2)ew York Stock Exchange (the “(cid:2)YSE”) under the symbol “CODI” since (cid:2)ovember 1, 2011. Previously, our stock was traded on the (cid:2)ASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “CODI.” The following table sets forth the high and low sales prices per share as reported (cid:2)YSE, and thereafter on the (cid:2)YSE. The highest and lowest sales prices per share of Trust stock were $14.81 and $19.64, respectively, for the periods presented below: Quarter Ended December 31, 2014 September 31, 2014 June 30, 2014 March 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 September 30, 2013 June 30, 2013 March 31, 2013 Common Stock Holders High Low Distribution Declared $ $ 18.45 18.21 17.86 18.23 19.64 18.94 17.99 16.21 $ 15.89 17.14 15.99 16.42 16.97 16.92 15.68 14.81 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 On December 31, 2014 there were 18 registered holders of our common stock. The number of registered holders includes banks and brokers who act as nominees, each of whom may represent more than one shareholder. COMPARATIVE PERFORMA(cid:2)CE OF SHARES OF TRUST STOCK The performance graph shown below compares the change in cumulative total shareholder return on shares of Trust stock with the (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index, the (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index, the (cid:2)YSE Composite Index and the (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index from May 16, 2006, when we completed our initial public offering, through the quarter ended December 31, 2014. The graph sets the beginning value of shares of Trust stock and the indices at $100, and assumes that all quarterly dividends were reinvested at the time of payment. This graph does not forecast future performance of shares of Trust stock. 82 Data Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index (cid:2)YSE Composite Index Data Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index (cid:2)YSE Composite Index Data Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index (cid:2)YSE Composite Index June 30, 2006 September 30, 2006 December 31, 2006 94.88 97.44 94.03 96.28 97.39 $ $ $ $ $ 102.73 101.31 104.02 102.56 100.98 $ $ $ $ $ 117.00 108.35 107.59 109.91 108.96 June 30, 2007 September 30, 2007 December 31, 2007 125.83 116.78 112.86 110.18 117.71 $ $ $ $ $ 115.41 121.19 107.18 106.81 119.69 $ $ $ $ $ 109.10 118.98 108.11 95.51 116.13 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ March 31, 2007 116.32 108.64 104.70 108.12 110.42 March 31, 2008 June 30, 2008 September 30, 2008 December 31, 2008 98.39 102.24 86.86 83.31 104.88 $ $ $ $ $ 87.54 102.86 85.52 71.39 103.25 $ $ $ $ $ 109.45 93.84 90.56 69.23 89.81 $ $ $ $ $ 90.41 70.75 57.91 44.28 68.64 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 83 Data Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index (cid:2)YSE Composite Index Data Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index (cid:2)YSE Composite Index Data Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index (cid:2)YSE Composite Index Data Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index (cid:2)YSE Composite Index Data Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index (cid:2)YSE Composite Index Data Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)ASDAQ Stock Market Index (cid:2)ASDAQ Other Finance Index (cid:2)YSE Financial Sector Index (cid:2)YSE Composite Index March 31, 2009 June 30, 2009 September 30, 2009 December 31, 2009 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 73.55 68.57 55.01 33.01 59.39 March 31, 2010 139.58 107.57 77.58 58.00 88.80 March 31, 2011 143.35 124.76 86.58 59.27 100.21 March 31, 2012 153.56 138.69 83.12 55.18 97.85 March 31, 2013 174.98 146.58 98.41 63.14 108.58 March 31, 2014 218.56 188.37 115.15 73.30 125.52 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 68.75 82.32 68.57 44.86 70.40 $ $ $ $ $ 91.64 95.21 74.63 56.70 82.39 $ $ $ $ $ 114.42 101.80 75.76 54.32 85.66 June 30, 2010 September 30, 2010 December 31, 2010 124.69 94.62 67.39 49.31 77.13 $ $ $ $ $ 152.90 106.26 70.23 53.76 86.81 $ $ $ $ $ 169.77 119.01 84.52 57.05 94.95 June 30, 2011 September 30, 2011 December 31, 2011 163.05 124.42 82.50 56.77 99.18 $ $ $ $ $ 122.22 108.36 66.10 43.78 80.97 $ $ $ $ $ 126.56 116.87 71.25 46.75 89.14 June 30, 2012 September 30, 2012 December 31, 2012 147.20 131.67 80.69 51.30 93.02 $ $ $ $ $ 158.36 139.80 83.59 54.71 98.37 $ $ $ $ $ 159.96 135.46 83.87 58.85 100.67 June 30, 2013 September 30, 2013 December 31, 2013 195.86 152.67 102.70 65.10 108.65 $ $ $ $ $ 201.45 169.19 106.62 68.66 114.71 $ $ $ $ $ 224.45 187.36 117.93 73.10 124.00 June 30, 2014 September 30, 2014 December 31, 2014 212.14 197.75 114.94 75.02 130.90 $ $ $ $ $ 206.95 201.58 113.84 74.39 127.60 $ $ $ $ $ 194.20 212.46 117.29 77.17 129.23 84 Distributions For the years 2014, 2013 and 2012, we have declared and paid quarterly cash distributions to holders of record as follows: Quarter Ended December 31, 2014 September 30, 2014 June 30, 2014 March 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 September 30, 2013 June 30, 2013 March 31, 2013 December 31, 2012 September 30, 2012 June 30, 2012 March 31, 2012 Declaration Date Payment Date Distribution Per Share January 8, 2015 October 7, 2014 July 10, 2014 April 10, 2014 January 9, 2014 October 10, 2013 July 10, 2013 April 9, 2013 January 10, 2013 October 9, 2012 July 10, 2012 April 10, 2012 January 29, 2015 October 30, 2014 July 30, 2014 April 30, 2014 January 30, 2014 October 30, 2013 July 30, 2013 April 30, 2013 January 31, 2013 October 31, 2012 July 31, 2012 April 30, 2012 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 0.36 We currently intend to continue to declare and pay regular quarterly cash distributions on all outstanding shares through fiscal 2015. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations—Liquidity and Capital Resources” in Part II, Item 7. ITEM 6. – SELECTED FI(cid:2)A(cid:2)CIAL DATA The following table sets forth selected historical and other data of the Company and should be read in conjunction with the more detailed consolidated financial statements included elsewhere in this report. Selected financial data below includes the results of operations, cash flow and balance sheet data of the Company for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, 2012, 2011, and 2010. We completed our IPO on May 16, 2006 and used the proceeds of the IPO and separate private placement transactions that closed in conjunction with our IPO, and from our Prior Credit Agreement, to purchase controlling interests in four of our initial operating subsidiaries. The following table details our acquisitions and dispositions subsequent to our IPO. Acquisitions: Advanced Circuits(1) Staffmark(1) Crosman(1) Silvue(1) Tridien Aeroglide HALO American Furniture FOX (2) Liberty Ergobaby CamelBak Arnold Magnetics Clean Earth SternoCandleLamp (1) Represent initial operating subsidiaries. 85 Acquisition Date May 16, 2006 May 16, 2006 May 16, 2006 May 16, 2006 August 1, 2006 February 28, 2007 February 28, 2007 August 31, 2007 January 4, 2008 March 31, 2010 September 16, 2010 August 24, 2011 March 5, 2012 August 26, 2014 October 10, 2014 Disposition Date n/a October 17, 2011 January 5, 2007 June 25, 2008 n/a June 24, 2008 May 1, 2012 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a (2) The Company sold 5,800,238 shares of FOX during FOX's initial public offering in August 2013, and an additional 4,466,569 shares during a FOX secondary offering in July 2014, resulting in the Company holding approximately 41% ownership interest in FOX at December 31, 2014. Effective July 11, 2014, the date that the Company's ownership interest in FOX fell below 50%, the Company began accounting for the investment in FOX as an equity method investment at fair value. FOX's results of operations and cash flows are included in the consolidated results of operations and cash flows of the Company from the date of acquisition through July 10, 2014, the date at which the Company began accounting for the investment in FOX using the equity method of accounting. The operating results for HALO are reflected as discontinued operations in 2012, 2011, and 2010 and are not included in the continuing operations data below. The operating results for Staffmark are reflected as discontinued operations in 2011 and 2010 and are not included in the continuing operations data below. Data included below only includes activity in our operating subsidiaries from their respective dates of acquisition. 86 Statements of Operations Data: (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Operating expenses: Selling, general and administrative Supplemental put expense (reversal) Management fees Amortization expense Impairment expense Operating income (loss) Gain on deconsolidation of subsidiary Gain on equity method investment Income (loss) from continuing operations Income (loss) and gain (loss) from discontinued operations (cid:2)et income (loss) Year ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 2011 2010 $ 982,300 $ 985,539 $ 884,721 $ 606,644 $ 504,659 688,631 293,669 679,708 305,831 605,867 278,854 427,500 179,144 366,297 138,362 161,141 110,031 181,683 — 22,722 33,606 — 167,738 (45,995) 18,632 29,632 12,918 15,995 17,633 30,268 — $ 55,658 $ 122,906 $ 53,817 $ 264,325 11,029 — — — — $ 291,155 $ 78,816 $ 5,753 11,783 16,283 22,072 81,585 32,516 14,576 17,023 38,835 27,769 (8,794) $ (46,173) — — — — $ (32,801) $ (66,324) — 291,155 — 78,816 (1,413) 4,340 105,613 72,812 21,554 (44,770) (cid:2)et income from continuing operations—noncontrolling interest 12,320 10,752 8,508 5,641 902 (cid:2)et income (loss) from discontinued operations— noncontrolling interest (cid:2)et income (loss) attributable to Holdings Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share attributable to Holdings: Continuing operations Discontinued operations Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share attributable to Holdings Cash Flow Data: Cash provided by operating activities Cash provided by (used in) investing activities Cash (used in) provided by financing activities — — $ 278,835 $ 68,064 $ (226) (3,942) $ 2,212 64,959 3,085 $ (48,757) $ $ $ $ $ $ 5.38 — 5.38 70,695 (424,753) 265,487 $ 1.05 — (0.06) $ (0.02) (0.81) $ 2.18 (1.64) 0.45 1.05 $ (0.08) $ 1.37 $ (1.19) 72,374 66,286 (44,122) $ 52,566 (84,426) (82,232) $ 91,374 (86,620) 114,080 $ 44,841 (182,392) 119,592 (cid:2)et increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents (89,526) 94,988 (114,129) 118,834 (17,959) Balance Sheet Data: Current assets Total assets Current liabilities Long-term debt Total liabilities (cid:2)oncontrolling interests 2014 2013 2012 2011 2010 December 31, $ 320,799 $ 399,133 $ 267,659 $ 360,221 $ 333,339 1,547,430 1,044,913 955,201 1,029,906 141,231 485,547 739,096 40,903 130,130 280,389 475,978 95,550 113,799 267,008 498,989 41,584 118,162 214,000 433,428 98,969 984,041 151,404 94,000 408,131 87,840 Shareholders’ equity attributable to Holdings 767,431 473,385 414,628 497,509 488,070 87 ITEM 7. – MA(cid:2)AGEME(cid:2)T’S DISCUSSIO(cid:2) A(cid:2)D A(cid:2)ALYSIS OF FI(cid:2)A(cid:2)CIAL CO(cid:2)DITIO(cid:2) A(cid:2)D RESULTS OF OPERATIO(cid:2)S This Item 7 contains forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements in this Annual Report on Form 10-K are subject to a number of risks and uncertainties, some of which are beyond our control. Our actual results, performance, prospects or opportunities could differ materially from those expressed in or implied by the forward-looking statements. Additional risks of which we are not currently aware or which we currently deem immaterial could also cause our actual results to differ, including those discussed in the sections entitled “Forward-Looking Statements” and “Risk Factors” included elsewhere in this Annual Report. Overview Compass Diversified Holdings, a Delaware statutory trust, was incorporated in Delaware on (cid:2)ovember 18, 2005. Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability Company, was also formed on (cid:2)ovember 18, 2005. In accordance with the Trust Agreement, the Trust is sole owner of 100% of the Trust Interests (as defined in the LLC Agreement) of the Company and, pursuant to the LLC Agreement, the Company has outstanding, the identical number of Trust Interests as the number of outstanding shares of the Trust. Sostratus LLC owns all of our Allocation Interests. The Company is the operating entity with a board of directors and other corporate governance responsibilities, similar to that of a Delaware corporation. The Trust and the Company were formed to acquire and manage a group of small and middle-market businesses headquartered in (cid:2)orth America. We characterize small and middle market businesses as those that generate annual cash flows of up to $60 million. We focus on companies of this size because we believe that these companies are more able to achieve growth rates above those of their relevant industries and are also frequently more susceptible to efforts to improve earnings and cash flow. In pursuing new acquisitions, we seek businesses with the following characteristics: stable and growing earnings and cash flow; • (cid:2)orth American base of operations; • • maintains a significant market share in defensible industry niche (i.e., has a “reason to exist”); • • • solid and proven management team with meaningful incentives; low technological and/or product obsolescence risk; and a diversified customer and supplier base. Our management team’s strategy for our subsidiaries involves: • • • • • utilizing structured incentive compensation programs tailored to each business in order to attract, recruit and retain talented managers to operate our businesses; regularly monitoring financial and operational performance, instilling consistent financial discipline, and supporting management in the development and implementation of information systems to effectively achieve these goals; assisting management in their analysis and pursuit of prudent organic cash flow growth strategies (both revenue and cost related); identifying and working with management to execute attractive external growth and acquisition opportunities; and forming strong subsidiary level boards of directors, including independent directors, to supplement management in their development and implementation of strategic goals and objectives. Based on the experience of our management team and its ability to identify and negotiate acquisitions, we believe we are well positioned to acquire additional attractive businesses. Our management team has a large network of approximately 2,000 deal intermediaries to whom it actively markets and who we expect to expose us to potential acquisitions. Through this network, as well as our management team’s active proprietary transaction sourcing efforts, we typically have a substantial pipeline of potential acquisition targets. In consummating transactions, our management team has, in the past, been able to successfully navigate complex situations surrounding acquisitions, including corporate spin-offs, transitions of family-owned businesses, management buy-outs and reorganizations. We believe the flexibility, creativity, experience and expertise of our management team in structuring transactions provides us with a strategic advantage by allowing us to consider non-traditional and complex transactions tailored to fit a specific acquisition target. In addition, because we intend to fund acquisitions through the utilization of our Revolving Credit Facility, we do not expect to be subject to delays in or conditions by closing acquisitions that would be typically associated with transaction specific financing, as is typically the case in such acquisitions. We believe this advantage is a powerful one and is highly unusual in the marketplace for acquisitions in which we operate. 88 Initial public offering and Company formation On May 16, 2006, we completed our initial public offering of 13,500,000 shares of the Trust at an offering price of $15.00 per share (the “IPO”). Subsequent to the IPO the Company’s board of directors engaged our Manager to externally manage the day- to-day operations and affairs of the Company, oversee the management and operations of the businesses and to perform those services customarily performed by executive officers of a public company. From May 16, 2006 through December 31, 2014, we purchased fifteen businesses (each of our businesses is treated as a separate operating segment) and disposed of five as follows: Acquisitions • On May 16, 2006, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in CBS Personnel Holdings for $55 million and later Staffmark Holdings, Inc., which we refer to as Staffmark, for approximately $129 million. • On May 16, 2006, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Crosman for approximately $73 million. • On May 16, 2006, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Advanced Circuits for approximately $81 million. As of December 31, 2014, we own approximately 69.4% of the common stock on a primary basis and 69.3% on a fully diluted basis. • On May 16, 2006, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Silvue for approximately $36 million. • On August 1, 2006, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Tridien for approximately $31 million. As of December 31, 2014, we own approximately 81.3% of the common stock on a primary basis and 65.4% on a fully diluted basis. • On February 28, 2007, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Aeroglide for approximately $58 million. • On February 28, 2007, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in HALO for approximately $62 million. • On August 31, 2007, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in American Furniture for approximately $97 million. As of December 31, 2014, we own approximately 99.9% of the common stock on a primary basis and 99.9% on a fully diluted basis. • On January 4, 2008, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in FOX for approximately $80.4 million. As of December 31, 2013, we own approximately 41% of the common stock. • On March 31, 2010, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Liberty Safe for approximately $70.2 million. As of December 31, 2014 we own approximately 96.2% on a primary basis and 84.8% on a fully diluted basis. • On September 16, 2010, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Ergobaby for approximately $85.2 million. As of December 31, 2014, we own approximately 81.0% on a primary basis and 74.3% on a fully diluted basis. • On August 24, 2011, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in CamelBak for approximately $211.6 million. As of December 31, 2014, we own approximately 89.9% on a primary basis and 79.7% on a fully diluted basis. • On March 5, 2012, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Arnold Magnetics for approximately $128.8 million. As of December 31, 2014, we own approximately 96.7% on a primary basis and 87.5% on a fully diluted basis. • On August 26, 2014, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Clean Earth for approximately $251.4 million. As of December 31, 2014, we own approximately 97.9% of the common stock on a primary basis and 86.2% on a fully diluted basis. • On October 10, 2014, we made loans to and purchased all of the outstanding shares of SternoCandleLamp for approximately $160.0 million. As of December 31, 2014, we own approximately 100.0% of the outstanding common stock on a primary basis, and 91.7 % on a fully diluted basis. Dispositions • On January 5, 2007, we sold all of our interest in Crosman, for approximately $143 million. We recorded a gain on the sale in the first quarter of 2007 of approximately $36 million. • On June 24, 2008, we sold all of our interest in Aeroglide, for approximately $95 million. We recorded a gain on the sale in the second quarter of 2008 of approximately $34 million. • On June 25, 2008, we sold all of our interest in Silvue, for approximately $95 million. We recorded a gain on the sale in the second quarter of 2008 of approximately $39 million. • On October 17, 2011, we sold our interest in Staffmark for approximately $217.2 million. We recorded a gain on the sale in the fourth quarter of 2011 of approximately $89 million. • On May 1, 2012, we sold our interest in HALO for approximately $66.0 million. We recorded a loss on the sale of $0.5 million in 2012. In addition, FOX completed an IPO of its common stock in August 2013 in which we sold a 22% interest in FOX receiving net proceeds totaling $80.9 million, and a secondary offering of its common stock in July 2014 in which we sold a 12% interest in FOX and received net proceeds of approximately $65.5 million. We now hold approximately 41% ownership interest in FOX. 89 We are dependent on the earnings of, and cash receipts from, the businesses that we own in order to meet our corporate overhead and management fee expenses and to pay distributions. These earnings and distributions, net of any non-controlling interest in these businesses, are available to: • meet capital expenditure requirements, management fees and corporate overhead charges; • • fund distributions from the businesses to the Company; and be distributed by the Trust to shareholders. 2014 Highlights Acquisitions Clean Earth On August 26, 2014, we purchased a 97.9% controlling interest (86.2% on a fully diluted basis) in Clean Earth. Founded in 1990 and headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, Clean Earth is a provider of environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials. Clean Earth provides a one-stop shop solution that analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste streams generated in multiple end-markets such as power, construction, commercial development, oil & gas, infrastructure, industrial and dredging. Approximately 98% of the material processed by Clean Earth is beneficially reused for such purposes as daily landfill cover, industrial and brownfield redevelopment projects. The purchase price, including proceeds from non-controlling interests, was approximately $251.4 million and was based on a total enterprise value of $243 million and included approximately $10.3 million in cash and working capital adjustments. We funded the acquisition through available cash on hand and a draw of $95 million on our Revolving Credit Facility. Clean Earth’s management invested in the transaction alongside us, collectively representing approximately 2.1% in initial non-controlling interest on a primary basis. CGM acted as an advisor to us in the acquisition and will continue to provide integration services during the first year of our ownership of Clean Earth. CGM will receive integration service fees of approximately $2.5 million which will be payable quarterly as services are rendered beginning on October 1, 2014. CGM received $0.6 million in integration service fees during the three months ended December 31, 2014. SternoCandleLamp On October 10, 2014, we purchased all of the issued and outstanding equity of SternoCandleLamp. Headquartered in Corona, California, SternoCandleLamp is the leading manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative table lighting solutions for the foodservice industry. SternoCandleLamp’s product line includes wick and gel chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories, liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps. The purchase price was approximately $160.0 million based on a total enterprise value of $161.5 million, and included approximately $1.3 million in working capital adjustments. We funded the acquisition through available cash on hand and a drawing of approximately $166 million on our Revolving Credit Facility. CGM acted as an advisor to us in the acquisition and will continue to provide integration services during the first year of our ownership of SternoCandleLamp. CGM will receive integration service fees of approximately $1.5 million which will be payable quarterly as services are rendered beginning on (cid:2)ovember 1, 2014. CGM received $0.4 million in integration service fees during the three months ended December 31, 2014. Debt Refinancing On June 6, 2014, we obtained a $725 million credit facility led by Bank of America, (cid:2).A., as Administrative Agent for a group of lenders. The 2014 Credit Facility provides for (i) revolving loans, swing line loans and letters of credit up to a maximum aggregate amount of $400 million, and (ii) a $325 million term loan. The 2014 Term Loan was issued at an original issuance discount of 99.5% of par value. The 2014 Term Loan requires quarterly payments of $812,500 commencing September 30, 2014 with a final payment of all remaining principal and interest due on June 6, 2021, which is the 2014 Term Loan maturity date. All amounts outstanding under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility will become due on June 6, 2019, which is the maturity date of loans advanced under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility and the termination date of the revolving loan commitment. The 2014 Credit Facility also permits us, prior to the applicable maturity date, to increase the revolving loan commitment and/or obtain additional term loans in an aggregate amount of up to $200 million subject to certain restrictions and conditions. We used approximately $290.0 million of the 2014 Term Loan proceeds to pay all amounts outstanding under the 2011 Credit Facility and to pay the closing costs. In addition, at closing, approximately $1.2 million of the revolving loan commitment was utilized in connection with the issuance of letters of credit. 90 Future advances under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility will be used to finance working capital, capital expenditures and other general corporate purposes (including funding acquisitions of additional businesses, permitted distributions and loans to our businesses and, in the case of any incremental loans that are term loans, to repay amounts outstanding under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. Public Share Offering On (cid:2)ovember 11, 2014, we completed a public offering of 6,000,000 Trust shares at an offering price of $17.50 per share. We received net proceeds of approximately $99.9 million after deducting the underwriters' discount and offering costs. We used the proceeds from the offering to paydown our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. Sale of FOX common stock On July 10, 2014, 5,750,000 shares of FOX common stock, held by certain FOX shareholders, including us, were sold in a secondary offering at a price of $15.50 per share for total net proceeds to selling shareholders of approximately $84.4 million. As a selling shareholder we sold a total of 4,466,569 shares of FOX common stock, including 633,955 shares sold in connection with underwriters’ exercise of the over-allotment option in full, for total net proceeds of approximately $65.5 million. Upon completion of the offering, our ownership in FOX was reduced from approximately 53% to 41%, or 15,108,718 shares of FOX’s common stock. As a result of the FOX Secondary Offering, we deconsolidated FOX as of July 10, 2014 which is consistent with our intention to streamline our consolidated financial reporting. In connection with the FOX deconsolidation, we recorded a gain of $264.3 million in the quarter ended September 30, 2014. 2014 Distributions For the 2014 fiscal year we declared distributions to our shareholders totaling $1.44 per share. Areas of focus in 2015 The areas of focus for 2015, which are generally applicable to each of our businesses, include: • Achieving sales growth through a combination of new product development, increasing distribution and international expansion; • Taking market share, where possible, in each of our niche market leading companies, generally at the expense of less well capitalized competitors; Striving for excellence in supply chain management, manufacturing and technological capabilities; • • Continuing to pursue expense reduction and cost savings in lower margin business lines or in response to lower production volume; • Continuing to grow through disciplined, strategic acquisitions and rigorous integration processes; and • Driving free cash flow through increased net income and effective working capital management, enabling continued investment in our businesses, strategic acquisitions, and distributions to our shareholders. Middle market deal flow in the year ended December 31, 2014 increased relative to 2013, both in terms of quantity and quality, in part due to attractive valuations for sellers. High valuation levels continue to be driven by the availability of debt capital with favorable terms and financial and strategic buyers seeking to deploy available equity capital. Results of Operations We were formed on (cid:2)ovember 18, 2005 and acquired our existing businesses (segments) as follows: May 16, 2006 Advanced Circuits August 1, 2006 Tridien August 31, 2007 American Furniture March 31, 2010 Liberty Safe September 16, 2010 Ergobaby August 24, 2011 CamelBak March 5, 2012 Arnold August 26, 2014 Clean Earth October 10, 2014 SternoCandleLamp 91 Fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012 each represent a full year of operating results included in our consolidated results of operations for six of our businesses. We acquired Arnold in March 2012, and Clean Earth and SternoCandleLamp in August 2014 and October 2014, respectively. Additionally, on July 10, 2014, our ownership interest in FOX decreased to approximately 41% and as a result, beginning July 10, 2014, FOX no longer met the requirements for inclusion in our consolidated results of operations. In the following results of operations, we provide (i) our actual Consolidated Results of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, which includes the historical results of operations of each of our businesses (operating segments) from the date of acquisition and (ii) comparative historical results of operations for each of our businesses on a stand-alone basis (“Results of Operations – Our Businesses”), for each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, where all years presented include relevant pro-forma adjustments for pre-acquisition periods and explanations where applicable. Consolidated Results of Operations — Compass Diversified Holdings (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expense Management fees Amortization of intangibles Operating income (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expense Management fees Supplemental put reversal (1) Amortization of intangibles Impairment expense Operating income Year Ended December 31, 2014 Consolidated Results of Operations Less: FOX (191 days) Consolidated Results less FOX $ $ 982,300 688,631 293,669 181,683 22,722 33,606 55,658 $ $ 149,995 103,701 46,294 25,780 — 3,220 17,294 $ $ 832,305 584,930 247,375 155,903 22,722 30,386 38,364 Year Ended December 31, 2013 Consolidated Results of Operations Less: FOX Consolidated Results less FOX $ 985,539 $ 272,746 $ 679,708 305,831 167,738 18,632 (45,995) 29,632 12,918 192,617 80,129 35,662 308 — 5,378 — $ 122,906 $ 38,781 $ 712,793 487,091 225,702 132,076 18,324 (45,995) 24,254 12,918 84,125 (1) Refer to – “Liquidity and Capital Resources – Termination of Supplemental Put Agreement” for more detail surrounding this transaction. 92 (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expense Management fees Supplemental put expense Amortization of intangibles Operating income Year Ended December 31, 2012 Consolidated Results of Operations Less: FOX Consolidated Results less FOX $ $ 884,721 $ 235,869 $ 605,867 278,854 161,141 17,633 15,995 30,268 173,040 62,829 30,862 500 — 5,315 53,817 $ 26,152 $ 648,852 432,827 216,025 130,279 17,133 15,995 24,953 27,665 Year Ended December 31, 2014 compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales On a consolidated basis, net of FOX, net sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased $119.5 million or 16.8% as compared to the year ended December 31, 2013. Refer to “Results of Operations – Our Businesses” for a more detailed analysis of net sales by business segment. We do not generate any revenues apart from those generated by the businesses we own. We may generate interest income on the investment of available funds, but expect such earnings to be minimal. Our investment in our businesses is typically in the form of loans from the Company to such businesses, as well as equity interests in those businesses. Cash flows coming to the Trust and the Company are the result of interest payments on those loans, amortization of those loans and, in some cases, dividends on our equity ownership. However, on a consolidated basis these items will be eliminated. Cost of sales On a consolidated basis, net of FOX, cost of sales increased approximately $97.8 million during the year ended December 31, 2014 as compared to the same period in 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of sales was approximately 29.7% in the year ended December 31, 2014, compared to 31.7% in 2013. This decrease in gross profit as a percentage of sales in the year ended December 31, 2014 is due principally to a decrease in gross margins at Liberty Safe resulting from discounted sales and production volume variances due to the reduction in sales, as well as the mix of sales at our subsidiaries during 2014 as compared to 2013. Refer to "Results of Operations - Our Businesses" for a more detailed analysis of cost of sales by business segment. Selling, general and administrative expense On a consolidated basis, net of FOX, selling, general and administrative expense increased $23.8 million during the year ended December 31, 2014, as compared to the corresponding period in 2013. The increase in expenses was due to our acquisition of Clean Earth in August 2014 ($12.4 million in selling, general and administrative expenses from date of acquisition through year- end) and SternoCandleLamp in October 2014 ($6.3 million in selling, general and administrative expenses from the date of acquisition through year-end), as well as an increase of $5.3 million in selling, general and administrative expenses at Ergobaby during 2014 as compared to the corresponding period in 2013 related to costs associated with new product promotion and support. These 2014 increases were offset in part by a decrease in costs at Liberty Safe during 2014 as compared to 2013. At the corporate level, general and administrative expense was $11.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014 and $10.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $0.3 million. Refer to “Results of Operations – Our Businesses”, for a more detailed analysis of selling, general and administrative expense by segment. 93 Management fees Pursuant to the Management Services Agreement, we pay CGM a quarterly management fee equal to 0.5% (2.0% annually) of our consolidated adjusted net assets. We accrue for the management fee on a quarterly basis. The management fee in 2014 as compared to 2013 increased $4.4 million, primarily as a result of the acquisition of Clean Earth in August 2014 and SternoCandleLamp in October 2014. Refer to —“Related Party Transactions and Certain Transactions Involving our Businesses” for more information about the MSA. Supplemental put reversal On July 1, 2013, we terminated the Supplemental Put Agreement with our Manager. As a result of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, we derecognized the supplemental put liability associated with the Manager’s put right, reversing the entire $61.3 million liability at July 1, 2013 through supplemental put expense on the consolidated statement of operations during the year ended December 31, 2013. Impairment expense During fiscal 2013, one of Tridien’s largest customers lost a large contract program that was being serviced substantially with Tridien product. The expected lost sales and net income were significant enough to trigger an interim goodwill and indefinite- lived asset impairment analysis during the second quarter of 2013, and additional declines in revenue led to impairment testing at Tridien during the fourth quarter of 2013. The interim impairment testing during 2013 resulted in impairment of the Tridien long-lived intangible assets and goodwill of $12.9 million during 2013. Year Ended December 31, 2013 compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2012 (cid:2)et sales On a consolidated basis, net of FOX, net sales increased by approximately $63.9 million or 9.9% for the year ended December 31, 2013 when compared to 2012. Meaningful sales increases at American Furniture ($13.4 million) and Liberty ($34.9 million) together with incremental 2013 sales at Arnold, our 2012 acquisition ($20.3 million), were offset in part by a decrease in sales at CamelBak ($17.7 million). The increase in sales at our three other businesses account for the remaining increase in sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012. Refer to “Results of Operations – Our Businesses” for a more detailed analysis of net sales by business segment. Cost of sales On a consolidated basis, net of FOX, cost of sales increased approximately $54.3 million during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the corresponding period in 2012. This increase is due almost entirely to the corresponding increase in net sales referred to above. Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased approximately 160 basis points in the twelve months ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 which is principally the result of the decrease in CamelBak’s sales in 2013, which carry a higher margin than each of those businesses which showed meaningful sales increases in 2013. Selling, general and administrative expense On a consolidated basis, net of FOX, selling, general and administrative expense increased approximately $1.8 million during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the corresponding period in 2012. This increase is principally due to increased costs at Liberty, the business which experienced the most significant top line sales growth during the twelve months ended December 31, 2013 compared to 2012. Refer to “Results of Operations – Our Businesses” for a more detailed analysis of selling, general and administrative expense by business segment. At the corporate level, general and administrative expense increased $1.2 million during year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 principally as a result of increases in legal and professional fees ($0.8 million) and unsuccessful acquisition transaction costs ($0.4 million). 94 Management fees Pursuant to the Management Services Agreement, we pay CGM a quarterly management fee equal to 0.5% (2.0% annually) of our consolidated adjusted net assets. We accrue for the management fee on a quarterly basis. For the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, net of FOX, we incurred approximately $18.3 million and $17.1 million, respectively, in expense for these fees. The increase in management fees for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 is principally due to proceeds from the FOX IPO. Refer to—“Related Party Transactions and Certain Transactions Involving our Businesses” for more information about the MSA. Supplemental put expense On July 1, 2013, we terminated the Supplemental Put Agreement with our Manager. As a result of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, we derecognized the supplemental put liability associated with the Manager’s put right, reversing the entire $61.3 million liability at July 1, 2013 through supplemental put expense on the consolidated statement of operations during the year ended December 31, 2013. Impairment expense During the second fiscal quarter of 2013, one of Tridien’s largest customers lost a large contract program that was being serviced substantially with Tridien product. The expected lost sales and net income were significant enough to trigger an interim goodwill and indefinite-lived asset impairment analysis. The result of these analyses supported the carrying value of goodwill but indicated that sales of product, reliant on trade names, could not fully support the carrying value of Tridien’s trade names. As such we wrote down the value of the trade names by $0.9 million to a carrying value of approximately $0.6 million at that time. At December 31, 2013, further revenue decreases together with a revised 2014 forecast that indicated little to no growth prompted an additional interim impairment analysis as of December 31, 2013. The result of the year end goodwill impairment analysis (step 1) indicated that goodwill was impaired. Further testing (step 2) resulted in the following; (i) goodwill was written down $11.5 million to a balance of $16.8 million; (ii) trade names were written down $0.4 million to a balance of $0.2 million and; (iii) technology assets were written down $0.1 million to a balance of $0.8 million. Results of Operations — Our Businesses As previously discussed, we acquired our businesses on various acquisition dates beginning May 16, 2006. As a result, our consolidated operating results only include the results of operations since the acquisition date associated with each of our businesses in accordance with Generally Accepted Accounting Principles. The following discussion reflects a comparison of the historical results of operations for each of our businesses (segments) for the complete fiscal years ending December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. For the 2014 acquisitions, the following discussion reflects comparative pro forma results of operations for the entire fiscal years ending December 31, 2014 and 2013 as if we had acquired the businesses on January 1, 2013. For the 2012 acquisition, the following discussions reflects pro forma results of operations for the entire fiscal year ending December 31, 2012 as if we had acquired the business January 1, 2012. Where appropriate, relevant pro forma adjustments are reflected as part of the historical operating results. Adjustments to depreciation and amortization resulting from purchase allocation step ups that are not “pushed down” to a business are not included as a component of operating results. We believe this presentation enhances the discussion and provides a more meaningful comparison of operating results. The following operating results of our businesses are not necessarily indicative of the results to be expected for a full year, going forward. We categorize the businesses we own into two separate groups of businesses (i) branded consumer businesses and, (ii) niche industrial businesses. Branded consumer businesses are characterized as those businesses that we believe capitalize on a valuable brand name in their respective market sector. We believe that our branded consumer businesses are leaders in their particular category. (cid:2)iche industrial businesses are characterized as those businesses that focus on manufacturing and selling particular products or services within a specific market sector. We believe that our niche industrial businesses are leaders in their specific market sector. 95 CamelBak Overview Branded Consumer Businesses CamelBak, headquartered in Petaluma, California, is a premier designer and manufacturer of personal hydration products for outdoor, recreation and military applications. CamelBak offers a broad range of recreational and military personal hydration packs, reusable water bottles, specialty military gloves and performance accessories. As the leading supplier of hydration products to specialty outdoor, cycling and military retailers, CamelBak maintains the leading market share position in recreational markets for hands-free hydration packs and the leading market share position for reusable water bottles in specialty channels. CamelBak is also the dominant supplier of hydration packs to the military, with a leading market share in post-issue hydration packs. Over its more than 25-year history, CamelBak has developed a reputation as the preferred supplier for the hydration needs of the most demanding athletes and warfighters. Across its markets, CamelBak is respected for its innovation, leadership and authenticity. We purchased a controlling interest in CamelBak on August 24, 2011. Results of Operations The table below summarizes the results of operations for CamelBak for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses Management fees Amortization of intangibles Income from operations Year ended December 31, 2014 148,675 86,003 62,672 35,547 500 8,712 17,913 $ $ 2013 139,943 78,588 61,355 33,958 500 8,978 17,919 $ $ 2012 157,632 85,424 72,208 36,829 500 9,378 25,501 $ $ Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $148.7 million, an increase of $8.7 million, or 6.2%, compared to the same period in 2013. The increase in net sales is a result of increased gross sales in Bottles ($16.0 million), and Gloves ($1.2 million), offset in part by a decrease in sales in Hydration systems ($7.0 million) and Accessories ($1.7 million). The increase in Bottle sales during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 is primarily attributable to an increase in both domestic and international bottle sales including, eddyTM, the Podium line of insulated bottles, Chute, an ergonomic high-flow water bottle, the introduction of the filtered pitcher, Relay, and the continued expansion in its customer base, including new and existing customers, for all product lines. The increase in Glove sales during the same period is the result of timing of government orders which are sporadic in nature. The decrease in sales of Hydration systems during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 2013 is primarily attributable to the United States Marine Corps ("Marine Corps") contract sales in the 2013 period ($6.5 million) and the timing of shipments for certain pack models. There were no Marine Corps contract sales in 2014. The decrease in sales of Accessories during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 2013 is primarily attributable to a large order in 2013 that did not occur in 2014. Sales of Hydration systems and Bottles represented approximately 87% of gross sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 86% for the same period in 2013. Military sales were approximately 21% of gross sales for the year ended December 31, 2014, down from 29% for the same period in 2013. International sales were approximately 25% and 22% of gross sales, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013. The decrease in military sales is attributable to the absence of Marine Corps contract sales and a decrease in other military sales during the year ended December 31, 2014, due to decreased demand as a result of the drawdown of U.S. combat troops. 96 Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $86.0 million compared to approximately $78.6 million in the same period of 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased to 42.2% during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 43.8% in the same period in 2013. The decrease is attributable to an unfavorable sales mix in Bottles and Hydration Systems and a decrease in obsolescence reserve in the first quarter of 2013, offset in part by an increase in gross margin attributable to Glove sales as a result of non-recurring discounted Glove sales in the first quarter of 2013. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased to approximately $35.5 million or 23.9% of net sales from $34.0 million or 24.3% of net sales for the same period of 2013. The slight increase is attributable to increases in marketing costs to support new product launches in 2014 and severance costs that occurred in the first half of 2014, in connection with closing an international sales office. Income from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2014 was approximately $17.9 million, which was flat when compared to the same period in 2013. Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2012 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 were approximately $139.9 million, a decrease of $17.7 million, or 11.2%, compared to the same period in 2012. The decrease in gross sales is a result of decreased sales in Hydration Systems ($17.2 million) and Gloves ($5.5 million), offset in part by an increase in Bottle sales ($4.6 million) and Accessories ($0.2 million). The increase in Bottle sales during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 is attributable to the expansion of offerings in Bottles, such as eddy™, Chute and the re-design Podium line of insulated bottles, and the continued expansion in its customer base, including new and existing customers. The decrease in sales in Hydration Systems in the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period of 2012 is primarily due to substantial sales to the Marine Corps as part of their pack program during the year ended December 31, 2012. The Marine Corps contract was substantially fulfilled in the first quarter of 2013. Sales attributable to the Marine Corps contract were $13.2 million higher in 2012 than they were in 2013. To a lesser extent, cooler weather patterns during the second quarter of 2013, we believe, may have had a negative impact on sales to recreational Hydration System customers during that period that were not replaced by sales in subsequent quarters. The decrease in Glove sales in the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 is principally due to continuing decreased demand from the U.S. military as a result of the drawdown of U.S. combat troops in 2013. Sales of Hydration Systems and Bottles represented approximately 86% of gross sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 84% for the same period in 2012. Military sales were approximately 29% of gross sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 38% for the same period in 2012. International sales were approximately 22% of gross sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 19% for the same period in 2012. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 were approximately $78.6 million compared to approximately $85.4 million in the same period of 2012. The decrease of $6.8 million is due principally to the corresponding decrease in net sales. Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased to 43.8% for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 45.8% in the comparable period ended December 31, 2012. The decrease is attributable to: (i) an unfavorable sales mix in Hydration Systems and Accessories offset in part by a favorable sales mix in Bottle sales during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012, and (ii) discounted Glove sales in 2013. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2013 decreased $2.9 million to approximately $34.0 million or 24.3% of net sales compared to $36.8 million or 23.4% of net sales for the same period of 2012 due primarily to a decrease in incentive compensation expense and sales commissions. 97 Income from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2013 was approximately $17.9 million, a decrease of $7.6 million when compared to the same period in 2012, based primarily on the decrease in net sales and other factors described above. Ergobaby Overview Ergobaby, headquartered in Los Angeles, California, is a premier designer, marketer and distributor of wearable baby carriers and related baby wearing products, as well as stroller travel systems and accessories. Ergobaby offers a broad range of wearable baby carriers, stroller travel systems and related products that are sold through more than 450 retailers and web shops in the United States and throughout the world. Ergobaby has two main product lines: baby carriers (baby carriers and accessories) and infant travel systems (strollers and accessories). On September 16, 2010, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Ergobaby for approximately $85.2 million, representing approximately 84% of the equity in Ergobaby. Ergobaby’s reputation for product innovation, reliability and safety has led to numerous awards and accolades from consumer surveys and publications, including Parenting Magazine, Pregnancy Magazine and Wired Magazine. On (cid:2)ovember 18, 2011, Ergobaby acquired all the outstanding stock of Orbit Baby for $17.5 million. Orbit Baby produces and markets a premium line of stroller travel systems. Orbit Baby’s high-quality products include car seats, strollers and bassinets that are interchangeable using a patented hub ring. Results of Operations The table below summarizes the results of operations for Ergobaby for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses Management fees Amortization of intangibles Income from operations Year ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 $ $ 82,255 29,740 52,515 30,891 500 2,977 18,147 $ $ 67,340 25,692 41,648 25,560 500 2,972 12,616 $ $ 64,032 25,091 38,941 24,476 500 3,037 10,928 Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were $82.3 million, an increase of $14.9 million or 22.1% compared to the same period in 2013. During the year ended December 31, 2014 international sales were approximately $46.7 million, representing an increase of $6.4 million over the corresponding period in 2013. International baby carrier and accessory sales increased by approximately $5.4 million and international infant travel systems sales increased by approximately $1.0 million. The growth in international baby carrier sales was due to shipments of the new Ergobaby 360 4-position carrier as well as increased shipments of Ergobaby’s Bundle of Joy (baby carrier plus infant insert). Domestic sales were $35.6 million in the 2014 reflecting an increase of $8.5 million over the corresponding period in 2013. The increase in domestic sales in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 2013 is attributable to increased sales of both baby carriers and accessories ($5.9 million) to national and specialty retail accounts and infant travel systems and accessories ($2.7 million) to national retail accounts and online. The increase in baby carrier sales is partially attributable to the launch of Ergobaby’s 360 4-position carrier. Ergobaby also released the new Orbit Baby G3 infant travel system, which includes stroller bases, various seats and accessories, into the domestic market during the first quarter of 2014. The G3 release accounts for the remainder of the increase in net sales. The G3 infant travel system became available to the international market in the third quarter of 2014. 98 Baby carriers and accessories represented 83.0% of sales in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 84.7% in the same period in 2013. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $29.7 million compared to $25.7 million in the same period of 2013. The increase of $4.0 million is principally due to the increase in sales in 2014 compared to the same period in 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of sales was 63.8% in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 61.8% for the same period in 2013. The 200 basis points increase is primarily attributable to a higher percentage of domestic sales and to increased gross profit margins attributable to domestic infant travel systems sales resulting from improved gross profit margins for the new Orbit Baby G3 product line and to improved gross margins for domestic baby carrier sales. Gross margins for the year ended December 31, 2013 were negatively impacted by discounts given to customers as the Company transitioned to its new logo. Selling, general and administrative expenses Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased to approximately $30.9 million million or 37.6% of net sales compared to $25.6 million or 38.0% of net sales for the same period of 2013. The $5.3 million increase in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 is primarily attributable to increases in marketing expenses ($1.9 million) in support of new product launches and consumer engagement activities, and increases in employee related costs due to increased headcount to support business growth ($1.9 million). The increase was also attributable to increases in variable expenses, due to higher sales, as well as to unfavorable foreign exchange rates and lease accounting adjustments. Income from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased $5.5 million to $18.1 million, compared to $12.6 million the same period of 2013, based on the factors described above. Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2012 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 were $67.3 million, an increase of $3.3 million or 5.2% compared to the same period in 2012. During the year ended December 31, 2013 domestic sales were approximately $27.0 million, representing an increase of $0.4 million or 1.6% over the corresponding period in 2012. Domestic baby carrier and accessory sales increased by approximately $1.4 million, and domestic stroller and accessory sales decreased by approximately $1.0 million. The increase in baby carrier sales are primarily due to expanded domestic distribution to national retail (“Chain”) channels and discounted sales of old logo baby carrier product and accessory product during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 2012. The decrease in stroller sales is principally tied to reduced orders in 2013 in anticipation of the new G3 stroller launched in January 2014. International sales were approximately $40.3 million in the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to approximately $37.4 million in the same period in 2012, an increase of $2.9 million or 7.7%. International baby carrier and accessory sales increased by approximately $4.9 million and stroller sales decreased by approximately $2.0 million. The increase in international baby carrier and accessory sales during 2013 are due to expanded distribution channels. International stroller sales were negatively impacted in the year ended December 31, 2013 due to reductions in shipments to international distributers in anticipation of Orbit Baby’s 2014 product launch. Baby carriers and accessories represented 85% and 79% of net sales in the year ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 were approximately $25.7 million compared to $25.1 million in the same period of 2012. The increase of $0.6 million is due principally to the increase in sales in the same period. Gross profit as a percentage of sales increased from 60.8% for the year ended December 31, 2012 to 61.8% in 2013. The cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2012 includes approximately $0.6 million of amortization expense related to an inventory fair value step-up as part of the Orbit Baby purchase price allocation. Excluding the inventory step-up amortization expense reflected in 2012, gross profit as a percentage of sales was 61.8% in the 2012 period. Increases in gross profit as a percentage of sales in 2013 due to a greater proportion of baby carrier sales to total sales during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 2012 was offset by discounts provided to domestic baby carrier and accessory customers as Ergobaby transitioned to a new logo for its baby carrier products in 2013. Baby carrier sales carry a higher gross profit margin than stroller sales. 99 Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2013 increased to approximately $25.6 million or 38.0% of net sales compared to $24.5 million or 38.2% of net sales for the same period of 2012. The $1.1 million increase is almost entirely attributable to increases in employee related costs due to increased headcount to support business growth. Income from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2013 increased approximately $1.7 million to $12.6 million compared to the same period in 2012 due principally to increased net sales offset in part by the increases in selling, general and administrative expenses and other factors as described above. Liberty Safe Overview Based in Payson, Utah and founded in 1988, Liberty Safe is the premier designer, manufacturer and marketer of home and gun safes in (cid:2)orth America. From its over 314,000 square foot manufacturing facility, Liberty Safe produces a wide range of home and gun safe models in a broad assortment of sizes, features and styles ranging from an entry level product to good, better and best products. Products are marketed under the Liberty brand, as well as a portfolio of licensed and private label brands, including Remington, Cabela’s and John Deere. Liberty Safe’s products are the market share leader and are sold through an independent dealer network (“Dealer sales”) in addition to various sporting goods, farm and fleet and home improvement retail outlets (“(cid:2)on- Dealer, “(cid:2)ational” sales”). Liberty has the largest independent dealer network in the industry.We acquired Liberty Safe on March 31, 2010. Historically, approximately 60% of Liberty Safe’s net sales are (cid:2)on-Dealer sales and 40% are Dealer sales. We acquired Liberty Safe on March 31, 2010. Results of Operations The table below summarizes the results of operations for Liberty Safe for the full fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, and 2013 and 2012. (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses Management fees Amortization of intangibles Income (loss) from operations Year ended December 31, 2014 $ 90,149 76,889 13,260 11,591 500 3,886 (2,717) $ 2013 126,541 95,866 30,675 13,623 500 4,094 12,458 $ $ 2012 91,622 68,050 23,572 12,103 500 4,984 5,985 $ $ Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 decreased approximately $36.4 million or 28.8% compared to the corresponding period ended December 31, 2013. (cid:2)on-Dealer sales were approximately $50.4 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to $75.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 representing a decrease of $24.8 million or 33.0%. Dealer sales totaled approximately $39.7 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to $51.4 million in the same period in 2013, representing a decrease of $11.7 million or 22.8%. The decrease in (cid:2)on-Dealer sales in the year ended December 31, 2014 is due to (i) lower sales to one large customer that over ordered in 2013 and as a result had excess inventory during 2014 and (ii) a reduction in sales to the majority of Liberty’s larger customers as a result of an across-the board reduction in consumer demand for gun safes as gun owners concerns of more restrictive gun control legislation has subsided. The decrease in sales to Dealer accounts is principally attributable to the aforementioned reduced consumer demand and increased sales rebates and deeply discounted sales prices for the import line of safes. Liberty Safe’s sales backlog was approximately $9.5 million at December 31, 2014 compared to approximately $9.1 million at December 31, 2013. 100 Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 decreased approximately $19.0 million when compared to the same period in 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of net sales totaled approximately 14.7% and 24.2% of net sales for the years ended December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. The steep decrease in gross profit as a percentage of sales during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 is primarily attributable to: (i) discounted sales prices for import safes, (ii) negative cost variances as a result of lower manufacturing volume during 2014 compared to 2013 and (iii) increases in unit production costs resulting from upgrades added to several 2014 safe models that were not able to be passed on to customers as a result of the softening market. These costs were partially offset by price increases during the first quarter of 2014. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2014 decreased to approximately $11.6 million or 12.9% of net sales compared to $13.6 million or 10.8% of net sales for the same period of 2013. The $2.0 million decrease is primarily attributable to decreases in advertising costs and sales commissions ($1.7 million) and costs associated with a reduction in headcount ($0.3 million) during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period of 2013. Income (loss) from operations Income from operations decreased $15.2 million during the year ended December 31, 2014 to a loss from operations of $2.7 million compared to the same period in 2013, principally as a result of the decrease in sales, reduced gross profit as a percentage of sales and other factors, as described above. Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2012 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 increased approximately $34.9 million or 38.1% compared to the same period in 2012. (cid:2)on-Dealer sales were approximately $75.2 million in the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to $52.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2012, representing an increase of $22.9 million or 43.9%. Dealer sales totaled approximately $51.4 million in the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to $39.4 million in the same period in 2012, representing an increase of $12.0 million or 30.5%. The increase in (cid:2)on-Dealer sales in the year ended December 31, 2013 is due in large part to increased sales to Liberty’s two largest (cid:2)on-Dealer accounts in connection with their expansion of new stores. Liberty is the sole provider of safes to these two accounts. In addition, the significant increase in net sales at both the Dealer and (cid:2)on-Dealer level was the result of (i) strong demand for Liberty branded product by many gun owners due to increased gun and ammunition sales resulting from expected challenges by federal and state government to the second amendment, (ii) increased availability of import safes and safes manufactured in-house, on Liberty’s new production line and (iii) (cid:2)on-Dealer price increases. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 increased approximately $27.8 million compared to the same period in 2012. This increase is primarily due to the increase in net sales. Gross profit as a percentage of net sales totaled approximately 24.2% and 25.7% of net sales for each of the twelve month periods ended December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012, respectively. The decrease in gross profit as a percentage of sales during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 is principally attributable to increased sales of import safes that carry a lower margin and unfavorable manufacturing labor and overhead spending variances experienced during 2013 resulting from increased costs to keep pace with customer demand, offset in part by (cid:2)on-Dealer price increases enacted during the first quarter of 2013. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2013, increased approximately $1.5 million compared to the same period in 2012. This increase is principally the result of increases in the following costs: (i) commissions for the increase in sales, and compensation expense ($0.5 million), (ii) co-op advertising and national advertising ($0.9 million), and (iii) other miscellaneous costs ($0.1 million), including depreciation, travel, legal, and other costs. Amortization of intangibles Intangible asset amortization decreased $0.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 2012 due to fully amortizing certain intangible assets recorded as part of the 2010 purchase price allocation. 101 Income from operations Income from operations increased $6.5 million during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012, principally as a result of the significant increase in net sales, offset in part by other factors, as described above. Advanced Circuits Overview (cid:2)iche Industrial Businesses Advanced Circuits is a provider of small-run, quick-turn and volume production PCBs to customers throughout the United States. Collectively, small-run and quick-turn PCBs represent approximately 55% of Advanced Circuits’ gross revenues in 2013. Small- run and quick-turn PCBs typically command higher margins than volume production PCBs given that customers require high levels of responsiveness, technical support and timely delivery of small-run and quick-turn PCBs and are willing to pay a premium for them. Advanced Circuits is able to meet its customers’ demands by manufacturing custom PCBs in as little as 24 hours, while maintaining over 98.0% error-free production rates and real-time customer service and product tracking 24 hours per day. We purchased a controlling interest in Advanced Circuits on May 16, 2006. On May 23, 2012, Advanced Circuits acquired Universal Circuits for approximately $2.3 million. Universal Circuits supplies PCBs to major military, aerospace, and medical original equipment manufacturers and contract manufacturers. Universal Circuits’ Minnesota facility meets certain Department of Defense clearance requirements and is noted for custom and advanced technologies. Universal Circuits’ sales are primarily in the long-lead sector. For the year ended December 31, 2012, the consolidated results of operations of Advanced Circuits includes net sales of Universal Circuits aggregating $8.5 million and gross profit of Universal Circuits aggregating $2.0 million, respectively. The following Results of Operations does not include any operating results from Universal Circuits prior to the date of acquisition. Results of Operations The table below summarizes the statement of operations for Advanced Circuits for the fiscal years ending December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses Management fees Amortization of intangibles Income from operations Year Ended December 31, 2013 2012 2014 $ $ 85,918 46,801 39,117 13,598 500 2,564 22,455 $ $ 87,406 46,954 40,452 13,943 500 3,064 22,945 $ $ 84,071 42,575 41,496 13,975 500 3,054 23,967 Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 decreased approximately $1.5 million or 1.7% as compared to the corresponding year ended December 31, 2013. The decrease in net sales is primarily the result of a decrease in gross sales in long-lead time PCBs ($1.6 million) and quick-turn production and small-run PCBs ($1.2 million) offset in part by an increase in assembly sales ($0.9 million) and a decrease in sales promotions and discounts ($0.5 million) in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013. The decrease in sales of long lead time PCB’s is attributable to a reduction in orders as compared to the prior year period. The decrease in sales of quick-turn and small-run PCBs in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 2013 is primarily the result of a decline in orders from Department of Defense contractors. In addition to the decline in net sales 102 due to lower defense spending, we believe excess capacity created by current conditions in the global PCB market has negatively impacted net sales in the current year as foreign and domestic competitors operating below capacity have responded by competing aggressively on price within multiple service lines. Sales from quick-turn and small-run PCBs represented approximately 55% of gross sales in the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 decreased approximately $0.2 million compared to the comparable period in 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased 75 basis points during the year ended December 31, 2014 (45.5% at December 31, 2014 compared to 46.3% at December 31, 2013). The decrease is due to production inefficiencies realized in 2014 as a result of the reduced production volume. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expenses were approximately $13.6 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to $13.9 million in the same period in 2013. The $0.3 million decrease is primarily attributable to additional costs incurred in 2013 related to a potential acquisition. Income from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2014 was approximately $22.5 million compared to $22.9 million earned in the same period in 2013, a decrease of approximately $0.5 million, principally as a result of the decrease in net sales and other factors described above. Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2012 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 increased approximately $3.3 million or 4.0% over the corresponding period ended December 31, 2012. The increase in net sales is the result of an increase in gross sales in long-lead time PCBs ($5.6 million) and assembly sales ($1.1 million) and a decrease in sales promotions and discounts ($1.3 million) in the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012, offset in part by a decrease in sales of quick-turn production and small-run PCBs ($3.9 million) and sub-contract production ($0.7 million). The increase in long-lead sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 is the primarily the result of incremental sales in 2013 attributable to the Universal Circuits operation acquired in May 2012. The decrease in sales of quick-turn and small-run PCBs for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 is primarily the result of an overall decline in the business due to the state of the economy as a whole, decline in orders from Department of Defense and aerospace contractors, and pricing. Sales from quick-turn and small-run PCBs represented approximately 54.9% of gross sales in the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 60.3% during the same period of 2012. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 increased approximately $4.4 million compared to the same period in 2012. Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased to 46.3% for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 49.4% for the year ended December 31, 2012. This decrease in gross margin is principally the result of a greater proportion of long-lead sales to total sales in the 2013 period compared to 2012. Long lead PCB sales carry a significantly lower gross margin when compared to small- run or quick-turn PCB sales. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense decreased less than $0.1 million during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012. There were no notable increases or decreases in cost categories. Income from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2013 was approximately $22.9 million compared to $24.0 million earned in the same period in 2012, a decrease of approximately $1.0 million, principally as a result of those factors described above. 103 American Furniture Overview Founded in 1998 and headquartered in Ecru, Mississippi, American Furniture is a leading U.S. manufacturer of upholstered furniture, focused exclusively on the promotional segment of the furniture industry. American Furniture offers a broad product line of stationary and motion furniture, including sofas, loveseats, sectionals, recliners and complementary products, sold primarily at retail price points ranging between $199 and $1,499. American Furniture is a low-cost manufacturer and is able to ship most products in its line to in a short period of time to meet its customer’s demands. American Furniture’s products are adapted from established designs in the motion and recliner category and the stationary category. We purchased a controlling interest in American Furniture on August 31, 2007. Results of Operations The table below summarizes the results of operations for American Furniture for the fiscal years ending December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses Management fees Amortization of intangibles Income (loss) from operations 2014 Year Ended December 31, 2013 2012 $ $ 129,696 117,879 11,817 8,103 — 53 3,661 $ $ 104,885 96,571 8,314 8,086 — 53 175 $ $ 91,455 85,530 5,925 7,393 — 52 (1,520) Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased approximately $24.8 million, or 23.7% over the corresponding year ended December 31, 2013. During the year ended December 31, 2014, stationary product gross sales increased approximately $11.9 million and motion and recliner product gross sales increased approximately $12.7 million compared to the same period in 2013. This increase in sales for both product lines is principally attributable to a combination of increases in average unit price and the number of products shipped to American Furniture’s top twenty-five customers. In addition, a large sales promotion at one of American Furniture’s major customers completed during the second quarter of 2014 contributed to the increase in motion and recliner product sales in 2014. Cost of sales Cost of sales increased approximately $21.3 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period of 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of sales was 9.1% in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 7.9% for the same period in 2013. A favorable sales mix and increases in units manufactured in the year ended December 31, 2014 resulted in lower per unit costs compared to the same period in 2013. In addition, cost saving initiatives with respect to freight costs and reduction in indirect labor resulted in cost savings. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 were $8.1 million in each year. Although AFM had an increase in selling expenses due to higher trade show costs and increased sales commissions incurred during 2014 compared to the same period in 2013, this was offset by a decrease in professional fees during 2014 as compared to 2013. Selling, general and administrative costs as a percentage of sales were 6.2% in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 7.7% in the same period in 2013. 104 Income from operations Income from operations was $3.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to $0.2 million in the year ended December 31, 2013, an increase of $3.5 million, principally due to the factors described above. Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2012 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 increased approximately $13.4 million, or 14.7% over the corresponding year ended December 31, 2012. Stationary product sales increased approximately $7.5 million, recliner product sales increased approximately $5.2 million, and motion product sales increased approximately $0.5 million. Sales of other products and freight/ fuel surcharges increased $0.1 million during the twelve months ended December 31, 2013 compared to 2012. The increase in sales of stationary product is the result of a strong 2013 third and fourth quarter, driven by new product introductions and increased placements with several key retail accounts. The increase in motion and recliner sales is the result of increased orders from one key account, product line improvements in the merchandising area and pricing. Cost of sales Cost of sales increased approximately $11.0 million in the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period of 2012 and is principally due to the corresponding increase in sales. Gross profit as a percentage of sales was 7.9% in the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 6.5% in 2012. The increase in gross profit as a percentage of sales of approximately 1.4% during the year ended December 31, 2013 is principally attributable to: (i) increased pricing and (ii) continued improvements in freight expense and trucking costs through outsourcing and fleet elimination. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense totaled approximately $8.1 million or 7.7% of net sales during the twelve month period ended December 31, 2013 compared to $7.4 million or 8.1% of net sales in the same period of 2012. The increase in costs are principally attributable to costs associated with increased staffing in the sales and merchandising group. Income (loss) from operations Income from operations totaled approximately $0.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to a loss from operations of approximately $1.5 million in the year ended December 31, 2012, principally due the factors described above. Arnold Overview Founded in 1895 and headquartered in Rochester, (cid:2)ew York, Arnold Magnetics (or Arnold) is a manufacturer of engineered, application specific permanent magnets. Arnold products are used in applications such as general industrial, reprographic systems, aerospace and defense, advertising and promotional, consumer and appliance, energy, automotive and medical technology. Arnold is the largest U.S. manufacturer of engineered magnets as well as only one of two domestic producers to design, engineer and manufacture rare earth magnetic solutions. Arnold operates a 70,000 sq. ft. manufacturing assembly and distribution facility in Rochester, (cid:2)ew York with nine additional facilities worldwide, in countries including the United Kingdom, Switzerland and China. Arnold serves customers via three primary product sectors: • • • Permanent Magnet and Assemblies and Reprographics (“PMAG”) (approximately 75% of sales) – High performance magnets for precision motor/generator sensors as well as beam focusing applications and reprographic applications; Flexmag (approximately 20% of net sales) – Flexible bonded magnets for advertising, consumer and industrial applications; and Precision Thin Metals (approximately 5% of net sales) – Ultra thin metal foil products utilizing magnetic and non- magnetic alloys. Arnold is also a 50% partner in a China rare earth mine-to-magnet joint venture. Arnold accounts for its activity in the joint venture utilizing the equity method of accounting. Gains and losses from the joint venture are not material during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 or 2012. On March 5, 2012, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Arnold for approximately $131 million, representing approximately 96.6% of the equity in Arnold Magnetics. 105 Results of Operations The table below summarizes the results of operations for Arnold for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 and the pro-forma results of operations for the full fiscal year ended December 31, 2012. We acquired Arnold on March 5, 2012. The following operating results are reported as if we acquired Arnold on January 1, 2012. (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales (a) Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses (b) Management fees (c) Amortization of intangibles (d) Income from operations Year ended December 31, 2014 123,205 95,640 27,565 16,456 500 3,514 7,095 $ $ 2013 126,606 96,784 29,822 16,820 500 3,588 8,914 $ $ $ $ 2012 (Pro-forma) 127,433 98,769 28,664 15,821 500 3,499 8,844 Pro-forma results of operations of Arnold for the annual period ended December 31, 2012 includes the following pro-forma adjustments applied to historical results: (a) Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2012 does not include $3.1 million of amortization expense associated with the inventory fair value step-up recorded in 2012 as a result of and derived from the purchase price allocation in connection with our purchase of Arnold. (b) Selling, general and administrative costs were reduced by approximately $12.4 million in the year ended December 31, 2012, representing an adjustment for one-time transaction costs incurred as a result of our purchase. (c) Represents management fees that would have been payable to the Manager. (d) An increase in amortization of intangible assets totaling $0.6 million in 2012. This adjustment is a result of and was derived from the purchase price allocation in connection with our acquisition of Arnold. Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $123.2 million, a decrease of $3.4 million, or 2.7%, compared to the same period in 2013. The decrease in net sales is a result of decreased sales in PMAG ($2.9 million) and Flexmag ($1.0 million) product sectors offset in part by an increase in net sales in the Precision Thin Metals sector ($0.4 million). The decrease in PMAG sales in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 2013 is primarily due to a decrease in reprographic sales of approximately $4.1 million. PMAG sales represented approximately 75% of net sales in each of the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013. The decrease in Flexmag sales is the result of sales attributable to non-recurring projects for a customer in 2013 that was not replicated during 2014. The increase in Precision Thin Metals sales is attributable to positive steps taken over the last year by management to identify new customers and applications. International sales were $55.6 million during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to $61.4 million during the same period in 2013, a decrease of $5.8 million or 9.5%. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $95.6 million compared to approximately $96.8 million in the same period of 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of sales decreased from 23.6% for the year ended December 31, 2013 to 22.4% for the same period ended December 31, 2014. The decrease is principally attributable to decreased margins in the Flexmag sector due to a one-time high margin project in the second quarter of 2013 that was not replicated in 2014, offset in part by an increase in margin in the Precision Thin Metals sectors. The increase in margins in the Precision Thin Metals sector is due to a more favorable customer/product sales mix during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 and the positive impact of new customers and applications and increased production efficiencies. 106 Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2014 decreased to approximately $16.5 million or 13.4% of net sales compared to $16.8 million or 13.3% of net sales for the same period in 2013. The $0.4 million decrease in selling, general and administrative expenses in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 2013 is primarily attributable to a reduction in compensation expense for the period. Income from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2014 was approximately $7.1 million, a decrease of $1.8 million when compared to the same period in 2013, based on the factors described above. Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to the Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2012 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 were approximately $126.6 million, a decrease of $0.8 million, or 0.6%, compared to the same period in 2012. The decrease in net sales is a result of decreased sales in Precision Thin Metals ($2.7 million), offset in part by sales increases in PMAG ($1.7 million) and Flexmag ($0.2 million) product sectors. The increase in PMAG sales during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012 is principally attributable to strong order flow in (cid:2)orth America and Europe offset in part by lower reprographic application sales, a component of PMAG. The increase in Flexmag sales is due to a large non-recurring project order. PMAG sales represented approximately 74.8% of net sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 73.0% for the same period in 2012. The decrease in Precision Thin Metals sales during the current period is principally attributable to market softness in the U.S. defense market and the European energy market. International sales, reflecting sales to geographic locations outside the United States, were $61 million during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to $57 million during the same period in 2012, an increase of $4 million or 7.0%. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2013 were approximately $96.8 million compared to approximately $98.8 million in the same period of 2012. Gross profit as a percentage of sales increased from 22.5% for the year ended December 31, 2012 to 23.6% in the corresponding period of December 31, 2013. The increase is attributable to an increase in margins at its PMAG and Flexmag product sectors, offset in part by decreased margin in the Precision Thin Metals sector due to higher material costs and unfavorable customer / product sales mixes. The increase in margins in the PMAG sector are due to a more favorable customer/ product sales mix, due in part to the decrease in reprographic application sales during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2013 increased $1.0 million to approximately $16.8 million or 13.3% of net sales compared to $15.8 million or 12.4% of net sales for the same period in 2012, due principally to higher outside service costs and costs associated with hiring additional technical personnel during 2013. Income from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2013 was approximately $8.9 million, an increase of $0.1 million when compared to the same period in 2012, based principally on the factors described above. 107 Clean Earth Overview Founded in 1990 and headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, Clean Earth is a provider of environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials. Clean Earth provides a one-stop shop solution that analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste streams generated in multiple end-markets such as power, construction, commercial development, oil and gas, infrastructure, industrial and dredging. Historically, the majority of Clean Earth’s revenues have been generated by contaminated soils which include environmentally impacted soils, drill cuttings and other materials which are treated at one of its nine permitted soil treatment facilities. Clean Earth also operates three RCRA Part B hazardous waste facilities. The remaining revenue has been generated by dredge material, which consists of sediment removed from the floor of a body of water for navigational purposes and/or environmental remediation of contaminated waterways and is treated at one of its two permitted dredge processing facilities. Approximately 98% of the material processed by Clean Earth is beneficially reused for such purposes as daily landfill cover, industrial and brownfield redevelopment projects. On August 26, 2014, we made loans to and purchased a controlling interest in Clean Earth for approximately $251.4 million, representing approximately 98% of the equity in Clean Earth. Results of Operations The table below summarizes the pro forma results of operations for Clean Earth for the full fiscal years ended December 2014 and 2013. We acquired Clean Earth on August 26, 2014. The following results of operations are reported as if we acquired Clean Earth on January 1, 2013. (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales (a) Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses (b) Management fees (c) Amortization of intangibles (d) Income from operations Year ended December 31, 2014 (Pro forma) 2013 (Pro forma) $ 164,536 $ 112,636 51,900 27,034 500 11,524 $ 12,842 $ 155,929 113,965 41,964 21,210 500 11,524 8,730 Pro forma results of operations for Clean Earth for the annual periods ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 include the following proforma adjustments applied to historical results: (a) Cost of sales decreased $1.5 million and $1.0 million for years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, for a reduction in depreciation expense associated with the extension of the estimated useful lives of the property, plant and equipment resulting from the purchase price allocation in connection with our acquisition. (b) Selling, general and administrative costs were reduced by approximately $13.7 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 representing an adjustment for one-time seller’s transaction costs incurred as a result of our purchase, offset by approximately $1.0 million in additional expense related to stock options issued to management. (c) Represents management fees that would have been payable to the Manager in each period presented. (d) Represents an increase in amortization of intangible assets totaling $5.6 million and $10.0 million in the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, for additional amortization expense associated with the fair value step up of intangible assets resulting from the purchase price allocation in connection with our acquisition. 108 Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to the Pro Forma Year ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $164.5 million, an increase of $8.6 million or 5.5% compared to the same period in 2013. The increase in net sales is a result of increased volume in both contaminated soils and dredge material. The increase in volume of contaminated soils during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 is principally attributable to incremental net sales from a new treatment facility acquired in March 2013. The increase in volume of dredge material is principally attributable to the increase in the number of large maintenance dredge projects during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013. Contaminated soils represented approximately 74% of net sales for both the year ended December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $112.6 million compared to approximately $114.0 million in the same period of 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of sales increased from 26.9% for the year ended December 31, 2013 to 31.5% for the year period ended December 31, 2014. The increase in gross margin during the year ended December 31, 2014 is due to lower beneficial reuse costs during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased to approximately $27.0 million or 16.4% of net sales compared to $21.2 million or 13.6% of net sales for the same period in 2013. The $5.8 million increase in selling, general and administrative expenses in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 2013 is primarily attributable to one time buyer transaction costs incurred in September 2014 ($1.9 million), increased professional fees during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013, and additional employee compensation. Income from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2014 was approximately $12.8 million, an increase of $4.1 million when compared to the same period in 2013 as a result of those factors described above. SternoCandleLamp Overview SternoCandleLamp, headquartered in Corona, California, is a manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative table lighting solutions for the food service industry. SternoCandleLamp offers a broad range of wick and gel chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories, liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps. SternoCandleLamp was formed in 2012 with the merger of two manufacturers and marketers of portable food warming fuel products, The Sterno Group LLC and the Candle Lamp Company, LLC. On October 10, 2014, we made loans to and purchased all of the equity of SternoCandleLamp for approximately $160.0 million. Results of Operations The table below summarizes the pro forma results of operations for SternoCandleLamp for the full fiscal years ended December 2014 and 2013. We acquired SternoCandleLamp on October 10, 2014. The following results of operations are reported as if we acquired SternoCandleLamp on January 1, 2013. 109 (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales (a) Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses (b) Management fee (c) Amortization of intangibles (d) Income (loss) from operations Year ended December 31, 2014 (Pro forma) 2013 (Pro forma) $ $ $ 140,858 111,344 29,514 17,150 500 6,014 5,850 $ 133,603 106,379 27,224 21,139 500 6,014 (429) Pro forma results of operations for SternoCandleLamp for the annual periods ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 include the following proforma adjustments applied to historical results: (a) Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 does not include $2.0 million of amortization expense associated with the inventory fair value step-up recorded in 2014 as a result of and derived from the purchase price allocation in connection with our purchase of SternoCandleLamp. (b) Selling, general and administrative costs were reduced by approximately $10.8 million in the year ended December 31, 2014 representing an adjustment for one-time seller’s transaction costs incurred as a result of our purchase. An additional $0.6 million reduction in expense is recorded in 2013 related to the difference in stock compensation expense as a result of the transaction. (c) Represents management fees that would have been payable to the Manager in each period presented. (d) Represents an increase in amortization of intangible assets totaling $2.3 million and $3.8 million in the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, for additional amortization expense associated the fair value step up of intangible assets resulting from the purchase price allocation in connection with our acquisition. Pro Forma Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to the Pro Forma Year ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $140.9 million, an increase of $7.3 million or 5.4% compared to the same period in 2013. The increase in net sales is a result of additional product placement and share growth in the retail sales channel and price increases implemented by the Company during the 2014 fiscal year. Cost of sales Cost of sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $111.3 million compared to approximately $106.4 million in the same period of 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of sales increased from 20.4% for the year ended December 31, 2013 to 21.0% for the same period ended December 31, 2014. The improvement in gross margin during the year ended December 31, 2014 is primarily due to price increases net of commodity cost increases and additional efficiencies related to the merger of Candle Lamp Company, LLC and The Sterno Group LLC during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013. Selling, general and administrative expense Selling, general and administrative expense for the year ended December 31, 2014 decreased to approximately $17.2 million or 12.2% of net sales compared to $21.1 million or 15.8% of net sales for the same period in 2013. The $4.0 million decrease in selling, general and administrative expenses in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 2013 is primarily attributable to non-recurring expenses associated with the merger of CandleLamp Co. and the Sterno Group that were incurred during 2013. Income (loss) from operations Income from operations for the year ended December 31, 2014 was approximately $5.9 million, an increase of $6.3 million when compared to the same period in 2013, as a result of those factors described above. 110 Tridien Overview Tridien, headquartered in Coral Springs, Florida, is a developer, manufacturer and marketer of powered and non-powered medical therapeutic support surfaces and surgical patient positioning devices serving the acute care, long-term care and home health care markets. Tridien, together with its subsidiary companies, provides its customers the opportunity to source or co-develop innovative support surface technologies directly from the designer and manufacturer. Tridien’s customers include some of the largest and most respected providers of support surfaces and surgical patient positioners across the globe. Tridien historically receives approximately two-thirds of its revenues from its three largest customers. Results of Operations The table below summarizes the results of operations for Tridien for the fiscal years ending December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Selling, general and administrative expenses Management fees Amortization of intangibles Impairment expense Income (loss) from operations 2014 Year Ended December 31, 2013 2012 $ $ 67,254 53,089 14,165 9,845 350 1,779 — 2,191 $ $ $ 60,072 46,636 13,436 9,145 350 1,250 12,918 (10,227) $ 55,855 42,031 13,824 8,502 350 1,305 — 3,667 Year Ended December 31, 2014 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2014 were approximately $67.3 million compared to approximately $60.1 million for the same period in 2013, an increase of $7.2 million or 12.0%. Sales of non-powered products (including patient positioning devices) totaled $55.4 million during the year ended December 31, 2014 representing an increase of $8.2 million compared to the same period in 2013. The increase in non-powered product sales in the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 is principally the result of our customer's expansion into international markets with newly developed and existing products. Sales of powered products totaled $11.8 million during the year ended December 31, 2014 representing a decrease of $1.0 million compared to the same period in 2013. Cost of sales Cost of sales increased approximately $6.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013. Gross profit as a percentage of sales was 21.1% for the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to 22.4% in the corresponding period in 2013. The decrease in gross profit as a percentage of sales was primarily due to an unfavorable product sales mix during the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013. (cid:2)on-powered products typically carry lower margins than powered products. Selling, general and administrative expenses Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased $0.7 million compared to the same period in 2013. This increase is attributable to higher research and development costs and professional fees in 2014 compared to the prior year. Impairment expense During the second quarter of 2013, one of Tridien’s largest customers lost a large contract program that was being serviced substantially with Tridien product. The expected lost sales and net income were significant enough to trigger an interim goodwill and indefinite-lived asset impairment analysis. The result of these analyses supported the carrying value of goodwill but indicated that sales of product, reliant on trade names could not fully support the carrying value of Tridien’s trade names. At December 31 2013, further revenue decreases together with a revised 2014 forecast that indicated little to no growth prompted an additional 111 interim impairment analysis as of December 31, 2013. The result of the year end goodwill impairment analysis (step 1) indicated that goodwill was impaired. Further testing (step 2) resulted in the following results; (i) goodwill was written down $11.5 million to a balance of $16.8 million; (ii) trade names were written down $0.4 million to a balance of $0.2 million and; (iii) technology assets were written down $0.1 million to a balance of $0.8 million. In addition, as part of the 2013 analysis, Tridien shortened the life of some of its intangible assets, resulting in higher periodic intangible amortization expense. Income from operations Income from operations increased approximately $12.4 million to $2.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2014 compared to the same period in 2013 primarily due to the impairment expense recorded in 2013, and other factors as described above. Year Ended December 31, 2013 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2012 (cid:2)et sales (cid:2)et sales for the year ended December 31, 2013, were approximately $60.1 million compared to approximately $55.9 million for the same period in 2012, an increase of $4.2 million or 7.5%. Sales of non-powered products (including patient positioning devices) totaled $47.2 million during the year ended December 31, 2013 representing an increase of $1.8 million compared to the same period in 2012. Sales of powered products totaled $12.8 million during the year ended December 31, 2013 representing an increase of $2.4 million compared to the same period in 2012. These increases were driven primarily by $5.5 million of new product sales combined with higher capital purchases from other customers during the period, offset in part by price concessions and reduced volumes from two large customers. One large customer has been purchasing reduced volumes of Tridien exclusively manufactured products and another large customer experienced the loss of a contract program that represented approximately $3.0 million in non- powered annual sales for Tridien. Cost of sales Cost of sales increased approximately $4.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012. Gross profit as a percentage of sales was 22.4% for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to 24.8% in the corresponding period in 2012. The decrease in gross profit as a percentage of sales totaling 2.4% was primarily due to: (i) operational inefficiencies resulting from ramping up for new product releases, (ii) increased warranty costs, (iii) an unfavorable product sales mix and (iv) price concessions granted to major customers during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to the same period in 2012. Selling, general and administrative expenses Selling, general and administrative expenses for the year ended December 31, 2013 increased $0.6 million to $9.1 million compared to the same period in 2012, principally as a result of increased research and development spending for products launched in 2014 and cost associated with expansion of the management team. Impairment expense During the second quarter of 2013, one of Tridien’s largest customers lost a large contract program that was being serviced substantially with Tridien product. The expected lost sales and net income were significant enough to trigger an interim goodwill and indefinite-lived asset impairment analysis. The result of these analyses supported the carrying value of goodwill but indicated that sales of product, reliant on trade names, could not fully support the carrying value of Tridien’s trade names. As such we wrote down the value of the trade names by $0.9 million to a carrying value of approximately $0.6 million at that time. At December 31 2013 further revenue decreases together with a revised 2014 forecast that indicated little to no growth prompted an additional interim impairment analysis as of December 31, 2013. The result of the year end goodwill impairment analysis (step 1) indicated that goodwill was impaired. Further testing (step 2) resulted in the following results; (i) goodwill was written down $11.5 million to a balance of $16.8 million; (ii) trade names were written down $0.4 million to a balance of $0.2 million and; (iii) technology assets were written down $0.1 million to a balance of $0.8 million. Income (loss) from operations Income from operations decreased approximately $13.9 million to an operating loss of $10.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to operating income of $3.7 million in the same period in 2012 based on those factors described above, particularly the impairment expense. 112 Liquidity and Capital Resources The change in cash and cash equivalents is as follows: (in thousands) Cash provided by operations Cash provided by (used in) investing activities Cash provided by (used in) financing activities Effect of exchange rates on cash and cash equivalents Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents Year ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 $ $ $ 70,695 (424,753) 265,487 (955) (89,526) $ 72,374 $ 66,286 (44,122) 450 94,988 $ 52,566 (84,426) (82,232) (37) (114,129) Cash Flow from Operating Activities 2014 For the year ended December 31, 2014, on a consolidated basis, cash flows provided by operating activities totaled $70.7 million, which represents a $1.7 million decrease compared to the year-ended December 31, 2013. The decrease is principally the result of a decrease in net income after adjusting for non cash charges to operating results ($16.2 million) offset by changes in working capital ($14.5 million) primarily resulting from our 2014 acquisitions from date of acquisition through year-end, as well as the effect on working capital of the deconsolidation of our FOX business in July 2014. On a consolidated basis, cash flow from accounts receivable increased ($9.9 million), while there was a significant reduction in cash invested in inventory ($44.0 million). The decrease in cash invested in inventory was primarily at our Liberty segment as a result of their experiencing a significant drop off in sales during the first half of 2014, and our American Furniture segment as a result of an increase in sales orders during the fourth quarter of 2014 and a concerted effort to reduce their days sale in inventory by limiting the number of SKUs they manufacture and revising their process for ordering kits to provide a more efficient manufacturing process. Cash used for accounts payable and accrued expenses also decreased ($19.5 million) as a result of the decrease in inventory. 2013 For the year ended December 31, 2013, on a consolidated basis, cash flows provided by operating activities totaled approximately $72.4 million, which reflects the results of operations of all eight of our existing businesses during the year ended December 31, 2013 compared to $52.6 million provided by operating activities for the same period in 2012, an increase of $19.8 million. This increase is the result of (i) an increase in net income at our businesses during 2013 compare to 2012, adjusted for non-cash operating charges in each year for impairment expense, derivative mark-to-market losses and loss on debt extinguishment ($18.9 million); (ii) a decrease in payments of allocation interests during the year ended December 31, 2013, as reflected in operating activities compared to 2012 ($8.3 million); offset in part by the increase in cash absorbed through working capital needs at December 31, 2013 compared to 2012 ($5.5 million). The major working capital investments include investment in inventory ($24.5 million) and accounts receivable ($11.0 million) offset in part by increases in accrued expenses that provided short-term, temporary working capital at December 31, 2013. The investment in inventory is principally at American Furniture, Liberty and FOX. The inventory buildup at American Furniture is for “tax season” sales at AFM which typically occur January through April. The inventory buildup at Liberty and FOX is the result of steadily increasing sales during 2013 compared to a year ago. The increased balance in accounts receivable is principally attributable to FOX which recognized a considerable increase in sales in the fourth fiscal quarter of 2013 compared to 2012. The excess cash used for these working capital needs was offset in part by increases in trade accounts payable and accrued expenses that provided short-term, temporary working capital at December 31, 2013. 2012 For the year ended December 31, 2012, on a consolidated basis, cash flows provided by operating activities totaled approximately $52.6 million, which reflects the results of operations of all eight of our existing businesses and four months of Halo activity, during the year ended December 31, 2012 compared to $91.4 million provided by operating activities for the same period in 2011, a decrease of $38.8 million. The increase in cash provided by operating income of $13.2 million in 2012 over the prior year was offset by cash used for working capital investments of $27.0 million during 2012. The major working capital investments include pay down of the supplemental put liability ($13.9 million) and investment in inventory ($13.7 million) offset in part by increases in accrued expenses that provided short-term, temporary working capital at December 31, 2012. The investment in inventory is 113 principally at American Furniture, CamelBak and FOX. The inventory buildup at American Furniture is for “tax season” sales at AFM which typically occur January through April. The inventory buildup at CamelBak and FOX is the result of steadily increasing sales compared to a year ago. Cash Flow from Investing Activities 2014 Cash flows used in investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2014 was $424.8 million. This amount reflects the Company's purchase of our 2014 Acquisitions, Clean Earth ($250.4 million) and SternoCandleLamp ($165.3 million), as well as an add-on acquisition at Clean Earth ($15.9 million) and an acquisition by FOX prior to deconsolidation ($41.0 million), cash used for the purchase of capital expenditures ($15.3 million) and fixed cash payments on our interest rate swap ($2.0 million), offset in part by proceeds from the sale of FOX common stock ($65.5 million). We expect 2015 capital expenditures to increase to approximately $21.0 million to $26.0 million as compared to the 2014 capital expenditures due to the acquisitions of Clean Earth and SternoCandleLamp and continued investment in our businesses. 2013 For the year ended December 31, 2013, on a consolidated basis, cash flows provided by investing activities totaled approximately $66.3 million, which reflects the net proceeds from the sale of subsidiary stock (FOX—$80.9 million), and sale leaseback proceeds at Advanced Circuits ($4.4 million), offset in part by capital expenditures ($20.4 million). 2012 Cash flows used in investing activities totaled approximately $84.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2012, which reflects (i) cash used for both platform and add-on acquisitions made during 2012 ($126.4 million); (ii) capital expenditures at our businesses ($18.5 million); and, (iii) additional investment made by us in our existing businesses ($15.4 million) offset in part by proceeds from the sale of our businesses in 2012 ($75.1 million). Cash Flow from Financing Activities 2014 Cash flows provided by financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2014 was $265.5 million, principally reflecting: (i) net borrowings under our 2011 and 2014 Credit Facilities ($206.3 million) which was used to fund our 2014 acquisitions and net borrowings under the FOX credit facility prior to deconsolidation ($37.1 million), (ii) proceeds from a secondary offering that we completed during the fourth quarter of 2014 ($99.9 million), (iii) stock option proceeds received from minority shareholders ($4.0 million), and (iv) excess tax benefit at FOX ($1.7 million) offset in part by the payment of quarterly distributions to our shareholders ($69.6 million) and a profit allocation payment to our Allocation Interest Holders ($11.9 million). 2013 For the year ended December 31, 2013, on a consolidated basis, cash flows used in financing activities totaled approximately $44.1 million, principally reflecting distributions to majority and non-controlling shareholders ($88.6 million), offset in part by net proceeds from the sale of IPO stock at the subsidiary level ($36.1 million) and borrowings on our long-term debt, net of loan origination costs ($8.5 million). 2012 Cash flows used in financing activities totaled approximately $82.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2012, principally reflecting: (i) net proceeds from our Credit Facility ($51.0 million), and (ii) net proceeds from non-controlling interests ($12.1 million). These inflows were more than offset by distributions to shareholders ($99.6) million and redemption of CamelBak’s preferred stock ($48.0 million). 114 At December 31, 2014, we had approximately $23.7 million of cash and cash equivalents on hand. The majority of our cash is invested in short-term securities and corporate debt securities and is maintained in accordance with the Company’s investment policy, which identifies allowable investments and specifies credit quality standards. The primary objective of our investment activities is the preservation of principal and minimizing risk. We do not hold any investments for trading purposes. Intercompany loans to our businesses At December 31, 2014 we had the following outstanding loans due from our businesses: (in thousands) CamelBak Ergobaby Liberty Advanced Circuits American Furniture Arnold Clean Earth SternoCandleLamp Tridien $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 100,628 33,198 38,343 71,390 24,385 73,450 160,323 84,584 11,131 Each loan has a scheduled maturity and each business is entitled to repay all or a portion of the principal amount of the outstanding loans, without penalty, prior to maturity. As of December 31, 2013 and 2012, American Furniture was not in compliance with its Maintenance Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio requirement included in the amended credit agreement with us dated December 31, 2010. We are required to fund, in the form of an additional equity investment, any shortfall in the difference between Adjusted EBITDA and Fixed Charges as defined in American Furniture’s credit agreement with us. Per the maintenance agreement, in exchange for the shortfall that we are required to fund, American Furniture is in turn required to pay down its term debt with us. The amount of the shortfall at December 31, 2013 and 2012 was approximately $1.6 million and $3.5 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2014, Liberty was not in compliance with either its Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio or its Leverage Ratio included in their amended credit agreement with us. We have issued a waiver to Liberty which is effective through December 31, 2015. All of our businesses with the exception of Liberty are in compliance with their financial covenants with us as of December 31, 2014. Our primary source of cash is from the receipt of interest and principal on our outstanding loans to our businesses. Accordingly, we are dependent upon the earnings and cash flow of these businesses, which are available for (i) operating expenses; (ii) payment of principal and interest under our Credit Facility; (iii) payments to CGM due or potentially due pursuant to the revised MSA and the LLC Agreement; (iv) cash distributions to our shareholders and; (v) investments in future acquisitions. Payments made under (i) through (iii) above are required to be paid before distributions to shareholders and may be significant and exceed the funds held by us, which may require us to dispose of assets or incur debt to fund such expenditures. Credit Facility On June 6, 2014, we entered into a new credit facility, the 2014 Credit Facility, replacing our existing 2011 Credit Facility entered into in October 2011. The 2014 Credit Facility provides for (i) revolving loans, swing line loans and letters of credit up to a maximum aggregate amount of $400 million and matures in June 2019, and (ii) a $325 million term loan. Our 2014 Term Loan requires quarterly payments of $0.8 million with a final payment of the outstanding principal balance due in June 2021. (Refer to (cid:2)ote J to the Consolidated Financial Statements for a complete description of our 2014 Credit Facility.) We used approximately $290.0 million of the 2014 Term Loan proceeds to pay all amounts outstanding under the 2011 Credit Facility and to pay the closing costs. At December 31, 2014, we had $169.7 million in borrowings under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility and Letters of Credit totaling $4.5 million were outstanding. We had approximately $225.7 million in borrowing base availability under this facility at December 31, 2014. 115 The following table reflects required and actual financial ratios as of December 31, 2014 included as part of the affirmative covenants in our 2014 Credit Facility: Description of Required Covenant Ratio Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio Total Debt to EBITDA Ratio Covenant Ratio Requirement greater than or equal to 1.5:1.0 less than or equal to 4.25:1.0 Actual Ratio 4.44:1.00 2.99:1.00 We intend to use the availability under our Credit Facility and cash on hand to pursue acquisitions of additional businesses, to fund distributions and to provide for other working capital needs. We have considered the impact of recent market instability and credit availability in assessing the adequacy of our liquidity and capital resources. On September 12, 2014, we purchased an interest rate swap (“(cid:2)ew Swap”) with a notional amount of $220 million effective April 1, 2016 through June 6, 2021. The agreement requires us to pay interest on the notional amount at the rate of 2.97% in exchange for the three-month LIBOR rate. At December 31, 2014, the (cid:2)ew Swap had a fair value loss of $7.4 million, principally reflecting the present value of future payments and receipts under the agreement and is reflected as a component of other non-current liabilities. The 2011 Credit Facility required us to hedge the interest exposure on 50% of outstanding debt under the 2011 Term Loan Facility. On October 31, 2011, we purchased a three-year interest rate swap (“Swap”) with a notional amount of $200 million effective January 1, 2014 through December 31, 2016. The agreement required us to pay interest on the notional amount at the rate of 2.49% in exchange for the three-month LIBOR rate, with a floor of 1.5%. At December 31, 2014, this Swap had a fair value loss of $2.5 million and is reflected as a component of other non-current liabilities ($0.5 million) with the remaining balance included as a component of current liabilities. Investment in FOX FOX is a designer, manufacturer and marketer of high performance suspension products used primarily on mountain bikes, off- road vehicles and trucks, snowmobiles and motorcycles. We purchased a controlling interest in FOX on January 4, 2008 for approximately $80.4 million. In August 2013, FOX completed an initial public offering of its common stock at an initial offering price of $15.00 per share. FOX sold 2,857,143 shares and certain of its shareholders sold 7,000,000 shares (including 5,800,238 shares held by us). FOX trades on the (cid:2)ASDAQ stock market under the ticker “FOXF”. We received approximately $80.9 million in net proceeds from the sale of our FOX shares, and our ownership interest in FOX was reduced to approximately 53.9%. FOX used a portion of their net proceeds received from the sale of their shares as well as proceeds from the FOX credit facility to repay $61.5 million in outstanding indebtedness to us under their existing credit facility with us. On July 10, 2014, certain FOX shareholders, including us, sold shares of FOX common stock through a FOX secondary offering at a price of $15.50 per share. As a selling shareholder, we sold a total of 4,466,569 shares of FOX common stock, including 633,955 shares sold in connection with underwriters’ exercise of the over-allotment option in full, for total net proceeds of approximately $65.5 million. Upon completion of the offering, our ownership in FOX was lowered from approximately 53% to 41%, or 15,108,718 shares of FOX’s common stock. As a result of the sale of the FOX shares by the Company in the FOX Secondary Offering, we no longer hold a controlling ownership interest in FOX which resulted in the deconsolidation of the FOX operating segment effective as of the date of the FOX secondary Offering. We recognized a gain of approximately $76.2 million related to the shares that were sold in the FOX Secondary Offering, and a gain of approximately $188.0 million related to the deconsolidation of our retained interest in FOX, for a total gain of approximately $264.2 million. We account for our remaining equity interest in FOX using the equity method of accounting. We use the equity method of accounting for investments when we have the ability to exercise significant influence, but not control, over the operating and financial policies of the investee. We have elected to measure the FOX equity method investment at fair value with unrealized gains and losses reported in the consolidated statement of operations as gain (loss) from equity method investment. The investment in FOX had a fair value of $245.2 million at December 31, 2014, and we recorded a gain on the investment of $11.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. Supplemental Put Agreement Termination On July 1, 2013, we amended the MSA with our Manager to provide for certain modifications related to our Manager’s registration as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (“Advisor’s Act”), as amended. In connection with the 116 amendment resulting from the Manager’s registration as an investment adviser under the Adviser’s Act, we and our Manager agreed to terminate the Supplemental Put Agreement, which had the effect of eliminating the Manager’s right to require us to purchase the Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA. Pursuant to the MSA, as amended, our Manager will continue to manage the day-to-day operations and affairs of the Company, oversee the management and operations of our businesses, perform certain other services for which it will continue to receive management fees, and the holders of the Allocation Interests will continue to receive the profit allocation upon the occurrence of a Sale Event or a Holding Event. As a result of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, we derecognized the supplemental put liability associated with our Manager’s put right, reversing the entire $61.3 million liability during the year ended December 31, 2013 through supplemental put expense on the consolidated statement of operations. A profit allocation payment totaling $5.6 million was disbursed to holders of Allocation Interests as a result of FOX’s five-year Holding Event prior to the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement. Subsequent to the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, we record Holding Events and Sale Events as dividends declared on Allocations Interests to stockholders’ equity when they are approved by our board of directors. The FOX Secondary Offering was considered a Sale Event and in September 2014, our board of directors approved and declared a profit allocation payment totaling $11.9 million to holders of the Allocation Interests. The profit allocation payment was made on September 30, 2014. As a result of the FOX IPO, our board of directors approved and declared on October 30, 2013 a profit allocation payment totaling $16.0 million which was paid to holders of Allocation Interests in (cid:2)ovember of 2013. We believe that we currently have sufficient liquidity and capital resources, which include amounts available under our 2014 Revolving Credit Facility, to meet our existing obligations, including quarterly distributions to our shareholders, as approved by our board of directors, over the next twelve months. Interest Expense We incurred interest expense totaling $27.1 million in the year ended December 31, 2014, as compared to $19.4 million in the year ended December 31, 2013 and $25.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. The components of interest expense in each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 are as follows (in thousands): Interest on credit facilities Unused fee on Revolving Credit Facility Amortization of original issue discount Realized losses on interest rate hedges Unrealized losses on interest rate derivatives (1) Letter of credit fees Other Interest expense Average daily balance of debt outstanding Effective interest rate $ Years ended December 31, 2014 16,392 1,914 882 — 7,709 62 138 $ 2013 15,625 2,349 1,243 — 130 53 15 $ 2012 17,643 2,666 2,312 166 2,175 63 30 $ $ 27,097 379,034 $ $ 19,415 294,056 $ $ 25,055 271,776 7.2% 6.6% 9.2% (1) On September 14, 2014, we purchased an interest rate swap (the “(cid:2)ew Swap”) with a notional amount of $220 million effective April 1, 2016 through June 6, 2021. The agreement requires us to pay interest on the notional amount at the rate of 2.97% in exchange for the three-month LIBOR rate. At December 31, 2014, this (cid:2)ew Swap had a fair value of negative $7.4 million, essentially reflecting the present value of future payments and receipts under the agreement and is reflected as a component of interest expense and other non-current liabilities. In the above table, we provide the effective interest rate on outstanding debt, which includes the mark-to-market loss on the (cid:2)ew Swap. The effective interest rate for incurred debt during the year ended December 31, 2014 after elimination of the (cid:2)ew Swap, which has a term that does not begin until April 1, 2016, is 5.2%. Refer to (cid:2)ote K - Derivatives and Hedging Activities of the consolidated financial statements. Income Taxes We incurred income tax expense of $8.3 million with an annual effective rate of 2.8% during the year ended December 31, 2014, $20.7 million in income tax expense with an annual effective tax rate of 20.8% during the year ended December 31, 2013, and 117 $21.1 million with an effective tax rate of 78.6% during the year ended December 31, 2012. The effect of the gain on the deconsolidation of FOX incurred at the corporate level decreased the effective income tax rate by 30.8 %. The reversal of the supplemental put expense during 2013 was not taxable as it was incurred at the LLC level. In addition, other gains and losses incurred at the Company, which is an LLC, are not tax deductible as those costs are passed through to the shareholders. A portion of the acquisition costs expensed in the year ended December 31, 2012 in connection with the Arnold and Universal Circuits acquisitions are not tax deductible, and our losses incurred at the Company, which is an LLC, are not tax deductible at the corporate level as those costs are passed through to the shareholders. For the year ended December 31, 2012, these two items accounted for 3.0% and 31.1%, respectively, of the increased effective tax rate compared to the Federal statutory rate at December 31, 2012. The components of income tax expense as a percentage of income from continuing operations before income taxes for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 are as follows: United States Federal Statutory Rate Foreign and State income taxes (net of Federal benefits) Expenses of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC representing a pass through to shareholders Effect of deconsolidation of subsidiary (1) Effect of supplemental put expense (reversal) (2) Impact of subsidiary employee stock options Domestic production activities deduction (cid:2)on-deductible acquisition costs (cid:2)on-recognition of (cid:2)OL carryforwards at subsidiaries Other Effective income tax rate Year ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 35.0% (1.1) 0.7 (30.8) — 0.1 (0.3) 0.1 0.2 (1.1) 2.8% 35.0% 1.9 1.5 — (16.2) 0.4 (1.8) — 3.1 (3.1) 20.8% 35.0% 11.7 10.2 — 20.9 (1.8) (4.1) 3.0 4.8 (1.1) 78.6% (1) The effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2014 includes a significant gain at our parent, which is taxed as a partnership, related to the deconsolidation of FOX in July 2014. (2) The effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2013 includes a gain at our parent, which is taxed as a partnership, related to the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement in July 2013. Reconciliation of (cid:2)on-GAAP Financial Measures From time to time we may publicly disclose certain “non-GAAP” financial measures in the course of our investor presentations, earnings releases, earnings conference calls or other venues. A non-GAAP financial measure is a numerical measure of historical or future performance, financial position or cash flow that excludes amounts, or is subject to adjustments that effectively exclude amounts, included in the most directly comparable measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP in our financial statements, and vice versa for measures that include amounts, or are subject to adjustments that effectively include amounts, that are excluded from the most directly comparable measure as calculated and presented. GAAP refers to generally accepted accounting principles in the United States. (cid:2)on-GAAP financial measures are provided as additional information to investors in order to provide them with an alternative method for assessing our financial condition and operating results. These measures are not meant to be a substitute for GAAP, and may be different from or otherwise inconsistent with non-GAAP financial measures used by other companies. The tables below reconcile the most directly comparable GAAP financial measures to EBITDA, Adjusted EBITDA and Cash Flow Available for Distribution and Reinvestment (“CAD”). Reconciliation of (cid:2)et income (loss) to EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA EBITDA – Earnings before Interest, Income Taxes, Depreciation and Amortization (“EBITDA”) is calculated as net income (loss) before interest expense, income tax expense (benefit), depreciation expense and amortization expense. Amortization expenses consist of amortization of intangibles and debt charges, including debt issuance costs, discounts, etc. 118 Adjusted EBITDA – Is calculated utilizing the same calculation as described above in arriving at EBITDA further adjusted by: (i) non- controlling stockholder compensation, which generally consists of non-cash stock option expense; (ii) successful acquisition costs, which consist of transaction costs (legal, accounting , due diligences, etc.) incurred in connection with the successful acquisition of a business expensed during the period in compliance with ASC 805; (iii) increases or decreases in supplemental put charges for periods prior to July 1, 2013, which reflected the estimated potential liability due to our Manager that required us to acquire their Allocation Interests in the Company at a price based on a percentage of the fair value in our businesses over their original basis plus a hurdle rate; (iv) management fees, which reflect fees due quarterly to our Manager in connection with our MSA; (v) impairment charges, which reflect write downs to goodwill or other intangible assets; (vi) the gain related to the deconsolidation of FOX during the year ended December 31, 2014; (vii) gains or losses recorded in connection with changes in the fair value of our investment in FOX; and (viii) gains or losses recorded in connection with the sale of fixed assets. We believe that EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA provide useful information to investors and reflect important financial measures as they exclude the effects of items which reflect the impact of long-term investment decisions, rather than the performance of near term operations. When compared to net income (loss) these financial measures are limited in that they do not reflect the periodic costs of certain capital assets used in generating revenues of our businesses or the non-cash charges associated with impairments. This presentation also allows investors to view the performance of our businesses in a manner similar to the methods used by us and the management of our businesses, provides additional insight into our operating results and provides a measure for evaluating targeted businesses for acquisition. We believe these measurements are also useful in measuring our ability to service debt and other payment obligations. EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA are not meant to be a substitute for GAAP, and may be different from or otherwise inconsistent with non-GAAP financial measures used by other companies. The following table reconciles EBITDA and Adjusted EBITDA to net income (loss), which we consider to be the most comparable GAAP financial measure (in thousands): Adjusted EBITDA Year ended December 31, 2014 (cid:2)et income (loss) (1) Adjusted for: Provision (benefit) for income taxes Interest expense, net Intercompany interest Depreciation and amortization Loss on debt extinguishment Corporate CamelBak Ergobaby Liberty Advanced Circuits American Furniture Arnold Magnetics Clean Earth Sterno Candle Lamp Tridien Consolidated $257,305 $ 4,614 $ 8,159 $ (4,488) $11,101 $ 1,485 $ 229 $ (1,317) $ (2,008) $ 1,028 $ 276,108 (191) 3,144 4,735 (3,084) 4,406 26,509 7 (42,192) 9,917 413 13,830 2,143 — 25 4,917 4,159 — — 4,572 6,538 — (2) 6,561 4,977 — 28 — 2,222 228 — (966) (275) (1,537) (2) 7,219 8,884 — 151 3,997 6,776 — — 1,645 4,707 — 47 1 1,142 2,561 — 6,307 26,689 — 53,073 2,143 EBITDA 243,987 31,512 21,995 3,538 27,043 3,963 15,364 9,332 2,807 4,779 364,320 Loss on sale of fixed assets (cid:2)on-controlling shareholder compensation Acquisition expenses Gain on deconsolidation of subsidiary Gain on equity method investment Integration services fee Management fees — — — (264,325) (11,029) — 143 945 — — — — 661 — — — 17 371 96 — — — 6 23 — — — — 19,622 500 500 500 500 — — — — — — — 324 134 — — — 500 9 — 424 1,983 124 2,765 — — 625 125 — — 375 125 26 19 — 525 2,701 4,844 — (264,325) — — 350 (11,029) 1,000 22,722 Adjusted EBITDA $ (11,745) $33,100 $23,156 $ 4,522 $27,572 $ 3,963 $16,322 $12,498 $ 6,196 $ 5,174 $ 120,758 (1) As a result of the deconsolidation of our FOX subsidiary in July 2014, (cid:2)et income (loss) in the above schedule does not include (cid:2)et Income from FOX of $15.0 million for the period January 1, 2014 through July 10, 2014, and Adjusted EBITDA does not include Adjusted EBITDA of $25.1 million for FOX for the period January 1, 2014 through July 10, 2014. 119 Adjusted EBITDA Year ended December 31, 2013 (cid:2)et income (loss) Adjusted for: Provision (benefit) for income taxes Interest expense, net Intercompany interest Depreciation and amortization Loss on debt extinguishment EBITDA (Gain) loss on sale of fixed assets (cid:2)on-controlling shareholder compensation Impairment charges Acquisition expenses Supplemental put expense (reversal) Management fees Adjusted EBITDA Corporate CamelBak Ergobaby FOX Liberty Advanced Circuits American Furniture Arnold Tridien Consolidated $ 41,482 $ 4,010 $ 4,057 $ 24,104 $ 5,487 $ 9,167 $ (1,680) $ 1,586 $ (9,397) $ 78,816 (98) 2,198 2,603 10,566 19,139 (41,191) (1,541) 1,785 (4) 11,163 13,512 — 2 5,636 4,025 — 218 2,179 9,435 — 2,374 — 4,370 6,421 — 5,681 (2) 7,490 5,438 — 19,576 30,879 16,323 46,502 18,652 27,774 — — — — (45,995) 15,474 14 945 — — — 500 23 606 — — — 500 (7) 2,500 — — 308 — 391 — — — 500 (18) 23 — — — 500 13 — 1,755 291 — 379 — — — — — — (535) (2,073) 22 7,432 8,504 — 1 1,166 2,241 — 20,729 19,376 — 48,326 1,785 17,009 (8,062) 169,032 40 145 — — — 500 43 73 12,918 — — 350 95 4,683 12,918 — (45,995) 18,632 $ (10,945) $ 32,338 $ 17,452 $ 49,303 $ 19,543 $ 28,279 $ 379 $ 17,694 $ 5,322 $ 159,365 Adjusted EBITDA Year ended December 31, 2012 Corporate CamelBak Ergobaby FOX Liberty Advanced Circuits American Furniture Arnold Magnetics Tridien Consolidated $ (25,979) $ 6,823 $ 2,626 $ 14,208 $ 723 $ 11,969 $ (3,391) $ (5,156) $ 2,517 $ (9,868) (87) 5,138 24,937 (39,796) (590) 22 13,046 13,558 1,638 25 6,295 4,620 8,181 16 2,880 7,786 518 — 4,473 7,286 6,554 (2) 5,081 5,298 23 5 1,688 336 (1,946) 1,050 (2) 6,272 9,703 21,069 25,001 — — 61 2,355 50,352 (41,515) 38,587 15,204 33,071 13,000 28,900 (1,339) 8,871 5,983 100,762 1,413 — — 296 15,995 14,408 — 15 922 — — 500 — — 465 — — 500 — 253 2,148 — — 500 — (19) 301 — — 500 — — 24 366 — 500 — 11 216 — — — — 18 69 4,539 — 375 — 15 91 — — 350 1,413 293 4,236 5,201 15,995 17,633 $ (9,403) $ 40,024 $ 16,169 $ 35,972 $ 13,782 $ 29,790 $ (1,112) $ 13,872 $ 6,439 $ 145,533 (cid:2)et income (loss) Adjusted for: Provision (benefit) for income taxes Interest expense, net Intercompany interest Depreciation and amortization EBITDA Income (loss), gain (loss) from discontinued operations (Gain) loss on sale of fixed assets (cid:2)on-controlling shareholder compensation Acquisition expenses Supplemental put expense Management fees Adjusted EBITDA (1) (1) As a result of the sale of our HALO subsidiary in May 2012, Adjusted EBITDA does not include EBITDA from HALO for the period January 1, 2012 through April 30, 2012 of $2.2 million The table below details cash receipts and payments that are not reflected on our income statement in order to provide an additional measure of management’s estimate of cash CAD. CAD is a non-GAAP measure that we believe provides additional information to our shareholders in order to enable them to evaluate our ability to make anticipated quarterly distributions. Because other entities do not necessarily calculate CAD the same way we do, our presentation of CAD may not be comparable to similarly titled measures provided by other 120 entities. We believe that our historic and future CAD, together with our cash balances and access to cash via our debt facilities, will be sufficient to meet our anticipated distributions over the next twelve months. The table below reconciles CAD to net income and to cash flow provided by operating activities, which we consider to be the most directly comparable financial measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP. (in thousands) (cid:2)et income Adjustment to reconcile net income to cash provided by operating activities: Depreciation and amortization Impairment expense Gain on sale of Staffmark Loss on sale of HALO Amortization of debt issuance costs and original issue discount Unrealized loss on interest rate hedges Loss on debt repayment Excess tax benefit from subsidiary stock option exercise (1) Supplemental put expense (reversal) (cid:2)oncontrolling stockholders charges Gain on deconsolidation of subsidiary Gain on equity method investment Deferred taxes Other Changes in operating assets and liabilities (cid:2)et cash provided by operating activities Plus: Unused fee on revolving credit facility (2) Excess tax benefit from subsidiary stock option exercise (1) Successful acquisition expense Integration services agreement (3) Sale related expenses Changes in operating assets and liabilities Less: Changes in operating assets and liabilities Payment on interest rate swap Other Maintenance capital expenditures: (4) Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC Advanced Circuits American Furniture Arnold CamelBak Clean Earth ERGObaby FOX Halo (divested May 2012) Liberty SternoCandleLamp 121 Year Ended December 31, 2014 291,155 $ Year Ended December 31, 2013 78,816 $ Year Ended December 31, 2012 4,340 $ 55,696 — — — 3,125 7,722 2,143 (1,662) — 4,744 (264,325) (11,029) (8,601) 1,442 (9,715) 70,695 1,914 1,662 4,844 1,000 — 9,715 — 2,008 528 — 568 504 3,078 2,492 1,944 912 2,381 — 848 126 46,227 12,918 — — 3,366 130 1,785 — (45,995) 4,683 — — (5,257) (87) (24,212) 72,374 2,349 — — — 24,212 — — — — 3,220 298 2,839 815 — 1,504 3,932 — 1,031 — 49,450 — (219) 464 4,169 2,175 — — 15,995 4,236 — — (2,060) 986 (26,970) 52,566 2,666 — 5,201 1,976 26,970 — — 668 — 878 (133) 2,382 1,364 — 843 4,096 320 441 — Tridien FOX CAD (5) Estimated cash flow available for distribution and reinvestment Distribution paid in April 2014/2013 Distribution paid in July 2014/2013 Distribution paid in October 2014/2013 Distribution paid in January 2015/2014 784 15,716 57,992 $ (17,388) $ (17,388) (17,388) (19,548) (71,712) $ 569 11,189 73,538 $ (17,388) $ (17,388) (17,388) (17,388) (69,552) $ 807 — 69,002 (17,388) (17,388) (17,388) (17,388) (69,552) $ $ $ (1) Represents the non-cash excess tax benefit at FOX related to the exercise of stock options. (2) Represents the commitment fees on the unused portion of our 2011 Revolving Credit Facility and 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. (3) Represents fees paid by newly acquired companies to the Manager for integration services performed during the first year of ownership, payable quarterly. (4) Represents maintenance capital expenditures that were funded from operating cash flow and excludes growth capital expenditures of approximately $1.6 million, $7.5 million and $10.6 million incurred during the year ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. (5) Represents FOX CAD subsequent to the IPO date. For the year ended December 31, 2014, the amount includes $24.2 million of EBITDA, less: $3.8 million of cash taxes, $1.9 million of management fees, $2.4 million of maintenance capital expenditures and $0.4 million of interest expense. Earnings of certain of our businesses are seasonal in nature. Earnings from Liberty are typically lowest in the second quarter due to lower demand for safes at the onset of summer. Cash flows from American Furniture are typically highest in the months of January through April of each year, coinciding with homeowners’ tax refunds. Earnings from CamelBak are typically higher in the spring and summer months as this corresponds with warmer weather in the (cid:2)orthern Hemisphere and an increase in hydration related activities. Earnings from Clean Earth are typically lower during the winter months due to the limits on outdoor construction and dredging because of the colder weather in the (cid:2)ortheastern United States. Related Party Transactions and Certain Transactions Involving our Businesses We have entered into the following related party transactions with our Manager, CGM: • Management Services Agreement • LLC Agreement • Integration Services Agreement • Cost Reimbursement and Fees Management Services Agreement We entered into the MSA with CGM effective May 16, 2006. The MSA provides for, among other things, CGM to perform services for us in exchange for a management fee paid quarterly and equal to 0.5% of our adjusted net assets. The management fee is required to be paid prior to the payment of any distributions to shareholders. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, we incurred $22.7 million, $18.6 million and $17.6 million, respectively, in management fees to CGM (excludes offsetting fees paid by HALO). Pursuant to the MSA, CGM is entitled to enter into off-setting management service agreements with each of our segments. The amount of the fee is negotiated between CGM and the operating management of each segment and is based upon the value of the services to be provided. The fees paid directly to CGM by the segments offset on a dollar for dollar basis the amount due to CGM by the Company under the MSA. On July 1, 2013, we and our Manager amended the MSA to provide for certain modifications related to our Manager’s registration as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (“Advisor’s Act”), as amended. In connection with the amendment we and our Manager agreed to terminate the Supplemental Put Agreement, which had the effect of eliminating the Manager’s right to require us to purchase the Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA. Pursuant to the MSA, as amended, our Manager will continue to manage the day-to-day operations and affairs and oversee the management and operations of the 122 Company’s businesses, perform certain other services for which it will receive management fees, and the holders of the Allocation Interests will continue to receive the profit allocation upon the occurrence of a Sale Event or a Holding Event. On October 7, 2014 and effective as of September 30, 2014, the Company and CGM amended the MSA, as amended, to provide for certain modifications related to FOX no longer being a consolidated subsidiary. LLC Agreement As distinguished from its provision of providing management services to us, pursuant to the amended MSA, members of CGM are owners of 53.6% of the Allocation Interests in us through their ownership in Sostratus LLC. The LLC agreement gives the holders of Allocation Interests the right to distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of a Sale Event or a Holding Event. The Allocation Interest Holders are entitled to receive and as such can elect to receive the positive contribution- based profit allocation payment for each of the business acquisitions during the 30-day period following the fifth anniversary of the date upon which we acquired a controlling interest in that business (Holding Event) and upon the sale of the business (Sale Event). During the year ended December 31, 2014, we paid $11.9 million to holders of the Allocation interests related to FOX's secondary offering (Sale Event). During the year ended December 31, 2013, we paid $5.6 million to the holders of Allocation Interests related to FOX’s positive contribution-based profit (Holding Event) and $16.0 million as a result of FOX’s sale of common stock to the public (Sale Event). Certain persons who are employees and partners of the Manager, including the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, beneficially own 58.8% of the Allocation Interests, through Sostratus LLC, at December 31, 2014. Of the remaining 41.2% non-voting ownership of the Allocation Interests, 5.0% is held by CGI Diversified Holdings LP, 5.0% is held by the Chairman of the Company’s Board of Directors, and the remaining 31.2% is held by the former founding partner of the Manager. At December 31, 2013, 53.6% of the Allocation Interests were beneficially owned by certain persons who are employees and partners of the Manager, including the Company’s Chief Executive Officer. Of the remaining 46.4% non-voting ownership of the Allocation Interests, 5.0% was held by CGI Diversified Holdings LP, 5.0% was held by the Chairman of the Company’s Board of Directors, and 31.4% was held by the former founding partner of the Manager. A Director and the former Chief Financial Officer held 5.0% of the Allocation Interests until his retirement. The increase in beneficial ownership of the Allocation Interests by certain persons who are employees and partners of the Manager from 2013 to 2014 was a result of the retirement of the former Chief Financial Officer and the resulting assignment of Allocation Interests to other persons who are employees and partners of the Manager. The former Chief Financial Officer is entitled to continue to receive distributions from Sostratus LLC on his Allocation Interests earned prior to his retirement. Integration Services Agreement The 2014 acquisitions entered into Integration Services Agreements ("ISA") with CGM. The ISA provides for CGM to provide services for the 2014 acquisitions to, amongst other things, assist the management at the acquired entities in establishing a corporate governance program, including the retention of independent board members to serve on their board of directors, implement compliance and reporting requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act and align the acquired entity's policies and procedures with our other subsidiaries. Each ISA is for the twelve month period subsequent to the acquisition and is payable quarterly. Clean Earth will pay CGM $2.5 million and SternoCandleLamp will pay CGM $1.5 million under the agreements. During the year ended December 31, 2014, Clean Earth incurred $0.6 million in integration services fees, and SternoCandleLamp incurred $0.4 million. Cost Reimbursement and Fees We reimbursed CGM approximately $4.5 million, $3.5 million and $3.5 million, principally for occupancy and staffing costs incurred by CGM on our behalf during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. 123 Our businesses had the following significant related party transactions during 2014: FOX On July 10, 2014, 5,750,000 shares of FOX common stock, held by certain FOX shareholders, including us, were sold in a secondary offering at a price of $15.50 per share for total net proceeds to selling shareholders of approximately $84.4 million. As a selling shareholder, we sold a total of 4,466,569 shares of FOX common stock, including 633,955 shares sold in connection with the underwriters’ exercise of the over-allotment option in full, for total net proceeds of approximately $65.5 million. Upon completion of the offering, our ownership in FOX decreased from approximately 53% to 41%, or 15,108,718 shares of FOX’s common stock. We recorded a gain of $264.3 million in July 2014 in connection with the Fox deconsolidation. In September 2014, the Company and FOX entered into an agreement for the provision of services to FOX for assistance in complying the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as amended (the “Services Agreement”). The Services Agreement can be terminated by either party at any time, or will terminate on March 31, 2016. A statement of work was agreed to in connection with the Service Agreement, which provides that the Company’s internal audit team will assist FOX with various tasks, including, but not limited to, the development of internal control policies and procedures, risk and control matrices and the evaluation of internal controls. Services provided in accordance with the Services Agreement are billed on a time and materials basis. Fees for services provided in 2014 are estimated to be approximately $50,000 and fees for services to be provided in 2015 are estimated to be approximately $100,000. In January 2014, FOX hired the son-in-law of our Chairman to be its Vice-President of Business Development. Tridien Tridien leased a facility from an affiliate of a noncontrolling shareholder of Tridien during the year ended December 31, 2013. The terms of the lease was through February of 2014. Tridien paid rent under this leases of approximately $0.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. American Furniture American Furniture was not in compliance with its Maintenance Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio requirement included in the amended credit agreement with us dated December 31, 2010. We are required to fund, in the form of an additional equity investment, any shortfall in the difference between Adjusted EBITDA and Fixed Charges as defined in American Furniture’s credit agreement with us. Per the maintenance agreement, the shortfall that we are required to fund, American Furniture is in turn required to pay down its term debt with us. The amount of the shortfall at December 31, 2013 was approximately $1.6 million. There was no shortfall at December 31, 2014 as American Furniture was in compliance with the Maintenance Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio. Contractual Obligations and Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements We have no special purpose entities or off balance sheet arrangements, other than operating leases entered into in the ordinary course of business. Long-term contractual obligations, except for our long-term debt obligations, are generally not recognized in our consolidated balance sheet. (cid:2)on-cancelable purchase obligations are obligations we incur during the normal course of business, based on projected needs. 124 The table below summarizes the payment schedule of our contractual obligations at December 31, 2014 (in thousands): Long-term debt obligations (a) Operating lease obligations (b) Purchase obligations (c) Total (d) Total 596,357 93,636 258,740 948,733 Less than 1 Year 20,170 $ 15,050 161,653 196,873 $ $ $ $ $ 1-3 Years 3-5 Years More than 5 Years 43,938 24,828 49,587 118,353 $ $ 211,672 17,312 47,500 276,484 $ $ 320,577 36,446 — 357,023 (a) Reflects commitment fees and letter of credit fees under our Revolving Credit Facility and amounts due, together with interest on our Revolving Credit Facility and Term Loan Facility. (b) Reflects various operating leases for office space, manufacturing facilities and equipment from third parties. (c) Reflects non-cancelable commitments as of December 31, 2014, including: (i) shareholder distributions of $78.2 million, (ii) estimated management fees of $23.8 million per year over the next five years and; (iii) other obligations, including amounts due under employment agreements. Distributions to our shareholders are approved by our board of directors each fiscal quarter. The amount approved for future quarters may differ from the amount included in this schedule. (d) The contractual obligation table does not include approximately $0.7 million in liabilities associated with unrecognized tax benefits as of December 31, 2014 as the timing of the recognition of this liability is not certain. The amount of the liability is not expected to significantly change in the next twelve months. Critical Accounting Estimates The following discussion relates to critical accounting estimates for the Company, the Trust and each of our businesses at December 31, 2014. The preparation of our financial statements in conformity with GAAP will require management to adopt accounting policies and make estimates and judgments that affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from these estimates under different assumptions and judgments and uncertainties, and potentially could result in materially different results under different conditions. Our critical accounting estimates are discussed below. These critical accounting estimates are reviewed by our independent auditors and the audit committee of our board of directors. Revenue Recognition We recognize revenue when it is realized or realizable and earned. We consider revenue realized or realizable and earned when it has persuasive evidence of an arrangement, the product has been shipped or the services have been provided to the customer, the sales price is fixed or determinable and collectability is reasonably assured. Provisions for customer returns and other allowances based on historical experience are recognized at the time the related sale is recognized. Business Combinations The acquisitions of our businesses are accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting. The amounts assigned to the identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed in connection with acquisitions are based on estimated fair values as of the date of the acquisition, with the remainder, if any, to be recorded as identifiable intangibles or goodwill. The fair values are determined by our management team, taking into consideration information supplied by the management of the acquired entities and other relevant information. Such information typically includes valuations supplied by independent appraisal experts for significant business combinations. The valuations are generally based upon future cash flow projections for the acquired assets, discounted to present value. The determination of fair values requires significant judgment both by our management team and by outside experts engaged to assist in this process. This judgment could result in either a higher or lower value assigned to amortizable or depreciable assets. The impact could result in either higher or lower amortization and/or depreciation expense. Goodwill and Intangible Assets Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the assets acquired. We are required to perform impairment reviews at least annually and more frequently in certain circumstances. The estimates of future earnings and other market assumptions used to derive and test the fair value at each of our reporting units requires judgment on the part of management. Even minor adjustments to those values used and assumptions made can lead to significantly different results. 125 Annual goodwill and indefinite lived intangible assets impairment testing We review goodwill for impairment annually and whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate the carrying amount of goodwill may not be recoverable. Goodwill is tested for impairment at the reporting unit level. Each of our businesses represents a reporting unit except Arnold, which is comprised of three reporting units. We use March 31st as our annual date for impairment testing and all reporting units are tested with the exception of American Furniture. The balance of American Furniture’s goodwill was completely written off in 2011. We are permitted under applicable accounting standards to make a qualitative assessment of whether the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying value before applying the two-step goodwill impairment test. If a company concludes that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount it is not required to perform the two-step impairment test for that reporting unit. At March 31, 2014 we elected to use the qualitative assessment alternative to test goodwill for impairment for each of our reporting units that maintain a goodwill carrying value with the exception of two of the three reporting units at Arnold, Flexmag and Precision Thin Metals. We determined that two of the three reporting units at Arnold required further quantitative testing (step 1) because we could not conclude that the fair value of the reporting units exceeds their carrying value based on qualitative factors alone. Results of the quantitative analysis indicated that the fair value of these reporting units exceeded their carrying value. The fair value of the reporting unit was determined utilizing a discounted cash flow methodology ("DCF") on both an income and market approach for the Flexmag reporting unit and the income approach for Precision Thin Metals reporting unit. A representative market does not exist for Precision Thin metals. The DCF utilized a weighted average cost of capital of 12.5% for Flexmag and 14.5% for Precision Thin Metals. In conducting our qualitative assessment of reporting units as of March 31, 2014, we considered the following factors prior to performing Step 1 of the goodwill impairment test: • Macroeconomic conditions such as deterioration in general economic conditions, limitations on accessing capital, • fluctuations in foreign exchange rates, or other developments in equity and credit markets; Industry and market considerations such as deterioration in the environment in which an entity operates, an increased competitive environment, a decline (both absolute and relative to its peers) in market-dependent multiples or metrics, a change in the market for an entity’s products or services, or a regulatory or political development; • Cost factor, such as increases in raw materials, labor, or other costs that have a negative effect on earnings and cash flows; • Overall financial performance such as negative or declining cash flows or a decline in actual or planned revenue or earnings compared with actual or planned revenue or earnings compared with actual and projected results of relevant prior periods; • Other relevant entity-specific events such as litigation, contemplation of bankruptcy, or changes in management, key personnel, strategy, or customers; • Events affecting a reporting unit such as change in the composition or carrying amount of its net assets, a more-likely- than-not expectation of selling or disposing of all or a portion, of a reporting unit, the testing for recoverability of a significant asset group within a reporting unit, or a recognition of a goodwill impairment loss in the financial statements of a subsidiary that is a component of a reporting unit; and Sustained decrease (both absolute and relative to its peers) in share price, if applicable. • In addition to considering the above factors we performed the following procedures as of March 31, 2014 for each of our reporting units except for the Arnold Flexmag and Precision Thin Metals reporting units: • Compared and assessed Trailing Twelve month (“TTM”) net sales as of March 31, 2014 to TTM nets sales as of March 31, 2013: • Compared and assessed TTM operating income as of March 31, 2014 to TTM operating income as of March 31, 2013; • Compared and assessed TTM Adjusted EBITDA as of March 31, 2014 to Adjusted EBITDA as of March 31, 2013; • Compared and assessed Adjusted EBITDA for the year-ended December 31, 2013 to Budget; • Compared and assessed Adjusted EBITDA for the three-months ended March 31, 2014 to Budget; • Compared the fair value of each of our RU to its carrying amount using the same metrics as those used in determining the value of the supplemental put as of March 31, 2014 and concluded that in each case the fair value of the RU was in excess of its carrying amount; and Performed Market Cap reconciliation for CODI and determined that CODI’s public market cap was significantly in excess of the fair value of its consolidated equity (as derived from the aforementioned supplemental put analysis). • Based on our qualitative assessment as outlined above we believe that the fair value of each of our reporting units exceeds their carrying value at March 31, 2014. In connection with the annual goodwill impairment testing, we test other indefinite-lived intangible assets (trade names) at our reporting units. We are permitted to make a qualitative assessment of whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of an individual reporting unit's indefinite lived assets exceeds its carrying amount before applying a quantitative analysis. If a company 126 concludes that it is not more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit’s indefinite-lived assets exceeds its carrying amount it is not required to perform a quantitative test for that reporting unit. At March 31, 2014 we elected to use the qualitative assessment alternative to test indefinite-lived assets for impairment for each of our reporting units that record indefinite lived assets. At that time it was determined that the fair value of indefinite lived assets at each of our reporting units exceeded its carrying amount. Long-lived intangible assets subject to amortization, including customer relationships, non-compete agreements, permits and technology are amortized using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the intangible assets, which we determine based on the consideration of several factors including the period of time the asset is expected to remain in service. We evaluate long-lived assets for potential impairment whenever events occur or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of the assets may not be recoverable. The carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not recoverable if it exceeds the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected to result from the use and eventual disposition of the asset. If the carrying amount of a long-lived asset is not recoverable and is greater than its fair value, the asset is impaired and an impairment loss must be recognized. The determination of fair values and estimated useful lives requires significant judgment both by our management team and by outside experts engaged to assist in this process. This judgment could result in either a higher or lower value assigned to our reporting units and intangible assets. The impact could result in either higher or lower amortization and/or the incurrence of an impairment charge Liberty Safe During the third quarter of 2014 net sales and gross profit margins declined significantly at Liberty. In addition, Liberty recorded an inventory write down in June 2014 resulting from its decision to sell a portion of their finished goods inventory (import safes) at a price below their carrying value. We believe that the significant decline in sales over the past two fiscal quarters and resulting excess finished goods inventory is due almost exclusively to an overzealous market for firearms and as a by-product, gun safes, in fiscal 2012 and 2013. We also currently believe that the market for gun safes will begin to stabilize in 2015 after retailers inventories begin to normalize. If Liberty Safe does not believe it can achieve the financial performance that we and the management of Liberty Safe expect in 2015, it is possible that a goodwill impairment charge may result. The carrying value of goodwill at Liberty Safe is approximately $32.8 million. There can be no assurance that future events will not result in an impairment of goodwill. Tridien In January 2015, one of Tridien’s largest customers informed the Company they will not renew their Purchase Agreement when it expires on September 30, 2015. This customer represented 20% of Tridien’s sales in 2014. The expected lost sales and net income are significant enough to trigger an interim goodwill and indefinite-lived asset impairment analysis which will be performed during the first quarter of 2015. At December 31, 2014, Tridien had goodwill of $16.8 million and indefinite lived intangibles of $0.1 million recorded on its balance sheet. It is possible that the result of the lost sales and net income from this customer may result in a goodwill impairment. Allowance for Doubtful Accounts We record an allowance for doubtful accounts on an entity-by-entity basis with consideration for historical loss experience, customer payment patterns and current economic trends. The Company reviews the adequacy of the allowance for doubtful accounts on a periodic basis and adjusts the balance, if necessary. The determination of the adequacy of the allowance for doubtful accounts requires significant judgment by management. The impact of either over or under estimating the allowance could have a material effect on future operating results. The consolidated allowance for doubtful accounts is approximately $5.2 million at December 31, 2014. Deferred Tax Assets Several of our majority owned subsidiaries have deferred tax assets recorded at December 31, 2014 which in total amount to approximately $17.0 million. This deferred tax asset is net of $12.7 million of valuation allowance primarily associated with AFM and Tridien’s inability to utilize loss carryforwards associated with impairments in 2010, 2011, and 2013. These deferred tax assets are comprised primarily of reserves not currently deductible for tax purposes. The temporary differences that have resulted in the recording of these tax assets may be used to offset taxable income in future periods, reducing the amount of taxes we might 127 otherwise be required to pay. Realization of the deferred tax assets is dependent on generating sufficient future taxable income. Based upon the expected future results of operations, we believe it is more likely than not that we will generate sufficient future taxable income to realize the benefit of existing temporary differences, although there can be no assurance of this. The impact of not realizing these deferred tax assets would result in an increase in income tax expense for such period when the determination was made that the assets are not realizable. (Refer to (cid:2)ote L – “Income taxes" in the notes to consolidated financial statements.) Supplemental Put Agreement Supplemental Put Agreement Termination In connection with the Management Service Agreement (“MSA”), we entered into a Supplemental Put Agreement with the Manager at the time of our Initial Public Offering. Pursuant to the Supplemental Put Agreement, the Manager had the right to cause us to purchase the Allocation Interests then owned by the Manager upon termination of the MSA for a price to be determined in accordance with the Supplemental Put Agreement. The Allocation Interests entitle the holders to receive distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of certain events. The distributions of profit allocation will be paid only upon the occurrence of the sale of a material amount of capital stock or assets of one of our businesses (“Sale Event”) or, at the option of the Manager, at each five year anniversary date of the acquisition of our businesses (“Holding Event”). We historically recorded the Supplemental Put obligation at the fair value of the profit allocation amount. This amount has been determined using a model that multiplies the trailing twelve-month EBITDA for each business unit by an estimated enterprise value multiple to determine an estimated selling price of the business unit. This amount represented our obligation to physically settle the purchase of the Allocation Interest at the option of the Manager upon the termination of the MSA. We recorded increases or decreases in the obligation under the Supplemental Put obligation through the consolidated statement of operations. On July 1, 2013, the Company and the Manager amended the MSA to provide for certain modifications related to the Manager’s registration as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (“Advisor’s Act”), as amended. In connection with the amendment resulting from the Manager’s registration as an investment adviser under the Adviser’s Act, the Company and the Manager agreed to terminate the Supplemental Put Agreement, which had the effect of eliminating the Manager’s right to require us to purchase the Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA. Pursuant to the MSA, as amended, the Manager will continue to manage the day-to-day operations and affairs of the Company, oversee the management and operations of our businesses, perform certain other services for us and receive management fees, and the holders of the Allocation Interests will continue to receive the profit allocation upon the occurrence of a Sale Event or a Holding Event. As a result of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, we derecognized the supplemental put liability associated with the Manager’s put right, reversing the accumulated $61.3 million liability through supplemental put expense on the condensed consolidated statement of operations during the year ended December 31, 2013. We will record future Holding Events and Sale Events as liabilities when dividends declared on Allocations Interests are approved by our board of directors. In addition we will include the estimated allocation interests due for Holding Events as a component of basic and diluted earnings per share under the two-class method. The determination of distributions due to allocation interests requires significant judgment both by our management team and by outside experts engaged to assist in this process. This judgment could result in either a higher or lower value assigned to the estimated distribution. The impact could result in either higher or lower basic and diluted earnings per share. Recent Accounting Pronouncements Refer to footnote B to our consolidated financial statements. ITEM 7A. – Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk Interest Rate Sensitivity At December 31, 2014, we were exposed to interest rate risk primarily through borrowings under our 2014 Credit Facility because borrowings under this agreement are subject to variable interest rates. We had $323.4 million outstanding under the 2014 Term Loan Facility at December 31, 2014. We have entered into two interest rate swaps as of December 31, 2014. On October 30, 2011, we purchased a three-year interest rate swap with a notional amount of $200 million that is effective January 1, 2011 through March 31, 2016. This swap requires us to pay interest on the notional amount at the rate of 2.49% in exchange for the three-month LIBOR rate, with a floor of 1.5%. On September 16, 2014, we purchased an interest rate swap with a notional amount of $220 million. This swap is effective April 1, 2016 through June 6, 2021, the termination date of our 2014 Term Loan, and requires us to pay interest at rates on the notional amount at 2.97% in exchange for the three-month LIBOR rate. 128 Interest on our Term Loan is subject to a LIBOR floor of 1.0% and three-month LIBOR is currently 26 basis points. We currently estimate that a 100 basis point increase in LIBOR would not have a material impact on our results of operations, cash flows or financial condition. We expect to borrow under our Revolving Credit Facility in the future in order to finance our short term working capital needs and future acquisitions. These borrowings will be subject to variable interest rates. Exchange Rate Sensitivity At December 31, 2014, we were not exposed to significant foreign currency exchange rate risks that could have a material effect on our financial condition or results of operations. Credit Risk We are exposed to credit risk associated with cash equivalents, investments, and trade receivables. We do not believe that our cash equivalents or investments present significant credit risks because the counterparties to the instruments consist of major financial institutions and we manage the notional amount of contracts entered into with any one counterparty. Our cash and cash equivalents at December 31, 2014 consists principally of (i) treasury backed securities, (ii) insured prime money market funds, (iii) FDIC insured Certificates of Deposit, and (iv) cash balances in several non-interest bearing checking accounts. Substantially all trade receivable balances of our businesses are unsecured. The concentration of credit risk with respect to trade receivables is limited by the large number of customers in our customer base and their dispersion across various industries and geographic areas. Although we have a large number of customers who are dispersed across different industries and geographic areas, a prolonged economic downturn could increase our exposure to credit risk on our trade receivables. We perform ongoing credit evaluations of our customers and maintain an allowance for potential credit losses. Equity Method Investment We account for our investment in FOX using the equity method of accounting fair value option therefore our investment in FOX is subject to changes in the stock price of FOX. FOX trades on the (cid:2)ASDAQ stock market under the ticker “FOXF”. ITEM 8. – FI(cid:2)A(cid:2)CIAL STATEME(cid:2)TS A(cid:2)D SUPPLEME(cid:2)TARY DATA The consolidated financial statements and financial statement schedules referred to in the index contained on page F-1 of this report are incorporated herein by reference. ITEM 9. – CHA(cid:2)GES A(cid:2)D DISAGREEME(cid:2)TS WITH ACCOU(cid:2)TA(cid:2)TS O(cid:2) ACCOU(cid:2)TI(cid:2)G A(cid:2)D FI(cid:2)A(cid:2)CIAL DISCLOSURE (cid:2)O(cid:2)E ITEM 9A – CO(cid:2)TROLS A(cid:2)D PROCEDURES Disclosure Controls and Procedures (a) Management’s Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures. The Company’s management, with the participation of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, has evaluated the effectiveness of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as such term is defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”)) as of the end of the period covered by this report. Based on such evaluation, the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that, as of December 31, 2014, the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective in recording, processing, summarizing and reporting, on a timely basis, information required to be disclosed by the Company in the reports that it files or submits under the Exchange Act and in ensuring that information required to be disclosed by the Company in such reports is accumulated and communicated to the Company’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely discussions regarding require disclosure. (b) Information with respect to Report of Management on Internal Control over Financial Reporting Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 as amended (the Exchange Act)). Our management assessed the effectiveness 129 of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014. In making this assessment, our management used the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”) in Internal Control- Integrated Framework (2013 framework). Based on our assessment under the framework in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013 framework), our management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2014. The audited financial statements of the Company included in this annual report on 10-K include the results of acquisitions from their respective dates of acquisition. Management's assessment of internal control over financial reporting for the year ended December 31, 2014 does not include an assessment of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. or Sternocandlelamp Holdings, Inc., majority owned subsidiaries of the Company that were acquired during the year ended December 31, 2014. The financial statements of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and Sternocandlelamp Holdings, Inc. reflect total assets and revenues constituting 21.2% and 10.7%, respectively, of the related consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended December 31, 2104. Refer to "(cid:2)ote C - Acquisition of Businesses" for a description of the acquisitions of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and Sternocandlelamp Holdings, Inc. The effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014 has been audited by Grant Thornton LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report that is included herein. (c) Information with respect to Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control over Financial Reporting is contained on page F- 3 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K and is incorporated herein by reference. (d) Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting There have not been any changes in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting (as such term is defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) during our fourth fiscal quarter to which this Annual Report on Form 10-K relates that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. ITEM 9B. – OTHER I(cid:2)FORMATIO(cid:2) (cid:2)one PART III ITEM 10. – DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS A(cid:2)D CORPORATE GOVER(cid:2)A(cid:2)CE Information concerning our executive officers is incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2015 Annual Meeting of Shareholders. Information with respect to our directors and the nomination process is incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2015 Annual Meeting of Shareholders. Information regarding our audit committee and our audit committee financial experts is incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2015 Annual Meeting of Shareholders. Information required by Item 405 of Regulation S-K is incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2015 Annual Meeting of Shareholders. ITEM 11. – EXECUTIVE COMPE(cid:2)SATIO(cid:2) Information with respect to executive compensation is incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2015 Annual Meeting of Shareholders. ITEM 12. – SECURITY OW(cid:2)ERSHIP OF CERTAI(cid:2) BE(cid:2)EFICIAL OW(cid:2)ERS A(cid:2)D MA(cid:2)AGEME(cid:2)T A(cid:2)D RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS Information with respect to security ownership of certain beneficial owners and management is incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2015 Annual Meeting of Shareholders. 130 ITEM 13. – CERTAI(cid:2) RELATIO(cid:2)SHIPS A(cid:2)D RELATED PARTY TRA(cid:2)SACTIO(cid:2)S, A(cid:2)D DIRECTOR I(cid:2)DEPE(cid:2)DE(cid:2)CE Information with respect to such contractual relationships and independence is incorporated herein by reference to the information in the Proxy Statement for our 2015 Annual Meeting of Shareholders. ITEM 14. – PRI(cid:2)CIPAL ACCOU(cid:2)TA(cid:2)T FEES A(cid:2)D SERVICES Information with respect to principal accounting fees and services and pre-approval policies are incorporated herein by reference to information included in the Proxy Statement for our 2015 Annual Meeting of Shareholders. 131 PART IV ITEM 15. – EXHIBITS A(cid:2)D FI(cid:2)A(cid:2)CIAL STATEME(cid:2)T SCHEDULES 1. Financial Statements See “Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplemental Data” set forth on page F-1. 2. Financial Statement schedule See “Index to Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplemental Data” set forth on page F-1. 3. Exhibits See “Index to Exhibits” set forth on page E-1. 132 Exhibit (cid:2)umber 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.10 3.11 4.1 4.2 I(cid:2)DEX TO EXHIBITS Description Stock and (cid:2)ote Purchase Agreement dated as of July 31, 2006, among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Group Investments, Inc. and Compass Medical Mattress Partners, LP (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated June 24, 2008, among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and the other shareholders party thereto, Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sellers’ Representative, Aeroglide Holdings, Inc. and Bühler AG (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on June 26, 2008 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement, dated October 17, 2011, by and among Recruit Co., LTD. and RGF Staffing USA, Inc., as Buyers, the shareholders of Staffmark Holdings, Inc., as Sellers, Staffmark Holdings, Inc. and Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC as Seller Representative (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on October 18, 2011 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated May 1, 2012, among Candlelight Investment Holdings, Inc., Halo Holding Corporation, Halo Lee Wayne, LLC and each of the holders of equity interests of Halo Lee Wayne, LLC listed on Exhibit A thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 2, 2012 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Certificate of Trust of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form S-1 filed on December 14, 2005 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Certificate of Amendment to Certificate of Trust of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 8-K filed on September 13, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Certificate of Formation of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.3 of the Form S-1 filed on December 14, 2005 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.5 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 4 to the Form S-1 filed on April 26, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Amendment (cid:2)o. 1 to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006, of Compass Diversified Trust among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of (cid:2)ew York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 29, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Second Amendment to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006, as amended on May 23, 2007, of Compass Diversified Trust among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of (cid:2)ew York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Form 8-K filed on September 13, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Third Amendment to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement dated as of April 25, 2006, as amended on May 25, 2007 and September 14, 2007, of Compass Diversified Holdings among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of (cid:2)ew York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Form 8-K filed on December 21, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Fourth Amendment dated as of (cid:2)ovember 1, 2010 to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, as amended effective (cid:2)ovember 1, 2010, of Compass Diversified Holdings, originally effective as of April 25, 2006, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of (cid:2)ew York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 10-Q filed on (cid:2)ovember 8, 2010 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Second Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC dated January 9, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on January 10, 2007, (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Third Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC dated (cid:2)ovember 1, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Form 10-Q filed on (cid:2)ovember 8, 2010 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Fourth Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, dated January 1, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 10-Q filed on May 7, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Specimen Certificate evidencing a share of trust of Compass Diversified Holdings (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Form S-3 filed on (cid:2)ovember 7, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 333-147218)). Specimen LLC Interest Certificate evidencing an interest of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit A of Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on January 10, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). 133 10.1 10.2 10.3† 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10.8 10.9 10.10 10.11 10.12 10.13 10.14 10.15 10.16 10.17 10.18 10.19† Form of Registration Rights Agreement by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and Certain Shareholders (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 5 to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Form of Supplemental Put Agreement by and between Compass Group Management LLC and Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 4 to the Form S-1 filed on April 26, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated as of December 1, 2008 by and between James J. Bottiglieri and Compass Group Management LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K filed on December 3, 2008 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Form of Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 5 to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Form of Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and Pharos I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 5 to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Amended and Restated Management Services Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC, dated as of December 20, 2011 and originally effective as of May 16, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.06 of the Form 10-K filed on March 7, 2012 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Registration Rights Agreement by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP, dated as of April 3, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 1 to the Form S-1 filed on April 20, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 333-141856)). Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP, dated as of April 3, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.16 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 1 to the Form S-1 filed on April 20, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 333-141856)). Subscription Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Holdings and CGI Magyar Holdings, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Registration Rights Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Holdings and CGI Magyar Holdings, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Credit Agreement dated as of October 27, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, the financial institutions party thereto and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on October 27, 2011 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Second Amendment to Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, the financial institutions party thereto and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC, dated as of April 2, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on April 3, 2012 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Incremental Facility Amendment to Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC, dated as of April 2, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Form 8-K filed on April 3, 2012 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Third Amendment to Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC dated as of April 3, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K filed on April 3, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 0001-34927)). Incremental Facility Amendment to Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC, dated as of April 3, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on April 3, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, the financial institutions party thereto and Bank of America, (cid:2).A., dated as of June 6, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 8-K filed on June 9, 2014 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Fifth Amended and Restated Management Services Agreement dated July 1, 2013 and originally effective as of May 16, 2006, by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on July 1, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Sixth Amended and Restated Management Service Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC, dated as of September 30, 2014 and originally effective as of May 16, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on October 7, 2014 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Employment Agreement dated July 11, 2013, between Compass Group Management LLC and Ryan J. Faulkingham (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on July 11, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). 21.1* List of Subsidiaries 134 23.1* 31.1* 31.2* 32.1*+ 32.2*+ 99.1 99.2 99.3 99.4 99.5 99.6 99.7 99.8 99.9 99.10 99.11 Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of Chief Executive Officer of Registrant Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of Chief Financial Officer of Registrant Section 1350 Certification of Chief Executive Officer of Registrant Section 1350 Certification of Chief Financial Officer of Registrant (cid:2)ote Purchase and Sale Agreement dated as of July 31, 2006 among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Group Investments, Inc. and Compass Medical Mattress Partners, LP (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of February 28, 2007, by and between HA-LO Holdings, LLC and HALO Holding Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.3 of the Form 8-K filed on March 1, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Purchase Agreement dated December 19, 2007, among CBS Personnel Holdings, Inc. and Staffing Holding LLC, Staffmark Merger LLC, Staffmark Investment LLC, SF Holding Corp., Stephens-SM LLC and CBS Personnel Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form8-K filed on December 20, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Share Purchase Agreement dated January 4, 2008, among Fox Factory Holding Corp., Fox Factory, Inc. and Robert C. Fox, Jr. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on January 8, 2008 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated May 8, 2008, among Mitsui Chemicals, Inc., Silvue Technologies Group, Inc., the stockholders of Silvue Technologies Group, Inc. and the holders of Options listed on the signature pages thereto, and Compass Group Management LLC, as the Stockholders Representative (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 9, 2008 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated March 31, 2010 by and among Gable 5, Inc., Liberty Safe and Security Products, LLC and Liberty Safe Holding Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8- K filed on April 1, 2010 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated September 16, 2010, by and among ERGO Baby Intermediate Holding Corporation, The ERGO Baby Carrier, Inc., Karin A. Frost, in her individual capacity and as Trustee of the Revocable Trust of Karin A. Frost dated February 22, 2008 and as Trustee of the Karin A. Frost 2009 Qualified Annuity Trust u/a/d 12/21/2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on September 17, 2010 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Securities Purchase Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among CBK Holdings, LLC, CamelBak Products, LLC, CamelBak Acquisition Corp., for purposes of Section 6.15 and Articles 10 only, Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and for purposes of Section 6.13 and Article 10 only, IPC/CamelBak LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of March 5, 2012, by and among Arnold Magnetic Technologies Holdings Corporation, Arnold Magnetic Technologies, LLC and AMT Acquisition Corp. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on March 6, 2012 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of August 7, 2014, by and among CEHI Acquisition Corporation, Clean Earth Holdings, Inc., the holders of stock and options in Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and Littlejohn Fund III, L.P. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the 8-K filed on August 11, 2014 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Membership Interest Purchase Agreement dated as of October 10, 2014, by and among Candle Lamp Holdings, LLC, Candle Lamp Company, LLC and Sternocandlelamp Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed October 10, 2014 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). 101.I(cid:2)S* XBRL Instance Document 101.SCH* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document 101.CAL* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document 101.DEF* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document 101.LAB* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document 101.PRE* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document 135 * † + Filed herewith. Denotes management contracts and compensatory plans or arrangements. In accordance with Item 601(b)(32)(ii) of Regulation S-K and SEC Release (cid:2)os. 33-8238 and 34-47986, Final Rule: Management's Reports on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting and Certification of Disclosure in Exchange Act Periodic Reports, the certifications furnished in Exhibit 32.1 and 32.2 hereto are deemed to accompany this Form 10-K and will not be deemed “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act. Such certifications will not be deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, except to the extent that the registrant specifically incorporates it by reference. 136 Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized. SIG(cid:2)ATURE Date: March 2, 2015 COMPASS GROUP DIVERSIFIED HOLDI(cid:2)GS LLC By: /s/ Alan B. Offenberg Alan B. Offenberg Chief Executive Officer K(cid:2)OW ALL PERSO(cid:2)S BY THESE PRESE(cid:2)TS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Alan B. Offenberg and Ryan J. Faulkingham, and each of them, as his or her true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution for him or her, and in his or her name in any and all capacities, to sign any and all amendments to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, and to file the same, with exhibits thereto and other documents in connection therewith, with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done therewith, as fully to all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and either of them, his or her substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof. Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated. Signature /s/ Alan B. Offenberg Alan B. Offenberg /s/ Ryan J. Faulkingham Ryan J. Faulkingham /s/ C. Sean Day C. Sean Day /s/ D. Eugene Ewing D. Eugene Ewing /s/ Harold S. Edwards Harold S. Edwards /s/ Mark H. Lazarus Mark H. Lazarus /s/ Gordon Burns Gordon Burns /s/ James J. Bottiglieri James Bottiglieri Title Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer) and Director Date March 2, 2015 Chief Financial Officer March 2, 2015 (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer) March 2, 2015 March 2, 2015 March 2, 2015 March 2, 2015 March 2, 2015 March 2, 2015 Director Director Director Director Director Director 137 Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized. SIG(cid:2)ATURE COMPASS DIVERSIFIED HOLDI(cid:2)GS Date: March 2, 2015 By: /s/ Ryan J. Faulkingham Ryan J. Faulkingham Regular Trustee 138 Compass Diversified Holdings I(cid:2)DEX TO CO(cid:2)SOLIDATED FI(cid:2)A(cid:2)CIAL STATEME(cid:2)TS A(cid:2)D SUPPLEME(cid:2)TAL FI(cid:2)A(cid:2)CIAL DATA Historical Financial Statements: Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Years Ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 (cid:2)otes to Consolidated Financial Statements Supplemental Financial Data: The following supplementary financial data of the registrant and its subsidiaries required to be included in Item 15 (a) (2) of Form 10-K are listed below: Schedule II – Valuation and Qualifying Accounts All other schedules not listed above have been omitted as not applicable or because the required information is included in the Consolidated Financial Statements or in the notes thereto. Page (cid:2)umbers F-2 F-3 F-4 F-5 F-6 F-7 F-8 F-9 S-1 F-1 REPORT OF I(cid:2)DEPE(cid:2)DE(cid:2)T REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOU(cid:2)TI(cid:2)G FIRM Board of Directors and Shareholders Compass Diversified Holdings We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Compass Diversified Holdings (a Delaware Trust) and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Report of Management on Internal Control over Financial Reporting (“Management’s Report”). Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. Our audit of, and opinion on, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting does not include the internal control over financial reporting of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc., a 97.9 percent owned subsidiary, and SternoCandleLamp Holdings, Inc., a wholly owned subsidiary, whose financial statements, in aggregate, reflect total assets and revenues constituting 35 and 11 percent, respectively, of the related consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended December 31, 2014. As indicated in Management’s Report, Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and SternoCandleLamp Holdings, Inc. were acquired during 2014. Management’s assertion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting excluded internal control over financial reporting of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and SternoCandleLamp Holdings Inc. We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion. A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by COSO. We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of and for the year ended December 31, 2014, and our report dated March 2, 2015 expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements. /s/ GRA(cid:2)T THOR(cid:2)TO(cid:2) LLP (cid:2)ew York, (cid:2)ew York March 2, 2015 F-2 REPORT OF I(cid:2)DEPE(cid:2)DE(cid:2)T REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOU(cid:2)TI(cid:2)G FIRM Board of Directors and Shareholders Compass Diversified Holdings We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Compass Diversified Holdings (a Delaware Trust) and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income, stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014. Our audits of the basic consolidated financial statements included the financial statement schedule listed in the index appearing under Item 15(a)(2). These financial statements and financial statement schedule are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and financial statement schedule based on our audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Compass Diversified Holdings and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein. We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, based on criteria established in the 2013 Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated March 2, 2015 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon. /s/ GRA(cid:2)T THOR(cid:2)TO(cid:2) LLP (cid:2)ew York, (cid:2)ew York March 2, 2015 F-3 Compass Diversified Holdings Consolidated Balance Sheets (in thousands) Assets Current assets: Cash and cash equivalents Accounts receivable, less allowances of $5,200 at December 31, 2014 and $3,424 at December 31, 2013 Inventories Prepaid expenses and other current assets Total current assets Property, plant and equipment, net Equity method investment (refer to (cid:2)ote D) Goodwill Intangible assets, net Deferred debt issuance costs, less accumulated amortization of $1,233 at December 31, 2014 and $4,161 at December 31, 2013 Other non-current assets Total assets Liabilities and stockholders’ equity Current liabilities: Accounts payable Accrued expenses Due to related party Current portion, long-term debt Other current liabilities Total current liabilities Deferred income taxes Long-term debt, less original issue discount Other non-current liabilities Total liabilities Stockholders’ equity Trust shares, no par value, 500,000 authorized; 54,300 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2014 and 48,300 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2013 Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) Accumulated deficit Total stockholders’ equity attributable to Holdings (cid:2)oncontrolling interest Total stockholders’ equity Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity See notes to consolidated financial statements. December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 $ 23,703 $ 113,229 $ $ $ $ 157,535 111,214 28,347 320,799 115,871 245,214 359,180 487,220 11,197 7,949 1,547,430 62,099 63,378 6,193 3,250 6,311 141,231 97,731 485,547 14,587 739,096 825,321 (2,542) (55,348) 767,431 40,903 808,334 111,736 152,948 21,220 399,133 68,059 — 246,611 310,359 8,217 12,534 1,044,913 62,539 55,590 4,528 2,850 4,623 130,130 60,024 280,389 5,435 475,978 725,453 693 (252,761) 473,385 95,550 568,935 $ 1,547,430 $ 1,044,913 F-4 Compass Diversified Holdings Consolidated Statements of Operations (in thousands, except per share data) (cid:2)et sales Cost of sales Gross profit Operating expenses: Selling, general and administrative expense Supplemental put expense (reversal) Management fees Amortization expense Impairment expense Operating income Other income (expense): Interest expense, net Gain on equity method investment Gain on deconsolidation of subsidiary (refer to (cid:2)ote D) Amortization of debt issuance costs Loss on debt extinguishment Other income (expense), net Income from continuing operations before income taxes Provision for income taxes Income from continuing operations Loss from discontinued operations, net of income tax Loss on sale of discontinued operations, net of income tax (cid:2)et income Less: Income from continuing operations attributable to noncontrolling interest Less: Loss from discontinued operations attributable to noncontrolling interest (cid:2)et income (loss) attributable to Holdings Amounts attributable to Holdings: Income (loss) from continuing operations Loss from discontinued operations, net of income tax Loss on sale of discontinued operations, net of income tax (cid:2)et income (loss) attributable to Holdings Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share attributable to Holdings Continuing operations Discontinued operations Weighted average number of shares outstanding - basic and fully diluted Cash distribution declared per share (refer to (cid:2)ote (cid:2)) 2014 Year ended December 31, 2013 2012 $ $ 982,300 688,631 293,669 $ 985,539 679,708 305,831 181,683 — 22,722 33,606 — 55,658 (27,068) 11,029 264,325 (2,243) (2,143) (139) 299,419 8,264 291,155 — — 291,155 12,320 — 278,835 278,835 — — 278,835 5.38 — 5.38 $ $ $ $ $ 167,738 (45,995) 18,632 29,632 12,918 122,906 (19,376) — — (2,123) (1,785) (77) 99,545 20,729 78,816 — — 78,816 10,752 — 68,064 68,064 — — 68,064 1.05 — 1.05 $ $ $ $ $ 49,089 48,300 1.44 $ 1.44 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 884,721 605,867 278,854 161,141 15,995 17,633 30,268 — 53,817 (25,001) — — (1,811) — (183) 26,822 21,069 5,753 (1,168) (245) 4,340 8,508 (226) (3,942) (2,755) (942) (245) (3,942) (0.06) (0.02) (0.08) 48,300 1.44 See notes to consolidated financial statements. F-5 Compass Diversified Holdings Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (in thousands) (cid:2)et income Other comprehensive income (loss) Foreign currency translation and other Total comprehensive income, net of tax 2014 Year ended December 31, 2013 2012 291,155 $ 78,816 $ 4,340 (3,235) 287,920 $ 825 79,641 $ (132) 4,208 $ $ See notes to consolidated financial statements. F-6 8 7 4 , 6 9 5 $ 2 1 7 , 3 $ 7 5 2 , 5 9 $ 9 0 5 , 7 9 4 $ l a t o T ’ s r e d l o h k c o t S y t i u q E g n i l l o r t n o c - n o (cid:2) . c s i D f o t s e r e t n I . s p O - n o (cid:2) g n i l l o r t n o C t s e r e t n I ’ s r e d l o h k c o t S y t i u q E o t . b i r t t A s g n i d l o H r e h t O . m u c c A e v i s n e h e r p m o C ) s s o L ( e m o c n I d e t a l u m u c c A t i c i f e D t n u o m A f o r e b m u (cid:2) s e r a h S s g n i d l o H d e i f i s r e v i D s s a p m o C y t i u q E ’ s r e d l o h k c o t S f o s t n e m e t a t S d e t a d i l o s n o C ) 2 3 1 ( 0 4 3 4 , 3 1 7 1 , 6 1 9 , 2 ) 9 9 0 5 1 ( , ) 9 4 7 , 3 1 ( — ) 2 1 4 3 ( , ) 2 2 0 8 4 ( , 7 1 2 , 4 ) 6 8 4 , 3 ( ) 2 5 5 9 6 ( , 2 1 2 , 6 5 4 $ 5 2 8 6 1 8 , 8 7 ) 0 9 0 , 3 ( ) 0 9 9 , 5 1 ( 8 3 0 , 7 1 1 6 7 6 , 4 ) 2 5 5 9 6 ( , 5 3 9 , 8 6 5 5 5 1 , 1 9 2 ) 5 3 2 3 ( , 8 6 8 9 9 , ) 7 8 2 7 7 ( , 5 7 2 , 2 ) 0 7 8 1 1 ( , — 5 4 0 , 8 ) 2 5 5 , 9 6 ( $ 4 3 3 , 8 0 8 $ — — — — — — — — — ) 6 2 2 ( ) 6 8 4 3 ( , — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 8 0 5 , 8 3 1 7 1 , 6 1 9 2 , — — ) 2 3 1 ( ) 2 4 9 3 ( , ) 5 5 5 6 ( , ) 4 4 5 , 8 ( ) 9 4 7 , 3 1 ( 7 3 9 ) 8 3 6 3 ( , ) 2 2 0 8 4 ( , 7 1 2 , 4 — — — ) 7 3 9 ( 6 2 2 — — — ) 2 5 5 , 9 6 ( — — ) 2 3 1 ( — — — — — — — — — — $ ) 2 5 8 , 0 6 1 ( $ 1 6 3 , 8 5 6 $ 0 0 3 , 8 4 — — — — — ) 2 4 9 , 3 ( — — — — ) 7 3 9 ( ) 2 5 5 , 9 6 ( — — — — ) 4 4 5 , 8 ( — — 6 2 2 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — $ 4 8 5 , 1 4 $ 8 2 6 , 4 1 4 $ ) 2 3 1 ( $ ) 3 8 2 , 5 3 2 ( $ 3 4 0 , 0 5 6 $ 0 0 3 , 8 4 — 2 5 7 , 0 1 ) 0 9 0 , 3 ( 8 2 6 , 1 4 — — 6 7 6 , 4 — 4 6 0 , 8 6 5 2 8 0 1 4 5 7 , ) 0 9 9 5 1 ( , — ) 2 5 5 , 9 6 ( — 5 2 8 — — — — — — — — 4 6 0 , 8 6 ) 0 9 9 , 5 1 ( — ) 2 5 5 , 9 6 ( — — — — — — 0 1 4 , 5 7 — — — — — — — $ 0 5 5 , 5 9 $ 5 8 3 , 3 7 4 $ 3 9 6 $ ) 1 6 7 , 2 5 2 ( $ 3 5 4 , 5 2 7 $ 0 0 3 , 8 4 — — — 5 7 2 2 , ) 9 5 3 ( 5 4 0 , 8 — ) 8 2 9 6 7 ( , ) 5 3 2 , 3 ( 8 6 8 9 9 , ) 9 5 3 ( — ) 0 7 8 , 1 1 ( — 9 5 3 ) 2 5 5 9 6 ( , 0 2 3 , 2 1 5 3 8 , 8 7 2 — — — — — — — — ) 5 3 2 , 3 ( — — ) 9 5 3 ( — — 9 5 3 ) 0 7 8 , 1 1 ( ) 2 5 5 , 9 6 ( 5 3 8 , 8 7 2 — — — — 8 6 8 , 9 9 0 0 0 , 6 — — — — — — — — — — — — $ 3 0 9 , 0 4 $ 1 3 4 , 7 6 7 $ ) 2 4 5 , 2 ( $ ) 8 4 3 , 5 5 ( $ 1 2 3 , 5 2 8 $ 0 0 3 , 4 5 . s t n e m e t a t s l a i c n a n i f d e t a d i l o s n o c o t s e t o n e e S 7 - F n o i t a z i l a t i p a c e r x o F e h t o t d e t a l e r s r e d l o h e r a h s g n i l l o r t n o c n o n o t n o i t u b i r t s i D ) R e t o (cid:2) o t r e f e r ( n o i t a z i l a t i p a c e r I C A e h t o t d e t a l e r s r e d l o h e r a h s g n i l l o r t n o c n o n o t n o i t u b i r t s i D r e h t o d n a n o i t a l s n a r t y c n e r r u c n g i e r o f – s s o l e v i s n e h e r p m o c r e h t O s r e d l o h e r a h s g n i l l o r t n o c n o n d l o n r A m o r f d e v i e c e r s d e e c o r P s r e d l o h e r a h s g n i l l o r t n o c n o n m o r f d e v i e c e r s d e e c o r P s r e d l o h e r a h s g n i l l o r t n o c n o n o t e l b a t u b i r t t a y t i v i t c a n o i t p O s r e d l o h t s e r e t n i g n i l l o r t n o c n o n f o n o i t p m e d e R k c o t s d e r r e f e r p k a B l e m a C f o n o i t p m e d e R k c o t s d e r r e f e r p k a B l e m a C — n o i t e r c c A ) R e t o (cid:2) o t r e f e r ( 2 1 0 2 , 1 y r a u n a J — e c n a l a B ) s d n a s u o h t n i ( e m o c n i t e (cid:2) r e h t o d n a n o i t a l s n a r t y c n e r r u c n g i e r o f – s s o l e v i s n e h e r p m o c r e h t O ) B e t o (cid:2) o t r e f e r ( g n i r e f f o c i l b u p l a i t i n i y r a i d i s b u s f o t c e f f E ) (cid:2) e t o (cid:2) o t r e f e r ( s r e d l o h t s e r e t n I n o i t a c o l l A o t n o i t u b i r t s i D s r e d l o h e r a h s g n i l l o r t n o c n o n o t e l b a t u b i r t t a y t i v i t c a n o i t p O s r e d l o h t s e r e t n i g n i l l o r t n o c n o n o t n o i t u b i r t s i D 3 1 0 2 , 1 3 r e b m e c e D — e c n a l a B d i a p s n o i t u b i r t s i D e m o c n i t e (cid:2) r e h t o d n a n o i t a l s n a r t y c n e r r u c n g i e r o f – e m o c n i e v i s n e h e r p m o c r e h t O s r e d l o h t s e r e t n i g n i l l o r t n o c n o n h t r a E n a e l C m o r f s d e e c o r P ) (cid:2) e t o (cid:2) o t r e f e r ( s r e d l o h t s e r e t n I n o i t a c o l l A o t n o i t u b i r t s i D s r e d l o h e r a h s g n i l l o r t n o c n o n o t e l b a t u b i r t t a y t i v i t c a n o i t p O ) D e t o (cid:2) o t r e f e r ( y r a i d i s b u s f o n o i t a d i l o s n o c e d f o t c e f f E s t s o c g n i r e f f o f o t e n , s e r a h s t s u r T f o e c n a u s s I e s i c r e x e n o i t p o k c o t s y r a i d i s b u s f o t c e f f E 4 1 0 2 , 1 3 r e b m e c e D — e c n a l a B d i a p s n o i t u b i r t s i D 2 1 0 2 , 1 3 r e b m e c e D — e c n a l a B ) s s o l ( e m o c n i t e (cid:2) n o i t i s o p s i d O L A H d i a p s n o i t u b i r t s i D Compass Diversified Holdings Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (in thousands) Cash flows from operating activities: (cid:2)et income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities: Year ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 $ 291,155 $ 78,816 $ 4,340 Gain (loss) on sale of businesses Depreciation expense Amortization expense Impairment expense Amortization of debt issuance costs and original issue discount Loss on debt extinguishment Supplemental put expense (reversal) Unrealized loss on interest rate swap (cid:2)oncontrolling stockholder stock based compensation (cid:2)et gain on deconsolidation of subsidiary - FOX Gain on equity method investment Excess tax benefit from subsidiary stock options exercised Deferred taxes Other Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of acquisitions: Increase in accounts receivable (Increase) decrease in inventories Increase in prepaid expenses and other current assets Increase (decrease) in accounts payable and accrued expenses Payment of profit allocation (cid:2)et cash provided by operating activities Cash flows from investing activities: Acquisitions, net of cash acquired Purchases of property and equipment Proceeds from the FOX stock offering Proceeds from sale of businesses Purchase of noncontrolling interest Payment of interest rate swap Proceeds from sale leaseback transaction Other investing activities (cid:2)et cash (used in) provided by investing activities Cash flows from financing activities: Proceeds from the issuance of Trust shares, net Borrowings under credit facility Repayments under credit facility Redemption of CamelBak preferred stock Distributions paid (cid:2)et proceeds provided by noncontrolling shareholders Distributions paid to noncontrolling shareholders Debt issuance costs Excess tax benefit on stock-based compensation Other (cid:2)et cash provided by (used in) financing activities Foreign currency impact on cash (cid:2)et increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents — beginning of period Cash and cash equivalents — end of period — 20,048 35,648 — 3,125 2,143 — 7,722 4,744 (264,325) (11,029) (1,662) (8,601) 1,442 (20,853) 19,588 (6,205) (2,245) — 70,695 (474,657) (15,262) 65,528 2,001 — (2,008) — (355) (424,753) 99,868 677,000 (426,275) — (69,552) 4,025 (11,870) (7,370) 1,662 (2,001) 265,487 (955) (89,526) 113,229 — 16,595 29,632 12,918 3,366 1,785 (45,995) 130 4,683 — — — (5,257) (87) (10,988) (24,454) (413) 17,246 (5,603) 72,374 (1,117) (20,410) 80,913 2,760 — — 4,108 32 66,286 — 117,500 (106,275) — (69,552) 36,122 (19,081) (2,697) — (139) (44,122) 450 94,988 18,241 $ 23,703 $ 113,229 $ 245 14,793 34,657 — 4,169 — 15,995 2,175 4,236 — — — (2,060) 986 (2,137) (13,703) (1,580) 4,336 (13,886) 52,566 (126,412) (18,546) — 75,064 (15,423) — — 891 (84,426) — 186,000 (135,005) (48,022) (69,552) 12,061 (30,038) (3,154) 5,755 (277) (82,232) (37) (114,129) 132,370 18,241 See notes to consolidated financial statements. F-8 Compass Diversified Holdings (cid:2)otes to Consolidated Financial Statements December 31, 2014 (cid:2)ote A — Organization and Business Operations Compass Diversified Holdings, a Delaware statutory trust (“the Trust”), was incorporated in Delaware on (cid:2)ovember 18, 2005. Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability Company (the “Company”), was also formed on (cid:2)ovember 18, 2005 with equity interests which were subsequently reclassified as the “Allocation Interests”. The Trust and the Company were formed to acquire and manage a group of small and middle-market businesses headquartered in (cid:2)orth America. In accordance with the amended and restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006 (the “Trust Agreement”), the Trust is sole owner of 100% of the Trust Interests (as defined in the Company’s amended and restated operating agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006 (as amended and restated, the “LLC Agreement”)) of the Company and, pursuant to the LLC Agreement, the Company has, outstanding, the identical number of Trust Interests as the number of outstanding shares of the Trust. Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company is the operating entity with a board of directors and other corporate governance responsibilities, similar to that of a Delaware corporation. The Company is a controlling owner of nine businesses, or operating segments at December 31, 2014. The segments are as follows: CamelBak Products LLC. (“CamelBak”), The Ergo Baby Carrier, Inc. (“Ergobaby”), Liberty Safe and Security Products, Inc. (“Liberty Safe” or “Liberty”), Compass AC Holdings, Inc. (“ACI” or “Advanced Circuits”), American Furniture Manufacturing, Inc. (“AFM” or “American Furniture”), AMT Acquisition Corporation (“Arnold” or “Arnold Magnetics”), Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. ("Clean Earth"), Candle Lamp Company, LLC (“SternoCandleLamp”), and Tridien Medical, Inc. (“Tridien”). The segments are referred to interchangeably as “businesses”, “operating segments” or “subsidiaries” throughout the financial statements. Refer to (cid:2)ote F for further discussion of the operating segments. The Company also owns a non-controlling interest of approximately 41% in Fox Factory Holding Corp. (“FOX”) which is accounted for as an equity method investment. Compass Group Management LLC, a Delaware limited liability Company (“CGM” or the “Manager”), manages the day to day operations of the Company and oversees the management and operations of our businesses pursuant to a management services agreement (“MSA”). (cid:2)ote B — Summary of Significant Accounting Policies Accounting principles The Company’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (US GAAP). Basis of presentation The results of operations for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 represent the results of operations of the Company’s acquired businesses from the date of their acquisition by the Company, and therefore are not indicative of the results to be expected for the full year. Principles of consolidation The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Trust and the Company, as well as the businesses acquired as of their respective acquisition date. All significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. Discontinued operating entities are reflected as discontinued operations in the Company’s results of operations and statements of financial position. The acquisition of businesses that the Company owns or controls more than a 50% share of the voting interest are accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting. The amount assigned to the identifiable assets acquired and the liabilities assumed is based on the estimated fair values as of the date of acquisition, with the remainder, if any, recorded as goodwill. Discontinued Operations On May 1, 2012, the Company sold its majority owned subsidiary, HALO. As a result, HALO’s net income for the period from January 1, 2012 through the date of sale has been reclassified to income from discontinued operations for that period in accordance with accounting guidelines. F-9 Use of estimates The preparation of financial statements in conformity with US GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. These estimates are based on management’s best knowledge of current events and actions the Company may undertake in the future. It is possible that in 2015 actual conditions could be better or worse than anticipated when the Company developed the estimates and assumptions, which could materially affect the results of operations and financial position in the future. Such changes could result in future impairment of goodwill, intangibles and long-lived assets, inventory obsolescence, establishment of valuation allowances on deferred tax assets and increased tax liabilities, among other things. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Deconsolidation of FOX On August 13, 2013, the Company's FOX operating segment completed an initial public offering (the "FOX IPO") of its common stock pursuant to a registration statement on Form S-1 with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC"). In the FOX IPO, FOX sold 2,857,143 shares and certain of its shareholders sold 7,000,000 shares (including 5,800,238 shares held by the Company) at an initial offering price of $15.00 per share. FOX trades on the (cid:2)ASDAQ stock market under the ticker “FOXF”. The Company received approximately $80.9 million in net proceeds from the sale of their shares. The Company’s ownership interest in FOX was reduced from 75.8% to 53.9% on a primary basis and from 70.6% to 49.8% on a fully diluted basis as a result of the FOX IPO. The following table details the amounts recorded in the consolidated statement of stockholders’ equity during the year ended December 31, 2013 as a result of the FOX IPO (in thousands): Effect of FOX IPO proceeds Effect of FOX IPO proceeds on (cid:2)CI (1) Effect of FOX IPO on majority trust shares (2) Trust Shares (cid:2)CI Total $ $ 73,421 — 1,989 75,410 $ $ 36,125 7,492 (1,989) 41,628 $ $ 109,546 7,492 — 117,038 (1) Represents the effect on noncontrolling shareholders resulting from the Company’s proceeds from the FOX IPO, as determined based on the proporionate interest of the carrying value of FOX. (2) Represents the majority ownership effect on the Company resulting from the FOX IPO. On July 10, 2014, FOX filed a registration statement on Form S-1 with the SEC for a public offering of its common stock (the "FOX Secondary Offering") held by certain stockholders (the "Selling Stockholders"). The Selling Stockholders sold 5,750,000 shares of FOX common stock in the FOX Secondary Offering, which included an underwriters' option to purchase an additional 750,000 shares, at an offering price of $15.50 per share. The Company sold 4,466,569 shares of FOX common stock, including 633,955 shares sold in connection with the underwriters' exercise of their full option to purchase additional shares of common stock, and received net proceeds from the sale of approximately $65.5 million. As a result of the sale of the shares by the Company in the FOX Secondary Offering, the Company's ownership interest in FOX decreased to approximately 41%, which resulted in the deconsolidation of the FOX operating segment in the Company's consolidated financial statements effective as of the date of the FOX Secondary Offering. The Company recognized a gain of approximately $76.2 million related to the shares that were sold in connection with the FOX Secondary Offering, and a gain of approximately $188.0 million related to the Company's retained interest in FOX, for a total gain of approximately $264.3 million. Subsequent to the sale of the shares in the FOX Secondary Offering the Company owns approximately 15.1 million shares of FOX common stock. The Company has elected to account for its investment in FOX at fair value using the equity method beginning on the date that the investment became subject to the equity method of accounting. The Company uses the equity method of accounting when it has the ability to exercise significant influence, but not control, over the operating and financial policies of the investee. For equity method investments which the Company has elected to measure at fair value, unrealized gains and losses are reported in the consolidated statement of operations as gain (loss) from equity method investments. F-10 Termination of Supplemental Put Agreement The Company entered into a Supplemental Put Agreement with the Manager at the time of the Company’s Initial Public Offering (“IPO”) in connection with the MSA. Pursuant to the Supplemental Put Agreement, the Manager had the right to cause the Company to purchase the Allocation Interests then owned by the Manager upon termination of the MSA for a price to be determined in accordance with the Supplemental Put Agreement. The holders of the Allocation Interests (“Holders”) are entitled to receive distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of certain events. The distributions of the profit allocation will be paid only upon the occurrence of the sale of a material amount of capital stock or assets of one of the Company’s businesses (“Sale Event”) or, at the option of the Holders, at each five year anniversary date of the acquisition of one of the Company’s businesses (“Holding Event”). The Company historically recorded the Supplemental Put obligation at an amount equal to the fair value of the profit allocation. This amount was determined using a model that multiplies the trailing twelve-month EBITDA for each business unit by an estimated enterprise value multiple to determine an estimated selling price of the business unit. This amount represented the obligation of the Company to physically settle the purchase of the Allocation Interest at the option of the Holders upon the termination of the MSA. On July 1, 2013, the Company and the Manager amended the MSA to provide for certain modifications related to the Manager’s registration as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (“Advisor’s Act”), as amended. In connection with the amendment resulting from the Manager’s registration as an investment adviser under the Adviser’s Act, the Company and the Manager agreed to terminate the Supplemental Put Agreement, which had the effect of eliminating the Manager’s right to require the Company to purchase the Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA. Pursuant to the MSA, as amended, the Manager will continue to manage the day-to-day operations and affairs of the Company, oversee the management and operations of the Company’s businesses, perform certain other services for the Company and receive management fees, and the Holders will continue to receive the profit allocation upon the occurrence of a Sale Event or a Holding Event. Prior to July 1, 2013 the Company recorded increases or decreases in the supplemental put obligation as well as payments made upon the occurrence of a Sale Event or Holding Event, through the consolidated statement of operations. For the years ended December 31, 2012 and 2011, the Company recognized approximately $16.0 million and $11.8 million, respectively in expense related to the Supplemental Put Agreement. During 2012, the Company paid $13.7 million and $0.2 million, respectively, of the supplemental put liability due to the sale of Staffmark in October 2011, and Halo in May 2012, which qualified as Sale Events. Additionally, the Company paid $5.6 million in 2013 related to a Holding Event of the FOX business, and $6.9 million in 2011 related to a Holding Event of the ACI business. The FOX Holding Event in 2013 occurred prior to the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement and was therefore accounted for as an expense in the consolidated statement of operations. As a result of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, the Company has derecognized the supplemental put liability associated with the Manager’s put right, reversing the entire $61.3 million liability at June 30, 2013 through supplemental put expense on the consolidated statement of operations. Subsequent to the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, the Company records Holding Events and Sale Events as dividends declared on Allocations Interests to stockholders’ equity when they are approved by the Company’s board of directors. Revenue recognition In accordance with authoritative guidance on revenue recognition, the Company recognizes revenue when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery of the product or performance of services has occurred, the sellers price to the buyer is fixed and determinable, and collection is reasonably assured. Shipping and handling costs are charged to operations when incurred and are classified as a component of cost of sales. Taxes collected from customers and remitted to governmental authorities are presented on a net basis in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations. Revenue is recognized upon shipment of product to the customer or performance of services for a customer, net of sales returns and allowances. Appropriate reserves are established for anticipated returns and allowances based on past experience. Revenue is typically recorded at F.O.B. shipping point for all our businesses with the exception being American Furniture which reports revenues F.O.B. destination. Cash equivalents The Company considers all highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less to be cash equivalents. F-11 Allowance for doubtful accounts The Company uses estimates to determine the amount of the allowance for doubtful accounts in order to reduce accounts receivable to their estimated net realizable value. The Company estimates the amount of the required allowance by reviewing the status of past-due receivables and analyzing historical bad debt trends. The Company’s estimate also includes analyzing existing economic conditions. When the Company becomes aware of circumstances that may impair a specific customer’s ability to meet its financial obligations subsequent to the original sale, the Company will record an allowance against amounts due, and thereby reduce the net receivable to the amount it reasonably believes will be collectible. Balances that remain outstanding after the Company has used reasonable collection efforts are written off through a charge to the valuation allowance and a credit to accounts receivable. Inventories Inventories consist of raw materials, WIP, manufactured goods and purchased goods acquired for resale. Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or market, determined on the first-in, first-out method. Cost includes raw materials, direct labor, manufacturing overhead and indirect overhead. Market value is based on current replacement cost for raw materials and supplies and on net realizable value for finished goods. Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment is recorded at cost. The cost of major additions or betterments is capitalized, while maintenance and repairs that do not improve or extend the useful lives of the related assets are expensed as incurred. Depreciation is provided principally on the straight-line method over estimated useful lives. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the life of the lease or the life of the improvement, whichever is shorter. The ranges of useful lives are as follows: Machinery and equipment Office furniture, computers and software Leasehold improvements 2 to 25 years 2 to 8 years Shorter of useful life or lease term Property, plant and equipment and other long-lived assets that have definitive lives are evaluated for impairment when events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value of the assets may not be recoverable (‘triggering event’). Upon the occurrence of a triggering event, the asset is reviewed to assess whether the estimated undiscounted cash flows expected from the use of the asset plus residual value from the ultimate disposal exceeds the carrying value of the asset. If the carrying value exceeds the estimated recoverable amounts, the asset is written down to its fair value. Fair value of financial instruments The carrying value of the Company’s financial instruments, including cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable and accounts payable approximate their fair value due to their short term nature. Term Debt with a carrying value of $319.1 million, net of original issue discount, at December 31, 2014 approximated fair value. The fair value is based on interest rates that are currently available to the Company for issuance of debt with similar terms and remaining maturities. If measured at fair value in the financial statements, the Term Debt would be classified as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy. Business combinations The Company allocates the amount it pays for each acquisition to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their fair values at the date of acquisition, including identifiable intangible assets which arise from a contractual or legal right or are separable from goodwill. The Company bases the fair value of identifiable intangible assets acquired in a business combination on detailed valuations that use information and assumptions provided by management, which consider management’s best estimates of inputs and assumptions that a market participant would use. The Company allocates any excess purchase price that exceeds the fair value of the net tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired to goodwill. The use of alternative valuation assumptions, including estimated growth rates, cash flows, discount rates and estimated useful lives could result in different purchase price allocations and amortization expense in current and future periods. Transaction costs associated with these acquisitions are expensed as incurred through selling, general and administrative expense on the consolidated statement of operations. In those circumstances where an acquisition involves a contingent consideration arrangement, the Company recognizes a liability equal to the fair value F-12 of the contingent payments expected to be made as of the acquisition date. The Company re-measures this liability each reporting period and records changes in the fair value through a separate line item within the consolidated statements of operations. Goodwill Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price over the fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed. The Company is required to perform impairment reviews at each of its reporting units annually and more frequently in certain circumstances. In accordance with accounting guidelines, the Company is able to make a qualitative assessment of whether it is more likely than not that a reporting unit’s fair value is less than its carrying amount before applying the two-step goodwill impairment test. If a company concludes that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is not less than its carrying amount it is not required to perform the two-step impairment test for that reporting unit. The first step of the process after the qualitative assessment fails is estimating the fair value of each of its reporting units based on a discounted cash flow (“DCF”) model using revenue and profit forecast and a market approach which compares peer data and earnings multiples. The Company then compares those estimated fair values with the carrying values, which include allocated goodwill. If the estimated fair value is less than the carrying value, a second step is performed to compute the amount of the impairment by determining an “implied fair value” of goodwill. The determination of a reporting unit’s “implied fair value” of goodwill requires the allocation of the estimated fair value of the reporting unit to the assets and liabilities of the reporting unit. Any unallocated fair value represents the “implied fair value” of goodwill, which is then compared to its corresponding carrying value. The Company cannot predict the occurrence of certain future events that might adversely affect the implied value of goodwill and/or the fair value of intangible assets. Such events include, but are not limited to, strategic decisions made in response to economic and competitive conditions, the impact of the economic environment on its customer base, and material adverse effects in relationships with significant customers. The impact of over-estimating or under-estimating the implied fair value of goodwill at any of the reporting units could have a material effect on the results of operations and financial position. In addition, the value of the implied goodwill is subject to the volatility of the Company’s operations which may result in significant fluctuation in the value assigned at any point in time. Refer to (cid:2)ote H - Goodwill and Intangible Assets for the results of the annual impairment tests. Deferred debt issuance costs Deferred debt issuance costs represent the costs associated with the issuance of debt instruments and are amortized over the life of the related debt instrument. Warranties The Company’s CamelBak, Ergobaby, Liberty and Tridien operating segments estimate the exposure to warranty claims based on both current and historical product sales data and warranty costs incurred. The Company assesses the adequacy of its recorded warranty liability quarterly and adjusts the amount as necessary. Foreign currency For the Company’s segments with certain operations outside the United States, the local currency is the functional currency, and the financial statements are translated into U.S. dollars using exchange rates in effect at year-end for assets and liabilities and average exchange rates during the year for results of operations. The resulting translation gain or loss is included in stockholder’s equity as other comprehensive income or loss. Derivatives and hedging The Company utilizes interest rate swaps (derivative) to manage risks related to interest rates on the term loan portion of their Credit Facility. The Company has not elected hedge accounting treatment for the existing interest rate derivatives entered into as part of the Credit Facility. Refer to (cid:2)ote J - Debt for more information on the Company’s Credit Facility. F-13 (cid:2)oncontrolling interest (cid:2)oncontrolling interest represents the portion of a majority-owned subsidiary’s net income that is owned by noncontrolling shareholders. (cid:2)oncontrolling interest on the balance sheet represents the portion of equity in a consolidated subsidiary owned by noncontrolling shareholders. Deferred income taxes Deferred income taxes are calculated under the asset and liability method. Deferred income taxes are provided for the differences between the basis of assets and liabilities for financial reporting and income tax purposes at the enacted tax rates. A valuation allowance is established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount that is expected to more likely than not be realized. Several of the Company’s majority owned subsidiaries have deferred tax assets recorded at December 31, 2014 which in total amount to approximately $17.0 million. This deferred tax asset is net of $12.7 million of valuation allowance primarily associated with AFM’s inability to utilize loss carryforwards associated with impairments in 2010 and 2011 and losses in 2012 and 2013. These deferred tax assets are comprised primarily of reserves not currently deductible for tax purposes. The temporary differences that have resulted in the recording of these tax assets may be used to offset taxable income in future periods, reducing the amount of taxes required to be paid. Realization of the deferred tax assets is dependent on generating sufficient future taxable income at those subsidiaries with deferred tax assets. Based upon the expected future results of operations, the Company believes it is more likely than not that those subsidiaries with deferred tax assets will generate sufficient future taxable income to realize the benefit of existing temporary differences, although there can be no assurance of this. The impact of not realizing these deferred tax assets would result in an increase in income tax expense for such period when the determination was made that the assets are not realizable. Earnings per share Prior to the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, basic and diluted earnings per share attributable to Holdings was computed on a weighted average basis. Effective July 1, 2013, basic and fully diluted earnings per share is computed using the two-class method which requires companies to allocate participating securities that have rights to earnings that otherwise would have been available only to common shareholders as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per share. The Company has granted Allocation Interests that contain participating rights to receive profit allocations upon the occurrence of a Holding Event or a Sale Event. The calculation of basic and fully diluted earnings per share reflects the effect of dividends that were declared and paid to the Holders subsequent to the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement and the incremental increase in the profit allocation distribution to the Holders related to Holding Events during the period. The weighted average number of Trust shares outstanding for fiscal 2014 was computed based on 48,300,000 shares outstanding for the period from January 1, 2014 through (cid:2)ovember 14, 2014 and 6,000,000 additional shares outstanding from (cid:2)ovember 14, 2014 through December 31, 2014 issued in connection with a public share offering. The weighted average number of Trust shares outstanding for fiscal 2013 and 2012 was computed based on 48,300,000 shares outstanding for the period from January 1st through December 31st in both years. The Company did not have any stock option plans or any other potentially dilutive securities outstanding during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. Advertising costs Advertising costs are expensed as incurred and included in selling, general and administrative expense in the consolidated statements of operations. Advertising costs were $14.6 million, $13.5 million and $12.9 million during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Research and development Research and development costs are expensed as incurred and included in selling, general and administrative expense in the consolidated statements of operations. The Company incurred research and development expense of $15.7 million, $16.0 million and $11.8 million during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. F-14 Employee retirement plans The Company and many of its segments sponsor defined contribution retirement plans, such as 401(k) plans. Employee contributions to the plan are subject to regulatory limitations and the specific plan provisions. The Company and its segments may match these contributions up to levels specified in the plans and may make additional discretionary contributions as determined by management. The total employer contributions to these plans were $1.7 million, $1.4 million and $1.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The Company’s Arnold Magnetics subsidiary maintains a defined benefit plan for certain of its employees which is more fully described in (cid:2)ote M. Accounting guidelines require employers to recognize the overfunded or underfunded status of defined benefit pension and postretirement plans as assets or liabilities in their consolidated balance sheets and to recognize changes in that funded status in the year in which the changes occur as a component of comprehensive income. Seasonality Earnings of certain of the Company’s operating segments are seasonal in nature. Earnings from CamelBak are typically higher in the spring and summer months as this corresponds with warmer weather in the (cid:2)orthern Hemisphere and an increase in hydration related activities. Earnings from Liberty are typically lowest in the second quarter due to lower demand for safes at the onset of summer. Earnings from AFM are typically highest in the months of January through April of each year, coinciding with homeowners’ tax refunds. Earnings from Clean Earth are typically lower in the winter months due to lower levels of construction and development activity in the (cid:2)ortheastern United States. Stock based compensation The Company does not have a stock based compensation plan; however, certain of the Company’s subsidiaries maintain stock based compensation plans. During the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, $4.7 million, $4.7 million, and $4.2 million of stock based compensation expense was recorded to each expense category that included related salary expense in the consolidated statements of operations. As of December 31, 2014, the amount to be recorded for stock-based compensation expense in future years for unvested options is approximately $12.9 million. Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements In July 2013, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued an accounting standards update intended to provide guidance on the presentation of unrecognized tax benefits, reflecting the manner in which an entity would settle, at the reporting date, any additional income taxes that would result from the disallowance of a tax position when net operating loss carryforwards, similar tax losses, or tax credit carryforwards exist. The accounting standard was effective for the Company on January 1, 2014. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations. In March 2013, the FASB issued an accounting standards update intended to provide guidance on a parent’s accounting for the cumulative translation adjustment upon derecognition of certain subsidiaries or groups of assets within a foreign entity or of an investment in a foreign entity. This accounting standard was effective for the Company on January 1, 2014. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations. Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements In April 2014, the FASB issued an accounting standard update related to reporting discontinued operations and disclosures of disposals of components of an entity which changes the criteria for determining which disposals can be presented as discontinued operations and modifies related disclosure requirements. Under the new guidance, a discontinued operation is defined as a disposal of a component or group of components that is disposed of or is classified as held for sale and “represents a strategic shift that has (or will have) a major effect on an entity’s operations and financial results.” The new standard applies prospectively to new disposals and new classifications of disposal groups as held for sale after the effective date. The amendment is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2014, which for the Company is January 1, 2015, and interim periods within those annual periods. The adoption of this standard is not expected to change the manner in which the Company currently presents discontinued operations in the consolidated financial statements. In May 2014, the FASB issued a comprehensive new revenue recognition standard. The new standard outlines a new, single comprehensive model for entities to use in accounting for revenue arising from contracts with customers and supersedes most current revenue recognition guidance, including industry-specific guidance. The core principle of the revenue model is that an entity should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the F-15 consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. The standard is designed to create greater comparability for financial statement users across industries, jurisdictions and capital markets and also requires enhanced disclosures. The guidance is effective for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2016. Early adoption is not permitted. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of the adoption of this standard on its consolidated financial statements. (cid:2)ote C — Acquisition of Businesses Acquisition of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. On August 26, 2014, CEHI Acquisition Corp., a subsidiary of the Company, closed on the acquisition of all the issued and outstanding capital stock of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. pursuant to a stock purchase agreement among CEHI Acquisition Corp., Clean Earth, holders of stock and options in Clean Earth, Littlejohn Fund III, L.P. and the Company, entered into on August 7, 2014. Headquartered in Hatboro, Pennsylvania, Clean Earth provides environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials including soils, dredged material, hazardous waste and drill cuttings. Clean Earth analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste streams generated in multiple end-markets such as power, construction, oil and gas, infrastructure, industrial and dredging. Treatment includes thermal desorption, dredged material stabilization, bioremediation, physical treatment/screening and chemical fixation. Before the company accepts contaminated materials, it identifies a third party “beneficial reuse” site such as commercial redevelopment or landfill capping where the materials will be sent after they are treated. Clean Earth operates 14 permitted facilities in the Eastern U.S. Revenues from the environmental recycling facilities are generally recognized at the time of treatment. The Company made loans to and purchased a 98% controlling interest in Clean Earth. The purchase price, including proceeds from noncontrolling interest, was approximately $251.4 million. The Company funded its portion of the acquisition through drawings on its 2014 Revolving Credit Facility and cash on hand. Clean Earth management invested in the transaction along with the Company representing an approximate 2% initial noncontrolling interest on a primary and fully diluted basis. In addition to its equity investment in Clean Earth, the Company provided loans totaling approximately $146.3 million to Clean Earth as part of the transaction. The fair value of the noncontrolling interest was determined based on the enterprise value of the acquired entity multiplied by the ratio of the number of shares acquired by the minority holders to total shares. The transaction is accounted for as a business combination. CGM acted as an advisor to the Company in the acquisition and will continue to provide integration services during the first year of the Company's ownership of Clean Earth. CGM will receive integration service fees of approximately $2.5 million which will be payable quarterly as services are rendered beginning in the quarter ending December 31, 2014. The results of operations of Clean Earth have been included in the consolidated results of operations since the date of acquisition. Clean Earth's results of operations are reported as a separate operating segment. The table below provides the provisional recording of assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date. The amounts recorded for intangible assets and goodwill are preliminary pending finalization of valuation efforts. F-16 Clean Earth (in thousands) Acquisition Consideration Purchase price Working capital adjustment Cash acquired Total purchase consideration Less: Transaction costs Purchase price, net Amounts Recognized as of Acquisition Date Assets: Cash Accounts receivable, net (1) Property, plant and equipment (2) Intangible assets Goodwill Other current and noncurrent assets Total assets Liabilities and noncontrolling interest: Current liabilities Other liabilities Deferred tax liabilities (cid:2)oncontrolling interest Total liabilities and noncontrolling interest (cid:2)et assets acquired (cid:2)oncontrolling interest Intercompany loans to business and debt assumed $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 243,000 6,616 3,683 253,299 (1,935) 251,364 3,683 41,821 43,737 135,939 108,675 8,499 342,354 27,205 149,760 60,338 2,275 239,578 102,776 2,275 148,248 253,299 (1) Includes $42.5 million of gross contractual accounts receivable of which $0.6 million was not expected to be collected. The fair value of accounts receivable approximated book value acquired. (2) Includes $20.9 million of property, plant and equipment basis step-up. The Company incurred $1.9 million of transaction costs in conjunction with the Clean Earth acquisition for the year ended December 31, 2014, which is included in selling, general and administrative expense in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations. The goodwill of $108.7 million reflects the strategic fit of Clean Earth into the Company's niche industrial businesses. The goodwill is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes. F-17 The values assigned to the identified intangible assets were determined by discounting the estimated future cash flows associated with these assets to their present value. The intangible assets preliminarily recorded in connection with the Clean Earth acquisition are as follows (in thousands): Intangible assets Customer relationships Permits and Airspace Trade name Amount Estimated Useful Life $ $ 25,730 93,209 17,000 135,939 15 years 10 - 20 years 20 years Acquisition of SternoCandleLamp On October 10, 2014, the Company, through its wholly owned subsidiary business, Sternocandlelamp Holdings, Inc. (the “Purchaser”), entered into a membership interest purchase agreement (the “Sterno Purchase Agreement”) with Candle Lamp Holdings, LLC (the “Seller”), and Candle Lamp Company, LLC (“SternoCandleLamp”) pursuant to which the Purchaser acquired all of the issued and outstanding equity of SternoCandleLamp (the “Acquisition”). Headquartered in Corona, California, SternoCandleLamp is the leading manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative table lighting solutions for the foodservice industry. SternoCandleLamp’s product line includes wick and gel chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories, liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps. The purchase price was approximately $160.0 million. On a primary basis, CODI will initially own all of the common equity ownership in SternoCandleLamp. In addition to its equity investment in SternoCandleLamp, the Company provided loans totaling approximately $91.6 million to SternoCandleLamp as part of the transaction. The transaction is accounted for as a business combination. CGM acted as an advisor to the Company in the acquisition and will continue to provide integration services during the first year of the Company's ownership of SternoCandleLamp. CGM will receive integration service fees of $1.5 million which will be payable quarterly as services are rendered beginning in the quarter ending December 31, 2014. The results of operations of SternoCandleLamp have been included in the consolidated results of operations since the date of acquisition. SternoCandleLamp's results of operations are reported as a separate operating segment. The table below provides the provisional recording of assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date. The amounts recorded for property, plant and equipment, intangible assets and goodwill are preliminary pending finalization of valuation efforts. F-18 SternoCandleLamp (in thousands) Acquisition Consideration Purchase Price Working Capital Adjustment Total purchase consideration Less: Transaction costs Purchase price, net Amounts Recognized as of Acquisition Date Assets: Accounts Receivable (1) Inventory (2) Property, plant and equipment (3) Intangible assets Goodwill Other current and non-current assets Total assets Liabilities: Current liabilities Other liabilities Total liabilities (cid:2)et assets acquired Intercompany loans to business $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 161,500 1,251 162,751 (2,765) 159,986 18,534 19,932 18,004 90,950 33,717 1,734 182,871 20,120 91,647 111,767 71,104 91,647 162,751 (1) Includes $18.8 million of gross contractual accounts receivable of which $0.2 million was not expected to be collected. The fair value of accounts receivable approximates book value acquired. (2) Includes $2.0 million in inventory basis step-up, which was charged to cost of goods sold during the year ended December 31, 2014. (3) Includes $6.9 million of property, plant and equipment basis step-up. The Company incurred $2.8 million of transaction costs in conjunction with the SternoCandleLamp acquisition for the year ended December 31, 2014, which is included in selling, general and administrative expense in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations. The goodwill of $33.7 million reflects strategic fit of SternoCandleLamp into the Company's niche industrial businesses. The goodwill is expected to be deductible for tax purposes. The values assigned to the identified intangible assets were determined by discounting the estimated future cash flows associated with these assets to their present value. The intangible assets preliminarily recorded in connection with the SternoCandleLamp acquisition are as follows (in thousands): Intangible assets Trade name Customer Relationships Amount Estimated Useful Life 60,140 30,810 90,950 Indefinite 10 years $ F-19 Unaudited pro forma information The following unaudited pro forma data for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 gives effect to the acquisition of Clean Earth and SternoCandleLamp, as described above, as if the acquisitions had been completed as of January 1, 2013. The pro forma data gives effect to historical operating results with adjustments to interest expense, amortization and depreciation expense, management fees and related tax effects. The information is provided for illustrative purposes only and is not necessarily indicative of the operating results that would have occurred if the transaction had been consummated on the date indicated, nor is it necessarily indicative of future operating results of the consolidated companies, and should not be construed as representing results for any future period. (in thousands) (cid:2)et sales Operating income (cid:2)et income (cid:2)et income attributable to Holdings Basic and fully diluted net income per share attributable to Holdings Year Ended December 31, 2014 2013 $ 1,182,543 $ 1,275,071 66,335 291,150 278,742 5.38 124,117 74,572 63,782 0.96 2012 Acquisition Acquisition of Arnold Magnetics On March 5, 2012, AMT Acquisition Corp. (“Arnold Acquisition”), a subsidiary of the Company, entered into a stock purchase agreement with Arnold Magnetic Technologies, LLC, and Arnold Magnetics pursuant to which Arnold Acquisition acquired all of the issued and outstanding equity of Arnold Magnetics. The Company made loans to and purchased a 96.6% controlling interest in Arnold on a primary and fully diluted basis. The purchase price, including proceeds from noncontrolling interests, was approximately $130.5 million (excluding acquisition-related costs). Acquisition related costs were approximately $4.8 million and were recorded to selling, general and administrative expense during the year ended December 31, 2012. The Company funded the acquisition through available cash on its balance sheet and a draw of $25 million on its Revolving Credit Facility. Arnold’s management and certain other investors invested in the transaction alongside the Company, collectively representing 3.4% initial noncontrolling interest on a primary and fully diluted basis. CGM acted as an advisor to the Company in the transaction and received fees and expense payments totaling approximately $1.2 million. Joint Venture Arnold Magnetics is a 50% partner in a China rare earth mine-to-magnet joint venture. Arnold Magnetics accounts for its activity in the joint venture utilizing the equity method of accounting. Gains and losses from the joint venture were not material for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013. Other acquisitions Clean Earth On December 15, 2014, the Company's Clean Earth subsidiary completed the acquisition of American Environmental Services, Inc. ("AES"), for a purchase price of approximately $16.6 million. AES provides environmental services, managing hazardous and non-hazardous waste from off-site generators. AES has two fully permitted hazardous waste facilities located in Calvert City, Kentucky and Morgantown, West Virginia, serving industrial and government customers across the region. The acquisition expands Clean Earth's customer base and geographic market penetration. FOX On March 31, 2014, FOX acquired certain assets and assumed certain liabilities of Sport Truck, USA, Inc. ("Sport Truck"), a privately held global distributor of its own branded aftermarket suspension solutions and a reseller of FOX products. The transaction F-20 was accounted for as a business combination. FOX paid cash consideration of approximately $40.8 million. The purchase price of Sport Truck was allocated to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their respective fair values as of the date of acquisition with the excess purchase price allocated to goodwill. On October 31, 2013, FOX completed the acquisition of certain assets of its Germany based distributor and service center. The acquisition was accounted for as a business combination. The total consideration transferred for the acquisition was $2.5 million and consisted of cash paid at closing of $1.1 million and $1.2 million of cash paid in 2014. The total consideration was reduced by the effective settlement of trade receivables and payables in the amount of $0.2 million, resulting in a net purchase price of $2.3 million. The net assets acquired in the acquisitions by FOX in 2014 and 2013 were included in the balance of FOX that was deconsolidated as a result of the Company's ownership in FOX falling to 41% in July 2014. Refer to (cid:2)ote B. Advanced Circuits On May 23, 2012, the Company’s subsidiary, Advanced Circuits, completed the acquisition of Universal Circuits, Inc. a manufacturer of printed circuit boards, for approximately $2.3 million. The manufacturing facility is located in Maple Grove, Minnesota. This acquisition expands ACI’s capabilities and provides immediate access to manufacturing capabilities of more advanced higher tech PCBs. (cid:2)ote D — Equity Method Investment Investment in FOX The Company owns approximately 41% of the outstanding equity of FOX, and has elected to account for its investment in FOX at fair value using the equity method beginning on the date the investment became subject to the equity method of accounting. The investment in FOX had a fair value of $245.2 million at December 31, 2014 based on the closing price of FOX shares on that date. The Company recognized a gain of $11.0 million in the consolidated statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2014 due to an increase in the fair value of the FOX investment from the initial date of measurement through year-end. The following table reflects the year to date activity from our investment in FOX (in thousands): Balance January 1, 2014 Effect of deconsolidation (1) Gain on investment Balance December 31, 2014 Year ended December 31, 2014 $ $ — 234,185 11,029 245,214 (1) Refer to Footnote B to the consolidated financial statements. F-21 The results of operations and balance sheet information of the Company's FOX investment are summarized below: Condensed Income Statement information (1): (cid:2)et revenue Gross profit Operating income (cid:2)et income Condensed Balance Sheet information: Current assets (cid:2)on-current assets Current liabilities (cid:2)on-current liabilities Stockholders' equity $ $ $ $ $ December 31, 2014 306,734 94,420 34,623 27,686 112,609 145,828 258,437 60,825 68,806 128,806 258,437 (1) The condensed income statement information included in the table above reflects Fox's results of operations for the full fiscal year ending December 31, 2014. FOX's results of operations for the period from January 1, 2014 through July 10, 2014, the date of deconsolidation, are included in the results of operations of the Company for the year ending December 31, 2014. The following table summarizes FOX's results of operations that are included in the Company's consolidated results of operations for the period from January 1, 2014 through July 10, 2014, the date of deconsolidation, and for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012 (in thousands): (cid:2)et revenue Gross profit Operating income (cid:2)et income Year ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 $ 149,995 $ 272,746 $ 235,869 46,294 17,294 15,047 80,129 38,781 24,102 62,829 26,152 14,210 (cid:2)ote E — Discontinued Operations HALO sale On May 1, 2012, the Company sold its majority owned subsidiary HALO, to Candlelight Investment Holdings, Inc., for a total enterprise value of $76.5 million. The transaction is subject to customary escrow requirements and adjustment for certain changes in the working capital of HALO. The HALO purchase agreement contains customary representations, warranties, covenants and indemnification provisions. At the closing, the Company received approximately $66.0 million in cash in respect of its debt and equity interests in HALO and for the payment of accrued interest and fees after payments to non-controlling shareholders and payment of all transaction expenses. The Company also subsequently received approximately $0.8 million of proceeds that were held in escrow. In addition, the Company expects to receive a tax refund of approximately $1.0 million resulting from the tax benefit of the transaction expenses incurred in connection with the transaction. The net proceeds were used to repay outstanding debt under the Company’s Revolving F-22 Credit Facility. The Company recognized a loss of $0.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2012 as a result of the sale of HALO. The Company paid profit allocation of $0.2 million to Holders in the fourth quarter of 2012. Summarized operating results for HALO for the period from January 1, 2012 through the date of disposition were as follows (in thousands): (cid:2)et sales Operating loss Loss from continuing operations before income taxes Benefit for income taxes Loss from discontinued operations (1) For the period Jan. 1, 2012 through disposition $ $ 51,253 (2,141) (2,141) (973) (1,168) (1) The results of for the period from January 1, 2012 through disposition excludes $0.7 million of intercompany interest expense, respectively. (cid:2)ote F — Operating Segment Data At December 31, 2014, the Company had nine reportable operating segments. Each operating segment represents a platform acquisition. The Company’s operating segments are strategic business units that offer different products and services. They are managed separately because each business requires different technology and marketing strategies. A description of each of the reportable segments and the types of products from which each segment derives its revenues is as follows: • CamelBak is a diversified hydration and personal protection platform, offering products for outdoor, recreation and military applications. CamelBak offers a broad range of recreational / military hydration packs, reusable water bottles, specialized military gloves and performance accessories. Through its global distribution network, CamelBak products are available in more than 65 countries worldwide. CamelBak is headquartered in Petaluma, California. • Ergobaby, headquartered in Los Angeles, California, is a designer, marketer and distributor of wearable baby carriers and related baby wearing products, as well as stroller travel systems and accessories. Ergobaby offers a broad range of wearable baby carriers, stroller travel systems and related products that are sold through more than 450 retailers and web shops in the United States and throughout the world. Ergobaby has two main product lines: baby carriers (baby carriers and accessories) and infant travel systems (strollers and accessories). • Liberty Safe is a designer, manufacturer and marketer of premium home and gun safes in (cid:2)orth America. From it’s over 314,000 square foot manufacturing facility, Liberty produces a wide range of home and gun safe models in a broad assortment of sizes, features and styles. Liberty is headquartered in Payson, Utah. • Advanced Circuits, an electronic components manufacturing company, is a provider of small-run, quick-turn and volume production rigid printed circuit boards. ACI manufactures and delivers custom printed circuit boards to customers primarily in (cid:2)orth America. ACI is headquartered in Aurora, Colorado. • American Furniture is a low cost manufacturer of upholstered furniture sold to major and mid-sized retailers. American Furniture operates in the promotional-to-moderate priced upholstered segment of the furniture industry, which is characterized by affordable prices, fresh designs and fast delivery to the retailers. American Furniture was founded in 1998 and focuses on 3 product categories: (i) stationary, (ii) motion (reclining sofas/loveseats.) and (iii) recliners. AFM is headquartered in Ecru, Mississippi and its products are sold in the United States. • Arnold Magnetics is a global manufacturer of engineered magnetic solutions for a wide range of specialty applications and end-markets, including energy, medical, aerospace and defense, consumer electronics, general industrial and automotive. Arnold Magnetics produces high performance permanent magnets (PMAG), flexible magnets (FlexMag) and precision foil products (Precision Thin Metals) that are mission critical in motors, generators, sensors and other systems and components. Based on its long-term relationships, the company has built a diverse and blue-chip customer base totaling more than 2,000 clients worldwide. Arnold Magnetics is headquartered in Rochester, (cid:2)ew York. F-23 • Clean Earth provides environmental services for a variety of contaminated materials including soils dredged materials, hazardous waste and drill cuttings. Clean Earth analyzes, treats, documents and recycles waste streams generated in multiple end markets such as power, construction, oil and gas, infrastructure, industrial and dredging. Clean Earth is headquartered in Hatsboro, Pennsylvania and operates 14 facilities in the eastern United States. • SternoCandleLamp is a manufacturer and marketer of portable food warming fuel and creative table lighting solutions for the food service industry. SternoCandleLamp's products include wick and gel chafing fuels, butane stoves and accessories, liquid and traditional wax candles, catering equipment and lamps. SternoCandleLamp is headquartered in Corona, California. • Tridien is a designer and manufacturer of powered and non-powered medical therapeutic support surfaces and patient positioning devices serving the acute care, long-term care and home health care markets. Tridien is headquartered in Coral Springs, Florida and its products are sold primarily in (cid:2)orth America. The tabular information that follows shows data for each of the operating segments reconciled to amounts reflected in the consolidated financial statements. The operations of each of the operating segments are included in consolidated operating results as of their date of acquisition. FOX was an operating segment of the Company until July 10, 2014, when FOX was deconsoldiated and became an equity method investment. The results of operations of FOX are included in the disaggregated revenue and other financial data presented for the year ending December 31, 2014 for the period from January 1, 2014 through July 10, 2014. Segment profit is determined based on internal performance measures used by the Chief Executive Officer to assess the performance of each business. All our operating segments are deemed reporting units for purposes of annual or event-driven goodwill impairment testing, with the exception of Arnold Magnetics which has three reporting units (PMAG, FlexMag and Precision Thin Metals). Segment profit excludes certain charges from the acquisitions of the Company’s initial businesses not pushed down to the segments which are reflected in the Corporate and other line item. There were no significant inter-segment transactions. A disaggregation of the Company’s consolidated revenue and other financial data for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 is presented below (in thousands): (cid:2)et sales of operating segments CamelBak Ergobaby FOX Liberty ACI American Furniture Arnold Magnetics Clean Earth SternoCandleLamp Tridien Total 2014 Year ended December 31, 2013 2012 $ $ 148,675 82,255 149,995 90,149 85,918 129,696 123,205 68,440 36,713 67,254 982,300 $ 139,943 67,340 272,746 126,541 87,406 104,885 126,606 — — 60,072 985,539 157,633 64,032 235,869 91,622 84,071 91,455 104,184 — — 55,855 884,721 — 884,721 Reconciliation of segment revenues to consolidated revenues: Corporate and other Total consolidated revenues — 982,300 $ — 985,539 $ $ F-24 International Revenues Revenues from geographic locations outside the United States were material for the following segments: CamelBak, Ergobaby, Arnold and SternoCandleLamp, in each of the periods presented. Revenue attributable to any individual foreign country is not material. The international revenues from FOX in 2014 are for the period from January 1, 2014 through July 10, 2014, the date of deconsolidation. There were no significant inter-segment transactions. International revenues CamelBak Ergobaby FOX Arnold Magnetics SternoCandleLamp Year ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 $ 37,330 $ 31,639 $ 46,702 79,306 55,591 2,137 40,322 176,633 61,406 — 30,095 37,576 151,586 45,850 — Total international revenues $ 221,066 $ 310,000 $ 265,107 (1) Profit (loss) of operating segments CamelBak Ergobaby FOX Liberty ACI (2) American Furniture Arnold Magnetics (3) Clean Earth (4) SternoCandleLamp (5) Tridien (6) Total Reconciliation of segment profit to consolidated income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes: Interest expense, net Other income (expense), net Gain on equity method investment Corporate and other (7) Total consolidated income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes $ Year ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 $ 17,913 18,147 17,292 (2,717) 22,455 3,661 7,095 2,737 (1,810) 2,191 86,964 (27,068) (139) 11,029 228,633 $ 17,919 12,616 38,781 12,458 22,945 175 8,914 — — (10,227) 103,581 (19,376) (77) — 15,417 25,501 10,928 26,152 5,985 23,967 (1,520) (518) — — 3,667 94,162 (25,001) (183) — (42,156) $ 299,419 $ 99,545 $ 26,822 (1) Segment profit (loss) represents operating income (loss). (2) The year ended December 31, 2012 includes $0.4 million of acquisition-related costs incurred as a result of the acquisition of Universal Circuits. (3) The year ended December 31, 2012 results include $4.8 million of acquisition-related costs incurred in connection with the acquisition of Arnold, and $3.1 million of cost of goods sold expense associated with the amortization of the inventory fair value step-up recorded in 2012 in connection with the acquisition of Arnold. (4) The year ended December 31, 2014 includes $1.9 million of acquisition related costs incurred in connection with the acquisition of Clean Earth, and $0.6 million in integration service fees paid to CGM. (5) The year ended December 31, 2014 includes $2.8 million of acquisition related costs incurred in connection with the acquisition of SternoCandleLamp, $2.0 million of cost of goods sold expense related to the amortization of the step-up in inventory basis resulting from the purchase price allocation of SternoCandleLamp, and $0.1 million in integration service fees paid to CGM. (6) Includes $12.9 million of goodwill and intangible assets impairment charges during the year ended December 31, 2013. See (cid:2)ote H - Property, Plant and Equipment. (7) Primarily relates to the gain on the deconsolidation of FOX during 2014, the supplemental put reversal as a result of termination of the MSA during 2013, fair value adjustments to the supplemental put liability during 2012, and management fees expensed and payable to CGM. F-25 Accounts Receivable December 31, 2014 23,346 $ 9,671 — 11,376 5,730 16,641 15,664 52,059 21,113 7,135 162,735 Accounts Receivable December 31, 2013 18,054 $ 8,626 34,197 13,029 5,542 11,502 16,922 — — 7,288 115,160 — 162,735 (5,200) 157,535 $ — 115,160 (3,424) 111,736 Depreciation and Amortization Year ended December 31, 2014 $ 13,240 3,832 4,785 6,250 4,606 205 8,528 6,605 4,643 2,503 55,197 2013 $ 12,929 3,686 7,759 6,173 4,930 184 8,135 — — 2,178 45,974 2012 $ 12,973 4,215 7,204 7,023 4,865 139 9,373 — — 2,330 48,122 $ Identifiable Assets Dec. 31, 2013(1) $ 218,081 65,838 93,700 49,247 22,044 32,851 87,921 — — 15,324 585,006 Identifiable Assets Dec. 31, 2014(1) $ 207,831 65,309 — 34,139 19,334 27,810 77,610 203,938 126,302 14,844 777,117 Accounts receivable CamelBak Ergobaby FOX Liberty ACI American Furniture Arnold Magnetics Clean Earth SternoCandleLamp Tridien Total Reconciliation of segment to consolidated totals: Corporate and other Total Allowance for doubtful accounts Total consolidated net accounts receivable Goodwill Dec. 31, Goodwill Dec. 31, 2014 $ 5,546 41,664 2013 $ 5,546 41,664 — 31,924 32,684 57,615 — 51,767 — — 16,762 237,962 32,828 57,615 — 51,767 110,633 33,716 16,762 350,531 Goodwill and identifiable assets of operating segments CamelBak Ergobaby FOX Liberty ACI American Furniture Arnold Magnetics (2) Clean Earth SternoCandleLamp Tridien (3) Total Reconciliation of segment to consolidated total: Corporate and other identifiable assets Amortization of debt issuance costs and original issue discount Goodwill carried at Corporate level (4) Total — — 253,599 101,560 501 253 228 8,649 $359,180 8,649 $246,611 — $1,030,716 — $ 686,566 3,125 — $ 58,823 3,366 — $ 49,593 4,169 — $ 52,519 (1) Does not include accounts receivable balances per schedule above. (2) Arnold Magnetics has three reporting units PMAG, FlexMag and Precision Thin Metals with goodwill balances of $40.4 million, $4.8 million and $6.5 million, respectively. (3) Tridien goodwill and identifiable assets reflect impairment incurred during 2013 (see (cid:2)ote H). (4) Represents goodwill resulting from purchase accounting adjustments not “pushed down” to the segments. This amount is allocated back to the respective segments for purposes of goodwill impairment testing. During 2013 the Tridien goodwill previously carried at Corporate was pushed down to Tridien. The remaining amount of goodwill at the Corporate level relates to ACI. F-26 (cid:2)ote G - Property, Plant, Equipment and Inventory Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment is comprised of the following (in thousands): Machinery and equipment Office furniture, computers and software Leasehold improvements Buildings and land Less: accumulated depreciation Total December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 $ $ 127,035 12,322 10,419 25,271 175,047 (59,176) 115,871 $ $ 90,717 11,385 15,354 425 117,881 (49,822) 68,059 Depreciation expense was approximately $20.0 million, $16.6 million and $14.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Inventory Inventory is comprised of the following (in thousands): Raw materials and supplies Work-in-process Finished goods Less: obsolescence reserve Total December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 $ $ 49,727 10,632 59,442 (8,587) 111,214 $ $ 74,325 13,579 73,664 (8,620) 152,948 (cid:2)ote H — Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets Goodwill represents the difference between purchase cost and the fair value of net assets acquired in business acquisitions. Indefinite lived intangible assets, representing trademarks and trade names, are not amortized unless their useful life is determined to be finite. Long-lived intangible assets are subject to amortization using the straight-line method. Goodwill and indefinite lived intangible assets are tested for impairment annually as of March 31st of each year and more often if a triggering event occurs, by comparing the fair value of each reporting unit to its carrying value. Each of the Company’s businesses represents a reporting unit except Arnold, which is comprised of three reporting units. 2014 Annual Goodwill Impairment Testing At March 31, 2014, the Company elected to use the qualitative assessment alternative to test goodwill for impairment for each of the reporting units that maintain a goodwill carrying value. The Company determined that two of Arnold’s three reporting units required further quantitative testing (Step 1) since the Company could not conclude that the fair value of Arnold’s reporting units exceeded their carrying values based solely on qualitative factors. Results of the quantitative analysis indicated that the fair value of these reporting units exceeds their carrying value. The fair value of the reporting unit was determined utilizing a discounted cash flow methodology ("DCF") on both an income and market approach for the Flexmag reporting unit and the income approach for Precision Thin Metals reporting unit. A representative market does not exist for Precision Thin metals. The DCF utilized a weighted average cost of capital of 12.5% for Flexmag and 14.5% for Precision Thin Metals. The following factors were considered when making the qualitative assessment prior to performing Step 1 of the goodwill impairment test: • Macroeconomic conditions such as deterioration in general economic conditions, limitations on accessing capital, fluctuations in foreign exchange rates, or other developments in equity and credit markets; F-27 • Industry and market considerations such as deterioration in the environment in which an entity operates, an increased competitive environment, a decline (both absolute and relative to its peers) in market-dependent multiples or metrics, a change in the market for an entity’s products or services, or a regulatory or political development; • Cost factor, such as increases in raw materials, labor, or other costs that have a negative effect on earnings and cash flows; • Overall financial performance such as negative or declining cash flows or a decline in actual or planned revenue or earnings compared with actual or planned revenue or earnings compared with actual and projected results of relevant prior periods; • Other relevant entity-specific events such as litigation, contemplation of bankruptcy, or changes in management, key personnel, strategy, or customers; and • Events affecting a reporting unit such as change in the composition or carrying amount of its net assets, a more-likely- than-not expectation of selling or disposing of all or a portion, of a reporting unit, the testing for recoverability of a significant asset group within a reporting unit, or a recognition of a goodwill impairment loss in the financial statements of a subsidiary that is a component of a reporting unit. In addition to considering the above factors we performed the following procedures as of March 31, 2014 for each of our reporting units except for the Arnold Flexmag and Precision Thin Metals reporting units: • Compared and assessed trailing twelve month (“TTM”) net sales as of March 31, 2014 to TTM net sales as of March 31, 2013: • Compared and assessed TTM operating income as of March 31, 2014 to TTM operating income as of March 31, 2013; • Compared and assessed TTM Adjusted EBITDA as of March 31, 2014 to Adjusted EBITDA as of March 31, 2013; • Compared and assessed Adjusted EBITDA for the year-ended December 31, 2013 to Budget; • Compared and assessed Adjusted EBITDA for the three-months ended March 31, 2014 to Budget; • Compared the fair value of each of our reporting units to its carrying amount as of March 31, 2014 and concluded that • in each case the fair value of the reporting unit was in excess of its carrying amount; and Performed Market Cap reconciliation for CODI and determined that CODI’s public market cap was in excess of the fair value of its consolidated equity. Based on our qualitative assessment as outlined above we believe that it is more likely than not that the fair value of each of our reporting units exceeds its carrying amount at March 31, 2014. 2014 Annual Indefinite Lived Intangible Asset Impairment Testing At March 31, 2014, the Company elected to use the qualitative assessment alternative to test indefinite lived intangible assets for impairment for each of the reporting units that maintain indefinite lived intangible assets. The optional qualitative assessment permits an entity to consider events and circumstances that could affect the fair value of the indefinite-lived intangible asset and avoid the quantitative test if the entity is able to support a conclusion that the indefinite-lived intangible asset is not impaired. The Company’s indefinite-lived intangible assets consisted of trade names with a carrying value of approximately $147.6 million at March 31, 2014. Results of the qualitative analysis indicate that the fair value of the Company’s indefinite-lived intangible assets exceeded their carrying value. 2013 Annual Goodwill Impairment Test The Company completed its analysis of the 2013 annual goodwill impairment testing as of March 31, 2013. The Company elected to use the qualitative assessment alternative to test goodwill for impairment for each of the reporting units that maintain a goodwill carrying value with the exception of Arnold which required further quantitative testing (step 1), in that the Company could not conclude that the fair value of the Arnold reporting units exceeded the carrying value based on qualitative factors alone. As of March 31, 2013 the Company had concluded that the estimated fair value of each of the reporting units subject to the qualitative assessment exceeded its carrying value. In addition, based on the step 1 quantitative impairment analysis of the three reporting units at Arnold, the Company has concluded that the fair value for each of Arnold’s three reporting units exceeded its carrying amount. F-28 2013 Interim Goodwill Impairment Testing During the second quarter of 2013, one of Tridien’s largest customers lost a large contract program that was being serviced substantially with Tridien product. The expected lost sales and net income were significant enough to trigger an interim goodwill impairment analysis. The result of the interim goodwill impairment analysis indicated that the fair value of goodwill exceeded the carrying value of goodwill ($28.2 million) by approximately 6%. The weighted average cost of capital used in the anlaysis was 14.5%. A 1% increase in the weighted average cost of capital would have required the Company to impair Tridien’s goodwill balance at June 30, 2013. During the fourth quarter of 2013, further revenue decreases led the Company to lower its forecasted revenue growth at Tridien to reflect expected deterioration of future growth rates based on current operating results and future negative trends at the Tridien reporting unit. Revenue growth rates have a significant impact on the discounted cash flow models for the reporting unit and as a result, the change in the forecast triggered an interim goodwill impairment analysis. The result of the interim impairment analysis (step 1) indicated that goodwill was impaired. Further testing (step 2) resulted in the following: (i) goodwill was written down $11.5 million to a balance of $16.8 million; (ii) trade names were written down $0.4 million to a balance of $0.2 million and; (iii) technology assets were written down $0.1 million to a balance of $0.8 million. These charges were recorded as impairment expense in the accompanying consolidated statement of operations. 2013 Annual Indefinite Lived Intangible Asset Impairment Testing At March 31, 2013, the Company elected to use the qualitative assessment alternative to test its indefinite-lived intangible assets for impairment. As of March 31, 2013, the Company concluded that the estimated fair value of each of its indefinite lived intangible assets exceeded its carrying value. 2013 Interim Indefinite Lived Intangible Asset Impairment Testing During the second quarter of 2013, one of Tridien’s largest customers lost a large contract program that was being serviced substantially with Tridien product. The expected lost sales and net income were significant enough to trigger an interim indefinite- lived asset impairment analysis. The analysis indicated that sales of Tridien product, reliant on trade names could not fully support the carrying value of Tridien’s trade names. As such, the Company wrote down the value of the trade names by $0.9 million to a carrying value of approximately $0.6 million. As discussed above, during the fourth quarter of 2013, the Company lowered its forecasted revenue growth at Tridien to reflect expected deterioration of future growth rates based on current operating results and future negative trends at the Tridien reporting unit. The resulting impairment test resulted in an additional impairment of trade name intangible of $0.4 million. See above for results of the testing. 2012 Annual Goodwill Impairment Testing The Company conducted its 2012 annual goodwill impairment testing as of March 31, 2012. At each of the reporting units tested, the units’ implied fair value of goodwill exceeded its carrying value. 2012 Indefinite Lived Intangible Asset Impairment Testing The Company completed its 2012 annual impairment testing on indefinite lived intangible assets as of March 31, 2012 and the results of the testing did not indicate impairment. Tridien In January 2015, one of Tridien’s largest customers informed the Company they would not renew their purchase agreement when it expires on September 30, 2015. This customer represented 20% of Tridien’s sales in 2014. The expected lost sales and net income are significant enough to trigger an interim goodwill and indefinite-lived asset impairment analysis which will be performed during the first quarter of 2015. At December 31, 2014, Tridien had goodwill of $16.8 million and indefinite lived intangibles of $0.1 million recorded on its balance sheet. It is possible that the result of the lost sales and net income from this customer may result in a goodwill impairment. F-29 A reconciliation of the change in the carrying value of goodwill for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 are as follows (in thousands): Beginning balance: Goodwill Accumulated impairment losses Impairment losses Acquisition of businesses (1) Effect of deconsolidation of subsidiary (2) Total adjustments Ending balance: Goodwill Accumulated impairment losses December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 $ $ $ 299,514 (52,903) 246,611 — 157,864 (45,295) 112,569 412,083 (52,903) 359,180 $ 298,962 (41,435) 257,527 (11,468) 552 — (10,916) 299,514 (52,903) 246,611 (1) Acquisition of businesses during the year ended December 31, 2014 relates to the acquisition of Clean Earth in August 2014, SternoCandleLamp in October 2014, the acquisition of AES by Clean Earth in December 2014, and the acquisition of Sport Truck by FOX in March 2014. The $12.0 million of goodwill related to the Sport Truck acquisition and the $0.6 million related to a prior year acquisition by FOX is included in the amount of $45.3 million that was deconsolidated during the year ended December 31, 2014. (2) As a result of the sale of shares by the Company in the FOX Secondary Offering, the Company's ownership interest in FOX decreased to approximately 41%, which resulted in the deconsolidation of the FOX operating segment from the Company's consolidated financial statements effective July 10, 2014. Approximately $88.9 million of goodwill is deductible for income tax purposes at December 31, 2014. Other intangible assets subject to amortization are comprised of the following (in thousands): Customer relationships Technology and patents Trade names, subject to amortization Licensing and non-compete agreements Permits and airspace (1) Distributor relations and other Accumulated amortization: Customer relationships Technology and patents Trade names, subject to amortization Licensing and non-compete agreements Permits and airspace Distributor relations and other Total accumulated amortization Trade names, not subject to amortization Total intangibles, net Weighted Average Useful Lives 12 8 17 5 13 5 December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 266,976 56,731 7,595 7,856 98,406 606 438,170 (75,813) (26,906) (3,763) (7,499) (3,104) (606) (117,691) 166,741 487,220 $ $ 192,387 89,443 7,595 7,736 — 606 297,767 (64,752) (44,703) (1,895) (6,798) — (606) (118,754) 131,346 310,359 $ $ (1) Permits and airspace intangible assets relate to the acquisition of Clean Earth in August 2014. Permits are obtained by Clean Earth for the treatment of soil and solid waste from various government municipalities and are amortized over the estimated life of the permit. Modifications of existing permits to accept new waste streams, alterations of existing permits to enhance the permit limitations, and new permits, as well as the related costs associated with obtaining, modifying or renewing the permits, are capitalized and amortized over the estimated life of the permit. F-30 Estimated charges to amortization expense of intangible assets over the next five years, is as follows, (in thousands): 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 $ $ 40,589 38,368 35,451 32,974 31,556 178,938 The Company’s amortization expense of intangible assets for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 totaled $33.6 million, $29.6 million and $30.3 million, and respectively. (cid:2)ote I — Fair Value Measurement The following table provides the assets and liabilities carried at fair value measured on a recurring basis as of December 31, 2014 and 2013 (in thousands): Assets: Equity method investment - FOX Liabilities: Call option of noncontrolling shareholder (1) Put option of noncontrolling shareholders (2) Interest rate swaps Total recorded at fair value Assets: Interest rate cap Liabilities: Call option of noncontrolling shareholder Put option of noncontrolling shareholders Interest rate swap Total recorded at fair value Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2014 Carrying Value Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 $ 245,214 $ 245,214 $ — $ (25) (50) (9,828) 235,311 $ — — — 245,214 $ — — (9,828) (9,828) $ Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2013 Carrying Value Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 — $ (25) (50) (4,126) (4,201) $ — $ — — — — $ — $ — — (4,126) (4,126) $ $ $ $ — (25) (50) — (75) — (25) (50) — (75) (1) Represents a noncontrolling shareholder’s call option to purchase additional common stock in Tridien. (2) Represents put options issued to noncontrolling shareholders in connection with the Liberty acquisition. A reconciliation of the change in the carrying value of the Company’s Level 3 fair value measurements for the year ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 is as follows (in thousands): Balance at January 1 Payment of supplemental put liability Supplemental put expense Supplemental put termination Balance at December 31 F-31 2014 2013 (75) $ — — — (75) $ (51,673) 5,603 (15,308) 61,303 (75) $ $ Valuation Techniques Equity method investment The equity method investment in FOX is measured at fair value using the closing price of FOX's shares on the (cid:2)ASDAQ stock exchange as of the last business day in the reporting period. Since the FOX shares are traded on a public stock exchange, the fair value measurement is categorized as Level I. Options of noncontrolling shareholders: The call option of the noncontrolling shareholder was determined based on inputs that were not readily available in public markets or able to be derived from information available in publicly quoted markets. As such, the Company categorized the call option of the noncontrolling shareholder as Level 3. The primary inputs associated with this valuation utilizing a Black-Scholes model are volatility of 30%, an estimated term of 5 years and a discount rate of 45%. An increase or decrease in these primary inputs would not have a material impact on the determination of the fair value of this call option. The put options of noncontrolling shareholders were determined based on inputs that were not readily available in public markets or able to be derived from information available in publicly quoted markets. As such, the Company categorized the put options of the noncontrolling shareholders as Level 3. The primary inputs associated with this valuation utilizing a Black-Scholes model are volatility of 44%, an estimated term of 5 years and the underlying price equal to a calculation based on trailing twelve months earnings before interest, taxes amortization and depreciation times a multiple established in the shareholder put option agreement. An increase or decrease in these primary inputs would not have a material impact on the determination of the fair value of these put options. Interest rate swap—liability: The Company’s derivative instruments at December 31, 2014 consisted of over-the-counter interest rate swap contracts which are not traded on a public exchange. The fair value of the Company’s interest rate swap contracts were determined based on inputs that were readily available in public markets or could be derived from information available in publicly quoted markets. As such, the Company categorized the swaps as Level 2. Changes in the fair value of the interest rate swap liability during the year ended December 31, 2014 were expensed to interest expense on the consolidated statement of operations. Refer to "(cid:2)ote K - Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities". 2014 Term Loan At December 31, 2014, the carrying value of the principal under the Company's outstanding 2014 Term Loan, including the current portion, was $323.4 million, which approximates fair value because it has a variable interest rate that reflects market changes in interest rates and changes in the Company's net leverage ratio. The estimated fair value of the outstanding 2014 Term Loan is classified as Level 2 in the fair value hierarchy. The following table provides the assets and liabilities carried at fair value measured on a non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2013 (in thousands). Refer to "(cid:2)ote H – Goodwill and Intangibles", for a description of the valuation techniques used to determine fair value of the assets measured on a non-recurring basis in the table below. There were no assets and liabilities carried at fair value measured on a non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2014. (cid:2)on-recurring Assets: Trade name (1) Technology (1) Goodwill (1) Fair Value Measurements at Dec. 31, 2013 Expense Year ended December 31, Carrying Value Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 2013 $ $ 205 800 16,760 — $ — — — $ — — 205 800 16,760 $ $ 1,350 100 11,468 (1) Represents the fair value of the respective assets at the Tridien business segment subsequent to the goodwill impairment, indefinite-lived and long-lived asset impairment charges recognized during the year ended December 31, 2013. Refer to "(cid:2)ote H - Goodwill and Intangibles", for further discussion regarding impairments and valuation techniques applied. F-32 (cid:2)ote J – Debt 2014 Credit Agreement On June 6, 2014, the Company obtained a $725 million credit facility from a group of lenders (the “2014 Credit Facility”) led by Bank of America (cid:2).A. as Administrative Agent. The 2014 Credit Facility provides for (i) a revolving credit facility of $400 million (the “2014 Revolving Credit Facility”) and (ii) a $325 million term loan (the “2014 Term Loan Facility”). The 2014 Credit Facility permits the Company to increase the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility commitment and/ or obtain additional term loans in an aggregate of up to $200 million. The 2014 Credit Agreement is secured by all of the assets of the Company, including all of its equity interests in, and loans to, its consolidated subsidiaries. 2014 Revolving Credit Facility The 2014 Revolving Credit Facility will become due in June 2019. The Company can borrow, prepay and reborrow principal under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility from time to time during its term. Advances under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility can be either LIBOR rate loans or base rate loans. LIBOR rate revolving loans bear interest at a rate per annum equal to the London Interbank Offered Rate (the “LIBOR Rate”) plus a margin ranging from 2.00% to 2.75% based on the ratio of consolidated net indebtedness to adjusted consolidated earnings before interest expense, tax expense and depreciation and amortization expenses (the “Consolidated Leverage Ratio”). Base rate revolving loans bear interest at a fluctuating rate per annum equal to the greatest of (i) the prime rate of interest, or (ii) the Federal Funds Rate plus 0.5% (the “Base Rate”), plus a margin ranging from 1.00% to 1.75% based upon the Consolidated Leverage Ratio. 2014 Term Loan Facility The 2014 Term Loan Facility expires in June 2021 and requires quarterly payments of approximately$0.81 million that commenced September 30, 2014, with a final payment of all remaining principal and interest due on June 6, 2021. The 2014 Term Loan Facility was issued at an original issue discount of 99.5% of par value and bears interest at either the applicable LIBOR Rate plus 3.25% per annum, or Base Rate plus 2.25% per annum. The LIBOR Rate applicable to both base rate loans and LIBOR rate loans shall in no event be less than 1.00% at any time. Use of Proceeds The proceeds of the 2014 Term Loan Facility and advances under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility were/will be used to (i) refinance existing indebtedness of the Company, (ii) pay fees and expense, (iii) fund acquisitions of additional businesses, (iv) fund working capital needs and (v) to fund permitted distributions. The Company used approximately $290.0 million of the 2014 Term Loan Facility proceeds to pay all amounts outstanding under the 2011 Credit Agreement and to pay the closing costs. In addition, approximately $1.2 million of the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility commitment was utilized in connection with the issuance of letters of credit. Other The 2014 Credit Facility provides for sub-facilities under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility pursuant to which an aggregate amount of up to $100.0 million in letters of credit may be issued, as well as swing line loans of up to $25.0 million outstanding at one time. The issuance of such letters of credit and the making of any swing line loan reduces the amount available under the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility. The Company will pay (i) commitment fees on the unused portion of the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility ranging from 0.45% to 0.60% per annum based on its Consolidated Leverage Ratio, (ii) quarterly letter of credit fees, and (iii) administrative and agency fees. Debt Issuance Costs In connection with entering into the 2014 Credit Facility in which the loan syndication consisted of previous members of the syndication under the 2011 Credit Facility who either maintained or increased their position as well as new syndication members, the debt issuance costs associated with the 2011 Credit Facility and the 2014 Credit Facility have been classified as either debt modification costs which have been capitalized and will be amortized over the term of the 2014 Credit Facility, or debt extinguishment costs which have been recorded as an expense in the accompanying condensed consolidated statement of operations. The Company paid debt issuance costs of $7.3 million in connection with the 2014 Credit Facility (of which $0.2 million was expensed as debt modification and extinguishment costs and $7.1 million is being amortized over the term of the related debt in F-33 the 2014 Credit Facility) and recorded additional debt modification and extinguishment costs of $2.1 million to write-off previously capitalized debt issuance costs. 2011 Credit Agreement On October 27, 2011, the Company entered into a Credit Facility with a group of Lenders led by TD Securities for a $515 million credit facility, with an optional $135 million increase (the “2011 Credit Facility”). The 2011 Credit Facility provided for (i) a revolving line of credit of $290 million which was subsequently increased to $320 million (the "2011 Revolving credit Facility"), and (ii) a $225 million term loan which was subsequently increased to $279 million (the “2011 Term Loan Facility”). The 2011Term Loan Facility was issued at an original issuance discount of 96%. Amounts borrowed under the 2011 Revolving Credit Facility bore interest based on a leverage ratio defined in the credit agreement at either LIBOR plus a margin ranging from 2.5% to3.50%, or base rate plus a margin ranging from 1.50% to 2.50%. Amounts outstanding under the 2011 Term Loan Facility bore interest at LIBOR plus 4.00% with a LIBOR floor of 1.00%, or base rate plus a margin ranging from 1.50% to 2.50%. The 2011 Revolving Credit Facility was set to mature in October 2016, and the 2011 Term Loan Facility required quarterly payments of approximately $0.71 million, with the final payment of all remaining outstanding principle and interest due in October 2017. The Company was required to pay commitment fees of 1% per annum of the unused portion of the 2011 Revolving Credit Facility. The 2011 Credit Facility was terminated in June 2014. Covenants The Company is subject to certain customary affirmative and restrictive covenants arising under the 2014 Credit Facility. The following table reflects required and actual financial ratios as of December 31, 2014 included as part of the affirmative covenants in the 2014 Credit Facility: Description of Required Covenant Ratio Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio Total Debt to EBITDA Ratio Covenant Ratio Requirement greater than or equal to 1.5:1.0 less than or equal to 3.5:1.0 Actual Ratio 4.44:1.00 2.99:1.00 A breach of any of these covenants will be an event of default under the 2014 Credit Facility. Upon the occurrence of an event of default under the 2014 Credit Facility, the 2014 Revolving Credit Facility may be terminated, the 2014 Term Loan Facility and all outstanding loans and other obligations under the Credit Facility may become immediately due and payable and any letters of credit then outstanding may be required to be cash collateralized, and the Agent and the Lenders may exercise any rights or remedies available to them under the Credit Facility. Any such event would materially impair the Company’s ability to conduct its business. As of December 31, 2014, the Company was in compliance with all covenants as defined in the Credit Agreement. Letters of credit The Credit Facility allows for letters of credit in an aggregate face amount of up to $100.0 million. Letters of credit outstanding at December 31, 2014 totaled $4.5 million and at December 31, 2013 totaled approximately $1.6 million. Letter of credit fees recorded to interest expense was $0.1 million in each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. Interest hedge The Company has two swap contracts outstanding at December 31, 2014. One swap contract hedges $200 million of outstanding debt through 2016, while the second hedges $220 million of outstanding debt from April 2016 through June 2021. Refer to "(cid:2)ote K - Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities" for further information on the interest rate derivatives entered into as part of the Term Loan Facility. F-34 The following table provides the Company’s debt holdings at December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013 (in thousands): Revolving Credit Facility FOX Credit Facility Term Loan Facility Original issue discount (1) Total debt Less: Current portion, term loan facilities Long term debt December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 $ $ $ 169,725 — 323,375 (4,303) 488,797 (3,250) 485,547 $ $ $ — 8,000 279,750 (4,511) 283,239 (2,850) 280,389 (1) The Company recorded $4.6 million in original issue discount upon issuance of the 2014 Term Loan Facility in June 2014. This discount is being amortized over the life of the Term Loan Facility. Annual maturities of the 2014 Term Loan Facility and 2014 Revolving Credit Facility are as follows (in thousands): 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 2020 and thereafter $ $ $ 3,250 3,250 3,250 3,250 172,975 307,125 493,100 The following details the components of interest expense in each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 (in thousands): Interest on credit facilities Unused fee on Revolving Credit Facility Amortization of original issue discount Realized losses on interest rate hedges Unrealized losses on interest rate derivatives Letter of credit fees Other Interest expense Average daily balance of debt outstanding Effective interest rate Year ended December 31, 2014 2013 2012 $ $ $ 16,392 1,914 882 — 7,709 62 138 27,097 379,034 $ $ $ 15,625 2,349 1,243 — 130 53 15 19,415 294,056 $ $ $ 17,643 2,666 2,312 166 2,175 63 30 25,055 271,776 7.2% 6.6% 9.2% (cid:2)ote K — Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities Interest Rate Swaps On September 16, 2014, the Company purchased an interest rate swap ("(cid:2)ew Swap") with a notional amount of $220 million. The (cid:2)ew Swap is effective April 1, 2016 through June 6, 2021, the termination date of our 2014 Term Loan. The interest rate swap agreement requires the Company to pay interest rates on the notional amount at the rate of 2.97% in exchange for the three- month LIBOR rate. At December 31, 2014, the (cid:2)ew Swap had a fair value loss of $7.4 million, principally reflecting the present value of future payments and receipts under the agreement and is reflected as a component of other non-current liabilities. On October 31, 2011, the Company purchased a three-year interest rate swap (the "Swap") with a notional amount of $200 million effective January 1, 2011 through March 31, 2016. The interest rate swap agreement requires the Company to pay interest on the F-35 notional amount at the rate of 2.49% in exchange for the three-month LIBOR rate, with a floor of 1.5%. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, this Swap had a fair value loss of $2.5 million and $4.1 million , respectively, and is reflected in other current and other non-current liabilities with its mark-to-market value reflected as a component of interest expense. At December 31, 2014, the fair value loss of $2.5 million is reflected as a component of other non-current liabilities $(0.5) million with the remaining balance included as a component of current liabilities. The Company did not elect hedge accounting for the above derivative transaction associated with the Credit Facility and changes in fair value are included in interest expense on the consolidated statement of operations. (cid:2)ote L — Income Taxes Compass Diversified Holdings and Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC are classified as partnerships for U.S. Federal income tax purposes and are not subject to income taxes. Each of the Company’s majority owned subsidiaries are subject to Federal and state income taxes. Components of the Company’s income tax provision (benefit) are as follows (in thousands): Current taxes Federal State Foreign Total current taxes Deferred taxes: Federal State Foreign Total deferred taxes Total tax provision 2014 Year ended December 31, 2013 2012 $ $ $ 18,324 (2,619) 1,161 16,866 (6,993) (1,186) (423) (8,602) 8,264 $ 19,209 4,791 1,986 25,986 (3,834) (536) (887) (5,257) 20,729 $ $ 18,306 3,926 1,054 23,286 (1,767) 107 (557) (2,217) 21,069 The tax effects of temporary differences that have resulted in the creation of deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities at December 31, 2014 and 2013 are as follows (in thousands): Deferred tax assets: Tax credits Accounts receivable and allowances (cid:2)et operating loss carryforwards Accrued expenses Other Total deferred tax assets Valuation allowance (1) (cid:2)et deferred tax assets Deferred tax liabilities: Intangible assets Property and equipment Prepaid and other expenses Total deferred tax liabilities Total net deferred tax liability (1) Primarily relates to the AFM and Tridien operating segments. F-36 December 31, 2014 2013 $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 430 1,649 12,569 7,909 7,141 29,698 (12,664) 17,034 (83,768) $ (18,534) (1,027) (103,329) $ (86,295) $ 171 986 10,854 8,026 9,514 29,551 (12,028) 17,523 (46,314) (12,932) (778) (60,024) (42,501) For the years ending December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Company recognized approximately $103.3 million and $60.0 million, respectively in deferred tax liabilities. A significant portion of the balance in deferred tax liabilities reflects temporary differences in the basis of property and equipment and intangible assets related to the Company’s purchase accounting adjustments in connection with the acquisition of certain of its businesses. For financial accounting purposes the Company has recognized a significant increase in the fair values of the intangible assets and property and equipment in certain of the businesses it acquired. For income tax purposes the existing, pre-acquisition tax basis of the intangible assets and property and equipment is utilized. In order to reflect the increase in the financial accounting basis over the existing tax basis, a deferred tax liability was recorded. This liability will decrease in future periods as these temporary differences reverse but may be replaced by deferred tax liabilities generated as a result of future acquisitions. A valuation allowance relating to the realization of foreign tax credits and net operating losses of $12.7 million was provided at December 31, 2014 and $12.0 million was provided at December 31, 2013. A valuation allowance is provided whenever it is more likely than not that some or all of deferred assets recorded may not be realized. The reconciliation between the Federal Statutory Rate and the effective income tax rate for 2014, 2013 and 2012 are as follows: 2014 Year ended December 31, 2013 2012 United States Federal Statutory Rate Foreign and State income taxes (net of Federal benefits) Expenses of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC representing a pass through to shareholders (1) Effect of deconsolidation of subsidiary (2) Effect of supplemental put expense (reversal) (3) Impact of subsidiary employee stock options Domestic production activities deduction (cid:2)on-deductible acquisition costs (cid:2)on-recognition of (cid:2)OL carryforwards at subsidiaries Other Effective income tax rate 35.0% (1.1) 0.7 (30.8) — 0.1 (0.3) 0.1 0.2 (1.1) 2.8% 35.0% 1.9 1.5 — (16.2) 0.4 (1.8) — 3.1 (3.1) 20.8% 35.0% 11.7 10.2 — 20.9 (1.8) (4.1) 3.0 4.8 (1.1) 78.6% (1) The effective income tax rate for 2012 includes losses at the Company’s parent which is taxed as a partnership. (2) The effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2014 includes a significant gain at the Company's parent related to the deconsolidation of FOX in July 2014. (3) The effective income tax rate for the year ended December 31, 2013 includes a gain at our parent related to the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement in July 2013. F-37 A reconciliation of the amount of unrecognized tax benefits for 2014, 2013 and 2012 are as follows (in thousands): Balance at January 1, 2012 Additions for current years’ tax positions Additions for prior years’ tax positions Reductions for prior years’ tax positions Reductions for settlements Reductions for expiration of statute of limitations Balance at December 31, 2012 Additions for current years’ tax positions Additions for prior years’ tax positions Reductions for prior years’ tax positions Reductions for settlements Reductions for expiration of statute of limitations Balance at December 31, 2013 Additions for current years’ tax positions Additions for prior years’ tax positions Reductions for prior years’ tax positions (1) Reductions for settlements Reductions for expiration of statute of limitations Balance at December 31, 2014 $ $ $ $ 6,685 1,803 158 (29) — (835) 7,782 2,003 50 (2) — (1,725) 8,108 89 141 (7,620) — (67) 651 (1) $7.6 million of the reduction for prior year tax positions relates to the deconsolidation of FOX in July 2014. Included in the unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2014 and 2013 is $0.3 million and $7.9 million, respectively, of tax benefits that, if recognized, would affect the Company’s effective tax rate. The Company accrues interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions and at December 31, 2013, there is $0.2 million accrued. The amount accrued at December 31, 2014 is not material to the Company. Such amounts are included in the Provision (benefit) for income taxes in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations. The Company had an indemnification arrangement that offset $0.1 million of the unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2013. The change in the unrecognized tax benefits during 2013 is primarily due to the uncertainty of the deductibility of amortization and depreciation established as part of initial purchase price allocations in 2008, primarily related to FOX. The change in 2014 in the unrecognized tax benefits resulted from the deconsolidation of FOX. It is expected that the amount of unrecognized tax benefits will change in the next twelve months. However, we do not expect the change to have a significant impact on the consolidated results of operations or financial position. Each of the Company’s businesses file U.S. Federal, state and foreign income tax returns in multiple jurisdictions with varying statutes of limitations. The 2010 through 2014 tax years generally remain subject to examinations by the taxing authorities. (cid:2)ote M – Defined Benefit Plan In connection with the acquisition of Arnold, the Company has a defined benefit plan covering substantially all of Arnold’s employees at its Lupfig, Switzerland location. The benefits are based on years of service and the employees’ highest average compensation during the specific period. F-38 The following table sets forth the plan’s funded status and amounts recognized in the Company’s consolidated balance sheets at December 31, 2014 and 2013: Change in benefit obligation: Benefit obligation, beginning of year Service cost Interest cost Actuarial (gain)/loss Employee contributions and transfer Plan amendment Benefits paid Foreign currency translation Benefit obligation Change in plan assets: Fair value of assets, beginning of period Actual return on plan assets Company contribution Employee contributions and transfer Benefits paid Foreign currency translation Fair value of assets Funded status December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 $ $ $ $ 13,386 425 271 1,847 363 383 (621) (1,342) 14,712 $ 12,059 362 454 363 (621) (1,209) 11,408 (3,304) $ 14,395 484 298 (336) 394 — (2,375) 526 13,386 12,881 204 484 394 (2,375) 471 12,059 (1,327) The unfunded liability of $3.3 million and $1.3 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, is recognized in the consolidated balance sheet within other non-current liabilities. (cid:2)et periodic benefit cost consists of the following: Service cost Interest cost Expected return on plan assets (cid:2)et periodic benefit cost Year ended December 31, 2014 425 $ 271 (468) 228 $ Year ended December 31, 2013 484 $ 298 (284) 498 $ Date of acquisition through December 31, 2012 391 $ 316 (180) 527 $ Assumptions used to determine the benefit obligations and components of the net periodic benefit cost at December 31, 2014 and 2013: Discount rate Expected return on plan assets Rate of compensation increase December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 2.25% 2.25% 1.00% 1.25% 1.75% 1.00% The Company considers the historical level of long-term returns and the current level of expected long-term returns for the plan assets, as well as the current and expected allocation of assets when developing its expected long-term rate of return on assets assumption. The assumptions used for the plan are based upon customary rates and practices for the location of the Company. The Company, for 2015, will be contributing per the terms of the agreement, and the expected contribution to the plan will be approximately $0.6 million. F-39 The following presents the benefit payments which are expected to be paid for the plan (in thousands): Jan. 1, 2015 through Dec. 31, 2015 Jan. 1, 2016 through Dec. 31, 2016 Jan. 1, 2017 through Dec. 31, 2017 Jan. 1, 2018 through Dec. 31, 2018 Jan. 1, 2019 through Dec. 31, 2019 Jan. 1, 2020 and thereafter $ $ 519 507 855 521 1,332 4,111 7,845 Asset management objectives include maintaining an adequate level of diversification to reduce interest rate and market risk and providing adequate liquidity to meet immediate and future benefit payment requirements. The assets of the plan are reinsured in their entirety with Swiss Life Ltd. (“Swiss Life”) within the framework of the corresponding contracts with Swiss Life Collective BVG Foundation and Swiss Life Complementary Foundation. The assets are guaranteed by the insurance company and pooled with the assets of other participating employers. The allocation of pension plan assets by category in Swiss Life’s group life portfolio is as follows at December 31, 2014: Certificates of deposit and cash and cash equivalents Fixed income bonds and securities Private equity and hedge funds Real estate Equity and other investments 77% 6% 1% 12% 4% 100% The plan assets are pooled with assets of other participating employers and are not separable; therefore the fair values of the pension plan assets at December 31, 2014 and 2013 were considered Level 3. (cid:2)ote (cid:2) — Stockholder’s Equity Trust Shares The Trust is authorized to issue 500,000,000 Trust shares and the Company is authorized to issue a corresponding number of LLC interests. The Company will, at all times, have the identical number of LLC interests outstanding as Trust shares. Each Trust share represents an undivided beneficial interest in the Trust, and each Trust share is entitled to one vote per share on any matter with respect to which members of the Company are entitled to vote. Secondary Offering In (cid:2)ovember 2014, the Company completed an offering of 6,000,000 Trust shares at an offering price of $17.50 per share. The net proceeds to the Company, after deducting the underwriter's discount and offering costs, totaled approximately $99.9 million. Allocation Interests The Allocation Interests represent the original equity interest in the Company. The holders of the Allocation Interests (“Holders”), through Sostratus LLC, are entitled to receive distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of certain events. The distributions of the profit allocation is paid upon the occurrence of the sale of a material amount of capital stock or assets of one of the Company’s businesses (“Sale Event”) or, at the option of the Holders, at each five year anniversary date of the acquisition of one of the Company’s businesses (“Holding Event”). The Manager, as the original holder of the Allocation Interests, previously had the right to cause the Company to purchase the Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA in accordance with a Supplemental Put Agreement. On July 1, 2013, the Company and the Manager amended the MSA to provide for certain modifications related to the Manager’s registration as an investment advisor under the Investment Advisor’s Act of 1940, as amended (the “Advisor’s Act”). In connection with the amendment resulting from the Managers’ registration as an F-40 investment advisor under the Advisor’s Act, the Company and the Manager agreed to terminate the Supplemental Put Agreement. In connection with the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, on June 27, 2013, the Manager assigned 100% of the Allocation Interests to Sostratus LLC. The Company historically recorded the obligation associated with the Supplemental Put agreement as a liability that represented the amount the Company would have to pay to physically settle the purchase of the Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA. As a result of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, the Company currently records distributions of the profit allocation to the Holders upon occurrence of a Sale Event or Holding Event as dividends declared on Allocation Interests to stockholders’ equity when they are approved by the Company’s board of directors. The FOX Secondary Offering in July 2014 is considered a Sale Event and the Company's board of directors approved and declared in September 2014 a profit allocation payment totaling $11.9 million that was made to Holders on September 30, 2014. The FOX Initial Public Offering in August 2013 was considered a Sale Event and in October 2013 the Company's board of directors approved and declared a profit allocation totaling $16.0 million that was made to Holders in (cid:2)ovember 2013. Earnings per share Basic and diluted earnings per share for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2014 and 2013 is calculated as follows: (cid:2)et income attributable to Holdings Less: Profit Allocation paid to Holders Less: Effect of contribution based profit—Holding Event (cid:2)et income from Holdings attributable to Trust shares Basic and diluted weighted average shares outstanding Income from operations—Basic and fully diluted Distributions 2014 278,835 11,870 2,805 264,160 49,089 5.38 $ $ $ 2013 68,064 15,990 1,480 50,594 48,300 1.05 $ $ $ During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Company paid the following distributions: • On January 30, 2014, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of January 23, 2014. This distribution was declared on January 9, 2014. • On April 30, 2014, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of April 23, 2014. This distribution was declared on April 10, 2012. • On July 30, 2014, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of July 23, 2014. This distribution was declared on July 10, 2014. • On October 30, 2014, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of October 23, 2014. This distribution was declared on October 7, 2014. On January 29, 2015, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of January 22, 2015. This distribution was declared on January 8, 2015. During the year ended December 31, 2013, the Company paid the following distributions: • On January 31, 2013, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of January 25, 2013. This distribution was declared on January 10, 2012. • On April 30, 2013, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of April 23, 2013. This distribution was declared on April 9, 2013. • On July 30, 2013, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of July 23, 2013. This distribution was declared on July 10, 2013. • On October 30, 2013, the Company paid a distribution of $0.36 per share to holders of record as of October 23, 2013. This distribution was declared on October 10, 2013. F-41 (cid:2)ote O — (cid:2)oncontrolling Interest (cid:2)oncontrolling interest represents the portion of a majority-owned subsidiary’s net income and equity that is owned by noncontrolling shareholders. The following tables reflect the Company’s percentage ownership of its businesses, as of December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 and related noncontrolling interest balances as of December 31, 2014 and 2013: CamelBak Ergobaby FOX (2) Liberty ACI American Furniture Arnold Magnetics Clean Earth SternoCandleLamp Tridien % Ownership (1) December 31, 2014 % Ownership (1) December 31, 2013 % Ownership (1) December 31, 2012 Primary Fully Diluted Primary Fully Diluted Primary Fully Diluted 89.9 81.0 n/a 96.2 69.4 99.9 96.7 97.9 100.0 81.3 79.7 74.3 n/a 84.8 69.3 99.9 87.5 86.2 91.7 65.4 89.9 81.0 53.9 96.2 69.4 99.9 96.7 n/a n/a 81.3 79.7 75.0 49.8 84.8 69.4 99.9 87.2 n/a n/a 66.5 89.9 81.1 75.8 96.2 69.4 99.9 96.7 n/a n/a 81.3 79.7 77.1 70.6 86.7 69.4 99.9 87.9 n/a n/a 67.4 (1) The principal difference between primary and fully diluted percentages of our operating segments is due to stock option issuances of operating segment stock to management of the respective business. (2) FOX was deconsolidated on July 10, 2014 after the Company's ownership interest in FOX fell below 50%. Refer to (cid:2)ote B. (in thousands) CamelBak Ergobaby FOX Liberty ACI American Furniture Arnold Magnetics Clean Earth SternoCandleLamp Tridien Allocation Interests (cid:2)oncontrolling Interest Balances December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 $ $ 14,932 14,783 — 2,547 790 260 1,950 2,672 125 2,744 100 40,903 $ $ 13,519 12,571 64,949 2,339 (2,529) 260 1,808 — — 2,533 100 95,550 (cid:2)ote P — Commitments and Contingencies Leases The Company and its subsidiaries lease office and manufacturing facilities, computer equipment and software under various operating arrangements. Certain of the leases are subject to escalation clauses and renewal periods. The Company and its subsidiaries recognize lease expense, including predetermined fixed escalations, on a straight-line basis over the initial term of the lease including reasonably assured renewal periods from the time that the Company and its subsidiaries control the leased property. F-42 The future minimum rental commitments at December 31, 2014 under operating leases having an initial or remaining non- cancelable term of one year or more are as follows (in thousands): 2015 2016 2017 2018 2019 Thereafter $ $ 15,050 12,384 10,825 9,100 8,398 37,879 93,636 The Company’s rent expense for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 totaled $14.0 million, $12.9 million and $11.6 million, respectively. Legal Proceedings Tridien Tridien's subsidiary, AMF Support Services, Inc. ("AMF") is subject to a workers' compensation claim in the State of California, being adjudicated by the Riverside County Workers' Compensation Appeals Board. Tridien is a majority owned subsidiary of the Company. The claim is the result of an industrial accident that occurred on March 2, 2013, and the injuries sustained by a contract employee working at Tridien's Corona, California facility. The employee is seeking workers' compensation benefits from AMF, as the special employer, and the staffing company who employed the worker, as the general employer. The employee has also alleged that the employee's injuries are the result of the employer's "serious and willful misconduct", and has made a claim under California Labor Code § 4553 for damages. If proven, the "serious and willful" penalty is fixed by statute at either $0 or 50% of the value of all workers' compensation benefits paid as a result of the injury and is not insurable. The underlying workers' compensation claims are still being adjudicated. At this stage, it is not feasible to predict the outcome of or a range of loss, should a loss occur, from these proceedings. Accordingly, no amounts in respect of this matter have been provided in the Company's accompanying financial statements. The Company believes it has meritorious defenses to the allegations and will continue to vigorously defend against the claims. In the normal course of business, the Company and its subsidiaries are involved in various claims and legal proceedings. While the ultimate resolution of these matters has yet to be determined, the Company does not believe that any unfavorable outcomes will have a material adverse effect on the Company’s consolidated financial position or results of operations. (cid:2)ote Q — Supplemental Data Supplemental Balance Sheet Data (in thousands): Summary of accrued expenses: Accrued payroll and fringes Accrued taxes Income taxes payable Accrued interest Accrued rebates Warranty payable Accrued transportation and disposal costs Other accrued expenses Total F-43 December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 $ $ 17,962 2,306 2,325 1,124 10,742 2,540 9,439 16,940 63,378 $ $ 22,823 2,342 11,089 3,303 2,669 5,815 — 7,549 55,590 Warranty liability: Beginning balance Accrual Warranty payments Deconsolidation of subsidiary Ending balance Supplemental Cash Flow Statement Data (in thousands): Year ended December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 $ $ 5,815 $ 3,024 (2,420) (3,879) 2,540 $ 6,410 6,713 (7,308) — 5,815 Interest paid Taxes paid December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 December 31, 2012 $ $ 21,456 13,081 $ 16,057 17,325 19,024 14,257 (cid:2)ote R — Related Party Transactions The Company has entered into the following related party transactions with its Manager, CGM: Integration Services Agreement • Management Services Agreement • LLC Agreement • • Cost reimbursement and fees • • Sale of common stock to majority shareholder Supplemental Put Agreement (terminated in 2013 – refer to (cid:2)ote B) Management Services Agreement — The Company entered into a MSA with CGM effective May 16, 2006, as amended. The MSA provides for, among other things, CGM to perform services for the Company in exchange for a management fee paid quarterly and equal to 0.5% of the Company’s adjusted net assets, as defined in the MSA. The Company amended the MSA on (cid:2)ovember 8, 2006, to clarify that adjusted net assets are not reduced by non-cash charges associated with the Supplemental Put Agreement, which amendment was unanimously approved by the Compensation Committee and the Board of Directors. The management fee is required to be paid prior to the payment of any distributions to shareholders. Pursuant to the MSA, CGM is entitled to enter into off-setting management service agreements with each of the operating segments. The amount of the fee is negotiated between CGM and the operating management of each segment and is based upon the value of the services to be provided. The fees paid directly to CGM by the segments offset on a dollar for dollar basis the amount due CGM by the Company under the MSA. F-44 For the year ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Company incurred the following management fees to CGM, by entity (in thousands): CamelBak Ergobaby FOX Liberty Advanced Circuits American Furniture Arnold Magnetics Clean Earth SternoCandleLamp Tridien Corporate December 31, 2014 December 31, 2013 December 31, 2012 $ $ 500 500 — 500 500 — 500 125 125 350 19,622 22,722 $ $ 500 500 308 500 500 — 500 n/a n/a 350 15,474 18,632 $ $ 500 500 500 500 500 — 375 n/a n/a 350 14,408 17,633 (cid:2)OTE: (cid:2)ot included in the table above are management fees paid to CGM by HALO of $0.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2012. These amounts are included in income (loss) from discontinued operations on the consolidated statements of operations. Approximately $6.2 million and $4.5 million of the management fees incurred were unpaid as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and are reflected in Due to related party on the consolidated balance sheets. LLC Agreement The LLC agreement gives Holders the right to distributions pursuant to a profit allocation formula upon the occurrence of a Sale Event or a Holding Event. The Holders are entitled to receive and as such can elect to receive the positive contribution-based profit allocation payment for each of the business acquisitions during the 30-day period following the fifth anniversary of the date upon which we acquired a controlling interest in that business (Holding Event) and upon the sale of the business (Sale Event). During the year ended December 31, 2014, Holders were paid $11.9 million related to a secondary offering completed by FOX in July 2014 (Sale Event). During the year ended December 31, 2013, Holders were paid $5.6 million related to FOX’s positive contribution-based profit (Holding Event) and $16.0 million as a result of FOX’s sale of common stock to the public (Sale Event). Certain persons who are employees and partners of the Manager, including the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, beneficially own 58.8% of the Allocation Interests, through Sostratus LLC, at December 31, 2014. Of the remaining 41.2% non-voting ownership of the Allocation Interests, 5.0% is held by CGI Diversified Holdings LP, 5.0% is held by the Chairman of the Company’s Board of Directors, and the remaining 31.2% is held by the former founding partner of the Manager. At December 31, 2013, 53.6% of the Allocation Interests were beneficially owned by certain members of the Manager, including the Company’s Chief Executive Officer. Of the remaining 46.4% non-voting ownership of the Allocation Interests, 5.0% was held by CGI Diversified Holdings LP, 5.0% was held by the Chairman of the Company’s Board of Directors, and 31.4% was held by the former founding partner of the Manager. A Director and the former Chief Financial Officer held 5.0% of the Allocation Interests until his retirement. The increase in beneficial ownership of the Allocation Interests by certain persons who are employees and partners of the Manager from 2013 to 2014 was a result of the retirement of the former Chief Financial Officer and the resulting assignment of Allocation Interests to other persons who are employees and partners of the Manager. The former Chief Financial Officer is entitled to continue to receive distributions from Sostratus LLC on his Allocation Interests earned prior to his retirement. Integrations Services Agreements Clean Earth and SternoCandleLamp. (the "2014 acquisitions") entered into Integration Services Agreements ("ISA") with CGM. The ISA provides for CGM to provide services for the 2014 acquisitions to, amongst other things, assist the management at the F-45 acquired entities in establishing a corporate governance program, including the retention of independent board members to serve on their board of directors, implement compliance and reporting requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act and align the acquired entity's policies and procedures with our other subsidiaries. Each ISA is for the twelve month period subsequent to the acquisition and is payable quarterly. Clean Earth will pay CGM $2.5 million and SternoCandleLamp will pay CGM $1.5 million under the agreements. During the year ended December 31, 2014, Clean Earth incurred $0.6 million in integration services fees, and SternoCandleLamp incurred $0.4 million. Cost Reimbursement and Fees The Company reimbursed its Manager, CGM, approximately $4.5 million, $3.5 million and $3.1 million, principally for occupancy and staffing costs incurred by CGM on the Company’s behalf during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. CGM has entered into integration service agreements with the 2014 acquisitions for which it will receive $4.0 million during the twelve months subsequent to the completion of the acquisitions. CGM received $1.0 million in integration service fees during 2014 related to the 2014 acquisitions. The remaining amounts due under the integrations service agreements will be received quarterly during 2015 as services are performed. CGM acted as an advisor for the 2012 acquisition for which it received transaction service and expense payments totaling approximately $1.2 million. Sale of common stock to majority shareholder In connection with the acquisition of CamelBak, the Company issued 1,575,000 of its common shares in a private placement at the closing price of $12.50 per share on August 23, 2011, to CGI Maygar Holdings, LLC ("CMH"), the Company's largest shareholder. In addition, an affiliate of CMH purchased $45 million in 11% convertible preferred stock of CamelBak to facilitate the acquisition for which the affiliate received 652 shares of common stock of CamelBak. On March 6, 2012, CamelBak redeemed its 11% convertible preferred stock for $45.3 million plus accrued dividends of $2.7 million, from an affiliate of CMH ($47.7 million), and noncontrolling shareholders ($0.3 million). The redemption was funded by additional intercompany debt and an equity contribution from the Company of $19.2 million and $25.9 million, respectively. In addition, noncontrolling shareholders of CamelBak invested $2.9 million of equity in order for the Company and noncontrolling shareholders to maintain existing ownership percentages of CamelBak common stock of 89.9% and 10.1%, respectively. Supplemental Put Agreement Concurrent with the IPO, CGM and the Company entered into a Supplemental Put Agreement, which required the Company to acquire the Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA. On July 1, 2013, the Company and the Manager amended the MSA to provide for certain modifications related to the Manager’s registration as an investment adviser under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 (“Advisor’s Act”), as amended. In connection with the amendment resulting from the Manager’s registration as an investment adviser under the Adviser’s Act, the Company and the Manager agreed to terminate the Supplemental Put Agreement, which had the effect of eliminating the Manager’s right to require the Company to purchase the Allocation Interests upon termination of the MSA. On October 7, 2014 and effective as of September 30, 2014, the Company and CGM amended the MSA, as amended, to provide for certain modifications related to FOX no longer being a consolidated subsidiary. As a result of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement, the Company has derecognized the supplemental put liability associated with the Manager’s put right, reversing the entire $61.3 million liability at June 30, 2013 through supplemental put expense on the consolidated statement of operations. Pursuant to the MSA, as amended, the Manager will continue to manage the day-to-day operations and affairs of the Company, oversee the management and operations of the Company’s businesses, perform certain other services for the Company and receive management fees, and the Holders will continue to receive the profit allocation upon the occurrence of a Sale Event or a Holding Event. The Company has entered into the following significant related party transactions with its businesses: FOX On July 10, 2014, 5,750,000 shares of FOX common stock, held by certain FOX shareholders, including us, were sold in a secondary offering at a price of $15.50 per share for total net proceeds to selling shareholders of approximately $84.4 million. As a selling shareholder, we sold a total of 4,466,569 shares of FOX common stock, including 633,955 shares sold in connection with the underwriters’ exercise of the over-allotment option in full, for total net proceeds of approximately $65.5 million. Upon completion F-46 of the offering, our ownership in FOX decreased from approximately 53% to 41%, or 15,108,718 shares of FOX’s common stock. We recorded a gain of $264.3 million in July 2014 in connection with the Fox deconsolidation. Refer to (cid:2)ote B for additional information related to the FOX Secondary Offering and the deconsolidation of FOX. In September 2014, the Company and FOX entered into an agreement for the provision of services to FOX for assistance in complying the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, as amended (the “Services Agreement”). The Services Agreement can be terminated by either party at any time, or will terminate on March 31, 2016. A statement of work was agreed to in connection with the Service Agreement, which provides that the Company’s internal audit team will assist FOX with various tasks, including, but not limited to, the development of internal control policies and procedures, risk and control matrices and the evaluation of internal controls. Services provided in accordance with the Services Agreement are billed on a time and materials basis. Fees for services provided in 2014 are estimated to be approximately $50,000 and fees for services to be provided in 2015 are estimated to be approximately $100,000. On June 18, 2012, the Company recapitalized FOX and as a result entered into an amendment to the inter-company loan agreement with FOX (the “FOX Loan Agreement”). The FOX Loan Agreement was amended to (i) provide for term loan borrowings of $60.0 million and an increase to the revolving loan commitment of $2.0 million and to permit the proceeds thereof to fund cash distributions totaling $67.0 million by FOX to the Company and to its non-controlling shareholders, (ii) extend the maturity dates of the term loans under the FOX Loan Agreement, and (iii) modify borrowing rates under the FOX Loan Agreement. The Company’s share of the cash distribution was approximately $50.7 million with approximately $16.3 million being distributed to FOX’s non- controlling shareholders. All other material terms and conditions of the FOX Loan Agreement were unchanged. The outstanding inter-company loan was repaid in July 2013 with a portion of the proceeds received in connection with the FOX IPO (see (cid:2)ote C). The table below summarizes the stockholders’ equity impact as a result of the amendment to the intercompany loan agreement. Recapitalization proceeds to existing shareholders Shares purchased from noncontrolling shareholders Recapitalization proceeds to option holders Shares purchased by noncontrolling shareholders Tax benefit on options Stockholders’ equity attributable to Holdings $ $ — $ (8,544) — — — (8,544) $ (cid:2)CI Total (13,252) $ (13,252) (a) (10,969) (b) (3,036) (c) 7,204 (d) 4,954 (e) (2,425) (3,036) 7,204 4,954 (6,555) $ (15,099) (a) Represents the portion of the dividend recapitalization proceeds of $67 million allocated to noncontrolling shareholders based on their pro rata share ownership of outstanding common stock of FOX. (b) The approximately $11.0 million represents the 33,142 shares of subsidiary stock owned by noncontrolling shareholders purchased by the Company. The amount recorded to the value of Trust Shares within the consolidated statement of stockholders’ equity represents the difference between the amount by which (cid:2)CI was adjusted based on the percentage change in (cid:2)CI ownership as a result of the purchase and the fair value of the consideration paid in accordance with accounting standards applicable to changes in a parent’s ownership interest in a subsidiary. The amount recorded to (cid:2)CI represents the difference between the consideration paid and the amount recorded to Holdings’ equity. (c) Represents the portion of the dividend recapitalization proceeds of $67 million that stock option holders were allocated as a result of their pro rata share of ownership before the Company purchased the stock in (b) above. (d) Represents noncontrolling shareholders’ purchase of shares at the fair market value of the common stock on the date of recapitalization. (e) Represents the tax benefit on stock options exercised. Advanced Circuits On December 19, 2012, the Company recapitalized ACI and as a result entered into an amendment to the intercompany loan agreement with Advanced Circuits (the “ACI Loan Agreement”). The ACI Loan Agreement was amended to provide for additional term loan borrowings and to permit the proceeds thereof to fund cash distributions totaling $45.0 million by ACI to Compass AC Holdings, Inc. (“ACH”), ACI’s sole shareholder, and by ACH to its shareholders, including the Company and extend the maturity dates of the term loans under the ACI Loan Agreement. The Company’s share of the cash distribution was approximately $31.3 million with approximately $13.7 million being distributed to ACH’s non-controlling shareholders. All other material terms and conditions of the ACI Loan Agreement were unchanged. F-47 American Furniture American Furniture was not in compliance with its Maintenance Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio requirement included in the amended credit agreement with the Company dated December 31, 2010. The Company is required to fund, in the form of an additional equity investment, any shortfall in the difference between Adjusted EBITDA and Fixed Charges as defined in American Furniture’s credit agreement with the Company. Per the maintenance agreement, the shortfall that the Company is required to fund, American Furniture is in turn required to pay down its term debt with the Company. The amount of the shortfall at December 31, 2013 and December 31, 2012 was approximately $1.6 million and $3.5 million, respectively. There was no shortfall at December 31, 2014 as American Furniture was in compliance with the Maintenance Fixed Charge Coverage Ratio. Tridien On February 4, 2013, Tridien redeemed 175,000 shares of its Redeemable Preferred Stock at a redemption price of $100 per share, aggregating $17.5 million. The Company received $14.4 million of the redemption payout and non-controlling shareholders of Tridien received the remaining $3.1 million. In connection with this redemption, Tridien amended its inter-company loan agreement (the “Tridien Loan Agreement”). The Tridien Loan Agreement was amended to (i) provide for additional term loan borrowings of $16.5 million and an increase in the revolving loan commitment of $4.0 million and to permit the proceeds thereof to fund the preferred stock redemption totaling $17.5 million, (ii) extend the maturity dates of the term loans and revolving loan commitment under the Tridien Loan Agreement, and (iii) modify borrowing rates under the Tridien Loan Agreement. All other material terms and conditions of the Tridien Loan Agreement were unchanged. Tridien leased a facility from an affiliate of a noncontrolling shareholder of Tridien during the year ended December 31, 2014. The term of the lease was through February of 2014. Tridien paid rent under the lease of approximately $0.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2014. On August 28, 2012, the Company purchased shares of stock of Tridien from a group of Tridien’s noncontrolling shareholders for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $1.9 million. On August 8, 2008, the Company exchanged a note due August 15, 2008, totaling approximately $6.9 million (including accrued interest) due from Mark Bidner, the former CEO of Tridien in exchange for shares of common stock of Tridien held by Mr. Bidner. In addition, Mr. Bidner was granted an option to purchase approximately 10% of the outstanding shares of common stock of Tridien, at a strike price exceeding the exchange price, from the Company in the future for which Mr. Bidner exchanged Tridien common stock valued at $0.2 million (the fair value of the option at the date of grant) as consideration. (cid:2)ote S – Unaudited Quarterly Financial Data The following table presents the unaudited quarterly financial data. This information has been prepared on a basis consistent with that of the audited consolidated financial statements and all necessary material adjustments, consisting of normal recurring accruals and adjustments, have been included to present fairly the unaudited quarterly financial data. The quarterly results of operations for these periods are not necessarily indicative of future results of operations. The per share calculations for each of the quarters are based on the weighted average number of shares for each period; therefore, the sum of the quarters may not necessarily be equal to the full year per share amount. F-48 (in thousands) Total revenues Gross profit Operating income Income (loss) from continuing operations (cid:2)et income (loss) attributable to Holdings Basic and fully diluted income (loss) per share attributable to Holdings December 31, 2014 (1) September 30, 2014 (2) June 30, 2014 (3) March 31, 2014 $ 264,028 $ 203,140 $ 269,084 $ 246,048 72,725 6,082 8,933 7,359 62,050 9,720 262,530 261,098 82,542 21,761 12,319 5,719 76,352 18,095 7,373 4,659 $ 0.13 $ 5.15 $ 0.11 $ 0.08 (1) During the three months ended December 31, 2014, the Company acquired SternoCandleLamp for a purchase price of approximately $160.0 million - refer to "(cid:2)ote C - Acquisition of Businesses". Additionally, the Company completed a secondary offering of 6,000,000 Trust Shares at an offering price of $17.50 per share, resulting in net proceeds of $99.9 million. (2) During the three months ended September 30, 2014, the Company sold 4,466,569 shares of FOX common stock, and received net proceeds from the sale of approximately $65.5 million. As a result of the sale of the shares by the Company in the FOX Secondary Offering, the Company's ownership interest in FOX decreased to approximately 41%, which resulted in the deconsolidation of the FOX operating segment in the Company's consolidated financial statements effective as of the date of the FOX Secondary Offering - refer to "(cid:2)ote B - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies". Additionally, the Company closed on the acquisition of all the issued and outstanding capital stock of Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. for a purchase price of approximately $251.4 million - refer to "(cid:2)ote C- Acquisition of Businesses". (3) During the three months ended June 30, 2014, the Company obtained a $725 million credit facility from a group of lenders - refer to "(cid:2)ote J - Debt". (in thousands) Total revenues Gross profit Operating income (loss) Income (loss) from continuing operations (cid:2)et income (loss) attributable to Holdings Basic and fully diluted income (loss ) per share attributable to Holdings December 31, 2013 (1) September 30, 2013 (2) June 30, 2013 (3) March 31, 2013 $ $ $ 232,685 69,629 $ 265,512 82,472 2,306 (5,062) (6,348) 89,105 78,296 73,387 $ 245,775 77,357 14,673 1,956 (569) (0.47) $ 1.52 $ (0.01) $ 241,567 76,373 16,822 3,626 1,594 0.03 (1) The three months ended December 31, 2013 includes an impairment loss of $12.0 million related to the goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible asset write off at the Company’s Tridien operating segment. Refer to "(cid:2)ote H - Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets" for a description of the impairment loss. (2) The three months ended September 30, 2013 includes income of approximately $61.3 million related to the reversal of the Supplemental Put Liability as a result of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement on July 1, 2013. Refer to "(cid:2)ote B - Summary of Significant Accounting Policies" for a description of the termination of the Supplemental Put Agreement. (3) The three months ended June 30, 2013 includes (i) an impairment loss of $0.9 million related to the indefinite-lived intangible asset write- off at the Company’s Tridien operating segment and (ii) a loss on debt extinguishment of $1.8 million related to an amendment to the Company’s 2011 Term Loan Facility. F-49 SCHEDULE II – Valuation and Qualifying Accounts Balance at Additions beginning of year Charge to costs and expense (in thousands) Allowance for doubtful accounts - 2012 Allowance for doubtful accounts - 2013 Allowance for doubtful accounts - 2014 Valuation allowance for deferred tax assets - 2012 Valuation allowance for deferred tax assets - 2013 Valuation allowance for deferred tax assets - 2014 $ $ $ $ $ $ 2,420 3,049 3,424 6,269 8,912 12,028 $ $ $ $ $ $ Other (1) 365 Deductions 1,532 $ Balance at end of Year 3,049 $ 1,796 $ 2,475 $ — 3,510 $ 494 1,293 $ 1,350 3,116 $ — 388 $ 248 $ $ $ $ $ 2,100 2,228 $ $ — $ 3,424 5,200 8,912 — $ 12,028 — $ 12,664 (1) Represents opening allowance balances related to current year acquisitions, and the ending allowance for FOX, which was deducted as a result of the deconsolidation of the FOX subsidiary during 2014 . S-1 Exhibit (cid:2)umber 2.1 2.2 2.3 2.4 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 3.9 3.1 3.11 4.1 4.2 I(cid:2)DEX TO EXHIBITS Description Stock and (cid:2)ote Purchase Agreement dated as of July 31, 2006, among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Group Investments, Inc. and Compass Medical Mattress Partners, LP (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated June 24, 2008, among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and the other shareholders party thereto, Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sellers’ Representative, Aeroglide Holdings, Inc. and Bühler AG (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on June 26, 2008 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement, dated October 17, 2011, by and among Recruit Co., LTD. and RGF Staffing USA, Inc., as Buyers, the shareholders of Staffmark Holdings, Inc., as Sellers, Staffmark Holdings, Inc. and Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC as Seller Representative (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on October 18, 2011 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated May 1, 2012, among Candlelight Investment Holdings, Inc., Halo Holding Corporation, Halo Lee Wayne, LLC and each of the holders of equity interests of Halo Lee Wayne, LLC listed on Exhibit A thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 2, 2012(File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Certificate of Trust of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form S-1 filed on December 14, 2005 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Certificate of Amendment to Certificate of Trust of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 8-K filed on September 13, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Certificate of Formation of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.3 of the Form S-1 filed on December 14, 2005 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Amended and Restated Trust Agreement of Compass Diversified Trust (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.5 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 4 to the Form S-1 filed on April 26, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Amendment (cid:2)o. 1 to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006, of Compass Diversified Trust among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of (cid:2)ew York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 29, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Second Amendment to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, dated as of April 25, 2006, as amended on May 23, 2007, of Compass Diversified Trust among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of (cid:2)ew York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Form 8-K filed on September 13, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Third Amendment to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement dated as of April 25, 2006, as amended on May 25, 2007 and September 14, 2007, of Compass Diversified Holdings among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of (cid:2)ew York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Form 8-K filed on December 21, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Fourth Amendment dated as of (cid:2)ovember 1, 2010 to the Amended and Restated Trust Agreement, as amended effective (cid:2)ovember 1, 2010, of Compass Diversified Holdings, originally effective as of April 25, 2006, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, as Sponsor, The Bank of (cid:2)ew York (Delaware), as Delaware Trustee, and the Regular Trustees named therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 10-Q filed on (cid:2)ovember 8, 2010 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Second Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC dated January 9, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on January 10, 2007,(File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Third Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings, LLC dated (cid:2)ovember 1, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Form 10-Q filed on (cid:2)ovember 8, 2010 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Fourth Amended and Restated Operating Agreement of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, dated January 1, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Form 10-Q filed on May 7, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Specimen Certificate evidencing a share of trust of Compass Diversified Holdings (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Form S-3 filed on (cid:2)ovember 7, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 333-147218)). Specimen LLC Interest Certificate evidencing an interest of Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit A of Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on January 10, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). E-1 10.1 10.2 10.3† 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10.8 10.9 10.1 10.11 10.12 10.13 10.14 10.15 10.16 10.17 10.18 10.19† Form of Registration Rights Agreement by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and Certain Shareholders (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 5 to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Form of Supplemental Put Agreement by and between Compass Group Management LLC and Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 4 to the Form S-1 filed on April 26, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated as of December 1, 2008 by and between James J. Bottiglieri and Compass Group Management LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K filed on December 3, 2008 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Form of Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 5 to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Form of Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and Pharos I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 5 to the Form S-1 filed on May 5, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 333-130326)). Amended and Restated Management Services Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC, dated as of December 20, 2011 and originally effective as of May 16, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.06 of the Form 10-K filed on March 7, 2012 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Registration Rights Agreement by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP, dated as of April 3, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 1 to the Form S-1 filed on April 20, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 333-141856)). Share Purchase Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Trust and CGI Diversified Holdings, LP, dated as of April 3, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.16 of the Amendment (cid:2)o. 1 to the Form S-1 filed on April 20, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 333-141856)). Subscription Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Holdings and CGI Magyar Holdings, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011(File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Registration Rights Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Diversified Holdings and CGI Magyar Holdings, LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011(File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Credit Agreement dated as of October 27, 2011, by and among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, the financial institutions party thereto and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on October 27, 2011(File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Second Amendment to Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, the financial institutions party thereto and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC, dated as of April 2, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on April 3, 2012(File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Incremental Facility Amendment to Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC, dated as of April 2, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Form 8-K filed on April 3, 2012 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Third Amendment to Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC dated as of April 3, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Form 8-K filed on April 3, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 0001-34927)). Incremental Facility Amendment to Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC and Toronto Dominion (Texas) LLC, dated as of April 3, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Form 8-K filed on April 3, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Credit Agreement among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, the financial institutions party thereto and Bank of America, (cid:2).A., dated as of June 6, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the 8-K filed on June 9, 2014 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Fifth Amended and Restated Management Services Agreement dated July 1, 2013 and originally effective as of May 16, 2006, by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on July 1, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Sixth Amended and Restated Management Service Agreement by and between Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and Compass Group Management LLC, dated as of September 30, 2014 and originally effective as of May 16, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on October 7, 2014 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Employment Agreement dated July 11, 2013, between Compass Group Management LLC and Ryan J. Faulkingham (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Form 8-K filed on July 11, 2013 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). 21.1* List of Subsidiaries E-2 23.1* 31.1* 31.2* 32.1*+ 32.2*+ 99.1 99.2 99.3 99.4 99.5 99.6 99.7 99.8 99.9 99.1 99.11 Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of Chief Executive Officer of Registrant Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a) Certification of Chief Financial Officer of Registrant Section 1350 Certification of Chief Executive Officer of Registrant Section 1350 Certification of Chief Financial Officer of Registrant (cid:2)ote Purchase and Sale Agreement dated as of July 31, 2006 among Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, Compass Group Investments, Inc. and Compass Medical Mattress Partners, LP (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 1, 2006 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement, dated as of February 28, 2007, by and between HA-LO Holdings, LLC and HALO Holding Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.3 of the Form 8-K filed on March 1, 2007(File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Purchase Agreement dated December 19, 2007, among CBS Personnel Holdings, Inc. and Staffing Holding LLC, Staffmark Merger LLC, Staffmark Investment LLC, SF Holding Corp., Stephens-SM LLC and CBS Personnel Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on December 20, 2007 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Share Purchase Agreement dated January 4, 2008, among Fox Factory Holding Corp., Fox Factory, Inc. and Robert C. Fox, Jr. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on January 8, 2008 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated May 8, 2008, among Mitsui Chemicals, Inc., Silvue Technologies Group, Inc., the stockholders of Silvue Technologies Group, Inc. and the holders of Options listed on the signature pages thereto, and Compass Group Management LLC, as the Stockholders Representative (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on May 9, 2008(File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated March 31, 2010 by and among Gable 5, Inc., Liberty Safe and Security Products, LLC and Liberty Safe Holding Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8- K filed on April 1, 2010 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated September 16, 2010, by and among ERGO Baby Intermediate Holding Corporation, The ERGO Baby Carrier, Inc., Karin A. Frost, in her individual capacity and as Trustee of the Revocable Trust of Karin A. Frost dated February 22, 2008 and as Trustee of the Karin A. Frost 2009 Qualified Annuity Trust u/a/d 12/21/2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on September 17, 2010 (File (cid:2)o. 000-51937)). Securities Purchase Agreement dated August 24, 2011, by and among CBK Holdings, LLC, CamelBak Products, LLC, CamelBak Acquisition Corp., for purposes of Section 6.15 and Articles 10 only, Compass Group Diversified Holdings LLC, and for purposes of Section 6.13 and Article 10 only, IPC/CamelBak LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on August 25, 2011(File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of March 5, 2012, by and among Arnold Magnetic Technologies Holdings Corporation, Arnold Magnetic Technologies, LLC and AMT Acquisition Corp. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed on March 6, 2012 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Stock Purchase Agreement dated as of August 7, 2014, by and among CEHI Acquisition Corporation, Clean Earth Holdings, Inc., the holders of stock and options in Clean Earth Holdings, Inc. and Littlejohn Fund III, L.P. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the 8-K filed on August 11, 2014 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). Membership Interest Purchase Agreement dated as of October 10, 2014, by and among Candle Lamp Holdings, LLC, Candle Lamp Company, LLC and Sternocandlelamp Holdings, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of the Form 8-K filed October 10, 2014 (File (cid:2)o. 001-34927)). 101.I(cid:2)S* XBRL Instance Document 101.SCH* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document 101.CAL* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document 101.DEF* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document 101.LAB* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document 101.PRE* XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document E-3 * † + Filed herewith. Denotes management contracts and compensatory plans or arrangements. In accordance with Item 601(b)(32)(ii) of Regulation S-K and SEC Release (cid:2)os. 33-8238 and 34-47986, Final Rule: Management's Reports on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting and Certification of Disclosure in Exchange Act Periodic Reports, the certifications furnished in Exhibit 32.1 and 32.2 hereto are deemed to accompany this Form 10-K and will not be deemed “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act. Such certifications will not be deemed to be incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, except to the extent that the registrant specifically incorporates it by reference. E-4 COMPANY HEADQUARTERS 61 WILTON ROAD, SECOND FLOOR WESTPORT, CT 06880, (203) 221-1703 INDEPENDENT AUDITORS GRANT THORNTON LLP, NEW YORK, NY COMMON STOCK LISTING NYSE TICKER: CODI TRANSFER AGENT BROADRIDGE CORPORATE ISSUER SOLUTIONS P.O. BOX 1342 BRENTWOOD, NY 11717 INVESTOR RELATIONS CONTACT LEON BERMAN, THE IGB GROUP (212) 477-8438, LBERMAN@IGBIR.COM ANNUAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS MAY 27, 2015, 9:00 A.M., EST DELAMAR SOUTHPORT 275 OLD POST ROAD, SOUTHPORT, CONNECTICUT 06890 WEBSITE WWW.COMPASSDIVERSIFIEDHOLDINGS.COM CODI 14 EXECUTING OUR STRATEGY COMPASS DIVERSIFIED HOLDINGS 61 WILTON ROAD • WESTPORT, CT 06880 WWW.COMPASSDIVERSIFIEDHOLDINGS.COM
Continue reading text version or see original annual report in PDF format above